Remove assert in get_def_bb_for_const
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
blobb0173f7a5ce73099f22bc9394cef6251eda7c5ce
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
4 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
5 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
7 This file is part of GCC.
9 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
10 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
11 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
12 version.
14 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
15 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
16 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
17 for more details.
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
21 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
23 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
24 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
25 out locations for types and decls.
26 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
27 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
29 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
30 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
31 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
32 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
33 information. */
35 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
37 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
38 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
39 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
40 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
41 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
43 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
44 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
46 CIE = Common Information Entry
47 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
49 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
51 FDE = Frame Description Entry
52 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
53 how to restore registers
55 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
56 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
58 #include "config.h"
59 #include "system.h"
60 #include "coretypes.h"
61 #include "target.h"
62 #include "function.h"
63 #include "rtl.h"
64 #include "tree.h"
65 #include "tm_p.h"
66 #include "stringpool.h"
67 #include "insn-config.h"
68 #include "ira.h"
69 #include "cgraph.h"
70 #include "diagnostic.h"
71 #include "fold-const.h"
72 #include "stor-layout.h"
73 #include "varasm.h"
74 #include "version.h"
75 #include "flags.h"
76 #include "rtlhash.h"
77 #include "reload.h"
78 #include "output.h"
79 #include "expr.h"
80 #include "dwarf2out.h"
81 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
82 #include "toplev.h"
83 #include "md5.h"
84 #include "tree-pretty-print.h"
85 #include "debug.h"
86 #include "common/common-target.h"
87 #include "langhooks.h"
88 #include "lra.h"
89 #include "dumpfile.h"
90 #include "opts.h"
91 #include "tree-dfa.h"
92 #include "gdb/gdb-index.h"
93 #include "rtl-iter.h"
95 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *, int, bool);
96 static rtx_insn *last_var_location_insn;
97 static rtx_insn *cached_next_real_insn;
98 static void dwarf2out_decl (tree);
100 #ifndef XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
101 #define XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO 0
102 #endif
104 #ifndef HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS
105 #define HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS 0
106 #endif
108 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
109 int vms_file_stats_name (const char *, long long *, long *, char *, int *);
111 /* Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the directory specifications
112 which are output in the debug info should end with a separator. */
113 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 1
114 /* Define this macro to evaluate to a nonzero value if GCC should refrain
115 from generating indirect strings in DWARF2 debug information, for instance
116 if your target is stuck with an old version of GDB that is unable to
117 process them properly or uses VMS Debug. */
118 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 1
119 #else
120 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 0
121 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 0
122 #endif
124 /* ??? Poison these here until it can be done generically. They've been
125 totally replaced in this file; make sure it stays that way. */
126 #undef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
127 #undef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
128 #if (GCC_VERSION >= 3000)
129 #pragma GCC poison DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
130 #endif
132 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
133 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
134 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
135 #endif
137 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
138 must be kept around forever. */
139 static GTY(()) vec<rtx, va_gc> *used_rtx_array;
141 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
142 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
143 vec<tree, va_gc> *because we want to tell the garbage collector about
144 it. */
145 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *incomplete_types;
147 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
148 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
149 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
150 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
151 define type declaration DIE's. */
152 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *decl_scope_table;
154 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
155 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
156 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_info_section;
157 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
158 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_abbrev_section;
159 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
160 static GTY(()) section *debug_addr_section;
161 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
162 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
163 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_line_section;
164 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
165 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
166 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubtypes_section;
167 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
168 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_dwo_section;
169 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_offsets_section;
170 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
171 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
173 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
174 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
176 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
177 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
178 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
179 bytes.
181 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
182 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
184 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
185 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
186 #endif
188 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
189 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
190 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
192 /* CIE identifier. */
193 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
194 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
195 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
196 #else
197 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
198 #endif
201 /* A vector for a table that contains frame description
202 information for each routine. */
203 #define NOT_INDEXED (-1U)
204 #define NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED (-2U)
206 static GTY(()) vec<dw_fde_ref, va_gc> *fde_vec;
208 struct GTY((for_user)) indirect_string_node {
209 const char *str;
210 unsigned int refcount;
211 enum dwarf_form form;
212 char *label;
213 unsigned int index;
216 struct indirect_string_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<indirect_string_node>
218 typedef const char *compare_type;
220 static hashval_t hash (indirect_string_node *);
221 static bool equal (indirect_string_node *, const char *);
224 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *debug_str_hash;
226 /* With split_debug_info, both the comp_dir and dwo_name go in the
227 main object file, rather than the dwo, similar to the force_direct
228 parameter elsewhere but with additional complications:
230 1) The string is needed in both the main object file and the dwo.
231 That is, the comp_dir and dwo_name will appear in both places.
233 2) Strings can use three forms: DW_FORM_string, DW_FORM_strp or
234 DW_FORM_GNU_str_index.
236 3) GCC chooses the form to use late, depending on the size and
237 reference count.
239 Rather than forcing the all debug string handling functions and
240 callers to deal with these complications, simply use a separate,
241 special-cased string table for any attribute that should go in the
242 main object file. This limits the complexity to just the places
243 that need it. */
245 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *skeleton_debug_str_hash;
247 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
249 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
250 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
252 /* Whether the default text and cold text sections have been used at all. */
254 static GTY(()) bool text_section_used = false;
255 static GTY(()) bool cold_text_section_used = false;
257 /* The default cold text section. */
258 static GTY(()) section *cold_text_section;
260 /* The DIE for C++14 'auto' in a function return type. */
261 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref auto_die;
263 /* The DIE for C++14 'decltype(auto)' in a function return type. */
264 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref decltype_auto_die;
266 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
268 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
269 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
270 static void dwarf2out_note_section_used (void);
272 /* Personality decl of current unit. Used only when assembler does not support
273 personality CFI. */
274 static GTY(()) rtx current_unit_personality;
276 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
277 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
278 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
280 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
281 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
282 #endif
284 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
285 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
286 #endif
288 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
289 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
290 #endif
292 #ifndef PROLOGUE_END_LABEL
293 #define PROLOGUE_END_LABEL "LPE"
294 #endif
296 #ifndef EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL
297 #define EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL "LEB"
298 #endif
300 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
301 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
302 #endif
303 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
304 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
305 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
306 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
307 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
308 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
309 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
310 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
311 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
312 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
314 /* Match the base name of a file to the base name of a compilation unit. */
316 static int
317 matches_main_base (const char *path)
319 /* Cache the last query. */
320 static const char *last_path = NULL;
321 static int last_match = 0;
322 if (path != last_path)
324 const char *base;
325 int length = base_of_path (path, &base);
326 last_path = path;
327 last_match = (length == main_input_baselength
328 && memcmp (base, main_input_basename, length) == 0);
330 return last_match;
333 #ifdef DEBUG_DEBUG_STRUCT
335 static int
336 dump_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage,
337 enum debug_struct_file criterion, int generic,
338 int matches, int result)
340 /* Find the type name. */
341 tree type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (type);
342 tree t = type_decl;
343 const char *name = 0;
344 if (TREE_CODE (t) == TYPE_DECL)
345 t = DECL_NAME (t);
346 if (t)
347 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
349 fprintf (stderr, " struct %d %s %s %s %s %d %p %s\n",
350 criterion,
351 DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl) ? "sys" : "usr",
352 matches ? "bas" : "hdr",
353 generic ? "gen" : "ord",
354 usage == DINFO_USAGE_DFN ? ";" :
355 usage == DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE ? "." : "*",
356 result,
357 (void*) type_decl, name);
358 return result;
360 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
361 dump_struct_debug (type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result)
363 #else
365 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
366 (result)
368 #endif
370 /* Get the number of HOST_WIDE_INTs needed to represent the precision
371 of the number. Some constants have a large uniform precision, so
372 we get the precision needed for the actual value of the number. */
374 static unsigned int
375 get_full_len (const wide_int &op)
377 int prec = wi::min_precision (op, UNSIGNED);
378 return ((prec + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 1)
379 / HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
382 static bool
383 should_emit_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage)
385 enum debug_struct_file criterion;
386 tree type_decl;
387 bool generic = lang_hooks.types.generic_p (type);
389 if (generic)
390 criterion = debug_struct_generic[usage];
391 else
392 criterion = debug_struct_ordinary[usage];
394 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_NONE)
395 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
396 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_ANY)
397 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
399 type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type));
401 if (type_decl != NULL)
403 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_SYS && DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl))
404 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
406 if (matches_main_base (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (type_decl)))
407 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, true, true);
410 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
413 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
414 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
416 static inline char *
417 stripattributes (const char *s)
419 char *stripped = XNEWVEC (char, strlen (s) + 2);
420 char *p = stripped;
422 *p++ = '*';
424 while (*s && *s != ',')
425 *p++ = *s++;
427 *p = '\0';
428 return stripped;
431 /* Switch [BACK] to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
432 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic start label
433 for collect2 the first time around. */
435 static void
436 switch_to_eh_frame_section (bool back ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
438 if (eh_frame_section == 0)
440 int flags;
442 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
444 int fde_encoding;
445 int per_encoding;
446 int lsda_encoding;
448 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
449 /*global=*/0);
450 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
451 /*global=*/1);
452 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
453 /*global=*/0);
454 flags = ((! flag_pic
455 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
456 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
457 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
458 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
459 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
460 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
461 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
463 else
464 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
466 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
467 eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
468 #else
469 eh_frame_section = ((flags == SECTION_WRITE)
470 ? data_section : readonly_data_section);
471 #endif /* EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME */
474 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
476 #ifdef EH_FRAME_THROUGH_COLLECT2
477 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Emit special labels to guide
478 collect2. */
479 if (!back)
481 tree label = get_file_function_name ("F");
482 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
483 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
484 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
485 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
487 #endif
490 /* Switch [BACK] to the eh or debug frame table section, depending on
491 FOR_EH. */
493 static void
494 switch_to_frame_table_section (int for_eh, bool back)
496 if (for_eh)
497 switch_to_eh_frame_section (back);
498 else
500 if (!debug_frame_section)
501 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
502 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
503 switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
507 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
509 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
510 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
512 switch (cfi)
514 case DW_CFA_nop:
515 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
516 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
517 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
518 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
520 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
521 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
522 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
523 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
524 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
525 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
527 case DW_CFA_offset:
528 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
529 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
530 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
531 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
532 case DW_CFA_restore:
533 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
534 case DW_CFA_undefined:
535 case DW_CFA_same_value:
536 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
537 case DW_CFA_register:
538 case DW_CFA_expression:
539 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
541 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
542 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
543 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
544 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
546 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
547 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
549 default:
550 gcc_unreachable ();
554 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
556 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
557 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
559 switch (cfi)
561 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
562 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
563 case DW_CFA_offset:
564 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
565 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
566 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
568 case DW_CFA_register:
569 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
571 case DW_CFA_expression:
572 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
574 default:
575 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
579 /* Output one FDE. */
581 static void
582 output_fde (dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh, bool second,
583 char *section_start_label, int fde_encoding, char *augmentation,
584 bool any_lsda_needed, int lsda_encoding)
586 const char *begin, *end;
587 static unsigned int j;
588 char l1[20], l2[20];
590 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh,
591 /* empty */ 0);
592 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL,
593 for_eh + j);
594 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + j);
595 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + j);
596 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || for_eh)
598 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
599 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff, "Initial length escape value"
600 " indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
601 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
602 "FDE Length");
604 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
606 if (for_eh)
607 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
608 else
609 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
610 debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
612 begin = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_begin : fde->dw_fde_begin;
613 end = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end;
615 if (for_eh)
617 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, begin);
618 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
619 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref, false,
620 "FDE initial location");
621 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
622 end, begin, "FDE address range");
624 else
626 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, begin, "FDE initial location");
627 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, end, begin, "FDE address range");
630 if (augmentation[0])
632 if (any_lsda_needed)
634 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
636 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
638 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
639 + 4 /* CIE offset */
640 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
641 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
642 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
644 size += pad;
645 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
648 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
650 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
652 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
653 fde->funcdef_number);
654 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (lsda_encoding,
655 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
656 false,
657 "Language Specific Data Area");
659 else
661 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
662 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
663 dw2_asm_output_data (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
664 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
667 else
668 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
671 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with this FDE. */
672 fde->dw_fde_current_label = begin;
674 size_t from, until, i;
676 from = 0;
677 until = vec_safe_length (fde->dw_fde_cfi);
679 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
681 else if (!second)
682 until = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index;
683 else
684 from = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index;
686 for (i = from; i < until; i++)
687 output_cfi ((*fde->dw_fde_cfi)[i], fde, for_eh);
690 /* If we are to emit a ref/link from function bodies to their frame tables,
691 do it now. This is typically performed to make sure that tables
692 associated with functions are dragged with them and not discarded in
693 garbage collecting links. We need to do this on a per function basis to
694 cope with -ffunction-sections. */
696 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF
697 /* Switch to the function section, emit the ref to the tables, and
698 switch *back* into the table section. */
699 switch_to_section (function_section (fde->decl));
700 ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (section_start_label);
701 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, true);
702 #endif
704 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
705 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
706 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
707 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
709 j += 2;
712 /* Return true if frame description entry FDE is needed for EH. */
714 static bool
715 fde_needed_for_eh_p (dw_fde_ref fde)
717 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
718 return true;
720 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde->decl))
721 return true;
723 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
724 return true;
726 /* If exceptions are enabled, we have collected nothrow info. */
727 if (flag_exceptions && (fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls || fde->nothrow))
728 return false;
730 return true;
733 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
734 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
735 location of saved registers. */
737 static void
738 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
740 unsigned int i;
741 dw_fde_ref fde;
742 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
743 char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
744 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
745 char augmentation[6];
746 int augmentation_size;
747 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
748 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
749 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
750 int return_reg;
751 rtx personality = NULL;
752 int dw_cie_version;
754 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
755 if (!fde_vec)
756 return;
758 /* Nothing to do if the assembler's doing it all. */
759 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
760 return;
762 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't emit
763 any EH unwind information. If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to
764 emit an empty label for an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We
765 want to avoid having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to
766 is discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function template
767 in C++ requires EH information, an explicit specialization doesn't. */
768 if (for_eh)
770 bool any_eh_needed = false;
772 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, i, fde)
774 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
775 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
776 else if (fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
777 any_eh_needed = true;
778 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO)
779 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, 1, 1);
782 if (!any_eh_needed)
783 return;
786 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
787 if (flag_debug_asm)
788 app_enable ();
790 /* Switch to the proper frame section, first time. */
791 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, false);
793 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
794 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
796 /* Output the CIE. */
797 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
798 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
799 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || for_eh)
801 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
802 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
803 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
804 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
805 "Length of Common Information Entry");
807 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
809 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
810 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
811 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
812 (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
813 "CIE Identifier Tag");
815 /* Use the CIE version 3 for DWARF3; allow DWARF2 to continue to
816 use CIE version 1, unless that would produce incorrect results
817 due to overflowing the return register column. */
818 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
819 dw_cie_version = 1;
820 if (return_reg >= 256 || dwarf_version > 2)
821 dw_cie_version = 3;
822 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dw_cie_version, "CIE Version");
824 augmentation[0] = 0;
825 augmentation_size = 0;
827 personality = current_unit_personality;
828 if (for_eh)
830 char *p;
832 /* Augmentation:
833 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
834 augmentation section.
835 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
836 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
837 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
838 FDE code pointers.
839 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
840 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
842 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
843 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
844 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
846 p = augmentation + 1;
847 if (personality)
849 *p++ = 'P';
850 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
851 assemble_external_libcall (personality);
853 if (any_lsda_needed)
855 *p++ = 'L';
856 augmentation_size += 1;
858 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
860 *p++ = 'R';
861 augmentation_size += 1;
863 if (p > augmentation + 1)
865 augmentation[0] = 'z';
866 *p = '\0';
869 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
870 if (personality && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
872 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
873 + 4 /* CIE Id */
874 + 1 /* CIE version */
875 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
876 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
877 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
878 + 1 /* RA column */
879 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
880 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
881 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
883 augmentation_size += pad;
885 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
886 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
887 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
891 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
892 if (dw_cie_version >= 4)
894 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "CIE Address Size");
895 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "CIE Segment Size");
897 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
898 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
899 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
901 if (dw_cie_version == 1)
902 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
903 else
904 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
906 if (augmentation[0])
908 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
909 if (personality)
911 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
912 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
913 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
914 personality,
915 true, NULL);
918 if (any_lsda_needed)
919 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
920 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
922 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
923 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
924 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
927 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*cie_cfi_vec, i, cfi)
928 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
930 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
931 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
932 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
933 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
935 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
936 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, i, fde)
938 unsigned int k;
940 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
941 if (for_eh && !fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
942 continue;
944 for (k = 0; k < (fde->dw_fde_second_begin ? 2 : 1); k++)
945 output_fde (fde, for_eh, k, section_start_label, fde_encoding,
946 augmentation, any_lsda_needed, lsda_encoding);
949 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
950 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
952 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
953 if (flag_debug_asm)
954 app_disable ();
957 /* Emit .cfi_startproc and .cfi_personality/.cfi_lsda if needed. */
959 static void
960 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (bool second)
962 int enc;
963 rtx ref;
964 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
966 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_startproc\n");
968 if (personality)
970 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
971 ref = personality;
973 /* ??? The GAS support isn't entirely consistent. We have to
974 handle indirect support ourselves, but PC-relative is done
975 in the assembler. Further, the assembler can't handle any
976 of the weirder relocation types. */
977 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
978 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
980 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_personality %#x,", enc);
981 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
982 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
985 if (crtl->uses_eh_lsda)
987 char lab[20];
989 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
990 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (lab, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
991 current_function_funcdef_no);
992 ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, lab);
993 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (ref) = SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
995 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
996 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
998 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_lsda %#x,", enc);
999 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
1000 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1004 /* Allocate CURRENT_FDE. Immediately initialize all we can, noting that
1005 this allocation may be done before pass_final. */
1007 dw_fde_ref
1008 dwarf2out_alloc_current_fde (void)
1010 dw_fde_ref fde;
1012 fde = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_fde_node> ();
1013 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
1014 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
1015 fde->fde_index = vec_safe_length (fde_vec);
1016 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = crtl->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
1017 fde->uses_eh_lsda = crtl->uses_eh_lsda;
1018 fde->nothrow = crtl->nothrow;
1019 fde->drap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1020 fde->vdrap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1022 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
1023 cfun->fde = fde;
1024 vec_safe_push (fde_vec, fde);
1026 return fde;
1029 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
1030 the prologue. */
1032 void
1033 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1034 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1036 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1037 char * dup_label;
1038 dw_fde_ref fde;
1039 section *fnsec;
1040 bool do_frame;
1042 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
1044 do_frame = dwarf2out_do_frame ();
1046 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c for
1047 call-site information. We must emit this label if it might be used. */
1048 if (!do_frame
1049 && (!flag_exceptions
1050 || targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) == UI_SJLJ))
1051 return;
1053 fnsec = function_section (current_function_decl);
1054 switch_to_section (fnsec);
1055 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
1056 current_function_funcdef_no);
1057 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
1058 current_function_funcdef_no);
1059 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
1060 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
1062 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
1063 if (!do_frame)
1064 return;
1066 /* Cater to the various TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK implementations that
1067 emit insns as rtx but bypass the bulk of rest_of_compilation, which
1068 would include pass_dwarf2_frame. If we've not created the FDE yet,
1069 do so now. */
1070 fde = cfun->fde;
1071 if (fde == NULL)
1072 fde = dwarf2out_alloc_current_fde ();
1074 /* Initialize the bits of CURRENT_FDE that were not available earlier. */
1075 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
1076 fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
1077 fde->in_std_section = (fnsec == text_section
1078 || (cold_text_section && fnsec == cold_text_section));
1080 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
1081 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
1082 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
1083 if (file)
1084 dwarf2out_source_line (line, file, 0, true);
1085 #endif
1087 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1088 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (false);
1089 else
1091 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
1092 if (!current_unit_personality)
1093 current_unit_personality = personality;
1095 /* We cannot keep a current personality per function as without CFI
1096 asm, at the point where we emit the CFI data, there is no current
1097 function anymore. */
1098 if (personality && current_unit_personality != personality)
1099 sorry ("multiple EH personalities are supported only with assemblers "
1100 "supporting .cfi_personality directive");
1104 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code
1105 for a function prologue. This gets called *after* the prologue code has
1106 been generated. */
1108 void
1109 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1110 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1112 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1114 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1115 function. */
1116 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
1117 current_function_funcdef_no);
1118 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
1119 current_function_funcdef_no);
1120 cfun->fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue = xstrdup (label);
1123 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code
1124 for a function epilogue. This gets called *before* the prologue code has
1125 been generated. */
1127 void
1128 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1129 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1131 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
1132 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1134 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
1135 return;
1137 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1138 function. */
1139 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
1140 current_function_funcdef_no);
1141 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
1142 current_function_funcdef_no);
1143 fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue = xstrdup (label);
1146 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
1147 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
1148 been generated. */
1150 void
1151 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1152 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1154 dw_fde_ref fde;
1155 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1157 last_var_location_insn = NULL;
1158 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
1160 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1161 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
1163 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1164 function. */
1165 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
1166 current_function_funcdef_no);
1167 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
1168 fde = cfun->fde;
1169 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
1170 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
1171 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
1174 void
1175 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
1177 /* Output call frame information. */
1178 if (targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
1179 output_call_frame_info (0);
1181 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
1182 if ((flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions)
1183 && targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) == UI_DWARF2)
1184 output_call_frame_info (1);
1187 /* Note that the current function section is being used for code. */
1189 static void
1190 dwarf2out_note_section_used (void)
1192 section *sec = current_function_section ();
1193 if (sec == text_section)
1194 text_section_used = true;
1195 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
1196 cold_text_section_used = true;
1199 static void var_location_switch_text_section (void);
1200 static void set_cur_line_info_table (section *);
1202 void
1203 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
1205 section *sect;
1206 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
1208 gcc_assert (cfun && fde && fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL);
1210 if (!in_cold_section_p)
1212 fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
1213 fde->dw_fde_second_begin = crtl->subsections.hot_section_label;
1214 fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
1216 else
1218 fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
1219 fde->dw_fde_second_begin = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
1220 fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
1222 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
1224 /* There is no need to mark used sections when not debugging. */
1225 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
1226 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
1228 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1229 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
1231 /* Now do the real section switch. */
1232 sect = current_function_section ();
1233 switch_to_section (sect);
1235 fde->second_in_std_section
1236 = (sect == text_section
1237 || (cold_text_section && sect == cold_text_section));
1239 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1240 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (true);
1242 var_location_switch_text_section ();
1244 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
1245 set_cur_line_info_table (sect);
1248 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
1249 for emitting location expressions. */
1251 /* Data about a single source file. */
1252 struct GTY((for_user)) dwarf_file_data {
1253 const char * filename;
1254 int emitted_number;
1257 /* Describe an entry into the .debug_addr section. */
1259 enum ate_kind {
1260 ate_kind_rtx,
1261 ate_kind_rtx_dtprel,
1262 ate_kind_label
1265 struct GTY((for_user)) addr_table_entry {
1266 enum ate_kind kind;
1267 unsigned int refcount;
1268 unsigned int index;
1269 union addr_table_entry_struct_union
1271 rtx GTY ((tag ("0"))) rtl;
1272 char * GTY ((tag ("1"))) label;
1274 GTY ((desc ("%1.kind"))) addr;
1277 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
1278 so you can track variables that are in different places over
1279 their entire life. */
1280 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_loc_list_struct {
1281 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
1282 const char *begin; /* Label and addr_entry for start of range */
1283 addr_table_entry *begin_entry;
1284 const char *end; /* Label for end of range */
1285 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
1286 Only on head of list */
1287 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
1288 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
1289 hashval_t hash;
1290 /* True if all addresses in this and subsequent lists are known to be
1291 resolved. */
1292 bool resolved_addr;
1293 /* True if this list has been replaced by dw_loc_next. */
1294 bool replaced;
1295 bool emitted;
1296 /* True if the range should be emitted even if begin and end
1297 are the same. */
1298 bool force;
1299 } dw_loc_list_node;
1301 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
1302 static dw_loc_descr_ref uint_loc_descriptor (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
1304 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
1306 static const char *
1307 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
1309 const char *name = get_DW_OP_name (op);
1311 if (name != NULL)
1312 return name;
1314 return "OP_<unknown>";
1317 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
1318 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
1319 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
1321 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
1322 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
1323 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
1325 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_loc_descr_node> ();
1327 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
1328 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
1329 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
1330 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
1331 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
1332 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_entry = NULL;
1333 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
1335 return descr;
1338 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description for
1339 REG and OFFSET. */
1341 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
1342 new_reg_loc_descr (unsigned int reg, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1344 if (reg <= 31)
1345 return new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + reg),
1346 offset, 0);
1347 else
1348 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, reg, offset);
1351 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
1353 static inline void
1354 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
1356 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
1358 /* Find the end of the chain. */
1359 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
1362 *d = descr;
1365 /* Compare two location operands for exact equality. */
1367 static bool
1368 dw_val_equal_p (dw_val_node *a, dw_val_node *b)
1370 if (a->val_class != b->val_class)
1371 return false;
1372 switch (a->val_class)
1374 case dw_val_class_none:
1375 return true;
1376 case dw_val_class_addr:
1377 return rtx_equal_p (a->v.val_addr, b->v.val_addr);
1379 case dw_val_class_offset:
1380 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
1381 case dw_val_class_const:
1382 case dw_val_class_range_list:
1383 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
1384 case dw_val_class_macptr:
1385 /* These are all HOST_WIDE_INT, signed or unsigned. */
1386 return a->v.val_unsigned == b->v.val_unsigned;
1388 case dw_val_class_loc:
1389 return a->v.val_loc == b->v.val_loc;
1390 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
1391 return a->v.val_loc_list == b->v.val_loc_list;
1392 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
1393 return a->v.val_die_ref.die == b->v.val_die_ref.die;
1394 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
1395 return a->v.val_fde_index == b->v.val_fde_index;
1396 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
1397 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
1398 return strcmp (a->v.val_lbl_id, b->v.val_lbl_id) == 0;
1399 case dw_val_class_str:
1400 return a->v.val_str == b->v.val_str;
1401 case dw_val_class_flag:
1402 return a->v.val_flag == b->v.val_flag;
1403 case dw_val_class_file:
1404 return a->v.val_file == b->v.val_file;
1405 case dw_val_class_decl_ref:
1406 return a->v.val_decl_ref == b->v.val_decl_ref;
1408 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1409 return (a->v.val_double.high == b->v.val_double.high
1410 && a->v.val_double.low == b->v.val_double.low);
1412 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
1413 return *a->v.val_wide == *b->v.val_wide;
1415 case dw_val_class_vec:
1417 size_t a_len = a->v.val_vec.elt_size * a->v.val_vec.length;
1418 size_t b_len = b->v.val_vec.elt_size * b->v.val_vec.length;
1420 return (a_len == b_len
1421 && !memcmp (a->v.val_vec.array, b->v.val_vec.array, a_len));
1424 case dw_val_class_data8:
1425 return memcmp (a->v.val_data8, b->v.val_data8, 8) == 0;
1427 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
1428 return (!strcmp (a->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1, b->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1)
1429 && !strcmp (a->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1, b->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1));
1431 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
1432 return (a->v.val_discr_value.pos == b->v.val_discr_value.pos
1433 && a->v.val_discr_value.v.uval == b->v.val_discr_value.v.uval);
1434 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
1435 /* It makes no sense comparing two discriminant value lists. */
1436 return false;
1438 gcc_unreachable ();
1441 /* Compare two location atoms for exact equality. */
1443 static bool
1444 loc_descr_equal_p_1 (dw_loc_descr_ref a, dw_loc_descr_ref b)
1446 if (a->dw_loc_opc != b->dw_loc_opc)
1447 return false;
1449 /* ??? This is only ever set for DW_OP_constNu, for N equal to the
1450 address size, but since we always allocate cleared storage it
1451 should be zero for other types of locations. */
1452 if (a->dtprel != b->dtprel)
1453 return false;
1455 return (dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_loc_oprnd1, &b->dw_loc_oprnd1)
1456 && dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_loc_oprnd2, &b->dw_loc_oprnd2));
1459 /* Compare two complete location expressions for exact equality. */
1461 bool
1462 loc_descr_equal_p (dw_loc_descr_ref a, dw_loc_descr_ref b)
1464 while (1)
1466 if (a == b)
1467 return true;
1468 if (a == NULL || b == NULL)
1469 return false;
1470 if (!loc_descr_equal_p_1 (a, b))
1471 return false;
1473 a = a->dw_loc_next;
1474 b = b->dw_loc_next;
1479 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location expression. */
1481 static void
1482 loc_descr_plus_const (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1484 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
1485 HOST_WIDE_INT *p;
1487 gcc_assert (*list_head != NULL);
1489 if (!offset)
1490 return;
1492 /* Find the end of the chain. */
1493 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
1496 p = NULL;
1497 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg
1498 || (loc->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && loc->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_breg31))
1499 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
1500 else if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bregx)
1501 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
1503 /* If the last operation is fbreg, breg{0..31,x}, optimize by adjusting its
1504 offset. Don't optimize if an signed integer overflow would happen. */
1505 if (p != NULL
1506 && ((offset > 0 && *p <= INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)
1507 || (offset < 0 && *p >= INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)))
1508 *p += offset;
1510 else if (offset > 0)
1511 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
1513 else
1515 loc->dw_loc_next = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
1516 add_loc_descr (&loc->dw_loc_next, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
1520 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location list. */
1522 static void
1523 loc_list_plus_const (dw_loc_list_ref list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1525 dw_loc_list_ref d;
1526 for (d = list_head; d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
1527 loc_descr_plus_const (&d->expr, offset);
1530 #define DWARF_REF_SIZE \
1531 (dwarf_version == 2 ? DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
1533 static unsigned long int get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref);
1535 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
1537 static unsigned long
1538 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
1540 unsigned long size = 1;
1542 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
1544 case DW_OP_addr:
1545 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
1546 break;
1547 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
1548 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
1549 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
1550 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index);
1551 break;
1552 case DW_OP_const1u:
1553 case DW_OP_const1s:
1554 size += 1;
1555 break;
1556 case DW_OP_const2u:
1557 case DW_OP_const2s:
1558 size += 2;
1559 break;
1560 case DW_OP_const4u:
1561 case DW_OP_const4s:
1562 size += 4;
1563 break;
1564 case DW_OP_const8u:
1565 case DW_OP_const8s:
1566 size += 8;
1567 break;
1568 case DW_OP_constu:
1569 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1570 break;
1571 case DW_OP_consts:
1572 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1573 break;
1574 case DW_OP_pick:
1575 size += 1;
1576 break;
1577 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
1578 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1579 break;
1580 case DW_OP_skip:
1581 case DW_OP_bra:
1582 size += 2;
1583 break;
1584 case DW_OP_breg0:
1585 case DW_OP_breg1:
1586 case DW_OP_breg2:
1587 case DW_OP_breg3:
1588 case DW_OP_breg4:
1589 case DW_OP_breg5:
1590 case DW_OP_breg6:
1591 case DW_OP_breg7:
1592 case DW_OP_breg8:
1593 case DW_OP_breg9:
1594 case DW_OP_breg10:
1595 case DW_OP_breg11:
1596 case DW_OP_breg12:
1597 case DW_OP_breg13:
1598 case DW_OP_breg14:
1599 case DW_OP_breg15:
1600 case DW_OP_breg16:
1601 case DW_OP_breg17:
1602 case DW_OP_breg18:
1603 case DW_OP_breg19:
1604 case DW_OP_breg20:
1605 case DW_OP_breg21:
1606 case DW_OP_breg22:
1607 case DW_OP_breg23:
1608 case DW_OP_breg24:
1609 case DW_OP_breg25:
1610 case DW_OP_breg26:
1611 case DW_OP_breg27:
1612 case DW_OP_breg28:
1613 case DW_OP_breg29:
1614 case DW_OP_breg30:
1615 case DW_OP_breg31:
1616 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1617 break;
1618 case DW_OP_regx:
1619 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1620 break;
1621 case DW_OP_fbreg:
1622 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1623 break;
1624 case DW_OP_bregx:
1625 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1626 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
1627 break;
1628 case DW_OP_piece:
1629 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1630 break;
1631 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
1632 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1633 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned);
1634 break;
1635 case DW_OP_deref_size:
1636 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
1637 size += 1;
1638 break;
1639 case DW_OP_call2:
1640 size += 2;
1641 break;
1642 case DW_OP_call4:
1643 size += 4;
1644 break;
1645 case DW_OP_call_ref:
1646 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE;
1647 break;
1648 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
1649 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
1650 + loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
1651 break;
1652 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
1653 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE + size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
1654 break;
1655 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
1657 unsigned long op_size = size_of_locs (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
1658 size += size_of_uleb128 (op_size) + op_size;
1659 break;
1661 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
1663 unsigned long o
1664 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
1665 size += size_of_uleb128 (o) + 1;
1666 switch (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class)
1668 case dw_val_class_vec:
1669 size += loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length
1670 * loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size;
1671 break;
1672 case dw_val_class_const:
1673 size += HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
1674 break;
1675 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1676 size += HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
1677 break;
1678 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
1679 size += (get_full_len (*loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide)
1680 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1681 break;
1682 default:
1683 gcc_unreachable ();
1685 break;
1687 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
1689 unsigned long o
1690 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
1691 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
1692 + size_of_uleb128 (o);
1694 break;
1695 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
1697 unsigned long o
1698 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
1699 size += 1 + size_of_uleb128 (o);
1701 break;
1702 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
1703 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
1704 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
1705 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1706 else
1708 unsigned long o
1709 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
1710 size += size_of_uleb128 (o);
1712 break;
1713 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
1714 size += 4;
1715 break;
1716 default:
1717 break;
1720 return size;
1723 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
1725 unsigned long
1726 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
1728 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
1729 unsigned long size;
1731 /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
1732 field, to avoid writing to a PCH file. */
1733 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
1735 if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
1736 break;
1737 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
1739 if (! l)
1740 return size;
1742 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
1744 l->dw_loc_addr = size;
1745 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
1748 return size;
1751 /* Return the size of the value in a DW_AT_discr_value attribute. */
1753 static int
1754 size_of_discr_value (dw_discr_value *discr_value)
1756 if (discr_value->pos)
1757 return size_of_uleb128 (discr_value->v.uval);
1758 else
1759 return size_of_sleb128 (discr_value->v.sval);
1762 /* Return the size of the value in a DW_discr_list attribute. */
1764 static int
1765 size_of_discr_list (dw_discr_list_ref discr_list)
1767 int size = 0;
1769 for (dw_discr_list_ref list = discr_list;
1770 list != NULL;
1771 list = list->dw_discr_next)
1773 /* One byte for the discriminant value descriptor, and then one or two
1774 LEB128 numbers, depending on whether it's a single case label or a
1775 range label. */
1776 size += 1;
1777 size += size_of_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_lower_bound);
1778 if (list->dw_discr_range != 0)
1779 size += size_of_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_upper_bound);
1781 return size;
1784 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
1785 static void get_ref_die_offset_label (char *, dw_die_ref);
1786 static unsigned long int get_ref_die_offset (dw_die_ref);
1788 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
1789 The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
1790 converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
1791 hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
1792 info). This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
1793 (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0. See PR47324. */
1795 static void
1796 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
1798 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
1799 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
1801 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
1803 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
1804 case DW_OP_const2u:
1805 case DW_OP_const2s:
1806 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1807 break;
1808 case DW_OP_const4u:
1809 if (loc->dtprel)
1811 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
1812 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 4,
1813 val1->v.val_addr);
1814 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1815 break;
1817 /* FALLTHRU */
1818 case DW_OP_const4s:
1819 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1820 break;
1821 case DW_OP_const8u:
1822 if (loc->dtprel)
1824 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
1825 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 8,
1826 val1->v.val_addr);
1827 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1828 break;
1830 /* FALLTHRU */
1831 case DW_OP_const8s:
1832 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
1833 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1834 break;
1835 case DW_OP_skip:
1836 case DW_OP_bra:
1838 int offset;
1840 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
1841 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
1843 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
1845 break;
1846 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
1847 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
1848 switch (val2->val_class)
1850 case dw_val_class_const:
1851 dw2_asm_output_data (val1->v.val_unsigned, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
1852 break;
1853 case dw_val_class_vec:
1855 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
1856 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
1857 unsigned int i;
1858 unsigned char *p;
1860 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
1862 elt_size /= 2;
1863 len *= 2;
1865 for (i = 0, p = val2->v.val_vec.array;
1866 i < len;
1867 i++, p += elt_size)
1868 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
1869 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
1871 break;
1872 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1874 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
1876 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
1878 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
1879 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
1881 else
1883 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
1884 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
1886 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
1887 first, NULL);
1888 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
1889 second, NULL);
1891 break;
1892 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
1894 int i;
1895 int len = get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide);
1896 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
1897 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
1898 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
1899 val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
1900 else
1901 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
1902 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
1903 val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
1905 break;
1906 case dw_val_class_addr:
1907 gcc_assert (val1->v.val_unsigned == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
1908 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val2->v.val_addr, NULL);
1909 break;
1910 default:
1911 gcc_unreachable ();
1913 break;
1914 #else
1915 case DW_OP_const2u:
1916 case DW_OP_const2s:
1917 case DW_OP_const4u:
1918 case DW_OP_const4s:
1919 case DW_OP_const8u:
1920 case DW_OP_const8s:
1921 case DW_OP_skip:
1922 case DW_OP_bra:
1923 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
1924 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
1925 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
1926 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
1927 only doing unwinding. */
1928 gcc_unreachable ();
1929 #endif
1930 case DW_OP_const1u:
1931 case DW_OP_const1s:
1932 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1933 break;
1934 case DW_OP_constu:
1935 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
1936 break;
1937 case DW_OP_consts:
1938 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1939 break;
1940 case DW_OP_pick:
1941 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1942 break;
1943 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
1944 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
1945 break;
1946 case DW_OP_breg0:
1947 case DW_OP_breg1:
1948 case DW_OP_breg2:
1949 case DW_OP_breg3:
1950 case DW_OP_breg4:
1951 case DW_OP_breg5:
1952 case DW_OP_breg6:
1953 case DW_OP_breg7:
1954 case DW_OP_breg8:
1955 case DW_OP_breg9:
1956 case DW_OP_breg10:
1957 case DW_OP_breg11:
1958 case DW_OP_breg12:
1959 case DW_OP_breg13:
1960 case DW_OP_breg14:
1961 case DW_OP_breg15:
1962 case DW_OP_breg16:
1963 case DW_OP_breg17:
1964 case DW_OP_breg18:
1965 case DW_OP_breg19:
1966 case DW_OP_breg20:
1967 case DW_OP_breg21:
1968 case DW_OP_breg22:
1969 case DW_OP_breg23:
1970 case DW_OP_breg24:
1971 case DW_OP_breg25:
1972 case DW_OP_breg26:
1973 case DW_OP_breg27:
1974 case DW_OP_breg28:
1975 case DW_OP_breg29:
1976 case DW_OP_breg30:
1977 case DW_OP_breg31:
1978 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1979 break;
1980 case DW_OP_regx:
1982 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
1983 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
1984 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
1985 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
1986 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
1987 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
1989 break;
1990 case DW_OP_fbreg:
1991 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1992 break;
1993 case DW_OP_bregx:
1995 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
1996 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
1997 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
1998 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
1999 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2000 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2001 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2003 break;
2004 case DW_OP_piece:
2005 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2006 break;
2007 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
2008 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2009 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val2->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2010 break;
2011 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2012 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2013 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2014 break;
2016 case DW_OP_addr:
2017 if (loc->dtprel)
2019 if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
2021 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
2022 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2023 val1->v.val_addr);
2024 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
2026 else
2027 gcc_unreachable ();
2029 else
2031 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2032 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
2033 #else
2034 gcc_unreachable ();
2035 #endif
2037 break;
2039 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
2040 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
2041 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
2042 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index,
2043 "(index into .debug_addr)");
2044 break;
2046 case DW_OP_call2:
2047 case DW_OP_call4:
2049 unsigned long die_offset
2050 = get_ref_die_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2051 /* Make sure the offset has been computed and that we can encode it as
2052 an operand. */
2053 gcc_assert (die_offset > 0
2054 && die_offset <= (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_call2)
2055 ? 0xffff
2056 : 0xffffffff);
2057 dw2_asm_output_data ((loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_call2) ? 2 : 4,
2058 die_offset, NULL);
2060 break;
2062 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
2064 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
2065 + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2 + 2];
2066 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2067 get_ref_die_offset_label (label, val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2068 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_REF_SIZE, label, debug_info_section, NULL);
2069 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2071 break;
2073 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
2074 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size_of_locs (val1->v.val_loc), NULL);
2075 output_loc_sequence (val1->v.val_loc, for_eh_or_skip);
2076 break;
2078 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
2080 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die), l;
2081 gcc_assert (o);
2082 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2083 switch (val2->val_class)
2085 case dw_val_class_const:
2086 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2087 dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
2088 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2089 break;
2090 case dw_val_class_vec:
2092 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
2093 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
2094 unsigned int i;
2095 unsigned char *p;
2097 l = len * elt_size;
2098 dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
2099 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
2101 elt_size /= 2;
2102 len *= 2;
2104 for (i = 0, p = val2->v.val_vec.array;
2105 i < len;
2106 i++, p += elt_size)
2107 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
2108 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
2110 break;
2111 case dw_val_class_const_double:
2113 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
2114 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2116 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2 * l, NULL);
2117 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2119 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
2120 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
2122 else
2124 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
2125 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
2127 dw2_asm_output_data (l, first, NULL);
2128 dw2_asm_output_data (l, second, NULL);
2130 break;
2131 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
2133 int i;
2134 int len = get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide);
2135 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2137 dw2_asm_output_data (1, len * l, NULL);
2138 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2139 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
2140 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2141 else
2142 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
2143 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2145 break;
2146 default:
2147 gcc_unreachable ();
2150 break;
2151 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
2153 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
2154 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
2155 gcc_assert (o);
2156 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
2158 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2159 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2160 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2162 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2163 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2165 break;
2166 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
2168 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
2169 gcc_assert (o);
2170 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2171 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2173 break;
2174 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
2175 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
2176 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
2177 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2178 else
2180 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2181 gcc_assert (o);
2182 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2184 break;
2186 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
2188 unsigned long o;
2189 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2190 o = get_ref_die_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2191 dw2_asm_output_data (4, o, NULL);
2193 break;
2195 default:
2196 /* Other codes have no operands. */
2197 break;
2201 /* Output a sequence of location operations.
2202 The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
2203 converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
2204 hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
2205 info). This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
2206 (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0. See PR47324. */
2208 void
2209 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
2211 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
2213 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
2214 /* Output the opcode. */
2215 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
2216 && opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
2218 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
2219 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2220 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2221 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
2223 else if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
2224 && opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
2226 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
2227 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2228 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2229 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
2232 dw2_asm_output_data (1, opc,
2233 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (opc));
2235 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
2236 output_loc_operands (loc, for_eh_or_skip);
2240 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
2241 The output is single bytes on a line, suitable for .cfi_escape. */
2243 static void
2244 output_loc_operands_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2246 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
2247 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
2249 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
2251 case DW_OP_addr:
2252 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
2253 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
2254 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
2255 /* We cannot output addresses in .cfi_escape, only bytes. */
2256 gcc_unreachable ();
2258 case DW_OP_const1u:
2259 case DW_OP_const1s:
2260 case DW_OP_pick:
2261 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2262 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2263 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2264 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (1, val1->v.val_int);
2265 break;
2267 case DW_OP_const2u:
2268 case DW_OP_const2s:
2269 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2270 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, val1->v.val_int);
2271 break;
2273 case DW_OP_const4u:
2274 case DW_OP_const4s:
2275 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2276 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (4, val1->v.val_int);
2277 break;
2279 case DW_OP_const8u:
2280 case DW_OP_const8s:
2281 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
2282 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2283 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (8, val1->v.val_int);
2284 break;
2286 case DW_OP_skip:
2287 case DW_OP_bra:
2289 int offset;
2291 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
2292 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
2294 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2295 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, offset);
2297 break;
2299 case DW_OP_regx:
2301 unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
2302 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2303 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2304 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2305 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
2307 break;
2309 case DW_OP_constu:
2310 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2311 case DW_OP_piece:
2312 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2313 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
2314 break;
2316 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
2317 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2318 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
2319 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val2->v.val_unsigned);
2320 break;
2322 case DW_OP_consts:
2323 case DW_OP_breg0:
2324 case DW_OP_breg1:
2325 case DW_OP_breg2:
2326 case DW_OP_breg3:
2327 case DW_OP_breg4:
2328 case DW_OP_breg5:
2329 case DW_OP_breg6:
2330 case DW_OP_breg7:
2331 case DW_OP_breg8:
2332 case DW_OP_breg9:
2333 case DW_OP_breg10:
2334 case DW_OP_breg11:
2335 case DW_OP_breg12:
2336 case DW_OP_breg13:
2337 case DW_OP_breg14:
2338 case DW_OP_breg15:
2339 case DW_OP_breg16:
2340 case DW_OP_breg17:
2341 case DW_OP_breg18:
2342 case DW_OP_breg19:
2343 case DW_OP_breg20:
2344 case DW_OP_breg21:
2345 case DW_OP_breg22:
2346 case DW_OP_breg23:
2347 case DW_OP_breg24:
2348 case DW_OP_breg25:
2349 case DW_OP_breg26:
2350 case DW_OP_breg27:
2351 case DW_OP_breg28:
2352 case DW_OP_breg29:
2353 case DW_OP_breg30:
2354 case DW_OP_breg31:
2355 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2356 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2357 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val1->v.val_int);
2358 break;
2360 case DW_OP_bregx:
2362 unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
2363 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2364 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2365 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2366 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
2367 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2368 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val2->v.val_int);
2370 break;
2372 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
2373 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
2374 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
2375 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
2376 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
2377 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
2378 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
2379 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
2380 gcc_unreachable ();
2381 break;
2383 default:
2384 /* Other codes have no operands. */
2385 break;
2389 void
2390 output_loc_sequence_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2392 while (1)
2394 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
2395 /* Output the opcode. */
2396 if (opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
2398 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
2399 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
2400 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2401 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
2403 else if (opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
2405 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
2406 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
2407 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2408 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
2410 /* Output the opcode. */
2411 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%#x", opc);
2412 output_loc_operands_raw (loc);
2414 if (!loc->dw_loc_next)
2415 break;
2416 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
2418 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2422 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
2423 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
2424 expression. */
2426 struct dw_loc_descr_node *
2427 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
2429 struct dw_loc_descr_node *head, *tmp;
2431 offset += cfa->offset;
2433 if (cfa->indirect)
2435 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
2436 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
2437 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
2438 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
2439 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
2440 if (offset != 0)
2442 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
2443 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
2446 else
2447 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, offset);
2449 return head;
2452 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence for
2453 the address at OFFSET from the CFA when stack is aligned to
2454 ALIGNMENT byte. */
2456 struct dw_loc_descr_node *
2457 build_cfa_aligned_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa,
2458 HOST_WIDE_INT offset, HOST_WIDE_INT alignment)
2460 struct dw_loc_descr_node *head;
2461 unsigned int dwarf_fp
2462 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
2464 /* When CFA is defined as FP+OFFSET, emulate stack alignment. */
2465 if (cfa->reg == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && cfa->indirect == 0)
2467 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, 0);
2468 add_loc_descr (&head, int_loc_descriptor (alignment));
2469 add_loc_descr (&head, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
2470 loc_descr_plus_const (&head, offset);
2472 else
2473 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, offset);
2474 return head;
2477 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
2479 /* .debug_str support. */
2481 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
2482 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
2483 static void dwarf2out_early_finish (void);
2484 static void dwarf2out_assembly_start (void);
2485 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
2486 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
2487 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
2488 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
2489 static void dwarf2out_function_decl (tree);
2490 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
2491 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
2492 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree);
2493 static void dwarf2out_early_global_decl (tree);
2494 static void dwarf2out_late_global_decl (tree);
2495 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
2496 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree, tree, bool);
2497 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree, tree, tree,
2498 dw_die_ref);
2499 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
2500 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx_insn *);
2501 static void dwarf2out_size_function (tree);
2502 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
2503 static void dwarf2out_end_function (unsigned int);
2504 static void dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit (tree unit);
2505 static void dwarf2out_set_name (tree, tree);
2507 /* The debug hooks structure. */
2509 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
2511 dwarf2out_init,
2512 dwarf2out_finish,
2513 dwarf2out_early_finish,
2514 dwarf2out_assembly_start,
2515 dwarf2out_define,
2516 dwarf2out_undef,
2517 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
2518 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
2519 dwarf2out_begin_block,
2520 dwarf2out_end_block,
2521 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
2522 dwarf2out_source_line,
2523 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
2524 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2525 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue,
2526 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue,
2527 #else
2528 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2529 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2530 #endif
2531 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
2532 dwarf2out_begin_function,
2533 dwarf2out_end_function, /* end_function */
2534 dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit,
2535 dwarf2out_function_decl, /* function_decl */
2536 dwarf2out_early_global_decl,
2537 dwarf2out_late_global_decl,
2538 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
2539 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
2540 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
2541 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
2542 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
2543 something tries to reference them. */
2544 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
2545 debug_nothing_rtx_code_label, /* label */
2546 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
2547 dwarf2out_var_location,
2548 dwarf2out_size_function, /* size_function */
2549 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
2550 dwarf2out_set_name,
2551 1, /* start_end_main_source_file */
2552 TYPE_SYMTAB_IS_DIE /* tree_type_symtab_field */
2555 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_lineno_debug_hooks =
2557 dwarf2out_init,
2558 debug_nothing_charstar,
2559 debug_nothing_void,
2560 debug_nothing_void,
2561 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2562 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2563 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2564 debug_nothing_int,
2565 debug_nothing_int_int, /* begin_block */
2566 debug_nothing_int_int, /* end_block */
2567 debug_true_const_tree, /* ignore_block */
2568 dwarf2out_source_line, /* source_line */
2569 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* begin_prologue */
2570 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_prologue */
2571 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* begin_epilogue */
2572 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_epilogue */
2573 debug_nothing_tree, /* begin_function */
2574 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
2575 debug_nothing_tree, /* register_main_translation_unit */
2576 debug_nothing_tree, /* function_decl */
2577 debug_nothing_tree, /* early_global_decl */
2578 debug_nothing_tree, /* late_global_decl */
2579 debug_nothing_tree_int, /* type_decl */
2580 debug_nothing_tree_tree_tree_bool, /* imported_module_or_decl */
2581 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
2582 debug_nothing_tree, /* outlining_inline_function */
2583 debug_nothing_rtx_code_label, /* label */
2584 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
2585 debug_nothing_rtx_insn, /* var_location */
2586 debug_nothing_tree, /* size_function */
2587 debug_nothing_void, /* switch_text_section */
2588 debug_nothing_tree_tree, /* set_name */
2589 0, /* start_end_main_source_file */
2590 TYPE_SYMTAB_IS_ADDRESS /* tree_type_symtab_field */
2593 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
2594 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
2595 throughout the remainder of this file. */
2597 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
2598 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
2599 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
2600 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
2602 /* Whether to put type DIEs into their own section .debug_types instead
2603 of making them part of the .debug_info section. Only supported for
2604 Dwarf V4 or higher and the user didn't disable them through
2605 -fno-debug-types-section. It is more efficient to put them in a
2606 separate comdat sections since the linker will then be able to
2607 remove duplicates. But not all tools support .debug_types sections
2608 yet. */
2610 #define use_debug_types (dwarf_version >= 4 && flag_debug_types_section)
2612 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
2613 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
2615 typedef long int dw_offset;
2617 struct comdat_type_node;
2619 /* The entries in the line_info table more-or-less mirror the opcodes
2620 that are used in the real dwarf line table. Arrays of these entries
2621 are collected per section when DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO is not
2622 supported. */
2624 enum dw_line_info_opcode {
2625 /* Emit DW_LNE_set_address; the operand is the label index. */
2626 LI_set_address,
2628 /* Emit a row to the matrix with the given line. This may be done
2629 via any combination of DW_LNS_copy, DW_LNS_advance_line, and
2630 special opcodes. */
2631 LI_set_line,
2633 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_file. */
2634 LI_set_file,
2636 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_column. */
2637 LI_set_column,
2639 /* Emit a DW_LNS_negate_stmt; the operand is ignored. */
2640 LI_negate_stmt,
2642 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_prologue_end/epilogue_begin; the operand is ignored. */
2643 LI_set_prologue_end,
2644 LI_set_epilogue_begin,
2646 /* Emit a DW_LNE_set_discriminator. */
2647 LI_set_discriminator
2650 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_struct {
2651 enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode;
2652 unsigned int val;
2653 } dw_line_info_entry;
2656 struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_table {
2657 /* The label that marks the end of this section. */
2658 const char *end_label;
2660 /* The values for the last row of the matrix, as collected in the table.
2661 These are used to minimize the changes to the next row. */
2662 unsigned int file_num;
2663 unsigned int line_num;
2664 unsigned int column_num;
2665 int discrim_num;
2666 bool is_stmt;
2667 bool in_use;
2669 vec<dw_line_info_entry, va_gc> *entries;
2673 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
2674 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
2675 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
2677 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_attr_struct {
2678 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
2679 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
2681 dw_attr_node;
2684 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure. DIEs form a tree.
2685 The children of each node form a circular list linked by
2686 die_sib. die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node. */
2688 typedef struct GTY((chain_circular ("%h.die_sib"), for_user)) die_struct {
2689 union die_symbol_or_type_node
2691 const char * GTY ((tag ("0"))) die_symbol;
2692 comdat_type_node *GTY ((tag ("1"))) die_type_node;
2694 GTY ((desc ("%0.comdat_type_p"))) die_id;
2695 vec<dw_attr_node, va_gc> *die_attr;
2696 dw_die_ref die_parent;
2697 dw_die_ref die_child;
2698 dw_die_ref die_sib;
2699 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
2700 dw_offset die_offset;
2701 unsigned long die_abbrev;
2702 int die_mark;
2703 unsigned int decl_id;
2704 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
2705 /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused. */
2706 BOOL_BITFIELD die_perennial_p : 1;
2707 BOOL_BITFIELD comdat_type_p : 1; /* DIE has a type signature */
2708 /* Lots of spare bits. */
2710 die_node;
2712 /* Set to TRUE while dwarf2out_early_global_decl is running. */
2713 static bool early_dwarf;
2714 struct set_early_dwarf {
2715 bool saved;
2716 set_early_dwarf () : saved(early_dwarf) { early_dwarf = true; }
2717 ~set_early_dwarf () { early_dwarf = saved; }
2720 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order. */
2721 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do { \
2722 c = die->die_child; \
2723 if (c) do { \
2724 c = c->die_sib; \
2725 expr; \
2726 } while (c != die->die_child); \
2727 } while (0)
2729 /* The pubname structure */
2731 typedef struct GTY(()) pubname_struct {
2732 dw_die_ref die;
2733 const char *name;
2735 pubname_entry;
2738 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges {
2739 /* If this is positive, it's a block number, otherwise it's a
2740 bitwise-negated index into dw_ranges_by_label. */
2741 int num;
2744 /* A structure to hold a macinfo entry. */
2746 typedef struct GTY(()) macinfo_struct {
2747 unsigned char code;
2748 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT lineno;
2749 const char *info;
2751 macinfo_entry;
2754 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_by_label {
2755 const char *begin;
2756 const char *end;
2759 /* The comdat type node structure. */
2760 struct GTY(()) comdat_type_node
2762 dw_die_ref root_die;
2763 dw_die_ref type_die;
2764 dw_die_ref skeleton_die;
2765 char signature[DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE];
2766 comdat_type_node *next;
2769 /* A list of DIEs for which we can't determine ancestry (parent_die
2770 field) just yet. Later in dwarf2out_finish we will fill in the
2771 missing bits. */
2772 typedef struct GTY(()) limbo_die_struct {
2773 dw_die_ref die;
2774 /* The tree for which this DIE was created. We use this to
2775 determine ancestry later. */
2776 tree created_for;
2777 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
2779 limbo_die_node;
2781 typedef struct skeleton_chain_struct
2783 dw_die_ref old_die;
2784 dw_die_ref new_die;
2785 struct skeleton_chain_struct *parent;
2787 skeleton_chain_node;
2789 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
2790 implicitly generated for a type.
2792 Note that, unlike the C front-end (which generates a NULL named
2793 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type,
2794 and each function type node created) the C++ front-end generates
2795 a _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
2796 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
2797 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. Likewise with the Ada
2798 front-end, but for each type, tagged or not. */
2800 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
2801 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
2802 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
2803 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
2804 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
2805 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
2806 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
2807 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
2808 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
2810 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
2811 language, and compiler version. */
2813 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
2814 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
2815 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
2817 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF comdat type unit header. */
2818 #define DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
2819 (DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE \
2820 + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
2822 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
2823 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
2825 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
2826 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
2827 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
2828 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
2829 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
2831 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
2832 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
2833 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
2834 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
2835 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
2836 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
2838 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
2839 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
2840 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
2841 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
2842 #else
2843 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
2844 #endif
2845 #endif
2847 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
2848 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
2849 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
2851 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
2852 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE ((int)DW_LNS_set_isa + 1)
2854 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
2855 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
2857 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
2858 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
2859 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
2860 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
2861 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
2863 /* Maximum number of operations per instruction bundle. */
2864 #ifndef DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN
2865 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN 1
2866 #endif
2868 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
2869 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
2870 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
2872 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
2873 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref single_comp_unit_die;
2875 /* A list of type DIEs that have been separated into comdat sections. */
2876 static GTY(()) comdat_type_node *comdat_type_list;
2878 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
2879 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
2881 /* A list of DIEs for which we may have to generate
2882 DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name once their DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAMEs are set. */
2883 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *deferred_asm_name;
2885 struct dwarf_file_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<dwarf_file_data>
2887 typedef const char *compare_type;
2889 static hashval_t hash (dwarf_file_data *);
2890 static bool equal (dwarf_file_data *, const char *);
2893 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
2894 static GTY(()) hash_table<dwarf_file_hasher> *file_table;
2896 struct decl_die_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<die_node>
2898 typedef tree compare_type;
2900 static hashval_t hash (die_node *);
2901 static bool equal (die_node *, tree);
2903 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
2904 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
2905 static GTY (()) hash_table<decl_die_hasher> *decl_die_table;
2907 struct block_die_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<die_struct>
2909 static hashval_t hash (die_struct *);
2910 static bool equal (die_struct *, die_struct *);
2913 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe COMMON blocks.
2914 The key is DECL_UID() ^ die_parent. */
2915 static GTY (()) hash_table<block_die_hasher> *common_block_die_table;
2917 typedef struct GTY(()) die_arg_entry_struct {
2918 dw_die_ref die;
2919 tree arg;
2920 } die_arg_entry;
2923 /* Node of the variable location list. */
2924 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) var_loc_node {
2925 /* Either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION, or, for SRA optimized variables,
2926 EXPR_LIST chain. For small bitsizes, bitsize is encoded
2927 in mode of the EXPR_LIST node and first EXPR_LIST operand
2928 is either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION for a piece with a known
2929 location or NULL for padding. For larger bitsizes,
2930 mode is 0 and first operand is a CONCAT with bitsize
2931 as first CONCAT operand and NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION resp.
2932 NULL as second operand. */
2933 rtx GTY (()) loc;
2934 const char * GTY (()) label;
2935 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
2938 /* Variable location list. */
2939 struct GTY ((for_user)) var_loc_list_def {
2940 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
2942 /* Pointer to the last but one or last element of the
2943 chained list. If the list is empty, both first and
2944 last are NULL, if the list contains just one node
2945 or the last node certainly is not redundant, it points
2946 to the last node, otherwise points to the last but one.
2947 Do not mark it for GC because it is marked through the chain. */
2948 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
2950 /* Pointer to the last element before section switch,
2951 if NULL, either sections weren't switched or first
2952 is after section switch. */
2953 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last_before_switch;
2955 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
2956 unsigned int decl_id;
2958 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
2960 /* Call argument location list. */
2961 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) call_arg_loc_node {
2962 rtx GTY (()) call_arg_loc_note;
2963 const char * GTY (()) label;
2964 tree GTY (()) block;
2965 bool tail_call_p;
2966 rtx GTY (()) symbol_ref;
2967 struct call_arg_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
2971 struct decl_loc_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<var_loc_list>
2973 typedef const_tree compare_type;
2975 static hashval_t hash (var_loc_list *);
2976 static bool equal (var_loc_list *, const_tree);
2979 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
2980 static GTY (()) hash_table<decl_loc_hasher> *decl_loc_table;
2982 /* Head and tail of call_arg_loc chain. */
2983 static GTY (()) struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_locations;
2984 static struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_loc_last;
2986 /* Number of call sites in the current function. */
2987 static int call_site_count = -1;
2988 /* Number of tail call sites in the current function. */
2989 static int tail_call_site_count = -1;
2991 /* A cached location list. */
2992 struct GTY ((for_user)) cached_dw_loc_list_def {
2993 /* The DECL_UID of the decl that this entry describes. */
2994 unsigned int decl_id;
2996 /* The cached location list. */
2997 dw_loc_list_ref loc_list;
2999 typedef struct cached_dw_loc_list_def cached_dw_loc_list;
3001 struct dw_loc_list_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<cached_dw_loc_list>
3004 typedef const_tree compare_type;
3006 static hashval_t hash (cached_dw_loc_list *);
3007 static bool equal (cached_dw_loc_list *, const_tree);
3010 /* Table of cached location lists. */
3011 static GTY (()) hash_table<dw_loc_list_hasher> *cached_dw_loc_list_table;
3013 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
3014 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
3015 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
3016 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
3017 dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
3019 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
3020 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
3022 /* Number of elements in abbrev_die_table currently in use. */
3023 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
3025 /* A hash map to remember the stack usage for DWARF procedures. The value
3026 stored is the stack size difference between before the DWARF procedure
3027 invokation and after it returned. In other words, for a DWARF procedure
3028 that consumes N stack slots and that pushes M ones, this stores M - N. */
3029 static hash_map<dw_die_ref, int> *dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map;
3031 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3032 abbrev_die_table. */
3033 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
3035 /* A global counter for generating labels for line number data. */
3036 static unsigned int line_info_label_num;
3038 /* The current table to which we should emit line number information
3039 for the current function. This will be set up at the beginning of
3040 assembly for the function. */
3041 static dw_line_info_table *cur_line_info_table;
3043 /* The two default tables of line number info. */
3044 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *text_section_line_info;
3045 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *cold_text_section_line_info;
3047 /* The set of all non-default tables of line number info. */
3048 static GTY(()) vec<dw_line_info_table *, va_gc> *separate_line_info;
3050 /* A flag to tell pubnames/types export if there is an info section to
3051 refer to. */
3052 static bool info_section_emitted;
3054 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3055 accessible names. */
3056 static GTY (()) vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *pubname_table;
3058 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3059 accessible types. */
3060 static GTY (()) vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *pubtype_table;
3062 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of macro
3063 defines/undefines (and file start/end markers). */
3064 static GTY (()) vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *macinfo_table;
3066 /* True if .debug_macinfo or .debug_macros section is going to be
3067 emitted. */
3068 #define have_macinfo \
3069 ((!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS) \
3070 && debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE \
3071 && !macinfo_table->is_empty ())
3073 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
3074 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges *ranges_table;
3076 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
3077 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
3079 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
3080 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
3082 /* Array of pairs of labels referenced in ranges_table. */
3083 static GTY ((length ("ranges_by_label_allocated")))
3084 dw_ranges_by_label *ranges_by_label;
3086 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_by_label. */
3087 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_allocated;
3089 /* Number of elements in ranges_by_label currently in use. */
3090 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_in_use;
3092 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3093 ranges_table. */
3094 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3096 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
3097 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
3099 /* Unique label counter. */
3100 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
3102 /* Unique label counter for point-of-call tables. */
3103 static GTY(()) unsigned int poc_label_num;
3105 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file(). */
3106 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
3108 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
3109 static GTY(()) int label_num;
3111 static GTY(()) vec<die_arg_entry, va_gc> *tmpl_value_parm_die_table;
3113 /* Instances of generic types for which we need to generate debug
3114 info that describe their generic parameters and arguments. That
3115 generation needs to happen once all types are properly laid out so
3116 we do it at the end of compilation. */
3117 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *generic_type_instances;
3119 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
3120 within the current function. */
3121 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
3122 static bool frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid;
3124 static vec<dw_die_ref> base_types;
3126 /* Flags to represent a set of attribute classes for attributes that represent
3127 a scalar value (bounds, pointers, ...). */
3128 enum dw_scalar_form
3130 dw_scalar_form_constant = 0x01,
3131 dw_scalar_form_exprloc = 0x02,
3132 dw_scalar_form_reference = 0x04
3135 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
3137 static int is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx);
3138 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
3139 static int is_tagged_type (const_tree);
3140 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
3141 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
3142 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
3143 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree);
3144 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
3145 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_node *);
3146 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_node *);
3147 static inline unsigned int AT_index (dw_attr_node *);
3148 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3149 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_node *);
3150 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
3151 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_node *);
3152 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3153 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_node *);
3154 static void add_AT_double (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3155 HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3156 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
3157 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
3158 static void add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned char *);
3159 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3160 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_node *);
3161 static enum dwarf_form AT_string_form (dw_attr_node *);
3162 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
3163 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3164 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_node *);
3165 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *);
3166 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *, int);
3167 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3168 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
3169 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_node *);
3170 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3171 dw_loc_list_ref);
3172 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_node *);
3173 static addr_table_entry *add_addr_table_entry (void *, enum ate_kind);
3174 static void remove_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *);
3175 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx, bool);
3176 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_node *);
3177 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3178 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3179 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3180 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3181 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3182 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3183 unsigned long, bool);
3184 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_node *);
3185 static dw_attr_node *get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3186 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
3187 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
3188 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3189 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3190 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3191 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3192 static bool is_cxx (void);
3193 static bool is_fortran (void);
3194 static bool is_ada (void);
3195 static bool remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3196 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
3197 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3198 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
3199 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
3200 static dw_die_ref strip_naming_typedef (tree, dw_die_ref);
3201 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree);
3202 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3203 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
3204 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (const_tree);
3205 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3206 static struct var_loc_node *add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, rtx, const char *);
3207 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
3208 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
3209 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3210 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
3211 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3212 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_node *, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3213 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3214 static void checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
3215 static void checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
3216 static void loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3217 static void attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag, dw_attr_node *,
3218 struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3219 struct checksum_attributes;
3220 static void collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *, dw_die_ref);
3221 static void die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3222 static void checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3223 static void generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref, comdat_type_node *);
3224 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
3225 static int same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *, const dw_val_node *, int *);
3226 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_node *, dw_attr_node *, int *);
3227 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
3228 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3229 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
3230 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
3231 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
3232 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
3233 static inline bool is_template_instantiation (dw_die_ref);
3234 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
3235 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
3236 static int is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref);
3237 static int should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref);
3238 static dw_die_ref clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref);
3239 static dw_die_ref clone_die (dw_die_ref);
3240 static dw_die_ref clone_tree (dw_die_ref);
3241 static dw_die_ref copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3242 static void generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *);
3243 static void generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *);
3244 static dw_die_ref generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref);
3245 static dw_die_ref remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref,
3246 dw_die_ref,
3247 dw_die_ref);
3248 static void break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref);
3249 static void copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref);
3251 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
3252 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
3253 static int constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3254 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
3255 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
3256 static void calc_base_type_die_sizes (void);
3257 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3258 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3259 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
3260 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *);
3261 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
3262 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_node *);
3263 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_node *);
3264 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
3265 static void output_die_abbrevs (unsigned long, dw_die_ref);
3266 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
3267 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
3268 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
3269 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
3270 static void output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *);
3271 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
3272 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
3273 static void add_enumerator_pubname (const char *, dw_die_ref);
3274 static void add_pubname_string (const char *, dw_die_ref);
3275 static void add_pubtype (tree, dw_die_ref);
3276 static void output_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *);
3277 static void output_aranges (void);
3278 static unsigned int add_ranges_num (int);
3279 static unsigned int add_ranges (const_tree);
3280 static void add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref, const char *, const char *,
3281 bool *, bool);
3282 static void output_ranges (void);
3283 static dw_line_info_table *new_line_info_table (void);
3284 static void output_line_info (bool);
3285 static void output_file_names (void);
3286 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree, bool);
3287 static int is_base_type (tree);
3288 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3289 static int decl_quals (const_tree);
3290 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, bool, dw_die_ref);
3291 static dw_die_ref generic_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
3292 static dw_die_ref template_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3293 static int type_is_enum (const_tree);
3294 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (const_rtx);
3295 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
3296 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum var_init_status);
3297 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int,
3298 enum var_init_status);
3299 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
3300 enum var_init_status);
3301 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT,
3302 enum var_init_status);
3303 static int is_based_loc (const_rtx);
3304 static bool resolve_one_addr (rtx *);
3305 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
3306 enum var_init_status);
3307 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx, machine_mode mode,
3308 enum var_init_status);
3309 struct loc_descr_context;
3310 static void add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref);
3311 static void add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list);
3312 static dw_loc_list_ref loc_list_from_tree (tree, int,
3313 const struct loc_descr_context *);
3314 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree, int,
3315 const struct loc_descr_context *);
3316 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
3317 static tree field_type (const_tree);
3318 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree);
3319 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree);
3320 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree);
3321 struct vlr_context;
3322 static dw_loc_descr_ref field_byte_offset (const_tree, struct vlr_context *,
3323 HOST_WIDE_INT *);
3324 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3325 dw_loc_list_ref);
3326 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
3327 struct vlr_context *);
3328 static bool add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
3329 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
3330 static void insert_wide_int (const wide_int &, unsigned char *, int);
3331 static void insert_float (const_rtx, unsigned char *);
3332 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
3333 static bool add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
3334 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3335 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref, tree);
3336 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
3337 static void add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, dw_die_ref);
3338 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
3339 static void add_scalar_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree, int,
3340 const struct loc_descr_context *);
3341 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree,
3342 const struct loc_descr_context *);
3343 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
3344 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3345 static inline void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
3346 struct vlr_context *);
3347 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3348 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3349 static dw_die_ref add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3350 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3351 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
3352 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
3353 static void add_discr_value (dw_die_ref, dw_discr_value *);
3354 static void add_discr_list (dw_die_ref, dw_discr_list_ref);
3355 static inline dw_discr_list_ref AT_discr_list (dw_attr_node *);
3356 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
3357 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
3358 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
3359 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3360 static inline int class_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3361 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3362 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, bool, dw_die_ref);
3363 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3364 static const char *type_tag (const_tree);
3365 static tree member_declared_type (const_tree);
3366 #if 0
3367 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
3368 #endif
3369 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3370 static void gen_descr_array_type_die (tree, struct array_descr_info *, dw_die_ref);
3371 #if 0
3372 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3373 #endif
3374 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3375 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
3376 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref, tree*);
3377 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3378 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3379 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3380 static void gen_variable_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3381 static void gen_const_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3382 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3383 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3384 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3385 static void gen_field_die (tree, struct vlr_context *, dw_die_ref);
3386 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3387 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
3388 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3389 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3390 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref,
3391 enum debug_info_usage);
3392 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3393 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3394 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3395 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3396 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref);
3397 static bool is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree);
3398 static inline dw_die_ref get_context_die (tree);
3399 static void gen_namespace_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3400 static dw_die_ref gen_namelist_decl (tree, dw_die_ref, tree);
3401 static dw_die_ref gen_decl_die (tree, tree, struct vlr_context *, dw_die_ref);
3402 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
3403 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
3404 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
3405 static dw_die_ref declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
3406 static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
3407 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
3408 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3409 static void gen_generic_params_dies (tree);
3410 static void gen_tagged_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
3411 static void gen_type_die_with_usage (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
3412 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3413 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
3414 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
3415 const char *, const char *);
3416 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
3417 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
3418 static bool want_pubnames (void);
3420 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3421 static void prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref);
3422 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
3423 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
3424 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
3425 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
3426 static void prune_unused_types (void);
3427 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
3428 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_node *);
3429 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_node *);
3430 static inline void add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3431 const char *, const char *);
3432 static void append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref, tree);
3433 static void gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void);
3434 static bool generic_type_p (tree);
3435 static void schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t);
3436 static void gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void);
3438 static const char *comp_dir_string (void);
3440 static void hash_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref, inchash::hash &);
3442 /* enum for tracking thread-local variables whose address is really an offset
3443 relative to the TLS pointer, which will need link-time relocation, but will
3444 not need relocation by the DWARF consumer. */
3446 enum dtprel_bool
3448 dtprel_false = 0,
3449 dtprel_true = 1
3452 /* Return the operator to use for an address of a variable. For dtprel_true, we
3453 use DW_OP_const*. For regular variables, which need both link-time
3454 relocation and consumer-level relocation (e.g., to account for shared objects
3455 loaded at a random address), we use DW_OP_addr*. */
3457 static inline enum dwarf_location_atom
3458 dw_addr_op (enum dtprel_bool dtprel)
3460 if (dtprel == dtprel_true)
3461 return (dwarf_split_debug_info ? DW_OP_GNU_const_index
3462 : (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 ? DW_OP_const4u : DW_OP_const8u));
3463 else
3464 return dwarf_split_debug_info ? DW_OP_GNU_addr_index : DW_OP_addr;
3467 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated address location description. If
3468 dwarf_split_debug_info is true, then record the address with the appropriate
3469 relocation. */
3470 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
3471 new_addr_loc_descr (rtx addr, enum dtprel_bool dtprel)
3473 dw_loc_descr_ref ref = new_loc_descr (dw_addr_op (dtprel), 0, 0);
3475 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
3476 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = addr;
3477 ref->dtprel = dtprel;
3478 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
3479 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry
3480 = add_addr_table_entry (addr,
3481 dtprel ? ate_kind_rtx_dtprel : ate_kind_rtx);
3482 else
3483 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
3485 return ref;
3488 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
3490 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
3491 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
3492 #endif
3493 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION
3494 #define DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info.dwo"
3495 #endif
3496 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
3497 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
3498 #endif
3499 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION
3500 #define DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev.dwo"
3501 #endif
3502 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
3503 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
3504 #endif
3505 #ifndef DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION
3506 #define DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION ".debug_addr"
3507 #endif
3508 #ifndef DEBUG_NORM_MACINFO_SECTION
3509 #define DEBUG_NORM_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
3510 #endif
3511 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION
3512 #define DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo.dwo"
3513 #endif
3514 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
3515 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION \
3516 (!dwarf_split_debug_info \
3517 ? (DEBUG_NORM_MACINFO_SECTION) : (DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION))
3518 #endif
3519 #ifndef DEBUG_NORM_MACRO_SECTION
3520 #define DEBUG_NORM_MACRO_SECTION ".debug_macro"
3521 #endif
3522 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION
3523 #define DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION ".debug_macro.dwo"
3524 #endif
3525 #ifndef DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION
3526 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION \
3527 (!dwarf_split_debug_info \
3528 ? (DEBUG_NORM_MACRO_SECTION) : (DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION))
3529 #endif
3530 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
3531 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
3532 #endif
3533 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION
3534 #define DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line.dwo"
3535 #endif
3536 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
3537 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
3538 #endif
3539 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION
3540 #define DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc.dwo"
3541 #endif
3542 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
3543 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION \
3544 ((debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) \
3545 ? ".debug_gnu_pubnames" : ".debug_pubnames")
3546 #endif
3547 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
3548 #define DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION \
3549 ((debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) \
3550 ? ".debug_gnu_pubtypes" : ".debug_pubtypes")
3551 #endif
3552 #define DEBUG_NORM_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".debug_str_offsets"
3553 #define DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".debug_str_offsets.dwo"
3554 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION
3555 #define DEBUG_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION \
3556 (!dwarf_split_debug_info \
3557 ? (DEBUG_NORM_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION) : (DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION))
3558 #endif
3559 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION
3560 #define DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION ".debug_str.dwo"
3561 #endif
3562 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
3563 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
3564 #endif
3565 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
3566 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
3567 #endif
3569 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
3570 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
3571 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
3572 #endif
3574 /* Section flags for .debug_macinfo/.debug_macro section. */
3575 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_FLAGS \
3576 (dwarf_split_debug_info ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE : SECTION_DEBUG)
3578 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
3579 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
3580 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_debug_strings \
3581 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
3582 : SECTION_DEBUG)
3584 /* Section flags for .debug_str.dwo section. */
3585 #define DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS (SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE)
3587 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
3588 the section names themselves. */
3590 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
3591 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
3592 #endif
3593 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
3594 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
3595 #endif
3596 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
3597 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
3598 #endif
3599 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
3600 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_line"
3601 #endif
3602 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
3603 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
3604 #endif
3605 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
3606 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_info"
3607 #endif
3608 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
3609 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
3610 #endif
3611 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
3612 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_abbrev"
3613 #endif
3614 #ifndef DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL
3615 #define DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_addr"
3616 #endif
3617 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
3618 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
3619 #endif
3620 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
3621 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
3622 #endif
3623 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
3624 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
3625 #endif
3626 #ifndef DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL
3627 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macro"
3628 #endif
3629 #define SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV 1
3630 #define SKELETON_TYPE_DIE_ABBREV 2
3632 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
3633 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
3634 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
3635 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
3636 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
3638 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3639 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3640 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3641 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3642 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3643 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3644 static char debug_skeleton_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3645 static char debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3646 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3647 static char debug_addr_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3648 static char debug_skeleton_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3649 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3650 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3651 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3653 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
3654 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
3655 #endif
3656 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
3657 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
3658 #endif
3659 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
3660 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
3661 #endif
3662 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
3663 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
3664 #endif
3665 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
3666 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
3667 #endif
3670 /* Return the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3671 static dw_die_ref
3672 comp_unit_die (void)
3674 if (!single_comp_unit_die)
3675 single_comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
3676 return single_comp_unit_die;
3679 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
3680 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
3682 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
3684 void
3685 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
3687 demangle_name_func = func;
3690 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
3692 static inline int
3693 is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx rtl)
3695 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3696 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
3697 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
3700 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
3701 removed. */
3703 static inline tree
3704 type_main_variant (tree type)
3706 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
3708 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
3709 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
3710 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
3711 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
3712 here. */
3713 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
3714 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
3715 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
3717 return type;
3720 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
3722 static inline int
3723 is_tagged_type (const_tree type)
3725 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
3727 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
3728 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
3731 /* Set label to debug_info_section_label + die_offset of a DIE reference. */
3733 static void
3734 get_ref_die_offset_label (char *label, dw_die_ref ref)
3736 sprintf (label, "%s+%ld", debug_info_section_label, ref->die_offset);
3739 /* Return die_offset of a DIE reference to a base type. */
3741 static unsigned long int
3742 get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref ref)
3744 if (ref->die_offset)
3745 return ref->die_offset;
3746 if (comp_unit_die ()->die_abbrev)
3748 calc_base_type_die_sizes ();
3749 gcc_assert (ref->die_offset);
3751 return ref->die_offset;
3754 /* Return die_offset of a DIE reference other than base type. */
3756 static unsigned long int
3757 get_ref_die_offset (dw_die_ref ref)
3759 gcc_assert (ref->die_offset);
3760 return ref->die_offset;
3763 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
3765 static const char *
3766 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
3768 const char *name = get_DW_TAG_name (tag);
3770 if (name != NULL)
3771 return name;
3773 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
3776 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
3778 static const char *
3779 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
3781 const char *name;
3783 switch (attr)
3785 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
3786 case DW_AT_HP_prologue:
3787 return "DW_AT_HP_prologue";
3788 #else
3789 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
3790 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
3791 #endif
3793 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
3794 case DW_AT_HP_epilogue:
3795 return "DW_AT_HP_epilogue";
3796 #else
3797 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
3798 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
3799 #endif
3802 name = get_DW_AT_name (attr);
3804 if (name != NULL)
3805 return name;
3807 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
3810 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
3812 static const char *
3813 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
3815 const char *name = get_DW_FORM_name (form);
3817 if (name != NULL)
3818 return name;
3820 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
3823 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
3824 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
3825 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
3826 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
3827 given block. */
3829 static tree
3830 decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree decl)
3832 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
3833 return NULL_TREE;
3835 /* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN can point to itself; ignore that if
3836 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
3837 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
3838 return NULL_TREE;
3840 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
3841 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
3842 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
3844 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
3847 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
3848 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
3849 parameter. */
3851 static tree
3852 decl_class_context (tree decl)
3854 tree context = NULL_TREE;
3856 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
3857 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
3858 else
3859 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
3860 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
3862 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
3863 context = NULL_TREE;
3865 return context;
3868 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. */
3870 static inline void
3871 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_node *attr)
3873 /* Maybe this should be an assert? */
3874 if (die == NULL)
3875 return;
3877 vec_safe_reserve (die->die_attr, 1);
3878 vec_safe_push (die->die_attr, *attr);
3881 static inline enum dw_val_class
3882 AT_class (dw_attr_node *a)
3884 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
3887 /* Return the index for any attribute that will be referenced with a
3888 DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index or DW_FORM_GNU_str_index. String indices
3889 are stored in dw_attr_val.v.val_str for reference counting
3890 pruning. */
3892 static inline unsigned int
3893 AT_index (dw_attr_node *a)
3895 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
3896 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->index;
3897 else if (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry != NULL)
3898 return a->dw_attr_val.val_entry->index;
3899 return NOT_INDEXED;
3902 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
3904 static inline void
3905 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
3907 dw_attr_node attr;
3909 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3910 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
3911 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
3912 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
3913 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3916 static inline unsigned
3917 AT_flag (dw_attr_node *a)
3919 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
3920 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
3923 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
3925 static inline void
3926 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
3928 dw_attr_node attr;
3930 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3931 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
3932 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
3933 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
3934 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3937 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
3938 AT_int (dw_attr_node *a)
3940 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const);
3941 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
3944 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
3946 static inline void
3947 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3948 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
3950 dw_attr_node attr;
3952 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3953 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3954 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
3955 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
3956 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3959 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
3960 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_node *a)
3962 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const);
3963 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
3966 /* Add an unsigned wide integer attribute value to a DIE. */
3968 static inline void
3969 add_AT_wide (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3970 const wide_int& w)
3972 dw_attr_node attr;
3974 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3975 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_wide_int;
3976 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
3977 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
3978 *attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_wide = w;
3979 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3982 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
3984 static inline void
3985 add_AT_double (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3986 HOST_WIDE_INT high, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT low)
3988 dw_attr_node attr;
3990 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3991 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
3992 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
3993 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high = high;
3994 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low = low;
3995 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3998 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
4000 static inline void
4001 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4002 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
4004 dw_attr_node attr;
4006 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4007 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
4008 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4009 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
4010 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
4011 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
4012 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4015 /* Add an 8-byte data attribute value to a DIE. */
4017 static inline void
4018 add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4019 unsigned char data8[8])
4021 dw_attr_node attr;
4023 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4024 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_data8;
4025 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4026 memcpy (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_data8, data8, 8);
4027 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4030 /* Add DW_AT_low_pc and DW_AT_high_pc to a DIE. When using
4031 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
4032 final executable have force_direct set to avoid using indexed
4033 references. */
4035 static inline void
4036 add_AT_low_high_pc (dw_die_ref die, const char *lbl_low, const char *lbl_high,
4037 bool force_direct)
4039 dw_attr_node attr;
4040 char * lbl_id;
4042 lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_low);
4043 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_low_pc;
4044 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4045 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = lbl_id;
4046 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4047 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4048 = add_addr_table_entry (lbl_id, ate_kind_label);
4049 else
4050 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4051 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4053 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_high_pc;
4054 if (dwarf_version < 4)
4055 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4056 else
4057 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_high_pc;
4058 lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_high);
4059 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = lbl_id;
4060 if (attr.dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_lbl_id
4061 && dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4062 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4063 = add_addr_table_entry (lbl_id, ate_kind_label);
4064 else
4065 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4066 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4069 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
4071 hashval_t
4072 indirect_string_hasher::hash (indirect_string_node *x)
4074 return htab_hash_string (x->str);
4077 bool
4078 indirect_string_hasher::equal (indirect_string_node *x1, const char *x2)
4080 return strcmp (x1->str, x2) == 0;
4083 /* Add STR to the given string hash table. */
4085 static struct indirect_string_node *
4086 find_AT_string_in_table (const char *str,
4087 hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *table)
4089 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4091 indirect_string_node **slot
4092 = table->find_slot_with_hash (str, htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
4093 if (*slot == NULL)
4095 node = ggc_cleared_alloc<indirect_string_node> ();
4096 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
4097 *slot = node;
4099 else
4100 node = *slot;
4102 node->refcount++;
4103 return node;
4106 /* Add STR to the indirect string hash table. */
4108 static struct indirect_string_node *
4109 find_AT_string (const char *str)
4111 if (! debug_str_hash)
4112 debug_str_hash = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
4114 return find_AT_string_in_table (str, debug_str_hash);
4117 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
4119 static inline void
4120 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
4122 dw_attr_node attr;
4123 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4125 node = find_AT_string (str);
4127 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4128 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
4129 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4130 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
4131 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4134 static inline const char *
4135 AT_string (dw_attr_node *a)
4137 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4138 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
4141 /* Call this function directly to bypass AT_string_form's logic to put
4142 the string inline in the die. */
4144 static void
4145 set_indirect_string (struct indirect_string_node *node)
4147 char label[32];
4148 /* Already indirect is a no op. */
4149 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp || node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
4151 gcc_assert (node->label);
4152 return;
4154 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
4155 ++dw2_string_counter;
4156 node->label = xstrdup (label);
4158 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
4160 node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
4161 node->index = NOT_INDEXED;
4163 else
4165 node->form = DW_FORM_GNU_str_index;
4166 node->index = NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED;
4170 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
4171 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4173 static enum dwarf_form
4174 find_string_form (struct indirect_string_node *node)
4176 unsigned int len;
4178 if (node->form)
4179 return node->form;
4181 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
4183 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
4184 always better to put it inline. */
4185 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
4186 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4188 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
4189 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
4190 single module. */
4191 if (DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
4192 || ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
4193 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len))
4194 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4196 set_indirect_string (node);
4198 return node->form;
4201 /* Find out whether the string referenced from the attribute should be
4202 output inline in DIE or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4204 static enum dwarf_form
4205 AT_string_form (dw_attr_node *a)
4207 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4208 return find_string_form (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str);
4211 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4213 static inline void
4214 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
4216 dw_attr_node attr;
4217 gcc_checking_assert (targ_die != NULL);
4219 /* With LTO we can end up trying to reference something we didn't create
4220 a DIE for. Avoid crashing later on a NULL referenced DIE. */
4221 if (targ_die == NULL)
4222 return;
4224 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4225 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
4226 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4227 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
4228 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4229 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4232 /* Change DIE reference REF to point to NEW_DIE instead. */
4234 static inline void
4235 change_AT_die_ref (dw_attr_node *ref, dw_die_ref new_die)
4237 gcc_assert (ref->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4238 ref->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = new_die;
4239 ref->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4242 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
4243 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
4245 static inline void
4246 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
4248 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
4249 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
4250 targ_die->die_definition = die;
4253 static inline dw_die_ref
4254 AT_ref (dw_attr_node *a)
4256 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4257 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
4260 static inline int
4261 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *a)
4263 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
4264 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
4266 return 0;
4269 static inline void
4270 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *a, int i)
4272 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4273 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
4276 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4278 static inline void
4279 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
4281 dw_attr_node attr;
4283 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4284 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
4285 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4286 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
4287 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4290 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
4292 static inline void
4293 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4295 dw_attr_node attr;
4297 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4298 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
4299 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4300 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
4301 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4304 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4305 AT_loc (dw_attr_node *a)
4307 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
4308 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
4311 static inline void
4312 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
4314 dw_attr_node attr;
4316 if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO && !HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS)
4317 return;
4319 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4320 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
4321 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4322 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
4323 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4324 have_location_lists = true;
4327 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
4328 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_node *a)
4330 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
4331 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
4334 static inline dw_loc_list_ref *
4335 AT_loc_list_ptr (dw_attr_node *a)
4337 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
4338 return &a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
4341 struct addr_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<addr_table_entry>
4343 static hashval_t hash (addr_table_entry *);
4344 static bool equal (addr_table_entry *, addr_table_entry *);
4347 /* Table of entries into the .debug_addr section. */
4349 static GTY (()) hash_table<addr_hasher> *addr_index_table;
4351 /* Hash an address_table_entry. */
4353 hashval_t
4354 addr_hasher::hash (addr_table_entry *a)
4356 inchash::hash hstate;
4357 switch (a->kind)
4359 case ate_kind_rtx:
4360 hstate.add_int (0);
4361 break;
4362 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4363 hstate.add_int (1);
4364 break;
4365 case ate_kind_label:
4366 return htab_hash_string (a->addr.label);
4367 default:
4368 gcc_unreachable ();
4370 inchash::add_rtx (a->addr.rtl, hstate);
4371 return hstate.end ();
4374 /* Determine equality for two address_table_entries. */
4376 bool
4377 addr_hasher::equal (addr_table_entry *a1, addr_table_entry *a2)
4379 if (a1->kind != a2->kind)
4380 return 0;
4381 switch (a1->kind)
4383 case ate_kind_rtx:
4384 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4385 return rtx_equal_p (a1->addr.rtl, a2->addr.rtl);
4386 case ate_kind_label:
4387 return strcmp (a1->addr.label, a2->addr.label) == 0;
4388 default:
4389 gcc_unreachable ();
4393 /* Initialize an addr_table_entry. */
4395 void
4396 init_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *e, enum ate_kind kind, void *addr)
4398 e->kind = kind;
4399 switch (kind)
4401 case ate_kind_rtx:
4402 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4403 e->addr.rtl = (rtx) addr;
4404 break;
4405 case ate_kind_label:
4406 e->addr.label = (char *) addr;
4407 break;
4409 e->refcount = 0;
4410 e->index = NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED;
4413 /* Add attr to the address table entry to the table. Defer setting an
4414 index until output time. */
4416 static addr_table_entry *
4417 add_addr_table_entry (void *addr, enum ate_kind kind)
4419 addr_table_entry *node;
4420 addr_table_entry finder;
4422 gcc_assert (dwarf_split_debug_info);
4423 if (! addr_index_table)
4424 addr_index_table = hash_table<addr_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
4425 init_addr_table_entry (&finder, kind, addr);
4426 addr_table_entry **slot = addr_index_table->find_slot (&finder, INSERT);
4428 if (*slot == HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
4430 node = ggc_cleared_alloc<addr_table_entry> ();
4431 init_addr_table_entry (node, kind, addr);
4432 *slot = node;
4434 else
4435 node = *slot;
4437 node->refcount++;
4438 return node;
4441 /* Remove an entry from the addr table by decrementing its refcount.
4442 Strictly, decrementing the refcount would be enough, but the
4443 assertion that the entry is actually in the table has found
4444 bugs. */
4446 static void
4447 remove_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *entry)
4449 gcc_assert (dwarf_split_debug_info && addr_index_table);
4450 /* After an index is assigned, the table is frozen. */
4451 gcc_assert (entry->refcount > 0 && entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
4452 entry->refcount--;
4455 /* Given a location list, remove all addresses it refers to from the
4456 address_table. */
4458 static void
4459 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
4461 for (; descr; descr = descr->dw_loc_next)
4462 if (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry != NULL)
4464 gcc_assert (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
4465 remove_addr_table_entry (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry);
4469 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
4470 htab_traverse. Assign an addr_table_entry its index. All entries
4471 must be collected into the table when this function is called,
4472 because the indexing code relies on htab_traverse to traverse nodes
4473 in the same order for each run. */
4476 index_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry **h, unsigned int *index)
4478 addr_table_entry *node = *h;
4480 /* Don't index unreferenced nodes. */
4481 if (node->refcount == 0)
4482 return 1;
4484 gcc_assert (node->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
4485 node->index = *index;
4486 *index += 1;
4488 return 1;
4491 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. When using
4492 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
4493 final executable should be direct references--setting the parameter
4494 force_direct ensures this behavior. */
4496 static inline void
4497 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr,
4498 bool force_direct)
4500 dw_attr_node attr;
4502 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4503 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
4504 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
4505 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4506 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = add_addr_table_entry (addr, ate_kind_rtx);
4507 else
4508 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4509 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4512 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute. */
4514 static inline rtx
4515 AT_addr (dw_attr_node *a)
4517 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
4518 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
4521 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE. */
4523 static inline void
4524 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4525 struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
4527 dw_attr_node attr;
4529 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4530 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
4531 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4532 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
4533 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4536 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute. */
4538 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
4539 AT_file (dw_attr_node *a)
4541 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file);
4542 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
4545 /* Add a vms delta attribute value to a DIE. */
4547 static inline void
4548 add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4549 const char *lbl1, const char *lbl2)
4551 dw_attr_node attr;
4553 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4554 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vms_delta;
4555 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4556 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1 = xstrdup (lbl1);
4557 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2 = xstrdup (lbl2);
4558 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4561 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
4563 static inline void
4564 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4565 const char *lbl_id)
4567 dw_attr_node attr;
4569 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4570 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4571 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4572 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
4573 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
4574 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4575 = add_addr_table_entry (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id,
4576 ate_kind_label);
4577 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4580 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
4581 debug_line section. */
4583 static inline void
4584 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4585 const char *label)
4587 dw_attr_node attr;
4589 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4590 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
4591 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4592 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
4593 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4596 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
4597 debug_macinfo section. */
4599 static inline void
4600 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4601 const char *label)
4603 dw_attr_node attr;
4605 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4606 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
4607 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4608 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
4609 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4612 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
4614 static inline void
4615 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4616 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4618 dw_attr_node attr;
4620 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4621 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
4622 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4623 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
4624 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4627 /* Add a range_list attribute value to a DIE. When using
4628 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
4629 final executable should be direct references--setting the parameter
4630 force_direct ensures this behavior. */
4632 #define UNRELOCATED_OFFSET ((addr_table_entry *) 1)
4633 #define RELOCATED_OFFSET (NULL)
4635 static void
4636 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4637 long unsigned int offset, bool force_direct)
4639 dw_attr_node attr;
4641 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4642 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
4643 /* For the range_list attribute, use val_entry to store whether the
4644 offset should follow split-debug-info or normal semantics. This
4645 value is read in output_range_list_offset. */
4646 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4647 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = UNRELOCATED_OFFSET;
4648 else
4649 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = RELOCATED_OFFSET;
4650 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
4651 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4654 /* Return the start label of a delta attribute. */
4656 static inline const char *
4657 AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_node *a)
4659 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
4660 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1;
4663 /* Return the end label of a delta attribute. */
4665 static inline const char *
4666 AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_node *a)
4668 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
4669 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2;
4672 static inline const char *
4673 AT_lbl (dw_attr_node *a)
4675 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
4676 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
4677 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr
4678 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_high_pc));
4679 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
4682 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
4684 static dw_attr_node *
4685 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4687 dw_attr_node *a;
4688 unsigned ix;
4689 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
4691 if (! die)
4692 return NULL;
4694 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
4695 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
4696 return a;
4697 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
4698 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
4699 spec = AT_ref (a);
4701 if (spec)
4702 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
4704 return NULL;
4707 /* Returns the parent of the declaration of DIE. */
4709 static dw_die_ref
4710 get_die_parent (dw_die_ref die)
4712 dw_die_ref t;
4714 if (!die)
4715 return NULL;
4717 if ((t = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
4718 || (t = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification)))
4719 die = t;
4721 return die->die_parent;
4724 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
4725 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
4726 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
4728 static inline const char *
4729 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
4731 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
4733 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
4736 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
4737 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
4738 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
4740 static inline const char *
4741 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
4743 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
4745 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
4748 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
4749 NULL if it is not present. */
4751 static inline const char *
4752 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4754 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4756 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
4759 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
4760 if it is not present. */
4762 static inline int
4763 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4765 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4767 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
4770 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
4771 if it is not present. */
4773 static inline unsigned
4774 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4776 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4778 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
4781 static inline dw_die_ref
4782 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4784 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4786 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
4789 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
4790 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4792 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4794 return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
4797 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
4799 static inline bool
4800 is_cxx (void)
4802 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
4804 return (lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus
4805 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14);
4808 /* Return TRUE if the language is Java. */
4810 static inline bool
4811 is_java (void)
4813 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
4815 return lang == DW_LANG_Java;
4818 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
4820 static inline bool
4821 is_fortran (void)
4823 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
4825 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
4826 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
4827 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95
4828 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran03
4829 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran08);
4832 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
4834 static inline bool
4835 is_ada (void)
4837 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
4839 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
4842 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. Return TRUE if removal
4843 was successful. */
4845 static bool
4846 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4848 dw_attr_node *a;
4849 unsigned ix;
4851 if (! die)
4852 return false;
4854 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
4855 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
4857 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
4858 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
4859 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
4861 /* vec::ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
4862 that are needed. */
4863 die->die_attr->ordered_remove (ix);
4864 return true;
4866 return false;
4869 /* Remove CHILD from its parent. PREV must have the property that
4870 PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD. Does not alter CHILD. */
4872 static void
4873 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
4875 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
4876 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
4877 if (prev == child)
4879 gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
4880 prev = NULL;
4882 else
4883 prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
4884 if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
4885 child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
4888 /* Replace OLD_CHILD with NEW_CHILD. PREV must have the property that
4889 PREV->DIE_SIB == OLD_CHILD. Does not alter OLD_CHILD. */
4891 static void
4892 replace_child (dw_die_ref old_child, dw_die_ref new_child, dw_die_ref prev)
4894 dw_die_ref parent = old_child->die_parent;
4896 gcc_assert (parent == prev->die_parent);
4897 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == old_child);
4899 new_child->die_parent = parent;
4900 if (prev == old_child)
4902 gcc_assert (parent->die_child == old_child);
4903 new_child->die_sib = new_child;
4905 else
4907 prev->die_sib = new_child;
4908 new_child->die_sib = old_child->die_sib;
4910 if (old_child->die_parent->die_child == old_child)
4911 old_child->die_parent->die_child = new_child;
4914 /* Move all children from OLD_PARENT to NEW_PARENT. */
4916 static void
4917 move_all_children (dw_die_ref old_parent, dw_die_ref new_parent)
4919 dw_die_ref c;
4920 new_parent->die_child = old_parent->die_child;
4921 old_parent->die_child = NULL;
4922 FOR_EACH_CHILD (new_parent, c, c->die_parent = new_parent);
4925 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG. Do nothing if no child
4926 matches TAG. */
4928 static void
4929 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
4931 dw_die_ref c;
4933 c = die->die_child;
4934 if (c) do {
4935 dw_die_ref prev = c;
4936 c = c->die_sib;
4937 while (c->die_tag == tag)
4939 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
4940 c->die_parent = NULL;
4941 /* Might have removed every child. */
4942 if (c == c->die_sib)
4943 return;
4944 c = c->die_sib;
4946 } while (c != die->die_child);
4949 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE. */
4951 static void
4952 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
4954 /* FIXME this should probably be an assert. */
4955 if (! die || ! child_die)
4956 return;
4957 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
4959 child_die->die_parent = die;
4960 if (die->die_child)
4962 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
4963 die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
4965 else
4966 child_die->die_sib = child_die;
4967 die->die_child = child_die;
4970 /* Like add_child_die, but put CHILD_DIE after AFTER_DIE. */
4972 static void
4973 add_child_die_after (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die,
4974 dw_die_ref after_die)
4976 gcc_assert (die
4977 && child_die
4978 && after_die
4979 && die->die_child
4980 && die != child_die);
4982 child_die->die_parent = die;
4983 child_die->die_sib = after_die->die_sib;
4984 after_die->die_sib = child_die;
4985 if (die->die_child == after_die)
4986 die->die_child = child_die;
4989 /* Unassociate CHILD from its parent, and make its parent be
4990 NEW_PARENT. */
4992 static void
4993 reparent_child (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref new_parent)
4995 for (dw_die_ref p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
4996 if (p->die_sib == child)
4998 remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
4999 break;
5001 add_child_die (new_parent, child);
5004 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5005 is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
5006 This is done by removing and re-adding it. */
5008 static void
5009 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
5011 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5012 specification DIE at toplevel. */
5013 if (child->die_parent != parent)
5015 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5017 if (tmp)
5018 child = tmp;
5021 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
5022 || (child->die_parent
5023 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
5025 reparent_child (child, parent);
5028 /* Create and return a new die with a parent of PARENT_DIE. If
5029 PARENT_DIE is NULL, the new DIE is placed in limbo and an
5030 associated tree T must be supplied to determine parenthood
5031 later. */
5033 static inline dw_die_ref
5034 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
5036 dw_die_ref die = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
5038 die->die_tag = tag_value;
5040 if (parent_die != NULL)
5041 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5042 else
5044 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5046 /* No DIEs created after early dwarf should end up in limbo,
5047 because the limbo list should not persist past LTO
5048 streaming. */
5049 if (tag_value != DW_TAG_compile_unit
5050 /* These are allowed because they're generated while
5051 breaking out COMDAT units late. */
5052 && tag_value != DW_TAG_type_unit
5053 && !early_dwarf
5054 /* Allow nested functions to live in limbo because they will
5055 only temporarily live there, as decls_for_scope will fix
5056 them up. */
5057 && (TREE_CODE (t) != FUNCTION_DECL
5058 || !decl_function_context (t))
5059 /* Same as nested functions above but for types. Types that
5060 are local to a function will be fixed in
5061 decls_for_scope. */
5062 && (!RECORD_OR_UNION_TYPE_P (t)
5063 || !TYPE_CONTEXT (t)
5064 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (t)) != FUNCTION_DECL)
5065 /* FIXME debug-early: Allow late limbo DIE creation for LTO,
5066 especially in the ltrans stage, but once we implement LTO
5067 dwarf streaming, we should remove this exception. */
5068 && !in_lto_p)
5070 fprintf (stderr, "symbol ended up in limbo too late:");
5071 debug_generic_stmt (t);
5072 gcc_unreachable ();
5075 limbo_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<limbo_die_node> ();
5076 limbo_node->die = die;
5077 limbo_node->created_for = t;
5078 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5079 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5082 return die;
5085 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
5087 static inline dw_die_ref
5088 lookup_type_die (tree type)
5090 return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
5093 /* Given a TYPE_DIE representing the type TYPE, if TYPE is an
5094 anonymous type named by the typedef TYPE_DIE, return the DIE of the
5095 anonymous type instead the one of the naming typedef. */
5097 static inline dw_die_ref
5098 strip_naming_typedef (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5100 if (type
5101 && TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
5102 && type_die
5103 && type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef
5104 && is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
5105 type_die = get_AT_ref (type_die, DW_AT_type);
5106 return type_die;
5109 /* Like lookup_type_die, but if type is an anonymous type named by a
5110 typedef[1], return the DIE of the anonymous type instead the one of
5111 the naming typedef. This is because in gen_typedef_die, we did
5112 equate the anonymous struct named by the typedef with the DIE of
5113 the naming typedef. So by default, lookup_type_die on an anonymous
5114 struct yields the DIE of the naming typedef.
5116 [1]: Read the comment of is_naming_typedef_decl to learn about what
5117 a naming typedef is. */
5119 static inline dw_die_ref
5120 lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree type)
5122 dw_die_ref die = lookup_type_die (type);
5123 return strip_naming_typedef (type, die);
5126 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
5128 static inline void
5129 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5131 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
5134 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
5136 inline hashval_t
5137 decl_die_hasher::hash (die_node *x)
5139 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
5142 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
5144 inline bool
5145 decl_die_hasher::equal (die_node *x, tree y)
5147 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5150 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
5152 static inline dw_die_ref
5153 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
5155 return decl_die_table->find_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5158 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
5160 inline hashval_t
5161 decl_loc_hasher::hash (var_loc_list *x)
5163 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
5166 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
5167 UID of decl *Y. */
5169 inline bool
5170 decl_loc_hasher::equal (var_loc_list *x, const_tree y)
5172 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5175 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
5177 static inline var_loc_list *
5178 lookup_decl_loc (const_tree decl)
5180 if (!decl_loc_table)
5181 return NULL;
5182 return decl_loc_table->find_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5185 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a cached_dw_loc_list_list). */
5187 inline hashval_t
5188 dw_loc_list_hasher::hash (cached_dw_loc_list *x)
5190 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
5193 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of cached_dw_loc_list X is the same as
5194 UID of decl *Y. */
5196 inline bool
5197 dw_loc_list_hasher::equal (cached_dw_loc_list *x, const_tree y)
5199 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5202 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
5204 static void
5205 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
5207 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5209 *decl_die_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, decl_id, INSERT) = decl_die;
5210 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
5213 /* Return how many bits covers PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
5215 static HOST_WIDE_INT
5216 decl_piece_bitsize (rtx piece)
5218 int ret = (int) GET_MODE (piece);
5219 if (ret)
5220 return ret;
5221 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (piece, 0)) == CONCAT
5222 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0)));
5223 return INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0));
5226 /* Return pointer to the location of location note in PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
5228 static rtx *
5229 decl_piece_varloc_ptr (rtx piece)
5231 if ((int) GET_MODE (piece))
5232 return &XEXP (piece, 0);
5233 else
5234 return &XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 1);
5237 /* Create an EXPR_LIST for location note LOC_NOTE covering BITSIZE bits.
5238 Next is the chain of following piece nodes. */
5240 static rtx_expr_list *
5241 decl_piece_node (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx next)
5243 if (bitsize > 0 && bitsize <= (int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
5244 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (bitsize, loc_note, next);
5245 else
5246 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (0, gen_rtx_CONCAT (VOIDmode,
5247 GEN_INT (bitsize),
5248 loc_note), next);
5251 /* Return rtx that should be stored into loc field for
5252 LOC_NOTE and BITPOS/BITSIZE. */
5254 static rtx
5255 construct_piece_list (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
5256 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize)
5258 if (bitsize != -1)
5260 loc_note = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, NULL_RTX);
5261 if (bitpos != 0)
5262 loc_note = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos, loc_note);
5264 return loc_note;
5267 /* This function either modifies location piece list *DEST in
5268 place (if SRC and INNER is NULL), or copies location piece list
5269 *SRC to *DEST while modifying it. Location BITPOS is modified
5270 to contain LOC_NOTE, any pieces overlapping it are removed resp.
5271 not copied and if needed some padding around it is added.
5272 When modifying in place, DEST should point to EXPR_LIST where
5273 earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits, when copying SRC points
5274 to the start of the whole list and INNER points to the EXPR_LIST
5275 where earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits. */
5277 static void
5278 adjust_piece_list (rtx *dest, rtx *src, rtx *inner,
5279 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos,
5280 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx loc_note)
5282 HOST_WIDE_INT diff;
5283 bool copy = inner != NULL;
5285 if (copy)
5287 /* First copy all nodes preceding the current bitpos. */
5288 while (src != inner)
5290 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
5291 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
5292 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5293 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
5296 /* Add padding if needed. */
5297 if (bitpos != piece_bitpos)
5299 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos - piece_bitpos,
5300 copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
5301 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5303 else if (*dest && decl_piece_bitsize (*dest) == bitsize)
5305 gcc_assert (!copy);
5306 /* A piece with correct bitpos and bitsize already exist,
5307 just update the location for it and return. */
5308 *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*dest) = loc_note;
5309 return;
5311 /* Add the piece that changed. */
5312 *dest = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
5313 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5314 /* Skip over pieces that overlap it. */
5315 diff = bitpos - piece_bitpos + bitsize;
5316 if (!copy)
5317 src = dest;
5318 while (diff > 0 && *src)
5320 rtx piece = *src;
5321 diff -= decl_piece_bitsize (piece);
5322 if (copy)
5323 src = &XEXP (piece, 1);
5324 else
5326 *src = XEXP (piece, 1);
5327 free_EXPR_LIST_node (piece);
5330 /* Add padding if needed. */
5331 if (diff < 0 && *src)
5333 if (!copy)
5334 dest = src;
5335 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, -diff, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
5336 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5338 if (!copy)
5339 return;
5340 /* Finally copy all nodes following it. */
5341 while (*src)
5343 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
5344 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
5345 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5346 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
5350 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
5352 static struct var_loc_node *
5353 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, rtx loc_note, const char *label)
5355 unsigned int decl_id;
5356 var_loc_list *temp;
5357 struct var_loc_node *loc = NULL;
5358 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = -1, bitpos = -1;
5360 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
5361 && DECL_HAS_DEBUG_EXPR_P (decl))
5363 tree realdecl = DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl);
5364 if (handled_component_p (realdecl)
5365 || (TREE_CODE (realdecl) == MEM_REF
5366 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (realdecl, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR))
5368 HOST_WIDE_INT maxsize;
5369 bool reverse;
5370 tree innerdecl
5371 = get_ref_base_and_extent (realdecl, &bitpos, &bitsize, &maxsize,
5372 &reverse);
5373 if (!DECL_P (innerdecl)
5374 || DECL_IGNORED_P (innerdecl)
5375 || TREE_STATIC (innerdecl)
5376 || bitsize <= 0
5377 || bitpos + bitsize > 256
5378 || bitsize != maxsize)
5379 return NULL;
5380 decl = innerdecl;
5384 decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5385 var_loc_list **slot
5386 = decl_loc_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5387 if (*slot == NULL)
5389 temp = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_list> ();
5390 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
5391 *slot = temp;
5393 else
5394 temp = *slot;
5396 /* For PARM_DECLs try to keep around the original incoming value,
5397 even if that means we'll emit a zero-range .debug_loc entry. */
5398 if (temp->last
5399 && temp->first == temp->last
5400 && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
5401 && NOTE_P (temp->first->loc)
5402 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (temp->first->loc) == decl
5403 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)
5404 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc)
5405 && GET_CODE (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc))
5406 == GET_CODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
5407 && prev_real_insn (temp->first->loc) == NULL_RTX
5408 && (bitsize != -1
5409 || !rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc),
5410 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note))
5411 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (temp->first->loc)
5412 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))))
5414 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
5415 temp->first->next = loc;
5416 temp->last = loc;
5417 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
5419 else if (temp->last)
5421 struct var_loc_node *last = temp->last, *unused = NULL;
5422 rtx *piece_loc = NULL, last_loc_note;
5423 HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos = 0;
5424 if (last->next)
5426 last = last->next;
5427 gcc_assert (last->next == NULL);
5429 if (bitsize != -1 && GET_CODE (last->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
5431 piece_loc = &last->loc;
5434 HOST_WIDE_INT cur_bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc);
5435 if (piece_bitpos + cur_bitsize > bitpos)
5436 break;
5437 piece_bitpos += cur_bitsize;
5438 piece_loc = &XEXP (*piece_loc, 1);
5440 while (*piece_loc);
5442 /* TEMP->LAST here is either pointer to the last but one or
5443 last element in the chained list, LAST is pointer to the
5444 last element. */
5445 if (label && strcmp (last->label, label) == 0)
5447 /* For SRA optimized variables if there weren't any real
5448 insns since last note, just modify the last node. */
5449 if (piece_loc != NULL)
5451 adjust_piece_list (piece_loc, NULL, NULL,
5452 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
5453 return NULL;
5455 /* If the last note doesn't cover any instructions, remove it. */
5456 if (temp->last != last)
5458 temp->last->next = NULL;
5459 unused = last;
5460 last = temp->last;
5461 gcc_assert (strcmp (last->label, label) != 0);
5463 else
5465 gcc_assert (temp->first == temp->last
5466 || (temp->first->next == temp->last
5467 && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL));
5468 memset (temp->last, '\0', sizeof (*temp->last));
5469 temp->last->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
5470 return temp->last;
5473 if (bitsize == -1 && NOTE_P (last->loc))
5474 last_loc_note = last->loc;
5475 else if (piece_loc != NULL
5476 && *piece_loc != NULL_RTX
5477 && piece_bitpos == bitpos
5478 && decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc) == bitsize)
5479 last_loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*piece_loc);
5480 else
5481 last_loc_note = NULL_RTX;
5482 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
5483 and either both or neither of the locations is uninitialized,
5484 we have nothing to do. */
5485 if (last_loc_note == NULL_RTX
5486 || (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (last_loc_note),
5487 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note)))
5488 || ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
5489 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))
5490 && ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
5491 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
5492 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note)
5493 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED))))
5495 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. If the last
5496 element of the list has been removed above, reuse its
5497 memory for the new node, otherwise allocate a new one. */
5498 if (unused)
5500 loc = unused;
5501 memset (loc, '\0', sizeof (*loc));
5503 else
5504 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
5505 if (bitsize == -1 || piece_loc == NULL)
5506 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
5507 else
5508 adjust_piece_list (&loc->loc, &last->loc, piece_loc,
5509 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
5510 last->next = loc;
5511 /* Ensure TEMP->LAST will point either to the new last but one
5512 element of the chain, or to the last element in it. */
5513 if (last != temp->last)
5514 temp->last = last;
5516 else if (unused)
5517 ggc_free (unused);
5519 else
5521 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
5522 temp->first = loc;
5523 temp->last = loc;
5524 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
5526 return loc;
5529 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
5530 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
5531 the DIE internal representation. */
5532 static int print_indent;
5534 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
5536 static inline void
5537 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
5539 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
5542 /* Print a type signature in hex. */
5544 static inline void
5545 print_signature (FILE *outfile, char *sig)
5547 int i;
5549 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
5550 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", sig[i] & 0xff);
5553 static inline void
5554 print_discr_value (FILE *outfile, dw_discr_value *discr_value)
5556 if (discr_value->pos)
5557 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, discr_value->v.sval);
5558 else
5559 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, discr_value->v.uval);
5562 static void print_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref, FILE *);
5564 /* Print the value associated to the VAL DWARF value node to OUTFILE. If
5565 RECURSE, output location descriptor operations. */
5567 static void
5568 print_dw_val (dw_val_node *val, bool recurse, FILE *outfile)
5570 switch (val->val_class)
5572 case dw_val_class_addr:
5573 fprintf (outfile, "address");
5574 break;
5575 case dw_val_class_offset:
5576 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
5577 break;
5578 case dw_val_class_loc:
5579 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
5580 if (val->v.val_loc == NULL)
5581 fprintf (outfile, " -> <null>\n");
5582 else if (recurse)
5584 fprintf (outfile, ":\n");
5585 print_indent += 4;
5586 print_loc_descr (val->v.val_loc, outfile);
5587 print_indent -= 4;
5589 else
5590 fprintf (outfile, " (%p)\n", (void *) val->v.val_loc);
5591 break;
5592 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
5593 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
5594 val->v.val_loc_list->ll_symbol);
5595 break;
5596 case dw_val_class_range_list:
5597 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
5598 break;
5599 case dw_val_class_const:
5600 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, val->v.val_int);
5601 break;
5602 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5603 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, val->v.val_unsigned);
5604 break;
5605 case dw_val_class_const_double:
5606 fprintf (outfile, "constant (" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC","\
5607 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED")",
5608 val->v.val_double.high,
5609 val->v.val_double.low);
5610 break;
5611 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
5613 int i = val->v.val_wide->get_len ();
5614 fprintf (outfile, "constant (");
5615 gcc_assert (i > 0);
5616 if (val->v.val_wide->elt (i - 1) == 0)
5617 fprintf (outfile, "0x");
5618 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
5619 val->v.val_wide->elt (--i));
5620 while (--i >= 0)
5621 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_PADDED_HEX,
5622 val->v.val_wide->elt (i));
5623 fprintf (outfile, ")");
5624 break;
5626 case dw_val_class_vec:
5627 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
5628 break;
5629 case dw_val_class_flag:
5630 fprintf (outfile, "%u", val->v.val_flag);
5631 break;
5632 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5633 if (val->v.val_die_ref.die != NULL)
5635 dw_die_ref die = val->v.val_die_ref.die;
5637 if (die->comdat_type_p)
5639 fprintf (outfile, "die -> signature: ");
5640 print_signature (outfile,
5641 die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
5643 else if (die->die_id.die_symbol)
5644 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", die->die_id.die_symbol);
5645 else
5646 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %ld", die->die_offset);
5647 fprintf (outfile, " (%p)", (void *) die);
5649 else
5650 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
5651 break;
5652 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
5653 fprintf (outfile, "delta: @slotcount(%s-%s)",
5654 val->v.val_vms_delta.lbl2, val->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1);
5655 break;
5656 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5657 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5658 case dw_val_class_macptr:
5659 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
5660 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", val->v.val_lbl_id);
5661 break;
5662 case dw_val_class_str:
5663 if (val->v.val_str->str != NULL)
5664 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", val->v.val_str->str);
5665 else
5666 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
5667 break;
5668 case dw_val_class_file:
5669 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", val->v.val_file->filename,
5670 val->v.val_file->emitted_number);
5671 break;
5672 case dw_val_class_data8:
5674 int i;
5676 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
5677 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", val->v.val_data8[i]);
5678 break;
5680 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
5681 print_discr_value (outfile, &val->v.val_discr_value);
5682 break;
5683 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
5684 for (dw_discr_list_ref node = val->v.val_discr_list;
5685 node != NULL;
5686 node = node->dw_discr_next)
5688 if (node->dw_discr_range)
5690 fprintf (outfile, " .. ");
5691 print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_lower_bound);
5692 print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_upper_bound);
5694 else
5695 print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_lower_bound);
5697 if (node->dw_discr_next != NULL)
5698 fprintf (outfile, " | ");
5700 default:
5701 break;
5705 /* Likewise, for a DIE attribute. */
5707 static void
5708 print_attribute (dw_attr_node *a, bool recurse, FILE *outfile)
5710 print_dw_val (&a->dw_attr_val, recurse, outfile);
5714 /* Print the list of operands in the LOC location description to OUTFILE. This
5715 routine is a debugging aid only. */
5717 static void
5718 print_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, FILE *outfile)
5720 dw_loc_descr_ref l = loc;
5722 if (loc == NULL)
5724 print_spaces (outfile);
5725 fprintf (outfile, "<null>\n");
5726 return;
5729 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
5731 print_spaces (outfile);
5732 fprintf (outfile, "(%p) %s",
5733 (void *) l,
5734 dwarf_stack_op_name (l->dw_loc_opc));
5735 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class != dw_val_class_none)
5737 fprintf (outfile, " ");
5738 print_dw_val (&l->dw_loc_oprnd1, false, outfile);
5740 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class != dw_val_class_none)
5742 fprintf (outfile, ", ");
5743 print_dw_val (&l->dw_loc_oprnd2, false, outfile);
5745 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5749 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
5750 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5752 static void
5753 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
5755 dw_attr_node *a;
5756 dw_die_ref c;
5757 unsigned ix;
5759 print_spaces (outfile);
5760 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4ld: %s (%p)\n",
5761 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag),
5762 (void*) die);
5763 print_spaces (outfile);
5764 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
5765 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %ld", die->die_offset);
5766 fprintf (outfile, " mark: %d\n", die->die_mark);
5768 if (die->comdat_type_p)
5770 print_spaces (outfile);
5771 fprintf (outfile, " signature: ");
5772 print_signature (outfile, die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
5773 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5776 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
5778 print_spaces (outfile);
5779 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
5781 print_attribute (a, true, outfile);
5782 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5785 if (die->die_child != NULL)
5787 print_indent += 4;
5788 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
5789 print_indent -= 4;
5791 if (print_indent == 0)
5792 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5795 /* Print the list of operations in the LOC location description. */
5797 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
5798 debug_dwarf_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5800 print_loc_descr (loc, stderr);
5803 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
5805 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
5806 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
5808 print_die (die, stderr);
5811 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
5812 debug (die_struct &ref)
5814 print_die (&ref, stderr);
5817 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
5818 debug (die_struct *ptr)
5820 if (ptr)
5821 debug (*ptr);
5822 else
5823 fprintf (stderr, "<nil>\n");
5827 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
5828 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5830 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
5831 debug_dwarf (void)
5833 print_indent = 0;
5834 print_die (comp_unit_die (), stderr);
5837 /* Sanity checks on DIEs. */
5839 static void
5840 check_die (dw_die_ref die)
5842 unsigned ix;
5843 dw_attr_node *a;
5844 bool inline_found = false;
5845 int n_location = 0, n_low_pc = 0, n_high_pc = 0, n_artificial = 0;
5846 int n_decl_line = 0, n_decl_file = 0;
5847 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
5849 switch (a->dw_attr)
5851 case DW_AT_inline:
5852 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned)
5853 inline_found = true;
5854 break;
5855 case DW_AT_location:
5856 ++n_location;
5857 break;
5858 case DW_AT_low_pc:
5859 ++n_low_pc;
5860 break;
5861 case DW_AT_high_pc:
5862 ++n_high_pc;
5863 break;
5864 case DW_AT_artificial:
5865 ++n_artificial;
5866 break;
5867 case DW_AT_decl_line:
5868 ++n_decl_line;
5869 break;
5870 case DW_AT_decl_file:
5871 ++n_decl_file;
5872 break;
5873 default:
5874 break;
5877 if (n_location > 1 || n_low_pc > 1 || n_high_pc > 1 || n_artificial > 1
5878 || n_decl_line > 1 || n_decl_file > 1)
5880 fprintf (stderr, "Duplicate attributes in DIE:\n");
5881 debug_dwarf_die (die);
5882 gcc_unreachable ();
5884 if (inline_found)
5886 /* A debugging information entry that is a member of an abstract
5887 instance tree [that has DW_AT_inline] should not contain any
5888 attributes which describe aspects of the subroutine which vary
5889 between distinct inlined expansions or distinct out-of-line
5890 expansions. */
5891 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
5892 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_low_pc
5893 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_high_pc
5894 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_location
5895 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_frame_base
5896 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_GNU_all_call_sites);
5900 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
5901 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
5902 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
5904 static dw_die_ref
5905 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
5907 const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
5908 dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
5910 new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
5911 return new_unit;
5914 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
5916 static dw_die_ref
5917 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
5919 dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
5921 old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
5922 return new_unit;
5925 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
5926 #define CHECKSUM_BLOCK(FOO, SIZE) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), (SIZE), ctx)
5927 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
5929 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
5931 static inline void
5932 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5934 int tem;
5935 inchash::hash hstate;
5936 hashval_t hash;
5938 tem = (loc->dtprel << 8) | ((unsigned int) loc->dw_loc_opc);
5939 CHECKSUM (tem);
5940 hash_loc_operands (loc, hstate);
5941 hash = hstate.end();
5942 CHECKSUM (hash);
5945 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
5947 static void
5948 attr_checksum (dw_attr_node *at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5950 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5951 rtx r;
5953 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
5955 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
5956 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
5957 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
5958 return;
5960 switch (AT_class (at))
5962 case dw_val_class_const:
5963 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
5964 break;
5965 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5966 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
5967 break;
5968 case dw_val_class_const_double:
5969 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
5970 break;
5971 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
5972 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->get_val (),
5973 get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
5974 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
5975 break;
5976 case dw_val_class_vec:
5977 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array,
5978 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
5979 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size));
5980 break;
5981 case dw_val_class_flag:
5982 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
5983 break;
5984 case dw_val_class_str:
5985 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
5986 break;
5988 case dw_val_class_addr:
5989 r = AT_addr (at);
5990 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
5991 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
5992 break;
5994 case dw_val_class_offset:
5995 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
5996 break;
5998 case dw_val_class_loc:
5999 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
6000 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
6001 break;
6003 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6004 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
6005 break;
6007 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6008 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
6009 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6010 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6011 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6012 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6013 break;
6015 case dw_val_class_file:
6016 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
6017 break;
6019 case dw_val_class_data8:
6020 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
6021 break;
6023 default:
6024 break;
6028 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
6030 static void
6031 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6033 dw_die_ref c;
6034 dw_attr_node *a;
6035 unsigned ix;
6037 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
6038 if (die->die_mark)
6040 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
6041 return;
6043 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6045 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
6047 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6048 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
6050 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
6053 #undef CHECKSUM
6054 #undef CHECKSUM_BLOCK
6055 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
6057 /* For DWARF-4 types, include the trailing NULL when checksumming strings. */
6058 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
6059 #define CHECKSUM_BLOCK(FOO, SIZE) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), (SIZE), ctx)
6060 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO) + 1, ctx)
6061 #define CHECKSUM_SLEB128(FOO) checksum_sleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
6062 #define CHECKSUM_ULEB128(FOO) checksum_uleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
6063 #define CHECKSUM_ATTR(FOO) \
6064 if (FOO) attr_checksum_ordered (die->die_tag, (FOO), ctx, mark)
6066 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in signed LEB128 format. */
6068 static void
6069 checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6071 unsigned char byte;
6072 bool more;
6074 while (1)
6076 byte = (value & 0x7f);
6077 value >>= 7;
6078 more = !((value == 0 && (byte & 0x40) == 0)
6079 || (value == -1 && (byte & 0x40) != 0));
6080 if (more)
6081 byte |= 0x80;
6082 CHECKSUM (byte);
6083 if (!more)
6084 break;
6088 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in unsigned LEB128 format. */
6090 static void
6091 checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6093 while (1)
6095 unsigned char byte = (value & 0x7f);
6096 value >>= 7;
6097 if (value != 0)
6098 /* More bytes to follow. */
6099 byte |= 0x80;
6100 CHECKSUM (byte);
6101 if (value == 0)
6102 break;
6106 /* Checksum the context of the DIE. This adds the names of any
6107 surrounding namespaces or structures to the checksum. */
6109 static void
6110 checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6112 const char *name;
6113 dw_die_ref spec;
6114 int tag = die->die_tag;
6116 if (tag != DW_TAG_namespace
6117 && tag != DW_TAG_structure_type
6118 && tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
6119 return;
6121 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
6123 spec = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
6124 if (spec != NULL)
6125 die = spec;
6127 if (die->die_parent != NULL)
6128 checksum_die_context (die->die_parent, ctx);
6130 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('C');
6131 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
6132 if (name != NULL)
6133 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
6136 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
6138 static inline void
6139 loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6141 /* Special case for lone DW_OP_plus_uconst: checksum as if the location
6142 were emitted as a DW_FORM_sdata instead of a location expression. */
6143 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_plus_uconst && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
6145 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6146 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((HOST_WIDE_INT) loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
6147 return;
6150 /* Otherwise, just checksum the raw location expression. */
6151 while (loc != NULL)
6153 inchash::hash hstate;
6154 hashval_t hash;
6156 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dtprel);
6157 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dw_loc_opc);
6158 hash_loc_operands (loc, hstate);
6159 hash = hstate.end ();
6160 CHECKSUM (hash);
6161 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
6165 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
6167 static void
6168 attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag tag, dw_attr_node *at,
6169 struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6171 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
6172 rtx r;
6174 if (AT_class (at) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
6176 dw_die_ref target_die = AT_ref (at);
6178 /* For pointer and reference types, we checksum only the (qualified)
6179 name of the target type (if there is a name). For friend entries,
6180 we checksum only the (qualified) name of the target type or function.
6181 This allows the checksum to remain the same whether the target type
6182 is complete or not. */
6183 if ((at->dw_attr == DW_AT_type
6184 && (tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
6185 || tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
6186 || tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
6187 || tag == DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type))
6188 || (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_friend
6189 && tag == DW_TAG_friend))
6191 dw_attr_node *name_attr = get_AT (target_die, DW_AT_name);
6193 if (name_attr != NULL)
6195 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
6197 if (decl == NULL)
6198 decl = target_die;
6199 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('N');
6200 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6201 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
6202 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
6203 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('E');
6204 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
6205 return;
6209 /* For all other references to another DIE, we check to see if the
6210 target DIE has already been visited. If it has, we emit a
6211 backward reference; if not, we descend recursively. */
6212 if (target_die->die_mark > 0)
6214 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('R');
6215 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6216 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (target_die->die_mark);
6218 else
6220 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
6222 if (decl == NULL)
6223 decl = target_die;
6224 target_die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6225 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('T');
6226 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6227 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
6228 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
6229 die_checksum_ordered (target_die, ctx, mark);
6231 return;
6234 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('A');
6235 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6237 switch (AT_class (at))
6239 case dw_val_class_const:
6240 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6241 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
6242 break;
6244 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6245 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6246 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((int) at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
6247 break;
6249 case dw_val_class_const_double:
6250 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
6251 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double));
6252 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
6253 break;
6255 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
6256 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
6257 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
6258 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
6259 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->get_val (),
6260 get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
6261 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
6262 break;
6264 case dw_val_class_vec:
6265 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
6266 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6267 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size);
6268 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array,
6269 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6270 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size));
6271 break;
6273 case dw_val_class_flag:
6274 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_flag);
6275 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag ? 1 : 0);
6276 break;
6278 case dw_val_class_str:
6279 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
6280 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
6281 break;
6283 case dw_val_class_addr:
6284 r = AT_addr (at);
6285 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
6286 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
6287 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
6288 break;
6290 case dw_val_class_offset:
6291 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6292 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
6293 break;
6295 case dw_val_class_loc:
6296 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
6297 loc_checksum_ordered (loc, ctx);
6298 break;
6300 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6301 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6302 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6303 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6304 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6305 break;
6307 case dw_val_class_file:
6308 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
6309 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
6310 break;
6312 case dw_val_class_data8:
6313 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
6314 break;
6316 default:
6317 break;
6321 struct checksum_attributes
6323 dw_attr_node *at_name;
6324 dw_attr_node *at_type;
6325 dw_attr_node *at_friend;
6326 dw_attr_node *at_accessibility;
6327 dw_attr_node *at_address_class;
6328 dw_attr_node *at_allocated;
6329 dw_attr_node *at_artificial;
6330 dw_attr_node *at_associated;
6331 dw_attr_node *at_binary_scale;
6332 dw_attr_node *at_bit_offset;
6333 dw_attr_node *at_bit_size;
6334 dw_attr_node *at_bit_stride;
6335 dw_attr_node *at_byte_size;
6336 dw_attr_node *at_byte_stride;
6337 dw_attr_node *at_const_value;
6338 dw_attr_node *at_containing_type;
6339 dw_attr_node *at_count;
6340 dw_attr_node *at_data_location;
6341 dw_attr_node *at_data_member_location;
6342 dw_attr_node *at_decimal_scale;
6343 dw_attr_node *at_decimal_sign;
6344 dw_attr_node *at_default_value;
6345 dw_attr_node *at_digit_count;
6346 dw_attr_node *at_discr;
6347 dw_attr_node *at_discr_list;
6348 dw_attr_node *at_discr_value;
6349 dw_attr_node *at_encoding;
6350 dw_attr_node *at_endianity;
6351 dw_attr_node *at_explicit;
6352 dw_attr_node *at_is_optional;
6353 dw_attr_node *at_location;
6354 dw_attr_node *at_lower_bound;
6355 dw_attr_node *at_mutable;
6356 dw_attr_node *at_ordering;
6357 dw_attr_node *at_picture_string;
6358 dw_attr_node *at_prototyped;
6359 dw_attr_node *at_small;
6360 dw_attr_node *at_segment;
6361 dw_attr_node *at_string_length;
6362 dw_attr_node *at_threads_scaled;
6363 dw_attr_node *at_upper_bound;
6364 dw_attr_node *at_use_location;
6365 dw_attr_node *at_use_UTF8;
6366 dw_attr_node *at_variable_parameter;
6367 dw_attr_node *at_virtuality;
6368 dw_attr_node *at_visibility;
6369 dw_attr_node *at_vtable_elem_location;
6372 /* Collect the attributes that we will want to use for the checksum. */
6374 static void
6375 collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *attrs, dw_die_ref die)
6377 dw_attr_node *a;
6378 unsigned ix;
6380 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6382 switch (a->dw_attr)
6384 case DW_AT_name:
6385 attrs->at_name = a;
6386 break;
6387 case DW_AT_type:
6388 attrs->at_type = a;
6389 break;
6390 case DW_AT_friend:
6391 attrs->at_friend = a;
6392 break;
6393 case DW_AT_accessibility:
6394 attrs->at_accessibility = a;
6395 break;
6396 case DW_AT_address_class:
6397 attrs->at_address_class = a;
6398 break;
6399 case DW_AT_allocated:
6400 attrs->at_allocated = a;
6401 break;
6402 case DW_AT_artificial:
6403 attrs->at_artificial = a;
6404 break;
6405 case DW_AT_associated:
6406 attrs->at_associated = a;
6407 break;
6408 case DW_AT_binary_scale:
6409 attrs->at_binary_scale = a;
6410 break;
6411 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
6412 attrs->at_bit_offset = a;
6413 break;
6414 case DW_AT_bit_size:
6415 attrs->at_bit_size = a;
6416 break;
6417 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
6418 attrs->at_bit_stride = a;
6419 break;
6420 case DW_AT_byte_size:
6421 attrs->at_byte_size = a;
6422 break;
6423 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
6424 attrs->at_byte_stride = a;
6425 break;
6426 case DW_AT_const_value:
6427 attrs->at_const_value = a;
6428 break;
6429 case DW_AT_containing_type:
6430 attrs->at_containing_type = a;
6431 break;
6432 case DW_AT_count:
6433 attrs->at_count = a;
6434 break;
6435 case DW_AT_data_location:
6436 attrs->at_data_location = a;
6437 break;
6438 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
6439 attrs->at_data_member_location = a;
6440 break;
6441 case DW_AT_decimal_scale:
6442 attrs->at_decimal_scale = a;
6443 break;
6444 case DW_AT_decimal_sign:
6445 attrs->at_decimal_sign = a;
6446 break;
6447 case DW_AT_default_value:
6448 attrs->at_default_value = a;
6449 break;
6450 case DW_AT_digit_count:
6451 attrs->at_digit_count = a;
6452 break;
6453 case DW_AT_discr:
6454 attrs->at_discr = a;
6455 break;
6456 case DW_AT_discr_list:
6457 attrs->at_discr_list = a;
6458 break;
6459 case DW_AT_discr_value:
6460 attrs->at_discr_value = a;
6461 break;
6462 case DW_AT_encoding:
6463 attrs->at_encoding = a;
6464 break;
6465 case DW_AT_endianity:
6466 attrs->at_endianity = a;
6467 break;
6468 case DW_AT_explicit:
6469 attrs->at_explicit = a;
6470 break;
6471 case DW_AT_is_optional:
6472 attrs->at_is_optional = a;
6473 break;
6474 case DW_AT_location:
6475 attrs->at_location = a;
6476 break;
6477 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
6478 attrs->at_lower_bound = a;
6479 break;
6480 case DW_AT_mutable:
6481 attrs->at_mutable = a;
6482 break;
6483 case DW_AT_ordering:
6484 attrs->at_ordering = a;
6485 break;
6486 case DW_AT_picture_string:
6487 attrs->at_picture_string = a;
6488 break;
6489 case DW_AT_prototyped:
6490 attrs->at_prototyped = a;
6491 break;
6492 case DW_AT_small:
6493 attrs->at_small = a;
6494 break;
6495 case DW_AT_segment:
6496 attrs->at_segment = a;
6497 break;
6498 case DW_AT_string_length:
6499 attrs->at_string_length = a;
6500 break;
6501 case DW_AT_threads_scaled:
6502 attrs->at_threads_scaled = a;
6503 break;
6504 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
6505 attrs->at_upper_bound = a;
6506 break;
6507 case DW_AT_use_location:
6508 attrs->at_use_location = a;
6509 break;
6510 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
6511 attrs->at_use_UTF8 = a;
6512 break;
6513 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
6514 attrs->at_variable_parameter = a;
6515 break;
6516 case DW_AT_virtuality:
6517 attrs->at_virtuality = a;
6518 break;
6519 case DW_AT_visibility:
6520 attrs->at_visibility = a;
6521 break;
6522 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
6523 attrs->at_vtable_elem_location = a;
6524 break;
6525 default:
6526 break;
6531 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE, using an ordered subset of attributes. */
6533 static void
6534 die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6536 dw_die_ref c;
6537 dw_die_ref decl;
6538 struct checksum_attributes attrs;
6540 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('D');
6541 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (die->die_tag);
6543 memset (&attrs, 0, sizeof (attrs));
6545 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
6546 if (decl != NULL)
6547 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, decl);
6548 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, die);
6550 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_name);
6551 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_accessibility);
6552 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_address_class);
6553 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_allocated);
6554 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_artificial);
6555 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_associated);
6556 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_binary_scale);
6557 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_offset);
6558 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_size);
6559 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_stride);
6560 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_size);
6561 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_stride);
6562 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_const_value);
6563 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_containing_type);
6564 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_count);
6565 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_location);
6566 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_member_location);
6567 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_scale);
6568 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_sign);
6569 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_default_value);
6570 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_digit_count);
6571 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr);
6572 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_list);
6573 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_value);
6574 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_encoding);
6575 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_endianity);
6576 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_explicit);
6577 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_is_optional);
6578 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_location);
6579 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_lower_bound);
6580 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_mutable);
6581 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_ordering);
6582 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_picture_string);
6583 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_prototyped);
6584 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_small);
6585 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_segment);
6586 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length);
6587 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_threads_scaled);
6588 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_upper_bound);
6589 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_location);
6590 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_UTF8);
6591 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_variable_parameter);
6592 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_virtuality);
6593 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_visibility);
6594 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_vtable_elem_location);
6595 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_type);
6596 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_friend);
6598 /* Checksum the child DIEs. */
6599 c = die->die_child;
6600 if (c) do {
6601 dw_attr_node *name_attr;
6603 c = c->die_sib;
6604 name_attr = get_AT (c, DW_AT_name);
6605 if (is_template_instantiation (c))
6607 /* Ignore instantiations of member type and function templates. */
6609 else if (name_attr != NULL
6610 && (is_type_die (c) || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram))
6612 /* Use a shallow checksum for named nested types and member
6613 functions. */
6614 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('S');
6615 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (c->die_tag);
6616 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
6618 else
6620 /* Use a deep checksum for other children. */
6621 /* Mark this DIE so it gets processed when unmarking. */
6622 if (c->die_mark == 0)
6623 c->die_mark = -1;
6624 die_checksum_ordered (c, ctx, mark);
6626 } while (c != die->die_child);
6628 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (0);
6631 /* Add a type name and tag to a hash. */
6632 static void
6633 die_odr_checksum (int tag, const char *name, md5_ctx *ctx)
6635 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
6636 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
6639 #undef CHECKSUM
6640 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
6641 #undef CHECKSUM_ATTR
6642 #undef CHECKSUM_LEB128
6643 #undef CHECKSUM_ULEB128
6645 /* Generate the type signature for DIE. This is computed by generating an
6646 MD5 checksum over the DIE's tag, its relevant attributes, and its
6647 children. Attributes that are references to other DIEs are processed
6648 by recursion, using the MARK field to prevent infinite recursion.
6649 If the DIE is nested inside a namespace or another type, we also
6650 need to include that context in the signature. The lower 64 bits
6651 of the resulting MD5 checksum comprise the signature. */
6653 static void
6654 generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref die, comdat_type_node *type_node)
6656 int mark;
6657 const char *name;
6658 unsigned char checksum[16];
6659 struct md5_ctx ctx;
6660 dw_die_ref decl;
6661 dw_die_ref parent;
6663 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
6664 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
6665 parent = get_die_parent (die);
6667 /* First, compute a signature for just the type name (and its surrounding
6668 context, if any. This is stored in the type unit DIE for link-time
6669 ODR (one-definition rule) checking. */
6671 if (is_cxx () && name != NULL)
6673 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
6675 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
6676 if (parent != NULL)
6677 checksum_die_context (parent, &ctx);
6679 /* Checksum the current DIE. */
6680 die_odr_checksum (die->die_tag, name, &ctx);
6681 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
6683 add_AT_data8 (type_node->root_die, DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature, &checksum[8]);
6686 /* Next, compute the complete type signature. */
6688 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
6689 mark = 1;
6690 die->die_mark = mark;
6692 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
6693 if (parent != NULL)
6694 checksum_die_context (parent, &ctx);
6696 /* Checksum the DIE and its children. */
6697 die_checksum_ordered (die, &ctx, &mark);
6698 unmark_all_dies (die);
6699 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
6701 /* Store the signature in the type node and link the type DIE and the
6702 type node together. */
6703 memcpy (type_node->signature, &checksum[16 - DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE],
6704 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE);
6705 die->comdat_type_p = true;
6706 die->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
6707 type_node->type_die = die;
6709 /* If the DIE is a specification, link its declaration to the type node
6710 as well. */
6711 if (decl != NULL)
6713 decl->comdat_type_p = true;
6714 decl->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
6718 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
6719 static inline int
6720 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
6722 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
6723 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
6724 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
6727 /* Do the values look the same? */
6728 static int
6729 same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *v1, const dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
6731 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
6732 rtx r1, r2;
6734 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
6735 return 0;
6737 switch (v1->val_class)
6739 case dw_val_class_const:
6740 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
6741 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6742 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
6743 case dw_val_class_const_double:
6744 return v1->v.val_double.high == v2->v.val_double.high
6745 && v1->v.val_double.low == v2->v.val_double.low;
6746 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
6747 return *v1->v.val_wide == *v2->v.val_wide;
6748 case dw_val_class_vec:
6749 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
6750 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
6751 return 0;
6752 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
6753 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
6754 return 0;
6755 return 1;
6756 case dw_val_class_flag:
6757 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
6758 case dw_val_class_str:
6759 return !strcmp (v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
6761 case dw_val_class_addr:
6762 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
6763 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
6764 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
6765 return 0;
6766 return !rtx_equal_p (r1, r2);
6768 case dw_val_class_offset:
6769 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
6771 case dw_val_class_loc:
6772 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
6773 loc1 && loc2;
6774 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
6775 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
6776 return 0;
6777 return !loc1 && !loc2;
6779 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6780 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
6782 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6783 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
6784 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6785 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6786 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6787 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6788 return 1;
6790 case dw_val_class_file:
6791 return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
6793 case dw_val_class_data8:
6794 return !memcmp (v1->v.val_data8, v2->v.val_data8, 8);
6796 default:
6797 return 1;
6801 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
6803 static int
6804 same_attr_p (dw_attr_node *at1, dw_attr_node *at2, int *mark)
6806 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
6807 return 0;
6809 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
6810 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
6811 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
6812 return 1;
6814 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
6817 /* Do the dies look the same? */
6819 static int
6820 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
6822 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
6823 dw_attr_node *a1;
6824 unsigned ix;
6826 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
6827 if (die1->die_mark)
6828 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
6829 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6831 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
6832 return 0;
6834 if (vec_safe_length (die1->die_attr) != vec_safe_length (die2->die_attr))
6835 return 0;
6837 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die1->die_attr, ix, a1)
6838 if (!same_attr_p (a1, &(*die2->die_attr)[ix], mark))
6839 return 0;
6841 c1 = die1->die_child;
6842 c2 = die2->die_child;
6843 if (! c1)
6845 if (c2)
6846 return 0;
6848 else
6849 for (;;)
6851 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
6852 return 0;
6853 c1 = c1->die_sib;
6854 c2 = c2->die_sib;
6855 if (c1 == die1->die_child)
6857 if (c2 == die2->die_child)
6858 break;
6859 else
6860 return 0;
6864 return 1;
6867 /* Do the dies look the same? Wrapper around same_die_p. */
6869 static int
6870 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
6872 int mark = 0;
6873 int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
6875 unmark_all_dies (die1);
6876 unmark_all_dies (die2);
6878 return ret;
6881 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
6882 info section. */
6883 static const char *comdat_symbol_id;
6885 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
6886 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
6888 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
6889 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
6891 static void
6892 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
6894 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
6895 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
6896 char *name = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (base) + 64);
6897 char *p;
6898 int i, mark;
6899 unsigned char checksum[16];
6900 struct md5_ctx ctx;
6902 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
6903 the name filename of the unit. */
6905 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
6906 mark = 0;
6907 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
6908 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
6909 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
6911 sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
6912 clean_symbol_name (name);
6914 p = name + strlen (name);
6915 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
6917 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
6918 p += 2;
6921 comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
6922 comdat_symbol_number = 0;
6925 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
6927 static int
6928 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
6930 switch (die->die_tag)
6932 case DW_TAG_array_type:
6933 case DW_TAG_class_type:
6934 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
6935 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
6936 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
6937 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
6938 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
6939 case DW_TAG_string_type:
6940 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
6941 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
6942 case DW_TAG_union_type:
6943 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
6944 case DW_TAG_set_type:
6945 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
6946 case DW_TAG_base_type:
6947 case DW_TAG_const_type:
6948 case DW_TAG_file_type:
6949 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
6950 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
6951 case DW_TAG_typedef:
6952 return 1;
6953 default:
6954 return 0;
6958 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
6959 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
6960 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
6961 compilations (functions). */
6963 static int
6964 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
6966 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
6967 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
6968 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
6969 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
6971 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
6972 return 0;
6974 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
6975 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
6976 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
6977 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
6978 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
6980 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
6982 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
6985 return is_type_die (c);
6988 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
6989 compilation unit. */
6991 static int
6992 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
6994 return (is_type_die (c)
6995 || is_declaration_die (c)
6996 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
6997 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_module);
7000 /* Returns true iff C is a compile-unit DIE. */
7002 static inline bool
7003 is_cu_die (dw_die_ref c)
7005 return c && c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit;
7008 /* Returns true iff C is a unit DIE of some sort. */
7010 static inline bool
7011 is_unit_die (dw_die_ref c)
7013 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit
7014 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_partial_unit
7015 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_type_unit);
7018 /* Returns true iff C is a namespace DIE. */
7020 static inline bool
7021 is_namespace_die (dw_die_ref c)
7023 return c && c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace;
7026 /* Returns true iff C is a class or structure DIE. */
7028 static inline bool
7029 is_class_die (dw_die_ref c)
7031 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
7032 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type);
7035 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a template parameter. */
7037 static inline bool
7038 is_template_parameter (dw_die_ref die)
7040 switch (die->die_tag)
7042 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
7043 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
7044 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param:
7045 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack:
7046 return true;
7047 default:
7048 return false;
7052 /* Return non-zero if this DIE represents a template instantiation. */
7054 static inline bool
7055 is_template_instantiation (dw_die_ref die)
7057 dw_die_ref c;
7059 if (!is_type_die (die) && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_subprogram)
7060 return false;
7061 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, if (is_template_parameter (c)) return true);
7062 return false;
7065 static char *
7066 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
7068 char buf[256];
7070 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
7071 return xstrdup (buf);
7074 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
7076 static void
7077 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
7079 dw_die_ref c;
7081 if (is_symbol_die (die) && !die->comdat_type_p)
7083 if (comdat_symbol_id)
7085 char *p = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
7087 sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
7088 comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
7089 die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
7091 else
7092 die->die_id.die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
7095 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_symbol_names (c));
7098 struct cu_hash_table_entry
7100 dw_die_ref cu;
7101 unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
7102 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
7105 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
7107 struct cu_hash_table_entry_hasher : pointer_hash <cu_hash_table_entry>
7109 typedef die_struct *compare_type;
7110 static inline hashval_t hash (const cu_hash_table_entry *);
7111 static inline bool equal (const cu_hash_table_entry *, const die_struct *);
7112 static inline void remove (cu_hash_table_entry *);
7115 inline hashval_t
7116 cu_hash_table_entry_hasher::hash (const cu_hash_table_entry *entry)
7118 return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_id.die_symbol);
7121 inline bool
7122 cu_hash_table_entry_hasher::equal (const cu_hash_table_entry *entry1,
7123 const die_struct *entry2)
7125 return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_id.die_symbol, entry2->die_id.die_symbol);
7128 inline void
7129 cu_hash_table_entry_hasher::remove (cu_hash_table_entry *entry)
7131 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
7133 while (entry)
7135 next = entry->next;
7136 free (entry);
7137 entry = next;
7141 typedef hash_table<cu_hash_table_entry_hasher> cu_hash_type;
7143 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
7144 accordingly. */
7145 static int
7146 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, cu_hash_type *htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
7148 struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
7149 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
7151 dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
7153 slot = htable->find_slot_with_hash (cu,
7154 htab_hash_string (cu->die_id.die_symbol),
7155 INSERT);
7156 entry = *slot;
7158 for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
7160 if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
7161 break;
7164 if (entry)
7166 *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
7167 return 1;
7170 entry = XCNEW (struct cu_hash_table_entry);
7171 entry->cu = cu;
7172 entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
7173 entry->next = *slot;
7174 *slot = entry;
7176 return 0;
7179 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE. */
7180 static void
7181 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, cu_hash_type *htable,
7182 unsigned int sym_num)
7184 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
7186 slot = htable->find_slot_with_hash (cu,
7187 htab_hash_string (cu->die_id.die_symbol),
7188 NO_INSERT);
7189 entry = *slot;
7191 entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
7194 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
7195 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
7196 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
7198 static void
7199 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
7201 dw_die_ref c;
7202 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
7203 limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
7205 c = die->die_child;
7206 if (c) do {
7207 dw_die_ref prev = c;
7208 c = c->die_sib;
7209 while (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
7210 || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
7212 dw_die_ref next = c->die_sib;
7214 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
7215 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
7217 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
7218 unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
7219 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
7220 unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
7221 else
7222 add_child_die (unit, c);
7223 c = next;
7224 if (c == die->die_child)
7225 break;
7227 } while (c != die->die_child);
7229 #if 0
7230 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
7231 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
7232 gcc_assert (!unit);
7233 #endif
7235 assign_symbol_names (die);
7236 cu_hash_type cu_hash_table (10);
7237 for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
7238 node;
7239 node = node->next)
7241 int is_dupl;
7243 compute_section_prefix (node->die);
7244 is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, &cu_hash_table,
7245 &comdat_symbol_number);
7246 assign_symbol_names (node->die);
7247 if (is_dupl)
7248 *pnode = node->next;
7249 else
7251 pnode = &node->next;
7252 record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, &cu_hash_table,
7253 comdat_symbol_number);
7258 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a declaration. */
7260 static int
7261 is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref die)
7263 dw_attr_node *a;
7264 unsigned ix;
7266 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7267 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_declaration)
7268 return 1;
7270 return 0;
7273 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is nested inside a subprogram. */
7275 static int
7276 is_nested_in_subprogram (dw_die_ref die)
7278 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7280 if (decl == NULL)
7281 decl = die;
7282 return local_scope_p (decl);
7285 /* Return non-zero if this DIE contains a defining declaration of a
7286 subprogram. */
7288 static int
7289 contains_subprogram_definition (dw_die_ref die)
7291 dw_die_ref c;
7293 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram && ! is_declaration_die (die))
7294 return 1;
7295 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, if (contains_subprogram_definition (c)) return 1);
7296 return 0;
7299 /* Return non-zero if this is a type DIE that should be moved to a
7300 COMDAT .debug_types section. */
7302 static int
7303 should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref die)
7305 switch (die->die_tag)
7307 case DW_TAG_class_type:
7308 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
7309 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
7310 case DW_TAG_union_type:
7311 /* Don't move declarations, inlined instances, types nested in a
7312 subprogram, or types that contain subprogram definitions. */
7313 if (is_declaration_die (die)
7314 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin)
7315 || is_nested_in_subprogram (die)
7316 || contains_subprogram_definition (die))
7317 return 0;
7318 return 1;
7319 case DW_TAG_array_type:
7320 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
7321 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
7322 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
7323 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
7324 case DW_TAG_string_type:
7325 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
7326 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
7327 case DW_TAG_set_type:
7328 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
7329 case DW_TAG_base_type:
7330 case DW_TAG_const_type:
7331 case DW_TAG_file_type:
7332 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
7333 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
7334 case DW_TAG_typedef:
7335 default:
7336 return 0;
7340 /* Make a clone of DIE. */
7342 static dw_die_ref
7343 clone_die (dw_die_ref die)
7345 dw_die_ref clone;
7346 dw_attr_node *a;
7347 unsigned ix;
7349 clone = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
7350 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
7352 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7353 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
7355 return clone;
7358 /* Make a clone of the tree rooted at DIE. */
7360 static dw_die_ref
7361 clone_tree (dw_die_ref die)
7363 dw_die_ref c;
7364 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (die);
7366 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_child_die (clone, clone_tree (c)));
7368 return clone;
7371 /* Make a clone of DIE as a declaration. */
7373 static dw_die_ref
7374 clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref die)
7376 dw_die_ref clone;
7377 dw_die_ref decl;
7378 dw_attr_node *a;
7379 unsigned ix;
7381 /* If the DIE is already a declaration, just clone it. */
7382 if (is_declaration_die (die))
7383 return clone_die (die);
7385 /* If the DIE is a specification, just clone its declaration DIE. */
7386 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7387 if (decl != NULL)
7389 clone = clone_die (decl);
7390 if (die->comdat_type_p)
7391 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
7392 return clone;
7395 clone = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
7396 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
7398 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7400 /* We don't want to copy over all attributes.
7401 For example we don't want DW_AT_byte_size because otherwise we will no
7402 longer have a declaration and GDB will treat it as a definition. */
7404 switch (a->dw_attr)
7406 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
7407 case DW_AT_artificial:
7408 case DW_AT_containing_type:
7409 case DW_AT_external:
7410 case DW_AT_name:
7411 case DW_AT_type:
7412 case DW_AT_virtuality:
7413 case DW_AT_linkage_name:
7414 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
7415 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
7416 break;
7417 case DW_AT_byte_size:
7418 default:
7419 break;
7423 if (die->comdat_type_p)
7424 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
7426 add_AT_flag (clone, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
7427 return clone;
7431 /* Structure to map a DIE in one CU to its copy in a comdat type unit. */
7433 struct decl_table_entry
7435 dw_die_ref orig;
7436 dw_die_ref copy;
7439 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of copied declarations. */
7441 /* Hashtable helpers. */
7443 struct decl_table_entry_hasher : free_ptr_hash <decl_table_entry>
7445 typedef die_struct *compare_type;
7446 static inline hashval_t hash (const decl_table_entry *);
7447 static inline bool equal (const decl_table_entry *, const die_struct *);
7450 inline hashval_t
7451 decl_table_entry_hasher::hash (const decl_table_entry *entry)
7453 return htab_hash_pointer (entry->orig);
7456 inline bool
7457 decl_table_entry_hasher::equal (const decl_table_entry *entry1,
7458 const die_struct *entry2)
7460 return entry1->orig == entry2;
7463 typedef hash_table<decl_table_entry_hasher> decl_hash_type;
7465 /* Copy DIE and its ancestors, up to, but not including, the compile unit
7466 or type unit entry, to a new tree. Adds the new tree to UNIT and returns
7467 a pointer to the copy of DIE. If DECL_TABLE is provided, it is used
7468 to check if the ancestor has already been copied into UNIT. */
7470 static dw_die_ref
7471 copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die,
7472 decl_hash_type *decl_table)
7474 dw_die_ref parent = die->die_parent;
7475 dw_die_ref new_parent = unit;
7476 dw_die_ref copy;
7477 decl_table_entry **slot = NULL;
7478 struct decl_table_entry *entry = NULL;
7480 if (decl_table)
7482 /* Check if the entry has already been copied to UNIT. */
7483 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (die, htab_hash_pointer (die),
7484 INSERT);
7485 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
7487 entry = *slot;
7488 return entry->copy;
7491 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that DIE has been copied to UNIT. */
7492 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
7493 entry->orig = die;
7494 entry->copy = NULL;
7495 *slot = entry;
7498 if (parent != NULL)
7500 dw_die_ref spec = get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification);
7501 if (spec != NULL)
7502 parent = spec;
7503 if (!is_unit_die (parent))
7504 new_parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, parent, decl_table);
7507 copy = clone_as_declaration (die);
7508 add_child_die (new_parent, copy);
7510 if (decl_table)
7512 /* Record the pointer to the copy. */
7513 entry->copy = copy;
7516 return copy;
7518 /* Copy the declaration context to the new type unit DIE. This includes
7519 any surrounding namespace or type declarations. If the DIE has an
7520 AT_specification attribute, it also includes attributes and children
7521 attached to the specification, and returns a pointer to the original
7522 parent of the declaration DIE. Returns NULL otherwise. */
7524 static dw_die_ref
7525 copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die)
7527 dw_die_ref decl;
7528 dw_die_ref new_decl;
7529 dw_die_ref orig_parent = NULL;
7531 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7532 if (decl == NULL)
7533 decl = die;
7534 else
7536 unsigned ix;
7537 dw_die_ref c;
7538 dw_attr_node *a;
7540 /* The original DIE will be changed to a declaration, and must
7541 be moved to be a child of the original declaration DIE. */
7542 orig_parent = decl->die_parent;
7544 /* Copy the type node pointer from the new DIE to the original
7545 declaration DIE so we can forward references later. */
7546 decl->comdat_type_p = true;
7547 decl->die_id.die_type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
7549 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_specification);
7551 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (decl->die_attr, ix, a)
7553 if (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_name
7554 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_declaration
7555 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_external)
7556 add_dwarf_attr (die, a);
7559 FOR_EACH_CHILD (decl, c, add_child_die (die, clone_tree (c)));
7562 if (decl->die_parent != NULL
7563 && !is_unit_die (decl->die_parent))
7565 new_decl = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, decl, NULL);
7566 if (new_decl != NULL)
7568 remove_AT (new_decl, DW_AT_signature);
7569 add_AT_specification (die, new_decl);
7573 return orig_parent;
7576 /* Generate the skeleton ancestor tree for the given NODE, then clone
7577 the DIE and add the clone into the tree. */
7579 static void
7580 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *node)
7582 if (node->new_die != NULL)
7583 return;
7585 node->new_die = clone_as_declaration (node->old_die);
7587 if (node->parent != NULL)
7589 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (node->parent);
7590 add_child_die (node->parent->new_die, node->new_die);
7594 /* Generate a skeleton tree of DIEs containing any declarations that are
7595 found in the original tree. We traverse the tree looking for declaration
7596 DIEs, and construct the skeleton from the bottom up whenever we find one. */
7598 static void
7599 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *parent)
7601 skeleton_chain_node node;
7602 dw_die_ref c;
7603 dw_die_ref first;
7604 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
7605 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
7607 node.parent = parent;
7609 first = c = parent->old_die->die_child;
7610 if (c)
7611 next = c->die_sib;
7612 if (c) do {
7613 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
7614 prev = c;
7615 c = next;
7616 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
7617 node.old_die = c;
7618 node.new_die = NULL;
7619 if (is_declaration_die (c))
7621 if (is_template_instantiation (c))
7623 /* Instantiated templates do not need to be cloned into the
7624 type unit. Just move the DIE and its children back to
7625 the skeleton tree (in the main CU). */
7626 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
7627 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
7628 c = prev;
7630 else
7632 /* Clone the existing DIE, move the original to the skeleton
7633 tree (which is in the main CU), and put the clone, with
7634 all the original's children, where the original came from
7635 (which is about to be moved to the type unit). */
7636 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (c);
7637 move_all_children (c, clone);
7639 /* If the original has a DW_AT_object_pointer attribute,
7640 it would now point to a child DIE just moved to the
7641 cloned tree, so we need to remove that attribute from
7642 the original. */
7643 remove_AT (c, DW_AT_object_pointer);
7645 replace_child (c, clone, prev);
7646 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (parent);
7647 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
7648 node.new_die = c;
7649 c = clone;
7652 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
7653 } while (next != NULL);
7656 /* Wrapper function for generate_skeleton_bottom_up. */
7658 static dw_die_ref
7659 generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref die)
7661 skeleton_chain_node node;
7663 node.old_die = die;
7664 node.new_die = NULL;
7665 node.parent = NULL;
7667 /* If this type definition is nested inside another type,
7668 and is not an instantiation of a template, always leave
7669 at least a declaration in its place. */
7670 if (die->die_parent != NULL
7671 && is_type_die (die->die_parent)
7672 && !is_template_instantiation (die))
7673 node.new_die = clone_as_declaration (die);
7675 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
7676 return node.new_die;
7679 /* Remove the CHILD DIE from its parent, possibly replacing it with a cloned
7680 declaration. The original DIE is moved to a new compile unit so that
7681 existing references to it follow it to the new location. If any of the
7682 original DIE's descendants is a declaration, we need to replace the
7683 original DIE with a skeleton tree and move the declarations back into the
7684 skeleton tree. */
7686 static dw_die_ref
7687 remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref child,
7688 dw_die_ref prev)
7690 dw_die_ref skeleton, orig_parent;
7692 /* Copy the declaration context to the type unit DIE. If the returned
7693 ORIG_PARENT is not NULL, the skeleton needs to be added as a child of
7694 that DIE. */
7695 orig_parent = copy_declaration_context (unit, child);
7697 skeleton = generate_skeleton (child);
7698 if (skeleton == NULL)
7699 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
7700 else
7702 skeleton->comdat_type_p = true;
7703 skeleton->die_id.die_type_node = child->die_id.die_type_node;
7705 /* If the original DIE was a specification, we need to put
7706 the skeleton under the parent DIE of the declaration.
7707 This leaves the original declaration in the tree, but
7708 it will be pruned later since there are no longer any
7709 references to it. */
7710 if (orig_parent != NULL)
7712 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
7713 add_child_die (orig_parent, skeleton);
7715 else
7716 replace_child (child, skeleton, prev);
7719 return skeleton;
7722 static void
7723 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (dw_die_ref die,
7724 comdat_type_node *type_node,
7725 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs);
7727 /* Helper for copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies. Make a copy of the DIE DWARF
7728 procedure, put it under TYPE_NODE and return the copy. Continue looking for
7729 DWARF procedure references in the DW_AT_location attribute. */
7731 static dw_die_ref
7732 copy_dwarf_procedure (dw_die_ref die,
7733 comdat_type_node *type_node,
7734 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
7736 /* We do this for COMDAT section, which is DWARFv4 specific, so
7737 DWARF procedure are always DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure DIEs (unlike
7738 DW_TAG_variable in DWARFv3). */
7739 gcc_assert (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure);
7741 /* DWARF procedures are not supposed to have children... */
7742 gcc_assert (die->die_child == NULL);
7744 /* ... and they are supposed to have only one attribute: DW_AT_location. */
7745 gcc_assert (vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) == 1
7746 && ((*die->die_attr)[0].dw_attr == DW_AT_location));
7748 /* Do not copy more than once DWARF procedures. */
7749 bool existed;
7750 dw_die_ref &die_copy = copied_dwarf_procs.get_or_insert (die, &existed);
7751 if (existed)
7752 return die_copy;
7754 die_copy = clone_die (die);
7755 add_child_die (type_node->root_die, die_copy);
7756 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (die_copy, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
7757 return die_copy;
7760 /* Helper for copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies. Look for references to DWARF
7761 procedures in DIE's attributes. */
7763 static void
7764 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (dw_die_ref die,
7765 comdat_type_node *type_node,
7766 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
7768 dw_attr_node *a;
7769 unsigned i;
7771 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, i, a)
7773 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
7775 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class != dw_val_class_loc)
7776 continue;
7778 for (loc = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
7780 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
7782 case DW_OP_call2:
7783 case DW_OP_call4:
7784 case DW_OP_call_ref:
7785 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
7786 == dw_val_class_die_ref);
7787 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die
7788 = copy_dwarf_procedure (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die,
7789 type_node,
7790 copied_dwarf_procs);
7792 default:
7793 break;
7799 /* Copy DWARF procedures that are referenced by the DIE tree to TREE_NODE and
7800 rewrite references to point to the copies.
7802 References are looked for in DIE's attributes and recursively in all its
7803 children attributes that are location descriptions. COPIED_DWARF_PROCS is a
7804 mapping from old DWARF procedures to their copy. It is used not to copy
7805 twice the same DWARF procedure under TYPE_NODE. */
7807 static void
7808 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (dw_die_ref die,
7809 comdat_type_node *type_node,
7810 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
7812 dw_die_ref c;
7814 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (die, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
7815 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (c,
7816 type_node,
7817 copied_dwarf_procs));
7820 /* Traverse the DIE and set up additional .debug_types sections for each
7821 type worthy of being placed in a COMDAT section. */
7823 static void
7824 break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref die)
7826 dw_die_ref c;
7827 dw_die_ref first;
7828 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
7829 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
7830 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
7832 first = c = die->die_child;
7833 if (c)
7834 next = c->die_sib;
7835 if (c) do {
7836 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
7837 prev = c;
7838 c = next;
7839 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
7840 if (should_move_die_to_comdat (c))
7842 dw_die_ref replacement;
7843 comdat_type_node *type_node;
7845 /* Break out nested types into their own type units. */
7846 break_out_comdat_types (c);
7848 /* Create a new type unit DIE as the root for the new tree, and
7849 add it to the list of comdat types. */
7850 unit = new_die (DW_TAG_type_unit, NULL, NULL);
7851 add_AT_unsigned (unit, DW_AT_language,
7852 get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language));
7853 type_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<comdat_type_node> ();
7854 type_node->root_die = unit;
7855 type_node->next = comdat_type_list;
7856 comdat_type_list = type_node;
7858 /* Generate the type signature. */
7859 generate_type_signature (c, type_node);
7861 /* Copy the declaration context, attributes, and children of the
7862 declaration into the new type unit DIE, then remove this DIE
7863 from the main CU (or replace it with a skeleton if necessary). */
7864 replacement = remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (unit, c, prev);
7865 type_node->skeleton_die = replacement;
7867 /* Add the DIE to the new compunit. */
7868 add_child_die (unit, c);
7870 /* Types can reference DWARF procedures for type size or data location
7871 expressions. Calls in DWARF expressions cannot target procedures
7872 that are not in the same section. So we must copy DWARF procedures
7873 along with this type and then rewrite references to them. */
7874 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> copied_dwarf_procs;
7875 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (c, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
7877 if (replacement != NULL)
7878 c = replacement;
7880 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
7881 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
7882 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
7883 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type)
7885 /* Look for nested types that can be broken out. */
7886 break_out_comdat_types (c);
7888 } while (next != NULL);
7891 /* Like clone_tree, but copy DW_TAG_subprogram DIEs as declarations.
7892 Enter all the cloned children into the hash table decl_table. */
7894 static dw_die_ref
7895 clone_tree_partial (dw_die_ref die, decl_hash_type *decl_table)
7897 dw_die_ref c;
7898 dw_die_ref clone;
7899 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
7900 decl_table_entry **slot;
7902 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
7903 clone = clone_as_declaration (die);
7904 else
7905 clone = clone_die (die);
7907 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (die,
7908 htab_hash_pointer (die), INSERT);
7910 /* Assert that DIE isn't in the hash table yet. If it would be there
7911 before, the ancestors would be necessarily there as well, therefore
7912 clone_tree_partial wouldn't be called. */
7913 gcc_assert (*slot == HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY);
7915 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
7916 entry->orig = die;
7917 entry->copy = clone;
7918 *slot = entry;
7920 if (die->die_tag != DW_TAG_subprogram)
7921 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c,
7922 add_child_die (clone, clone_tree_partial (c, decl_table)));
7924 return clone;
7927 /* Walk the DIE and its children, looking for references to incomplete
7928 or trivial types that are unmarked (i.e., that are not in the current
7929 type_unit). */
7931 static void
7932 copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, decl_hash_type *decl_table)
7934 dw_die_ref c;
7935 dw_attr_node *a;
7936 unsigned ix;
7938 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7940 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
7942 dw_die_ref targ = AT_ref (a);
7943 decl_table_entry **slot;
7944 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
7946 if (targ->die_mark != 0 || targ->comdat_type_p)
7947 continue;
7949 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (targ,
7950 htab_hash_pointer (targ),
7951 INSERT);
7953 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
7955 /* TARG has already been copied, so we just need to
7956 modify the reference to point to the copy. */
7957 entry = *slot;
7958 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = entry->copy;
7960 else
7962 dw_die_ref parent = unit;
7963 dw_die_ref copy = clone_die (targ);
7965 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that TARG has been copied.
7966 Need to do this now, before the recursive call,
7967 because DECL_TABLE may be expanded and SLOT
7968 would no longer be a valid pointer. */
7969 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
7970 entry->orig = targ;
7971 entry->copy = copy;
7972 *slot = entry;
7974 /* If TARG is not a declaration DIE, we need to copy its
7975 children. */
7976 if (!is_declaration_die (targ))
7978 FOR_EACH_CHILD (
7979 targ, c,
7980 add_child_die (copy,
7981 clone_tree_partial (c, decl_table)));
7984 /* Make sure the cloned tree is marked as part of the
7985 type unit. */
7986 mark_dies (copy);
7988 /* If TARG has surrounding context, copy its ancestor tree
7989 into the new type unit. */
7990 if (targ->die_parent != NULL
7991 && !is_unit_die (targ->die_parent))
7992 parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, targ->die_parent,
7993 decl_table);
7995 add_child_die (parent, copy);
7996 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = copy;
7998 /* Make sure the newly-copied DIE is walked. If it was
7999 installed in a previously-added context, it won't
8000 get visited otherwise. */
8001 if (parent != unit)
8003 /* Find the highest point of the newly-added tree,
8004 mark each node along the way, and walk from there. */
8005 parent->die_mark = 1;
8006 while (parent->die_parent
8007 && parent->die_parent->die_mark == 0)
8009 parent = parent->die_parent;
8010 parent->die_mark = 1;
8012 copy_decls_walk (unit, parent, decl_table);
8018 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_decls_walk (unit, c, decl_table));
8021 /* Copy declarations for "unworthy" types into the new comdat section.
8022 Incomplete types, modified types, and certain other types aren't broken
8023 out into comdat sections of their own, so they don't have a signature,
8024 and we need to copy the declaration into the same section so that we
8025 don't have an external reference. */
8027 static void
8028 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref unit)
8030 mark_dies (unit);
8031 decl_hash_type decl_table (10);
8032 copy_decls_walk (unit, unit, &decl_table);
8033 unmark_dies (unit);
8036 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
8037 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
8038 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
8040 static void
8041 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
8043 dw_die_ref c;
8045 if (! die->die_child)
8046 return;
8048 if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
8049 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
8051 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
8054 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
8056 static void
8057 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
8059 dw_die_ref c;
8060 dw_attr_node *a;
8061 unsigned ix;
8063 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8064 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
8065 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
8067 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
8070 /* We want to limit the number of external references, because they are
8071 larger than local references: a relocation takes multiple words, and
8072 even a sig8 reference is always eight bytes, whereas a local reference
8073 can be as small as one byte (though DW_FORM_ref is usually 4 in GCC).
8074 So if we encounter multiple external references to the same type DIE, we
8075 make a local typedef stub for it and redirect all references there.
8077 This is the element of the hash table for keeping track of these
8078 references. */
8080 struct external_ref
8082 dw_die_ref type;
8083 dw_die_ref stub;
8084 unsigned n_refs;
8087 /* Hashtable helpers. */
8089 struct external_ref_hasher : free_ptr_hash <external_ref>
8091 static inline hashval_t hash (const external_ref *);
8092 static inline bool equal (const external_ref *, const external_ref *);
8095 inline hashval_t
8096 external_ref_hasher::hash (const external_ref *r)
8098 dw_die_ref die = r->type;
8099 hashval_t h = 0;
8101 /* We can't use the address of the DIE for hashing, because
8102 that will make the order of the stub DIEs non-deterministic. */
8103 if (! die->comdat_type_p)
8104 /* We have a symbol; use it to compute a hash. */
8105 h = htab_hash_string (die->die_id.die_symbol);
8106 else
8108 /* We have a type signature; use a subset of the bits as the hash.
8109 The 8-byte signature is at least as large as hashval_t. */
8110 comdat_type_node *type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
8111 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
8113 return h;
8116 inline bool
8117 external_ref_hasher::equal (const external_ref *r1, const external_ref *r2)
8119 return r1->type == r2->type;
8122 typedef hash_table<external_ref_hasher> external_ref_hash_type;
8124 /* Return a pointer to the external_ref for references to DIE. */
8126 static struct external_ref *
8127 lookup_external_ref (external_ref_hash_type *map, dw_die_ref die)
8129 struct external_ref ref, *ref_p;
8130 external_ref **slot;
8132 ref.type = die;
8133 slot = map->find_slot (&ref, INSERT);
8134 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
8135 return *slot;
8137 ref_p = XCNEW (struct external_ref);
8138 ref_p->type = die;
8139 *slot = ref_p;
8140 return ref_p;
8143 /* Subroutine of optimize_external_refs, below.
8145 If we see a type skeleton, record it as our stub. If we see external
8146 references, remember how many we've seen. */
8148 static void
8149 optimize_external_refs_1 (dw_die_ref die, external_ref_hash_type *map)
8151 dw_die_ref c;
8152 dw_attr_node *a;
8153 unsigned ix;
8154 struct external_ref *ref_p;
8156 if (is_type_die (die)
8157 && (c = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_signature)))
8159 /* This is a local skeleton; use it for local references. */
8160 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (map, c);
8161 ref_p->stub = die;
8164 /* Scan the DIE references, and remember any that refer to DIEs from
8165 other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
8166 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8167 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
8168 && (c = AT_ref (a))->die_mark == 0
8169 && is_type_die (c))
8171 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (map, c);
8172 ref_p->n_refs++;
8175 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, optimize_external_refs_1 (c, map));
8178 /* htab_traverse callback function for optimize_external_refs, below. SLOT
8179 points to an external_ref, DATA is the CU we're processing. If we don't
8180 already have a local stub, and we have multiple refs, build a stub. */
8183 dwarf2_build_local_stub (external_ref **slot, dw_die_ref data)
8185 struct external_ref *ref_p = *slot;
8187 if (ref_p->stub == NULL && ref_p->n_refs > 1 && !dwarf_strict)
8189 /* We have multiple references to this type, so build a small stub.
8190 Both of these forms are a bit dodgy from the perspective of the
8191 DWARF standard, since technically they should have names. */
8192 dw_die_ref cu = data;
8193 dw_die_ref type = ref_p->type;
8194 dw_die_ref stub = NULL;
8196 if (type->comdat_type_p)
8198 /* If we refer to this type via sig8, use AT_signature. */
8199 stub = new_die (type->die_tag, cu, NULL_TREE);
8200 add_AT_die_ref (stub, DW_AT_signature, type);
8202 else
8204 /* Otherwise, use a typedef with no name. */
8205 stub = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, cu, NULL_TREE);
8206 add_AT_die_ref (stub, DW_AT_type, type);
8209 stub->die_mark++;
8210 ref_p->stub = stub;
8212 return 1;
8215 /* DIE is a unit; look through all the DIE references to see if there are
8216 any external references to types, and if so, create local stubs for
8217 them which will be applied in build_abbrev_table. This is useful because
8218 references to local DIEs are smaller. */
8220 static external_ref_hash_type *
8221 optimize_external_refs (dw_die_ref die)
8223 external_ref_hash_type *map = new external_ref_hash_type (10);
8224 optimize_external_refs_1 (die, map);
8225 map->traverse <dw_die_ref, dwarf2_build_local_stub> (die);
8226 return map;
8229 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
8230 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
8231 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
8232 die are visited recursively. */
8234 static void
8235 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die, external_ref_hash_type *extern_map)
8237 unsigned long abbrev_id;
8238 unsigned int n_alloc;
8239 dw_die_ref c;
8240 dw_attr_node *a;
8241 unsigned ix;
8243 /* Scan the DIE references, and replace any that refer to
8244 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked) with
8245 the local stubs we built in optimize_external_refs. */
8246 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8247 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
8248 && (c = AT_ref (a))->die_mark == 0)
8250 struct external_ref *ref_p;
8251 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p || AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
8253 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (extern_map, c);
8254 if (ref_p->stub && ref_p->stub != die)
8255 change_AT_die_ref (a, ref_p->stub);
8256 else
8257 /* We aren't changing this reference, so mark it external. */
8258 set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
8261 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
8263 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
8264 dw_attr_node *die_a, *abbrev_a;
8265 unsigned ix;
8266 bool ok = true;
8268 if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
8269 continue;
8270 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
8271 continue;
8273 if (vec_safe_length (abbrev->die_attr) != vec_safe_length (die->die_attr))
8274 continue;
8276 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, die_a)
8278 abbrev_a = &(*abbrev->die_attr)[ix];
8279 if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
8280 || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
8282 ok = false;
8283 break;
8286 if (ok)
8287 break;
8290 if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
8292 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
8294 n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
8295 abbrev_die_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_die_ref, abbrev_die_table,
8296 n_alloc);
8298 memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
8299 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
8300 abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
8303 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
8304 abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
8307 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
8308 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c, extern_map));
8311 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
8313 static int
8314 constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
8316 int log;
8318 if (value == 0)
8319 log = 0;
8320 else
8321 log = floor_log2 (value);
8323 log = log / 8;
8324 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
8326 return log;
8329 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
8330 .debug_info section. */
8332 static unsigned long
8333 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
8335 unsigned long size = 0;
8336 dw_attr_node *a;
8337 unsigned ix;
8338 enum dwarf_form form;
8340 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
8341 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8343 switch (AT_class (a))
8345 case dw_val_class_addr:
8346 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
8348 gcc_assert (AT_index (a) != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
8349 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
8351 else
8352 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8353 break;
8354 case dw_val_class_offset:
8355 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8356 break;
8357 case dw_val_class_loc:
8359 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
8361 /* Block length. */
8362 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
8363 size += size_of_uleb128 (lsize);
8364 else
8365 size += constant_size (lsize);
8366 size += lsize;
8368 break;
8369 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
8370 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
8372 gcc_assert (AT_index (a) != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
8373 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
8375 else
8376 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8377 break;
8378 case dw_val_class_range_list:
8379 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8380 break;
8381 case dw_val_class_const:
8382 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
8383 break;
8384 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8386 int csize = constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
8387 if (dwarf_version == 3
8388 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location
8389 && csize >= 4)
8390 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_unsigned (a));
8391 else
8392 size += csize;
8394 break;
8395 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8396 size += HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
8397 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
8398 size++; /* block */
8399 break;
8400 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
8401 size += (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
8402 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
8403 if (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide) * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
8404 > 64)
8405 size++; /* block */
8406 break;
8407 case dw_val_class_vec:
8408 size += constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
8409 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size)
8410 + a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
8411 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size; /* block */
8412 break;
8413 case dw_val_class_flag:
8414 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
8415 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
8416 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
8417 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
8418 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
8419 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
8420 the same abbrev entry. */
8421 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
8422 else
8423 size += 1;
8424 break;
8425 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
8426 if (AT_ref_external (a))
8428 /* In DWARF4, we use DW_FORM_ref_sig8; for earlier versions
8429 we use DW_FORM_ref_addr. In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr
8430 is sized by target address length, whereas in DWARF3
8431 it's always sized as an offset. */
8432 if (use_debug_types)
8433 size += DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE;
8434 else if (dwarf_version == 2)
8435 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8436 else
8437 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8439 else
8440 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8441 break;
8442 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
8443 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8444 break;
8445 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8446 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
8448 gcc_assert (AT_index (a) != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
8449 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
8451 else
8452 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8453 break;
8454 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
8455 case dw_val_class_macptr:
8456 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8457 break;
8458 case dw_val_class_str:
8459 form = AT_string_form (a);
8460 if (form == DW_FORM_strp)
8461 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8462 else if (form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
8463 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
8464 else
8465 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
8466 break;
8467 case dw_val_class_file:
8468 size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
8469 break;
8470 case dw_val_class_data8:
8471 size += 8;
8472 break;
8473 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
8474 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8475 break;
8476 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
8477 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8478 break;
8479 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
8480 size += size_of_discr_value (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value);
8481 break;
8482 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
8484 unsigned block_size = size_of_discr_list (AT_discr_list (a));
8486 /* This is a block, so we have the block length and then its
8487 data. */
8488 size += constant_size (block_size) + block_size;
8490 break;
8491 default:
8492 gcc_unreachable ();
8496 return size;
8499 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
8500 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
8501 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
8502 die_offset field in each DIE. */
8504 static void
8505 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
8507 dw_die_ref c;
8509 gcc_assert (die->die_offset == 0
8510 || (unsigned long int) die->die_offset == next_die_offset);
8511 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
8512 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
8514 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
8516 if (die->die_child != NULL)
8517 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
8518 next_die_offset += 1;
8521 /* Size just the base type children at the start of the CU.
8522 This is needed because build_abbrev needs to size locs
8523 and sizing of type based stack ops needs to know die_offset
8524 values for the base types. */
8526 static void
8527 calc_base_type_die_sizes (void)
8529 unsigned long die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
8530 unsigned int i;
8531 dw_die_ref base_type;
8532 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
8533 dw_die_ref prev = comp_unit_die ()->die_child;
8534 #endif
8536 die_offset += size_of_die (comp_unit_die ());
8537 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
8539 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
8540 gcc_assert (base_type->die_offset == 0
8541 && prev->die_sib == base_type
8542 && base_type->die_child == NULL
8543 && base_type->die_abbrev);
8544 prev = base_type;
8545 #endif
8546 base_type->die_offset = die_offset;
8547 die_offset += size_of_die (base_type);
8551 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
8552 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
8553 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
8554 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
8556 static void
8557 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
8559 dw_die_ref c;
8561 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
8563 die->die_mark = 1;
8564 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
8567 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
8569 static void
8570 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
8572 dw_die_ref c;
8574 if (! use_debug_types)
8575 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
8577 die->die_mark = 0;
8578 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
8581 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
8583 static void
8584 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
8586 dw_die_ref c;
8587 dw_attr_node *a;
8588 unsigned ix;
8590 if (!die->die_mark)
8591 return;
8592 die->die_mark = 0;
8594 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
8596 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8597 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
8598 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
8601 /* Calculate if the entry should appear in the final output file. It may be
8602 from a pruned a type. */
8604 static bool
8605 include_pubname_in_output (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *table, pubname_entry *p)
8607 /* By limiting gnu pubnames to definitions only, gold can generate a
8608 gdb index without entries for declarations, which don't include
8609 enough information to be useful. */
8610 if (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2 && is_declaration_die (p->die))
8611 return false;
8613 if (table == pubname_table)
8615 /* Enumerator names are part of the pubname table, but the
8616 parent DW_TAG_enumeration_type die may have been pruned.
8617 Don't output them if that is the case. */
8618 if (p->die->die_tag == DW_TAG_enumerator &&
8619 (p->die->die_parent == NULL
8620 || !p->die->die_parent->die_perennial_p))
8621 return false;
8623 /* Everything else in the pubname table is included. */
8624 return true;
8627 /* The pubtypes table shouldn't include types that have been
8628 pruned. */
8629 return (p->die->die_offset != 0
8630 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types);
8633 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
8634 generated for the compilation unit. */
8636 static unsigned long
8637 size_of_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *names)
8639 unsigned long size;
8640 unsigned i;
8641 pubname_entry *p;
8642 int space_for_flags = (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) ? 1 : 0;
8644 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
8645 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*names, i, p)
8646 if (include_pubname_in_output (names, p))
8647 size += strlen (p->name) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1 + space_for_flags;
8649 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8650 return size;
8653 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
8655 static unsigned long
8656 size_of_aranges (void)
8658 unsigned long size;
8660 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
8662 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
8663 if (text_section_used)
8664 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8665 if (cold_text_section_used)
8666 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8667 if (have_multiple_function_sections)
8669 unsigned fde_idx;
8670 dw_fde_ref fde;
8672 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
8674 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
8675 continue;
8676 if (!fde->in_std_section)
8677 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8678 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
8679 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8683 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
8684 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8685 return size;
8688 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
8690 static enum dwarf_form
8691 value_format (dw_attr_node *a)
8693 switch (AT_class (a))
8695 case dw_val_class_addr:
8696 /* Only very few attributes allow DW_FORM_addr. */
8697 switch (a->dw_attr)
8699 case DW_AT_low_pc:
8700 case DW_AT_high_pc:
8701 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
8702 case DW_AT_trampoline:
8703 return (AT_index (a) == NOT_INDEXED
8704 ? DW_FORM_addr : DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index);
8705 default:
8706 break;
8708 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
8710 case 1:
8711 return DW_FORM_data1;
8712 case 2:
8713 return DW_FORM_data2;
8714 case 4:
8715 return DW_FORM_data4;
8716 case 8:
8717 return DW_FORM_data8;
8718 default:
8719 gcc_unreachable ();
8721 case dw_val_class_range_list:
8722 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
8723 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
8724 return DW_FORM_sec_offset;
8725 /* FALLTHRU */
8726 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
8727 case dw_val_class_offset:
8728 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
8730 case 4:
8731 return DW_FORM_data4;
8732 case 8:
8733 return DW_FORM_data8;
8734 default:
8735 gcc_unreachable ();
8737 case dw_val_class_loc:
8738 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
8739 return DW_FORM_exprloc;
8740 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
8742 case 1:
8743 return DW_FORM_block1;
8744 case 2:
8745 return DW_FORM_block2;
8746 case 4:
8747 return DW_FORM_block4;
8748 default:
8749 gcc_unreachable ();
8751 case dw_val_class_const:
8752 return DW_FORM_sdata;
8753 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8754 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
8756 case 1:
8757 return DW_FORM_data1;
8758 case 2:
8759 return DW_FORM_data2;
8760 case 4:
8761 /* In DWARF3 DW_AT_data_member_location with
8762 DW_FORM_data4 or DW_FORM_data8 is a loclistptr, not
8763 constant, so we need to use DW_FORM_udata if we need
8764 a large constant. */
8765 if (dwarf_version == 3 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location)
8766 return DW_FORM_udata;
8767 return DW_FORM_data4;
8768 case 8:
8769 if (dwarf_version == 3 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location)
8770 return DW_FORM_udata;
8771 return DW_FORM_data8;
8772 default:
8773 gcc_unreachable ();
8775 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8776 switch (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
8778 case 8:
8779 return DW_FORM_data2;
8780 case 16:
8781 return DW_FORM_data4;
8782 case 32:
8783 return DW_FORM_data8;
8784 case 64:
8785 default:
8786 return DW_FORM_block1;
8788 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
8789 switch (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide) * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
8791 case 8:
8792 return DW_FORM_data1;
8793 case 16:
8794 return DW_FORM_data2;
8795 case 32:
8796 return DW_FORM_data4;
8797 case 64:
8798 return DW_FORM_data8;
8799 default:
8800 return DW_FORM_block1;
8802 case dw_val_class_vec:
8803 switch (constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
8804 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size))
8806 case 1:
8807 return DW_FORM_block1;
8808 case 2:
8809 return DW_FORM_block2;
8810 case 4:
8811 return DW_FORM_block4;
8812 default:
8813 gcc_unreachable ();
8815 case dw_val_class_flag:
8816 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
8818 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
8819 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
8820 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
8821 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
8822 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
8823 the same abbrev entry. */
8824 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
8825 return DW_FORM_flag_present;
8827 return DW_FORM_flag;
8828 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
8829 if (AT_ref_external (a))
8830 return use_debug_types ? DW_FORM_ref_sig8 : DW_FORM_ref_addr;
8831 else
8832 return DW_FORM_ref;
8833 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
8834 return DW_FORM_data;
8835 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8836 return (AT_index (a) == NOT_INDEXED
8837 ? DW_FORM_addr : DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index);
8838 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
8839 case dw_val_class_macptr:
8840 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? DW_FORM_sec_offset : DW_FORM_data;
8841 case dw_val_class_str:
8842 return AT_string_form (a);
8843 case dw_val_class_file:
8844 switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
8846 case 1:
8847 return DW_FORM_data1;
8848 case 2:
8849 return DW_FORM_data2;
8850 case 4:
8851 return DW_FORM_data4;
8852 default:
8853 gcc_unreachable ();
8856 case dw_val_class_data8:
8857 return DW_FORM_data8;
8859 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
8860 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
8862 case 1:
8863 return DW_FORM_data1;
8864 case 2:
8865 return DW_FORM_data2;
8866 case 4:
8867 return DW_FORM_data4;
8868 case 8:
8869 return DW_FORM_data8;
8870 default:
8871 gcc_unreachable ();
8874 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
8875 return (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.pos
8876 ? DW_FORM_udata
8877 : DW_FORM_sdata);
8878 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
8879 switch (constant_size (size_of_discr_list (AT_discr_list (a))))
8881 case 1:
8882 return DW_FORM_block1;
8883 case 2:
8884 return DW_FORM_block2;
8885 case 4:
8886 return DW_FORM_block4;
8887 default:
8888 gcc_unreachable ();
8891 default:
8892 gcc_unreachable ();
8896 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
8898 static void
8899 output_value_format (dw_attr_node *a)
8901 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
8903 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
8906 /* Given a die and id, produce the appropriate abbreviations. */
8908 static void
8909 output_die_abbrevs (unsigned long abbrev_id, dw_die_ref abbrev)
8911 unsigned ix;
8912 dw_attr_node *a_attr;
8914 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
8915 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
8916 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
8918 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
8919 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
8920 else
8921 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
8923 for (ix = 0; vec_safe_iterate (abbrev->die_attr, ix, &a_attr); ix++)
8925 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
8926 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
8927 output_value_format (a_attr);
8930 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
8931 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
8935 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
8936 table. */
8938 static void
8939 output_abbrev_section (void)
8941 unsigned long abbrev_id;
8943 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
8944 output_die_abbrevs (abbrev_id, abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id]);
8946 /* Terminate the table. */
8947 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
8950 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
8952 static inline void
8953 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
8955 const char *sym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
8957 gcc_assert (!die->comdat_type_p);
8959 if (sym == 0)
8960 return;
8962 if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
8963 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
8964 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
8965 will break. */
8966 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, sym);
8968 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
8971 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
8972 expression. */
8974 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
8975 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
8976 const char *section)
8978 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_loc_list_node> ();
8980 retlist->begin = begin;
8981 retlist->begin_entry = NULL;
8982 retlist->end = end;
8983 retlist->expr = expr;
8984 retlist->section = section;
8986 return retlist;
8989 /* Generate a new internal symbol for this location list node, if it
8990 hasn't got one yet. */
8992 static inline void
8993 gen_llsym (dw_loc_list_ref list)
8995 gcc_assert (!list->ll_symbol);
8996 list->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
8999 /* Output the location list given to us. */
9001 static void
9002 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
9004 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
9006 if (list_head->emitted)
9007 return;
9008 list_head->emitted = true;
9010 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
9012 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
9013 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
9015 unsigned long size;
9016 /* Don't output an entry that starts and ends at the same address. */
9017 if (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0 && !curr->force)
9018 continue;
9019 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
9020 /* If the expression is too large, drop it on the floor. We could
9021 perhaps put it into DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure and refer to that
9022 in the expression, but >= 64KB expressions for a single value
9023 in a single range are unlikely very useful. */
9024 if (size > 0xffff)
9025 continue;
9026 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
9028 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_GNU_start_length_entry,
9029 "Location list start/length entry (%s)",
9030 list_head->ll_symbol);
9031 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->begin_entry->index,
9032 "Location list range start index (%s)",
9033 curr->begin);
9034 /* The length field is 4 bytes. If we ever need to support
9035 an 8-byte length, we can add a new DW_LLE code or fall back
9036 to DW_LLE_GNU_start_end_entry. */
9037 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, curr->end, curr->begin,
9038 "Location list range length (%s)",
9039 list_head->ll_symbol);
9041 else if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
9043 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
9044 "Location list begin address (%s)",
9045 list_head->ll_symbol);
9046 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
9047 "Location list end address (%s)",
9048 list_head->ll_symbol);
9050 else
9052 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
9053 "Location list begin address (%s)",
9054 list_head->ll_symbol);
9055 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
9056 "Location list end address (%s)",
9057 list_head->ll_symbol);
9060 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
9061 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
9062 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
9064 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr, -1);
9067 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
9068 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_GNU_end_of_list_entry,
9069 "Location list terminator (%s)",
9070 list_head->ll_symbol);
9071 else
9073 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
9074 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
9075 list_head->ll_symbol);
9076 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
9077 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
9078 list_head->ll_symbol);
9082 /* Output a range_list offset into the debug_range section. Emit a
9083 relocated reference if val_entry is NULL, otherwise, emit an
9084 indirect reference. */
9086 static void
9087 output_range_list_offset (dw_attr_node *a)
9089 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
9091 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry == RELOCATED_OFFSET)
9093 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
9094 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
9095 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
9096 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
9097 *p = '\0';
9099 else
9100 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
9101 "%s (offset from %s)", name, ranges_section_label);
9104 /* Output the offset into the debug_loc section. */
9106 static void
9107 output_loc_list_offset (dw_attr_node *a)
9109 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
9111 gcc_assert (sym);
9112 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
9113 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, loc_section_label,
9114 "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
9115 else
9116 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
9117 "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
9120 /* Output an attribute's index or value appropriately. */
9122 static void
9123 output_attr_index_or_value (dw_attr_node *a)
9125 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
9127 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
9129 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_index (a), "%s", name);
9130 return;
9132 switch (AT_class (a))
9134 case dw_val_class_addr:
9135 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
9136 break;
9137 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
9138 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9139 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
9140 break;
9141 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
9142 output_loc_list_offset (a);
9143 break;
9144 default:
9145 gcc_unreachable ();
9149 /* Output a type signature. */
9151 static inline void
9152 output_signature (const char *sig, const char *name)
9154 int i;
9156 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
9157 dw2_asm_output_data (1, sig[i], i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
9160 /* Output a discriminant value. */
9162 static inline void
9163 output_discr_value (dw_discr_value *discr_value, const char *name)
9165 if (discr_value->pos)
9166 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (discr_value->v.uval, "%s", name);
9167 else
9168 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (discr_value->v.sval, "%s", name);
9171 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
9172 the definitions of each child DIE. */
9174 static void
9175 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
9177 dw_attr_node *a;
9178 dw_die_ref c;
9179 unsigned long size;
9180 unsigned ix;
9182 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
9183 them to point to. */
9184 if (! die->comdat_type_p && die->die_id.die_symbol)
9185 output_die_symbol (die);
9187 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (%#lx) %s)",
9188 (unsigned long)die->die_offset,
9189 dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
9191 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
9193 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
9195 switch (AT_class (a))
9197 case dw_val_class_addr:
9198 output_attr_index_or_value (a);
9199 break;
9201 case dw_val_class_offset:
9202 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
9203 "%s", name);
9204 break;
9206 case dw_val_class_range_list:
9207 output_range_list_offset (a);
9208 break;
9210 case dw_val_class_loc:
9211 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
9213 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
9214 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9215 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "%s", name);
9216 else
9217 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
9219 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a), -1);
9220 break;
9222 case dw_val_class_const:
9223 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
9224 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
9225 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
9226 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
9227 break;
9229 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9231 int csize = constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
9232 if (dwarf_version == 3
9233 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location
9234 && csize >= 4)
9235 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
9236 else
9237 dw2_asm_output_data (csize, AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
9239 break;
9241 case dw_val_class_const_double:
9243 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
9245 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
9246 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
9247 HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT
9248 / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
9249 NULL);
9251 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
9253 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
9254 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
9256 else
9258 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
9259 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
9262 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
9263 first, "%s", name);
9264 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
9265 second, NULL);
9267 break;
9269 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
9271 int i;
9272 int len = get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide);
9273 int l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
9274 if (len * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > 64)
9275 dw2_asm_output_data (1, get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide) * l,
9276 NULL);
9278 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
9279 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
9281 dw2_asm_output_data (l, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->elt (i),
9282 "%s", name);
9283 name = "";
9285 else
9286 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
9288 dw2_asm_output_data (l, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->elt (i),
9289 "%s", name);
9290 name = "";
9293 break;
9295 case dw_val_class_vec:
9297 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
9298 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
9299 unsigned int i;
9300 unsigned char *p;
9302 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (len * elt_size),
9303 len * elt_size, "%s", name);
9304 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
9306 elt_size /= 2;
9307 len *= 2;
9309 for (i = 0, p = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
9310 i < len;
9311 i++, p += elt_size)
9312 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
9313 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
9314 break;
9317 case dw_val_class_flag:
9318 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9320 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
9321 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
9322 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
9323 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
9324 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
9325 the same abbrev entry. */
9326 gcc_assert (AT_flag (a) == 1);
9327 if (flag_debug_asm)
9328 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s\n",
9329 ASM_COMMENT_START, name);
9330 break;
9332 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
9333 break;
9335 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
9336 output_attr_index_or_value (a);
9337 break;
9339 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
9340 if (AT_ref_external (a))
9342 if (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p)
9344 comdat_type_node *type_node =
9345 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node;
9347 gcc_assert (type_node);
9348 output_signature (type_node->signature, name);
9350 else
9352 const char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol;
9353 int size;
9355 gcc_assert (sym);
9356 /* In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr is sized by target address
9357 length, whereas in DWARF3 it's always sized as an
9358 offset. */
9359 if (dwarf_version == 2)
9360 size = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9361 else
9362 size = DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9363 dw2_asm_output_offset (size, sym, debug_info_section, "%s",
9364 name);
9367 else
9369 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
9370 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
9371 "%s", name);
9373 break;
9375 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
9377 char l1[20];
9379 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
9380 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
9381 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
9382 "%s", name);
9384 break;
9386 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
9387 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA
9388 dw2_asm_output_vms_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
9389 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
9390 "%s", name);
9391 #else
9392 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
9393 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
9394 "%s", name);
9395 #endif
9396 break;
9398 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9399 output_attr_index_or_value (a);
9400 break;
9402 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9403 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
9404 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
9405 break;
9407 case dw_val_class_macptr:
9408 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
9409 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
9410 break;
9412 case dw_val_class_str:
9413 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_strp)
9414 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
9415 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
9416 debug_str_section,
9417 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
9418 else if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
9419 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_index (a),
9420 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
9421 else
9422 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
9423 break;
9425 case dw_val_class_file:
9427 int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
9429 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
9430 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
9431 break;
9434 case dw_val_class_data8:
9436 int i;
9438 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
9439 dw2_asm_output_data (1, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i],
9440 i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
9441 break;
9444 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
9445 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
9446 get_AT_low_pc (die), "DW_AT_high_pc");
9447 break;
9449 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
9450 output_discr_value (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value, name);
9451 break;
9453 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
9455 dw_discr_list_ref list = AT_discr_list (a);
9456 const int size = size_of_discr_list (list);
9458 /* This is a block, so output its length first. */
9459 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size,
9460 "%s: block size", name);
9462 for (; list != NULL; list = list->dw_discr_next)
9464 /* One byte for the discriminant value descriptor, and then as
9465 many LEB128 numbers as required. */
9466 if (list->dw_discr_range)
9467 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_DSC_range,
9468 "%s: DW_DSC_range", name);
9469 else
9470 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_DSC_label,
9471 "%s: DW_DSC_label", name);
9473 output_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_lower_bound, name);
9474 if (list->dw_discr_range)
9475 output_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_upper_bound, name);
9477 break;
9480 default:
9481 gcc_unreachable ();
9485 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
9487 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
9488 if (die->die_child != NULL)
9489 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE %#lx",
9490 (unsigned long) die->die_offset);
9493 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
9494 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
9496 static void
9497 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
9499 /* We don't support actual DWARFv5 units yet, we just use some
9500 DWARFv5 draft DIE tags in DWARFv4 format. */
9501 int ver = dwarf_version < 5 ? dwarf_version : 4;
9503 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
9505 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
9506 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
9507 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
9508 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
9509 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
9510 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
9513 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF version number");
9514 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
9515 debug_abbrev_section,
9516 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
9517 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
9520 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
9522 static void
9523 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
9525 const char *secname, *oldsym;
9526 char *tmp;
9528 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
9529 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
9530 return;
9532 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
9533 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
9534 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
9535 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
9536 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
9537 mark_dies (die);
9539 external_ref_hash_type *extern_map = optimize_external_refs (die);
9541 build_abbrev_table (die, extern_map);
9543 delete extern_map;
9545 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
9546 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
9547 calc_die_sizes (die);
9549 oldsym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
9550 if (oldsym)
9552 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (oldsym) + 24);
9554 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
9555 secname = tmp;
9556 die->die_id.die_symbol = NULL;
9557 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
9559 else
9561 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
9562 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
9563 info_section_emitted = true;
9566 /* Output debugging information. */
9567 output_compilation_unit_header ();
9568 output_die (die);
9570 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
9571 output_pubnames. */
9572 if (oldsym)
9574 unmark_dies (die);
9575 die->die_id.die_symbol = oldsym;
9579 /* Whether to generate the DWARF accelerator tables in .debug_pubnames
9580 and .debug_pubtypes. This is configured per-target, but can be
9581 overridden by the -gpubnames or -gno-pubnames options. */
9583 static inline bool
9584 want_pubnames (void)
9586 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
9587 return false;
9588 if (debug_generate_pub_sections != -1)
9589 return debug_generate_pub_sections;
9590 return targetm.want_debug_pub_sections;
9593 /* Add the DW_AT_GNU_pubnames and DW_AT_GNU_pubtypes attributes. */
9595 static void
9596 add_AT_pubnames (dw_die_ref die)
9598 if (want_pubnames ())
9599 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_GNU_pubnames, 1);
9602 /* Add a string attribute value to a skeleton DIE. */
9604 static inline void
9605 add_skeleton_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
9606 const char *str)
9608 dw_attr_node attr;
9609 struct indirect_string_node *node;
9611 if (! skeleton_debug_str_hash)
9612 skeleton_debug_str_hash
9613 = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
9615 node = find_AT_string_in_table (str, skeleton_debug_str_hash);
9616 find_string_form (node);
9617 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
9618 node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
9620 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
9621 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
9622 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
9623 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
9624 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
9627 /* Helper function to generate top-level dies for skeleton debug_info and
9628 debug_types. */
9630 static void
9631 add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs (dw_die_ref die)
9633 const char *dwo_file_name = concat (aux_base_name, ".dwo", NULL);
9634 const char *comp_dir = comp_dir_string ();
9636 add_skeleton_AT_string (die, DW_AT_GNU_dwo_name, dwo_file_name);
9637 if (comp_dir != NULL)
9638 add_skeleton_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, comp_dir);
9639 add_AT_pubnames (die);
9640 add_AT_lineptr (die, DW_AT_GNU_addr_base, debug_addr_section_label);
9643 /* Output skeleton debug sections that point to the dwo file. */
9645 static void
9646 output_skeleton_debug_sections (dw_die_ref comp_unit)
9648 /* We don't support actual DWARFv5 units yet, we just use some
9649 DWARFv5 draft DIE tags in DWARFv4 format. */
9650 int ver = dwarf_version < 5 ? dwarf_version : 4;
9652 /* These attributes will be found in the full debug_info section. */
9653 remove_AT (comp_unit, DW_AT_producer);
9654 remove_AT (comp_unit, DW_AT_language);
9656 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_info_section);
9657 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_info_section_label);
9659 /* Produce the skeleton compilation-unit header. This one differs enough from
9660 a normal CU header that it's better not to call output_compilation_unit
9661 header. */
9662 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
9663 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
9664 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
9666 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
9667 DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE
9668 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
9669 + size_of_die (comp_unit),
9670 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
9671 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF version number");
9672 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
9673 debug_abbrev_section,
9674 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
9675 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
9677 comp_unit->die_abbrev = SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV;
9678 output_die (comp_unit);
9680 /* Build the skeleton debug_abbrev section. */
9681 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section);
9682 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label);
9684 output_die_abbrevs (SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV, comp_unit);
9686 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of skeleton .debug_abbrev");
9689 /* Output a comdat type unit DIE and its children. */
9691 static void
9692 output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *node)
9694 const char *secname;
9695 char *tmp;
9696 int i;
9697 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
9698 tree comdat_key;
9699 #endif
9701 /* First mark all the DIEs in this CU so we know which get local refs. */
9702 mark_dies (node->root_die);
9704 external_ref_hash_type *extern_map = optimize_external_refs (node->root_die);
9706 build_abbrev_table (node->root_die, extern_map);
9708 delete extern_map;
9709 extern_map = NULL;
9711 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
9712 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
9713 calc_die_sizes (node->root_die);
9715 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
9716 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
9717 secname = ".debug_types";
9718 else
9719 secname = ".debug_types.dwo";
9721 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
9722 sprintf (tmp, "wt.");
9723 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
9724 sprintf (tmp + 3 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
9725 comdat_key = get_identifier (tmp);
9726 targetm.asm_out.named_section (secname,
9727 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_LINKONCE,
9728 comdat_key);
9729 #else
9730 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 18 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
9731 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wt.");
9732 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
9733 sprintf (tmp + 17 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
9734 secname = tmp;
9735 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
9736 #endif
9738 /* Output debugging information. */
9739 output_compilation_unit_header ();
9740 output_signature (node->signature, "Type Signature");
9741 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->type_die->die_offset,
9742 "Offset to Type DIE");
9743 output_die (node->root_die);
9745 unmark_dies (node->root_die);
9748 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl. */
9750 static const char *
9751 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
9753 if (DECL_NAMELESS (decl))
9754 return NULL;
9755 return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
9758 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
9760 static void
9761 add_pubname_string (const char *str, dw_die_ref die)
9763 pubname_entry e;
9765 e.die = die;
9766 e.name = xstrdup (str);
9767 vec_safe_push (pubname_table, e);
9770 static void
9771 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
9773 if (!want_pubnames ())
9774 return;
9776 /* Don't add items to the table when we expect that the consumer will have
9777 just read the enclosing die. For example, if the consumer is looking at a
9778 class_member, it will either be inside the class already, or will have just
9779 looked up the class to find the member. Either way, searching the class is
9780 faster than searching the index. */
9781 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl) && !class_scope_p (die->die_parent))
9782 || is_cu_die (die->die_parent) || is_namespace_die (die->die_parent))
9784 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
9786 if (name)
9787 add_pubname_string (name, die);
9791 /* Add an enumerator to the pubnames section. */
9793 static void
9794 add_enumerator_pubname (const char *scope_name, dw_die_ref die)
9796 pubname_entry e;
9798 gcc_assert (scope_name);
9799 e.name = concat (scope_name, get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name), NULL);
9800 e.die = die;
9801 vec_safe_push (pubname_table, e);
9804 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate. */
9806 static void
9807 add_pubtype (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
9809 pubname_entry e;
9811 if (!want_pubnames ())
9812 return;
9814 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
9815 || is_cu_die (die->die_parent) || is_namespace_die (die->die_parent))
9816 && (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef || COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl)))
9818 tree scope = NULL;
9819 const char *scope_name = "";
9820 const char *sep = is_cxx () ? "::" : ".";
9821 const char *name;
9823 scope = TYPE_P (decl) ? TYPE_CONTEXT (decl) : NULL;
9824 if (scope && TREE_CODE (scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
9826 scope_name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (scope, 1);
9827 if (scope_name != NULL && scope_name[0] != '\0')
9828 scope_name = concat (scope_name, sep, NULL);
9829 else
9830 scope_name = "";
9833 if (TYPE_P (decl))
9834 name = type_tag (decl);
9835 else
9836 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, 1);
9838 /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
9839 it to the table. */
9840 if (name != NULL && name[0] != '\0')
9842 e.die = die;
9843 e.name = concat (scope_name, name, NULL);
9844 vec_safe_push (pubtype_table, e);
9847 /* Although it might be more consistent to add the pubinfo for the
9848 enumerators as their dies are created, they should only be added if the
9849 enum type meets the criteria above. So rather than re-check the parent
9850 enum type whenever an enumerator die is created, just output them all
9851 here. This isn't protected by the name conditional because anonymous
9852 enums don't have names. */
9853 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_enumeration_type)
9855 dw_die_ref c;
9857 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_enumerator_pubname (scope_name, c));
9862 /* Output a single entry in the pubnames table. */
9864 static void
9865 output_pubname (dw_offset die_offset, pubname_entry *entry)
9867 dw_die_ref die = entry->die;
9868 int is_static = get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_external) ? 0 : 1;
9870 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, die_offset, "DIE offset");
9872 if (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2)
9874 /* This logic follows gdb's method for determining the value of the flag
9875 byte. */
9876 uint32_t flags = GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_NONE;
9877 switch (die->die_tag)
9879 case DW_TAG_typedef:
9880 case DW_TAG_base_type:
9881 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
9882 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
9883 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
9884 break;
9885 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
9886 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
9887 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
9888 if (!is_cxx () && !is_java ())
9889 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
9890 break;
9891 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
9892 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
9893 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_FUNCTION);
9894 if (!is_ada ())
9895 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
9896 break;
9897 case DW_TAG_constant:
9898 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
9899 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
9900 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
9901 break;
9902 case DW_TAG_variable:
9903 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
9904 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
9905 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
9906 break;
9907 case DW_TAG_namespace:
9908 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
9909 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
9910 break;
9911 case DW_TAG_class_type:
9912 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
9913 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
9914 case DW_TAG_union_type:
9915 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
9916 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
9917 if (!is_cxx () && !is_java ())
9918 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
9919 break;
9920 default:
9921 /* An unusual tag. Leave the flag-byte empty. */
9922 break;
9924 dw2_asm_output_data (1, flags >> GDB_INDEX_CU_BITSIZE,
9925 "GDB-index flags");
9928 dw2_asm_output_nstring (entry->name, -1, "external name");
9932 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
9933 visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions. */
9935 static void
9936 output_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *names)
9938 unsigned i;
9939 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames (names);
9940 pubname_entry *pub;
9942 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
9944 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
9945 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
9946 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
9947 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
9948 "Pub Info Length");
9951 /* Version number for pubnames/pubtypes is independent of dwarf version. */
9952 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
9954 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
9955 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
9956 debug_skeleton_info_section,
9957 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
9958 else
9959 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
9960 debug_info_section,
9961 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
9962 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
9963 "Compilation Unit Length");
9965 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*names, i, pub)
9967 if (include_pubname_in_output (names, pub))
9969 dw_offset die_offset = pub->die->die_offset;
9971 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
9972 if (names == pubname_table && pub->die->die_tag != DW_TAG_enumerator)
9973 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
9975 /* If we're putting types in their own .debug_types sections,
9976 the .debug_pubtypes table will still point to the compile
9977 unit (not the type unit), so we want to use the offset of
9978 the skeleton DIE (if there is one). */
9979 if (pub->die->comdat_type_p && names == pubtype_table)
9981 comdat_type_node *type_node = pub->die->die_id.die_type_node;
9983 if (type_node != NULL)
9984 die_offset = (type_node->skeleton_die != NULL
9985 ? type_node->skeleton_die->die_offset
9986 : comp_unit_die ()->die_offset);
9989 output_pubname (die_offset, pub);
9993 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
9996 /* Output public names and types tables if necessary. */
9998 static void
9999 output_pubtables (void)
10001 if (!want_pubnames () || !info_section_emitted)
10002 return;
10004 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
10005 output_pubnames (pubname_table);
10006 /* ??? Only defined by DWARF3, but emitted by Darwin for DWARF2.
10007 It shouldn't hurt to emit it always, since pure DWARF2 consumers
10008 simply won't look for the section. */
10009 switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section);
10010 output_pubnames (pubtype_table);
10014 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
10015 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
10016 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
10018 static void
10019 output_aranges (void)
10021 unsigned i;
10022 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
10024 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
10026 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10027 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10028 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10029 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
10030 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
10033 /* Version number for aranges is still 2, even up to DWARF5. */
10034 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
10035 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
10036 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
10037 debug_skeleton_info_section,
10038 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10039 else
10040 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
10041 debug_info_section,
10042 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10043 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
10044 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
10046 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
10047 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
10049 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
10050 pointer size. */
10051 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
10052 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
10053 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
10054 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
10057 /* It is necessary not to output these entries if the sections were
10058 not used; if the sections were not used, the length will be 0 and
10059 the address may end up as 0 if the section is discarded by ld
10060 --gc-sections, leaving an invalid (0, 0) entry that can be
10061 confused with the terminator. */
10062 if (text_section_used)
10064 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
10065 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
10066 text_section_label, "Length");
10068 if (cold_text_section_used)
10070 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
10071 "Address");
10072 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
10073 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
10076 if (have_multiple_function_sections)
10078 unsigned fde_idx;
10079 dw_fde_ref fde;
10081 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
10083 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
10084 continue;
10085 if (!fde->in_std_section)
10087 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
10088 "Address");
10089 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_end,
10090 fde->dw_fde_begin, "Length");
10092 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
10094 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
10095 "Address");
10096 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_end,
10097 fde->dw_fde_second_begin, "Length");
10102 /* Output the terminator words. */
10103 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
10104 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
10107 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
10108 was placed. */
10110 static unsigned int
10111 add_ranges_num (int num)
10113 unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
10115 if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
10117 ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
10118 ranges_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_ranges, ranges_table,
10119 ranges_table_allocated);
10120 memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
10121 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_ranges));
10124 ranges_table[in_use].num = num;
10125 ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
10127 return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10130 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a block, or a
10131 range terminator if BLOCK is NULL. */
10133 static unsigned int
10134 add_ranges (const_tree block)
10136 return add_ranges_num (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
10139 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a pair of labels.
10140 When using dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined
10141 for the final executable should be direct references--setting the
10142 parameter force_direct ensures this behavior. */
10144 static void
10145 add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref die, const char *begin, const char *end,
10146 bool *added, bool force_direct)
10148 unsigned int in_use = ranges_by_label_in_use;
10149 unsigned int offset;
10151 if (in_use == ranges_by_label_allocated)
10153 ranges_by_label_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
10154 ranges_by_label = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_ranges_by_label, ranges_by_label,
10155 ranges_by_label_allocated);
10156 memset (ranges_by_label + ranges_by_label_in_use, 0,
10157 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_ranges_by_label));
10160 ranges_by_label[in_use].begin = begin;
10161 ranges_by_label[in_use].end = end;
10162 ranges_by_label_in_use = in_use + 1;
10164 offset = add_ranges_num (-(int)in_use - 1);
10165 if (!*added)
10167 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, offset, force_direct);
10168 *added = true;
10172 static void
10173 output_ranges (void)
10175 unsigned i;
10176 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset %#x";
10177 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
10179 for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
10181 int block_num = ranges_table[i].num;
10183 if (block_num > 0)
10185 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10186 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10188 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
10189 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
10191 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
10192 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
10193 base of the text section. */
10194 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
10196 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
10197 text_section_label,
10198 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
10199 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
10200 text_section_label, NULL);
10203 /* Otherwise, the compilation unit base address is zero,
10204 which allows us to use absolute addresses, and not worry
10205 about whether the target supports cross-section
10206 arithmetic. */
10207 else
10209 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
10210 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
10211 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
10214 fmt = NULL;
10217 /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label. */
10218 else if (block_num < 0)
10220 int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
10222 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
10224 gcc_unreachable ();
10225 #if 0
10226 /* If we ever use add_ranges_by_labels () for a single
10227 function section, all we have to do is to take out
10228 the #if 0 above. */
10229 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
10230 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
10231 text_section_label,
10232 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
10233 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
10234 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
10235 text_section_label, NULL);
10236 #endif
10238 else
10240 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
10241 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
10242 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
10243 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
10244 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
10245 NULL);
10248 else
10250 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
10251 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
10252 fmt = start_fmt;
10257 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
10258 struct file_info
10260 const char *path; /* Complete file name. */
10261 const char *fname; /* File name part. */
10262 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
10263 struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
10264 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
10267 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
10268 files. */
10269 struct dir_info
10271 const char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
10272 int length; /* Path length. */
10273 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
10274 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
10275 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
10278 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
10279 the directories in the path. */
10281 static int
10282 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
10284 const struct file_info *const s1 = (const struct file_info *) p1;
10285 const struct file_info *const s2 = (const struct file_info *) p2;
10286 const unsigned char *cp1;
10287 const unsigned char *cp2;
10289 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
10290 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
10291 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
10292 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
10293 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
10294 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
10295 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
10297 cp1 = (const unsigned char *) s1->path;
10298 cp2 = (const unsigned char *) s2->path;
10300 while (1)
10302 ++cp1;
10303 ++cp2;
10304 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
10305 if ((cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname)
10306 || (cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname))
10307 return ((cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname)
10308 - (cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname));
10310 /* Character of current path component the same? */
10311 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
10312 return *cp1 - *cp2;
10316 struct file_name_acquire_data
10318 struct file_info *files;
10319 int used_files;
10320 int max_files;
10323 /* Traversal function for the hash table. */
10326 file_name_acquire (dwarf_file_data **slot, file_name_acquire_data *fnad)
10328 struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
10329 struct file_info *fi;
10330 const char *f;
10332 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
10334 if (! d->emitted_number)
10335 return 1;
10337 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
10339 fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
10341 /* Skip all leading "./". */
10342 f = d->filename;
10343 while (f[0] == '.' && IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (f[1]))
10344 f += 2;
10346 /* Create a new array entry. */
10347 fi->path = f;
10348 fi->length = strlen (f);
10349 fi->file_idx = d;
10351 /* Search for the file name part. */
10352 f = strrchr (f, DIR_SEPARATOR);
10353 #if defined (DIR_SEPARATOR_2)
10355 char *g = strrchr (fi->path, DIR_SEPARATOR_2);
10357 if (g != NULL)
10359 if (f == NULL || f < g)
10360 f = g;
10363 #endif
10365 fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
10366 return 1;
10369 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
10370 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
10371 slowdowns with many input files. */
10373 static void
10374 output_file_names (void)
10376 struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
10377 int numfiles;
10378 struct file_info *files;
10379 struct dir_info *dirs;
10380 int *saved;
10381 int *savehere;
10382 int *backmap;
10383 int ndirs;
10384 int idx_offset;
10385 int i;
10387 if (!last_emitted_file)
10389 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
10390 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
10391 return;
10394 numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
10396 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
10397 files = XALLOCAVEC (struct file_info, numfiles);
10398 dirs = XALLOCAVEC (struct dir_info, numfiles);
10400 fnad.files = files;
10401 fnad.used_files = 0;
10402 fnad.max_files = numfiles;
10403 file_table->traverse<file_name_acquire_data *, file_name_acquire> (&fnad);
10404 gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
10406 qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
10408 /* Find all the different directories used. */
10409 dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
10410 dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
10411 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
10412 dirs[0].count = 1;
10413 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
10414 files[0].dir_idx = 0;
10415 ndirs = 1;
10417 for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
10418 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
10419 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
10420 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
10422 /* Same directory as last entry. */
10423 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
10424 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
10426 else
10428 int j;
10430 /* This is a new directory. */
10431 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
10432 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
10433 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
10434 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
10435 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
10437 /* Search for a prefix. */
10438 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
10439 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
10440 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
10441 && dirs[j].length > 1
10442 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
10443 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
10444 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
10445 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
10447 ++ndirs;
10450 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
10451 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
10452 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
10453 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
10454 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
10455 results in most cases and never is much off. */
10456 saved = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
10457 savehere = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
10459 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
10460 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
10462 int j;
10463 int total;
10465 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
10466 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
10467 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
10468 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
10470 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
10472 savehere[j] = 0;
10473 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
10475 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
10476 dirs[j] path. */
10477 int k;
10479 k = dirs[j].prefix;
10480 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
10481 k = dirs[k].prefix;
10483 if (k == (int) i)
10485 /* Yes it is. We can possibly save some memory by
10486 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
10487 dirs[i]. */
10488 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
10489 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
10494 /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
10495 directory. */
10496 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
10498 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
10499 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
10500 if (savehere[j] > 0)
10502 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
10503 saved[j] = savehere[j];
10505 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
10506 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
10511 /* Emit the directory name table. */
10512 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
10513 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
10514 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path,
10515 dirs[i].length
10516 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR,
10517 "Directory Entry: %#x", i + idx_offset);
10519 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
10521 /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
10522 used in the debug info generation. To do this efficiently we
10523 generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
10524 backmap = XALLOCAVEC (int, numfiles);
10525 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
10526 backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
10528 /* Now write all the file names. */
10529 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
10531 int file_idx = backmap[i];
10532 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
10534 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10535 #define MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN 6 /* ";32768" */
10537 /* Setting these fields can lead to debugger miscomparisons,
10538 but VMS Debug requires them to be set correctly. */
10540 int ver;
10541 long long cdt;
10542 long siz;
10543 int maxfilelen = strlen (files[file_idx].path)
10544 + dirs[dir_idx].length
10545 + MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN + 1;
10546 char *filebuf = XALLOCAVEC (char, maxfilelen);
10548 vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, 0, 0, &ver);
10549 snprintf (filebuf, maxfilelen, "%s;%d",
10550 files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, ver);
10552 dw2_asm_output_nstring
10553 (filebuf, -1, "File Entry: %#x", (unsigned) i + 1);
10555 /* Include directory index. */
10556 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
10558 /* Modification time. */
10559 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128
10560 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, &cdt, 0, 0, 0) == 0)
10561 ? cdt : 0,
10562 NULL);
10564 /* File length in bytes. */
10565 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128
10566 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, &siz, 0, 0) == 0)
10567 ? siz : 0,
10568 NULL);
10569 #else
10570 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
10571 "File Entry: %#x", (unsigned) i + 1);
10573 /* Include directory index. */
10574 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
10576 /* Modification time. */
10577 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
10579 /* File length in bytes. */
10580 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
10581 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
10584 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
10588 /* Output one line number table into the .debug_line section. */
10590 static void
10591 output_one_line_info_table (dw_line_info_table *table)
10593 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10594 unsigned int current_line = 1;
10595 bool current_is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
10596 dw_line_info_entry *ent;
10597 size_t i;
10599 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (table->entries, i, ent)
10601 switch (ent->opcode)
10603 case LI_set_address:
10604 /* ??? Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and
10605 must always use the most general form. GCC does not know the
10606 address delta itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many
10607 ports do have length attributes which will give an upper bound
10608 on the address range. We could perhaps use length attributes
10609 to determine when it is safe to use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
10610 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, ent->val);
10612 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
10613 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
10614 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s", line_label);
10615 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
10616 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
10617 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
10618 break;
10620 case LI_set_line:
10621 if (ent->val == current_line)
10623 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
10624 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy,
10625 "copy line %u", current_line);
10627 else
10629 int line_offset = ent->val - current_line;
10630 int line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
10632 current_line = ent->val;
10633 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
10635 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
10636 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE.
10637 This takes 1 byte. */
10638 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
10639 "line %u", current_line);
10641 else
10643 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
10644 depending on the value being encoded. */
10645 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
10646 "advance to line %u", current_line);
10647 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
10648 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, NULL);
10651 break;
10653 case LI_set_file:
10654 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "set file %u", ent->val);
10655 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
10656 break;
10658 case LI_set_column:
10659 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_column, "column %u", ent->val);
10660 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
10661 break;
10663 case LI_negate_stmt:
10664 current_is_stmt = !current_is_stmt;
10665 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_negate_stmt,
10666 "is_stmt %d", current_is_stmt);
10667 break;
10669 case LI_set_prologue_end:
10670 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_prologue_end,
10671 "set prologue end");
10672 break;
10674 case LI_set_epilogue_begin:
10675 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_epilogue_begin,
10676 "set epilogue begin");
10677 break;
10679 case LI_set_discriminator:
10680 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "discriminator %u", ent->val);
10681 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + size_of_uleb128 (ent->val), NULL);
10682 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_discriminator, NULL);
10683 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, NULL);
10684 break;
10688 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the table. */
10689 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s", table->end_label);
10690 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
10691 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
10692 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, table->end_label, NULL);
10694 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end sequence");
10695 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
10696 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
10699 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
10700 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
10702 static void
10703 output_line_info (bool prologue_only)
10705 char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
10706 /* We don't support DWARFv5 line tables yet. */
10707 int ver = dwarf_version < 5 ? dwarf_version : 4;
10708 bool saw_one = false;
10709 int opc;
10711 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
10712 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
10713 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
10714 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
10716 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
10718 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10719 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10720 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10721 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
10722 "Length of Source Line Info");
10725 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
10727 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF Version");
10728 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
10729 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
10731 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in bytes).
10732 In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for information
10733 purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language, we have no
10734 a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are generated for each
10735 source line, and therefore can use only the DW_LNE_set_address and
10736 DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information commands. Accordingly, we fix
10737 this as '1', which is "correct enough" for all architectures,
10738 and don't let the target override. */
10739 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Minimum Instruction Length");
10741 if (ver >= 4)
10742 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN,
10743 "Maximum Operations Per Instruction");
10744 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
10745 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
10746 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
10747 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
10748 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
10749 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
10750 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
10751 "Special Opcode Base");
10753 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
10755 int n_op_args;
10756 switch (opc)
10758 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
10759 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
10760 case DW_LNS_set_file:
10761 case DW_LNS_set_column:
10762 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
10763 case DW_LNS_set_isa:
10764 n_op_args = 1;
10765 break;
10766 default:
10767 n_op_args = 0;
10768 break;
10771 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: %#x has %d args",
10772 opc, n_op_args);
10775 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
10776 output_file_names ();
10777 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
10778 if (prologue_only)
10780 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
10781 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
10782 return;
10785 if (separate_line_info)
10787 dw_line_info_table *table;
10788 size_t i;
10790 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*separate_line_info, i, table)
10791 if (table->in_use)
10793 output_one_line_info_table (table);
10794 saw_one = true;
10797 if (cold_text_section_line_info && cold_text_section_line_info->in_use)
10799 output_one_line_info_table (cold_text_section_line_info);
10800 saw_one = true;
10803 /* ??? Some Darwin linkers crash on a .debug_line section with no
10804 sequences. Further, merely a DW_LNE_end_sequence entry is not
10805 sufficient -- the address column must also be initialized.
10806 Make sure to output at least one set_address/end_sequence pair,
10807 choosing .text since that section is always present. */
10808 if (text_section_line_info->in_use || !saw_one)
10809 output_one_line_info_table (text_section_line_info);
10811 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
10812 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
10815 /* Return true if DW_AT_endianity should be emitted according to REVERSE. */
10817 static inline bool
10818 need_endianity_attribute_p (bool reverse)
10820 return reverse && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict);
10823 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
10824 a DIE that describes the given type. REVERSE is true if the type is
10825 to be interpreted in the reverse storage order wrt the target order.
10827 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
10828 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
10830 static dw_die_ref
10831 base_type_die (tree type, bool reverse)
10833 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
10834 enum dwarf_type encoding;
10835 bool fpt_used = false;
10836 struct fixed_point_type_info fpt_info;
10837 tree type_bias = NULL_TREE;
10839 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
10840 return 0;
10842 /* If this is a subtype that should not be emitted as a subrange type,
10843 use the base type. See subrange_type_for_debug_p. */
10844 if (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE)
10845 type = TREE_TYPE (type);
10847 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
10849 case INTEGER_TYPE:
10850 if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
10851 && TYPE_NAME (type)
10852 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
10853 && DECL_IS_BUILTIN (TYPE_NAME (type))
10854 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)))
10856 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)));
10857 if (strcmp (name, "char16_t") == 0
10858 || strcmp (name, "char32_t") == 0)
10860 encoding = DW_ATE_UTF;
10861 break;
10864 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
10865 && lang_hooks.types.get_fixed_point_type_info)
10867 memset (&fpt_info, 0, sizeof (fpt_info));
10868 if (lang_hooks.types.get_fixed_point_type_info (type, &fpt_info))
10870 fpt_used = true;
10871 encoding = ((TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
10872 ? DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed
10873 : DW_ATE_signed_fixed);
10874 break;
10877 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
10879 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
10880 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
10881 else
10882 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
10884 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
10885 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
10886 else
10887 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
10889 if (!dwarf_strict
10890 && lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias)
10891 type_bias = lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias (type);
10892 break;
10894 case REAL_TYPE:
10895 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
10897 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
10898 encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
10899 else
10900 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
10902 else
10903 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
10904 break;
10906 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
10907 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
10908 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
10909 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
10910 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed;
10911 else
10912 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_fixed;
10913 break;
10915 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
10916 a user defined type for it. */
10917 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
10918 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
10919 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
10920 else
10921 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
10922 break;
10924 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
10925 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
10926 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
10927 break;
10929 default:
10930 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
10931 gcc_unreachable ();
10934 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die (), type);
10936 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
10937 int_size_in_bytes (type));
10938 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
10940 if (need_endianity_attribute_p (reverse))
10941 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_endianity,
10942 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? DW_END_little : DW_END_big);
10944 if (fpt_used)
10946 switch (fpt_info.scale_factor_kind)
10948 case fixed_point_scale_factor_binary:
10949 add_AT_int (base_type_result, DW_AT_binary_scale,
10950 fpt_info.scale_factor.binary);
10951 break;
10953 case fixed_point_scale_factor_decimal:
10954 add_AT_int (base_type_result, DW_AT_decimal_scale,
10955 fpt_info.scale_factor.decimal);
10956 break;
10958 case fixed_point_scale_factor_arbitrary:
10959 /* Arbitrary scale factors cannot be described in standard DWARF,
10960 yet. */
10961 if (!dwarf_strict)
10963 /* Describe the scale factor as a rational constant. */
10964 const dw_die_ref scale_factor
10965 = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, comp_unit_die (), type);
10967 add_AT_unsigned (scale_factor, DW_AT_GNU_numerator,
10968 fpt_info.scale_factor.arbitrary.numerator);
10969 add_AT_int (scale_factor, DW_AT_GNU_denominator,
10970 fpt_info.scale_factor.arbitrary.denominator);
10972 add_AT_die_ref (base_type_result, DW_AT_small, scale_factor);
10974 break;
10976 default:
10977 gcc_unreachable ();
10981 if (type_bias)
10982 add_scalar_info (base_type_result, DW_AT_GNU_bias, type_bias,
10983 dw_scalar_form_constant
10984 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
10985 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
10986 NULL);
10988 add_pubtype (type, base_type_result);
10990 return base_type_result;
10993 /* A C++ function with deduced return type can have a TEMPLATE_TYPE_PARM
10994 named 'auto' in its type: return true for it, false otherwise. */
10996 static inline bool
10997 is_cxx_auto (tree type)
10999 if (is_cxx ())
11001 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
11002 if (name == get_identifier ("auto")
11003 || name == get_identifier ("decltype(auto)"))
11004 return true;
11006 return false;
11009 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
11010 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
11012 static inline int
11013 is_base_type (tree type)
11015 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
11017 case ERROR_MARK:
11018 case VOID_TYPE:
11019 case INTEGER_TYPE:
11020 case REAL_TYPE:
11021 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
11022 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
11023 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
11024 case POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE:
11025 return 1;
11027 case ARRAY_TYPE:
11028 case RECORD_TYPE:
11029 case UNION_TYPE:
11030 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
11031 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
11032 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
11033 case METHOD_TYPE:
11034 case POINTER_TYPE:
11035 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
11036 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
11037 case OFFSET_TYPE:
11038 case LANG_TYPE:
11039 case VECTOR_TYPE:
11040 return 0;
11042 default:
11043 if (is_cxx_auto (type))
11044 return 0;
11045 gcc_unreachable ();
11048 return 0;
11051 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
11052 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
11053 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
11054 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
11055 ERROR_MARK node. */
11057 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
11058 simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
11060 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
11061 return BITS_PER_WORD;
11062 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
11063 return 0;
11064 else if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE (type)))
11065 return tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (type));
11066 else
11067 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
11070 /* Similarly, but return an offset_int instead of UHWI. */
11072 static inline offset_int
11073 offset_int_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
11075 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
11076 return BITS_PER_WORD;
11077 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
11078 return 0;
11079 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (type)) == INTEGER_CST)
11080 return wi::to_offset (TYPE_SIZE (type));
11081 else
11082 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
11085 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
11086 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
11088 static dw_die_ref
11089 subrange_type_die (tree type, tree low, tree high, tree bias,
11090 dw_die_ref context_die)
11092 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
11093 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
11095 if (context_die == NULL)
11096 context_die = comp_unit_die ();
11098 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
11100 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
11102 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
11103 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
11104 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
11107 if (low)
11108 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, low, NULL);
11109 if (high)
11110 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, high, NULL);
11111 if (bias && !dwarf_strict)
11112 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_GNU_bias, bias,
11113 dw_scalar_form_constant
11114 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
11115 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
11116 NULL);
11118 return subrange_die;
11121 /* Returns the (const and/or volatile) cv_qualifiers associated with
11122 the decl node. This will normally be augmented with the
11123 cv_qualifiers of the underlying type in add_type_attribute. */
11125 static int
11126 decl_quals (const_tree decl)
11128 return ((TREE_READONLY (decl)
11129 ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED)
11130 | (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
11131 ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED));
11134 /* Determine the TYPE whose qualifiers match the largest strict subset
11135 of the given TYPE_QUALS, and return its qualifiers. Ignore all
11136 qualifiers outside QUAL_MASK. */
11138 static int
11139 get_nearest_type_subqualifiers (tree type, int type_quals, int qual_mask)
11141 tree t;
11142 int best_rank = 0, best_qual = 0, max_rank;
11144 type_quals &= qual_mask;
11145 max_rank = popcount_hwi (type_quals) - 1;
11147 for (t = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type); t && best_rank < max_rank;
11148 t = TYPE_NEXT_VARIANT (t))
11150 int q = TYPE_QUALS (t) & qual_mask;
11152 if ((q & type_quals) == q && q != type_quals
11153 && check_base_type (t, type))
11155 int rank = popcount_hwi (q);
11157 if (rank > best_rank)
11159 best_rank = rank;
11160 best_qual = q;
11165 return best_qual;
11168 struct dwarf_qual_info_t { int q; enum dwarf_tag t; };
11169 static const dwarf_qual_info_t dwarf_qual_info[] =
11171 { TYPE_QUAL_CONST, DW_TAG_const_type },
11172 { TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE, DW_TAG_volatile_type },
11173 { TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT, DW_TAG_restrict_type },
11174 { TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC, DW_TAG_atomic_type }
11176 static const unsigned int dwarf_qual_info_size
11177 = sizeof (dwarf_qual_info) / sizeof (dwarf_qual_info[0]);
11179 /* If DIE is a qualified DIE of some base DIE with the same parent,
11180 return the base DIE, otherwise return NULL. Set MASK to the
11181 qualifiers added compared to the returned DIE. */
11183 static dw_die_ref
11184 qualified_die_p (dw_die_ref die, int *mask, unsigned int depth)
11186 unsigned int i;
11187 for (i = 0; i < dwarf_qual_info_size; i++)
11188 if (die->die_tag == dwarf_qual_info[i].t)
11189 break;
11190 if (i == dwarf_qual_info_size)
11191 return NULL;
11192 if (vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) != 1)
11193 return NULL;
11194 dw_die_ref type = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_type);
11195 if (type == NULL || type->die_parent != die->die_parent)
11196 return NULL;
11197 *mask |= dwarf_qual_info[i].q;
11198 if (depth)
11200 dw_die_ref ret = qualified_die_p (type, mask, depth - 1);
11201 if (ret)
11202 return ret;
11204 return type;
11207 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
11208 entry that chains the modifiers specified by CV_QUALS in front of the
11209 given type. REVERSE is true if the type is to be interpreted in the
11210 reverse storage order wrt the target order. */
11212 static dw_die_ref
11213 modified_type_die (tree type, int cv_quals, bool reverse,
11214 dw_die_ref context_die)
11216 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
11217 dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
11218 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
11219 tree item_type = NULL;
11220 tree qualified_type;
11221 tree name, low, high;
11222 dw_die_ref mod_scope;
11223 /* Only these cv-qualifiers are currently handled. */
11224 const int cv_qual_mask = (TYPE_QUAL_CONST | TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE
11225 | TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT | TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC);
11227 if (code == ERROR_MARK)
11228 return NULL;
11230 if (lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type)
11232 tree debug_type = lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type (type);
11234 if (debug_type != NULL_TREE && debug_type != type)
11235 return modified_type_die (debug_type, cv_quals, reverse, context_die);
11238 cv_quals &= cv_qual_mask;
11240 /* Don't emit DW_TAG_restrict_type for DWARFv2, since it is a type
11241 tag modifier (and not an attribute) old consumers won't be able
11242 to handle it. */
11243 if (dwarf_version < 3)
11244 cv_quals &= ~TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT;
11246 /* Likewise for DW_TAG_atomic_type for DWARFv5. */
11247 if (dwarf_version < 5)
11248 cv_quals &= ~TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC;
11250 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
11251 this type. */
11252 qualified_type = get_qualified_type (type, cv_quals);
11254 if (qualified_type == sizetype
11255 && TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)
11256 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)) == TYPE_DECL)
11258 tree t = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type));
11260 gcc_checking_assert (TREE_CODE (t) == INTEGER_TYPE
11261 && TYPE_PRECISION (t)
11262 == TYPE_PRECISION (qualified_type)
11263 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (t)
11264 == TYPE_UNSIGNED (qualified_type));
11265 qualified_type = t;
11268 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
11269 if (qualified_type)
11271 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
11273 /* DW_AT_endianity doesn't come from a qualifier on the type. */
11274 if (mod_type_die
11275 && (!need_endianity_attribute_p (reverse)
11276 || !is_base_type (type)
11277 || get_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_endianity)))
11278 return mod_type_die;
11281 name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
11283 /* Handle C typedef types. */
11284 if (name && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name)
11285 && !DECL_ARTIFICIAL (name))
11287 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
11289 if (qualified_type == dtype)
11291 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
11292 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
11293 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
11295 else
11297 int dquals = TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (dtype);
11298 dquals &= cv_qual_mask;
11299 if ((dquals & ~cv_quals) != TYPE_UNQUALIFIED
11300 || (cv_quals == dquals && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
11301 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use
11302 the unnamed type to which it refers. */
11303 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name), cv_quals,
11304 reverse, context_die);
11305 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
11309 mod_scope = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
11311 if (cv_quals)
11313 int sub_quals = 0, first_quals = 0;
11314 unsigned i;
11315 dw_die_ref first = NULL, last = NULL;
11317 /* Determine a lesser qualified type that most closely matches
11318 this one. Then generate DW_TAG_* entries for the remaining
11319 qualifiers. */
11320 sub_quals = get_nearest_type_subqualifiers (type, cv_quals,
11321 cv_qual_mask);
11322 if (sub_quals && use_debug_types)
11324 bool needed = false;
11325 /* If emitting type units, make sure the order of qualifiers
11326 is canonical. Thus, start from unqualified type if
11327 an earlier qualifier is missing in sub_quals, but some later
11328 one is present there. */
11329 for (i = 0; i < dwarf_qual_info_size; i++)
11330 if (dwarf_qual_info[i].q & cv_quals & ~sub_quals)
11331 needed = true;
11332 else if (needed && (dwarf_qual_info[i].q & cv_quals))
11334 sub_quals = 0;
11335 break;
11338 mod_type_die = modified_type_die (type, sub_quals, reverse, context_die);
11339 if (mod_scope && mod_type_die && mod_type_die->die_parent == mod_scope)
11341 /* As not all intermediate qualified DIEs have corresponding
11342 tree types, ensure that qualified DIEs in the same scope
11343 as their DW_AT_type are emitted after their DW_AT_type,
11344 only with other qualified DIEs for the same type possibly
11345 in between them. Determine the range of such qualified
11346 DIEs now (first being the base type, last being corresponding
11347 last qualified DIE for it). */
11348 unsigned int count = 0;
11349 first = qualified_die_p (mod_type_die, &first_quals,
11350 dwarf_qual_info_size);
11351 if (first == NULL)
11352 first = mod_type_die;
11353 gcc_assert ((first_quals & ~sub_quals) == 0);
11354 for (count = 0, last = first;
11355 count < (1U << dwarf_qual_info_size);
11356 count++, last = last->die_sib)
11358 int quals = 0;
11359 if (last == mod_scope->die_child)
11360 break;
11361 if (qualified_die_p (last->die_sib, &quals, dwarf_qual_info_size)
11362 != first)
11363 break;
11367 for (i = 0; i < dwarf_qual_info_size; i++)
11368 if (dwarf_qual_info[i].q & cv_quals & ~sub_quals)
11370 dw_die_ref d;
11371 if (first && first != last)
11373 for (d = first->die_sib; ; d = d->die_sib)
11375 int quals = 0;
11376 qualified_die_p (d, &quals, dwarf_qual_info_size);
11377 if (quals == (first_quals | dwarf_qual_info[i].q))
11378 break;
11379 if (d == last)
11381 d = NULL;
11382 break;
11385 if (d)
11387 mod_type_die = d;
11388 continue;
11391 if (first)
11393 d = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
11394 d->die_tag = dwarf_qual_info[i].t;
11395 add_child_die_after (mod_scope, d, last);
11396 last = d;
11398 else
11399 d = new_die (dwarf_qual_info[i].t, mod_scope, type);
11400 if (mod_type_die)
11401 add_AT_die_ref (d, DW_AT_type, mod_type_die);
11402 mod_type_die = d;
11403 first_quals |= dwarf_qual_info[i].q;
11406 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE || code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
11408 dwarf_tag tag = DW_TAG_pointer_type;
11409 if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
11411 if (TYPE_REF_IS_RVALUE (type) && dwarf_version >= 4)
11412 tag = DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type;
11413 else
11414 tag = DW_TAG_reference_type;
11416 mod_type_die = new_die (tag, mod_scope, type);
11418 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
11419 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
11420 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
11422 addr_space_t as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type);
11423 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (as))
11425 int action = targetm.addr_space.debug (as);
11426 if (action >= 0)
11428 /* Positive values indicate an address_class. */
11429 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class, action);
11431 else
11433 /* Negative values indicate an (inverted) segment base reg. */
11434 dw_loc_descr_ref d
11435 = one_reg_loc_descriptor (~action, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11436 add_AT_loc (mod_type_die, DW_AT_segment, d);
11440 else if (code == INTEGER_TYPE
11441 && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE
11442 && subrange_type_for_debug_p (type, &low, &high))
11444 tree bias = NULL_TREE;
11445 if (lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias)
11446 bias = lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias (type);
11447 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, low, high, bias, context_die);
11448 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
11450 else if (is_base_type (type))
11451 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type, reverse);
11452 else
11454 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
11456 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
11457 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
11458 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
11459 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
11460 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
11461 ..._TYPE node. */
11462 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
11463 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
11464 else
11465 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
11466 not the main variant. */
11467 return lookup_type_die (type);
11470 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
11471 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
11472 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type.
11473 Don't attach a DW_AT_name to DW_TAG_const_type or DW_TAG_volatile_type
11474 if the base type already has the same name. */
11475 if (name
11476 && ((TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL
11477 && (qualified_type == TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type)
11478 || (cv_quals == TYPE_UNQUALIFIED)))
11479 || (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL
11480 && TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type
11481 && DECL_NAME (name))))
11483 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
11484 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
11485 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
11486 useful source coordinates anyway. */
11487 name = DECL_NAME (name);
11488 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
11490 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
11491 else if (mod_type_die && mod_type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
11493 name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
11494 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die,
11495 name ? IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name) : "__unknown__");
11498 if (qualified_type)
11499 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
11501 if (item_type)
11502 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
11503 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
11504 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
11505 types are possible in Ada. */
11506 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
11507 TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (item_type),
11508 reverse,
11509 context_die);
11511 if (sub_die != NULL)
11512 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
11514 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (mod_type_die, type, context_die);
11515 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
11516 add_AT_flag (mod_type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11518 return mod_type_die;
11521 /* Generate DIEs for the generic parameters of T.
11522 T must be either a generic type or a generic function.
11523 See http://gcc.gnu.org/wiki/TemplateParmsDwarf for more. */
11525 static void
11526 gen_generic_params_dies (tree t)
11528 tree parms, args;
11529 int parms_num, i;
11530 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
11531 int non_default;
11533 if (!t || (TYPE_P (t) && !COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t)))
11534 return;
11536 if (TYPE_P (t))
11537 die = lookup_type_die (t);
11538 else if (DECL_P (t))
11539 die = lookup_decl_die (t);
11541 gcc_assert (die);
11543 parms = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t);
11544 if (!parms)
11545 /* T has no generic parameter. It means T is neither a generic type
11546 or function. End of story. */
11547 return;
11549 parms_num = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parms);
11550 args = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_args (t);
11551 if (TREE_CHAIN (args) && TREE_CODE (TREE_CHAIN (args)) == INTEGER_CST)
11552 non_default = int_cst_value (TREE_CHAIN (args));
11553 else
11554 non_default = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (args);
11555 for (i = 0; i < parms_num; i++)
11557 tree parm, arg, arg_pack_elems;
11558 dw_die_ref parm_die;
11560 parm = TREE_VEC_ELT (parms, i);
11561 arg = TREE_VEC_ELT (args, i);
11562 arg_pack_elems = lang_hooks.types.get_argument_pack_elems (arg);
11563 gcc_assert (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg);
11565 if (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg)
11567 /* If PARM represents a template parameter pack,
11568 emit a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE, followed
11569 by DW_TAG_template_*_parameter DIEs for the argument
11570 pack elements of ARG. Note that ARG would then be
11571 an argument pack. */
11572 if (arg_pack_elems)
11573 parm_die = template_parameter_pack_die (TREE_VALUE (parm),
11574 arg_pack_elems,
11575 die);
11576 else
11577 parm_die = generic_parameter_die (TREE_VALUE (parm), arg,
11578 true /* emit name */, die);
11579 if (i >= non_default)
11580 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_default_value, 1);
11585 /* Create and return a DIE for PARM which should be
11586 the representation of a generic type parameter.
11587 For instance, in the C++ front end, PARM would be a template parameter.
11588 ARG is the argument to PARM.
11589 EMIT_NAME_P if tree, the DIE will have DW_AT_name attribute set to the
11590 name of the PARM.
11591 PARENT_DIE is the parent DIE which the new created DIE should be added to,
11592 as a child node. */
11594 static dw_die_ref
11595 generic_parameter_die (tree parm, tree arg,
11596 bool emit_name_p,
11597 dw_die_ref parent_die)
11599 dw_die_ref tmpl_die = NULL;
11600 const char *name = NULL;
11602 if (!parm || !DECL_NAME (parm) || !arg)
11603 return NULL;
11605 /* We support non-type generic parameters and arguments,
11606 type generic parameters and arguments, as well as
11607 generic generic parameters (a.k.a. template template parameters in C++)
11608 and arguments. */
11609 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
11610 /* PARM is a nontype generic parameter */
11611 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_value_param, parent_die, parm);
11612 else if (TREE_CODE (parm) == TYPE_DECL)
11613 /* PARM is a type generic parameter. */
11614 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_type_param, parent_die, parm);
11615 else if (lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
11616 /* PARM is a generic generic parameter.
11617 Its DIE is a GNU extension. It shall have a
11618 DW_AT_name attribute to represent the name of the template template
11619 parameter, and a DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute to represent the
11620 name of the template template argument. */
11621 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param,
11622 parent_die, parm);
11623 else
11624 gcc_unreachable ();
11626 if (tmpl_die)
11628 tree tmpl_type;
11630 /* If PARM is a generic parameter pack, it means we are
11631 emitting debug info for a template argument pack element.
11632 In other terms, ARG is a template argument pack element.
11633 In that case, we don't emit any DW_AT_name attribute for
11634 the die. */
11635 if (emit_name_p)
11637 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm));
11638 gcc_assert (name);
11639 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_name, name);
11642 if (!lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
11644 /* DWARF3, 5.6.8 says if PARM is a non-type generic parameter
11645 TMPL_DIE should have a child DW_AT_type attribute that is set
11646 to the type of the argument to PARM, which is ARG.
11647 If PARM is a type generic parameter, TMPL_DIE should have a
11648 child DW_AT_type that is set to ARG. */
11649 tmpl_type = TYPE_P (arg) ? arg : TREE_TYPE (arg);
11650 add_type_attribute (tmpl_die, tmpl_type,
11651 (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (tmpl_type)
11652 ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED),
11653 false, parent_die);
11655 else
11657 /* So TMPL_DIE is a DIE representing a
11658 a generic generic template parameter, a.k.a template template
11659 parameter in C++ and arg is a template. */
11661 /* The DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute of the DIE must be set
11662 to the name of the argument. */
11663 name = dwarf2_name (TYPE_P (arg) ? TYPE_NAME (arg) : arg, 1);
11664 if (name)
11665 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_GNU_template_name, name);
11668 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
11669 /* So PARM is a non-type generic parameter.
11670 DWARF3 5.6.8 says we must set a DW_AT_const_value child
11671 attribute of TMPL_DIE which value represents the value
11672 of ARG.
11673 We must be careful here:
11674 The value of ARG might reference some function decls.
11675 We might currently be emitting debug info for a generic
11676 type and types are emitted before function decls, we don't
11677 know if the function decls referenced by ARG will actually be
11678 emitted after cgraph computations.
11679 So must defer the generation of the DW_AT_const_value to
11680 after cgraph is ready. */
11681 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (tmpl_die, arg);
11684 return tmpl_die;
11687 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE representing.
11688 PARM_PACK must be a template parameter pack. The returned DIE
11689 will be child DIE of PARENT_DIE. */
11691 static dw_die_ref
11692 template_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
11693 tree parm_pack_args,
11694 dw_die_ref parent_die)
11696 dw_die_ref die;
11697 int j;
11699 gcc_assert (parent_die && parm_pack);
11701 die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack, parent_die, parm_pack);
11702 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (die, parm_pack);
11703 for (j = 0; j < TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parm_pack_args); j++)
11704 generic_parameter_die (parm_pack,
11705 TREE_VEC_ELT (parm_pack_args, j),
11706 false /* Don't emit DW_AT_name */,
11707 die);
11708 return die;
11711 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
11712 an enumerated type. */
11714 static inline int
11715 type_is_enum (const_tree type)
11717 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
11720 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
11722 static unsigned int
11723 dbx_reg_number (const_rtx rtl)
11725 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
11727 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
11729 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
11730 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
11732 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
11733 if (leaf_reg != -1)
11734 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
11736 #endif
11738 regno = DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
11739 gcc_assert (regno != INVALID_REGNUM);
11740 return regno;
11743 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
11744 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
11745 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
11747 static void
11748 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
11750 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
11752 if (*list_head != NULL)
11754 /* Find the end of the chain. */
11755 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
11758 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
11759 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
11763 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
11764 zero if there is none. */
11766 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11767 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum var_init_status initialized)
11769 rtx regs;
11771 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
11772 return 0;
11774 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
11775 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
11776 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
11777 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's.
11778 Use DW_OP_fbreg offset DW_OP_stack_value in this case. */
11779 if ((rtl == arg_pointer_rtx || rtl == frame_pointer_rtx)
11780 && eliminate_regs (rtl, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX) != rtl)
11782 dw_loc_descr_ref result = NULL;
11784 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
11786 result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, GET_MODE (rtl), VOIDmode,
11787 initialized);
11788 if (result)
11789 add_loc_descr (&result,
11790 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
11792 return result;
11795 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
11797 if (REG_NREGS (rtl) > 1 || regs)
11798 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs, initialized);
11799 else
11801 unsigned int dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (rtl);
11802 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
11803 return 0;
11804 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_regnum, initialized);
11808 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
11809 a given hard register number. */
11811 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11812 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno, enum var_init_status initialized)
11814 dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descr;
11816 if (regno <= 31)
11817 reg_loc_descr
11818 = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + regno), 0, 0);
11819 else
11820 reg_loc_descr = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
11822 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
11823 add_loc_descr (&reg_loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
11825 return reg_loc_descr;
11828 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
11829 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
11831 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11832 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs,
11833 enum var_init_status initialized)
11835 int size, i;
11836 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
11838 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
11839 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
11841 unsigned reg = REGNO (rtl);
11842 int nregs;
11844 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
11845 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
11847 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
11848 if (leaf_reg != -1)
11849 reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
11851 #endif
11853 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
11854 nregs = REG_NREGS (rtl);
11856 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
11858 loc_result = NULL;
11859 while (nregs--)
11861 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
11863 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg),
11864 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11865 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
11866 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
11867 ++reg;
11869 return loc_result;
11872 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
11874 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
11876 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
11877 loc_result = NULL;
11879 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
11881 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
11883 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)),
11884 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11885 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
11886 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
11889 if (loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
11890 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
11891 return loc_result;
11894 static unsigned long size_of_int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
11896 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant i,
11897 as a compound operation from constant (i >> shift), constant shift
11898 and DW_OP_shl. */
11900 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11901 int_shift_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i, int shift)
11903 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (i >> shift);
11904 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
11905 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
11906 return ret;
11909 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
11911 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11912 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
11914 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
11916 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
11917 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
11918 if (i >= 0)
11920 int clz = clz_hwi (i);
11921 int ctz = ctz_hwi (i);
11922 if (i <= 31)
11923 op = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_lit0 + i);
11924 else if (i <= 0xff)
11925 op = DW_OP_const1u;
11926 else if (i <= 0xffff)
11927 op = DW_OP_const2u;
11928 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 5
11929 && clz + 5 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11930 /* DW_OP_litX DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 3 bytes and
11931 DW_OP_litX DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes just 4 bytes,
11932 while DW_OP_const4u is 5 bytes. */
11933 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 5);
11934 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
11935 && clz + 8 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11936 /* DW_OP_const1u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 4 bytes,
11937 while DW_OP_const4u is 5 bytes. */
11938 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 8);
11939 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
11940 op = DW_OP_const4u;
11941 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
11942 && clz + 8 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11943 /* DW_OP_const1u X DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes just 5 bytes,
11944 while DW_OP_constu of constant >= 0x100000000 takes at least
11945 6 bytes. */
11946 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 8);
11947 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 16
11948 && clz + 16 + (size_of_uleb128 (i) > 5 ? 255 : 31)
11949 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11950 /* DW_OP_const2u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 5 bytes,
11951 DW_OP_const2u X DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes 6 bytes,
11952 while DW_OP_constu takes in this case at least 6 bytes. */
11953 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 16);
11954 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 32
11955 && clz + 32 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
11956 && size_of_uleb128 (i) > 6)
11957 /* DW_OP_const4u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 7 bytes. */
11958 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 32);
11959 else
11960 op = DW_OP_constu;
11962 else
11964 if (i >= -0x80)
11965 op = DW_OP_const1s;
11966 else if (i >= -0x8000)
11967 op = DW_OP_const2s;
11968 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i >= -0x80000000)
11970 if (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i) < 5)
11972 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (-i);
11973 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
11974 return ret;
11976 op = DW_OP_const4s;
11978 else
11980 if (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i)
11981 < (unsigned long) 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i))
11983 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (-i);
11984 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
11985 return ret;
11987 op = DW_OP_consts;
11991 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
11994 /* Likewise, for unsigned constants. */
11996 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11997 uint_loc_descriptor (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i)
11999 const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_int = INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT);
12000 const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_uint
12001 = INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
12003 /* If possible, use the clever signed constants handling. */
12004 if (i <= max_int)
12005 return int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
12007 /* Here, we are left with positive numbers that cannot be represented as
12008 HOST_WIDE_INT, i.e.:
12009 max (HOST_WIDE_INT) < i <= max (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
12011 Using DW_OP_const4/8/./u operation to encode them consumes a lot of bytes
12012 whereas may be better to output a negative integer: thanks to integer
12013 wrapping, we know that:
12014 x = x - 2 ** DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
12015 = x - 2 * (max (HOST_WIDE_INT) + 1)
12016 So numbers close to max (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) could be represented as
12017 small negative integers. Let's try that in cases it will clearly improve
12018 the encoding: there is no gain turning DW_OP_const4u into
12019 DW_OP_const4s. */
12020 if (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 8 == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
12021 && ((DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 && i > max_uint - 0x8000)
12022 || (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 8 && i > max_uint - 0x80000000)))
12024 const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first_shift = i - max_int - 1;
12026 /* Now, -1 < first_shift <= max (HOST_WIDE_INT)
12027 i.e. 0 <= first_shift <= max (HOST_WIDE_INT). */
12028 const HOST_WIDE_INT second_shift
12029 = (HOST_WIDE_INT) first_shift - (HOST_WIDE_INT) max_int - 1;
12031 /* So we finally have:
12032 -max (HOST_WIDE_INT) - 1 <= second_shift <= -1.
12033 i.e. min (HOST_WIDE_INT) <= second_shift < 0. */
12034 return int_loc_descriptor (second_shift);
12037 /* Last chance: fallback to a simple constant operation. */
12038 return new_loc_descr
12039 ((HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
12040 ? DW_OP_const4u
12041 : DW_OP_const8u,
12042 i, 0);
12045 /* Generate and return a location description that computes the unsigned
12046 comparison of the two stack top entries (a OP b where b is the top-most
12047 entry and a is the second one). The KIND of comparison can be LT_EXPR,
12048 LE_EXPR, GT_EXPR or GE_EXPR. */
12050 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12051 uint_comparison_loc_list (enum tree_code kind)
12053 enum dwarf_location_atom op, flip_op;
12054 dw_loc_descr_ref ret, bra_node, jmp_node, tmp;
12056 switch (kind)
12058 case LT_EXPR:
12059 op = DW_OP_lt;
12060 break;
12061 case LE_EXPR:
12062 op = DW_OP_le;
12063 break;
12064 case GT_EXPR:
12065 op = DW_OP_gt;
12066 break;
12067 case GE_EXPR:
12068 op = DW_OP_ge;
12069 break;
12070 default:
12071 gcc_unreachable ();
12074 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
12075 jmp_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
12077 /* Until DWARFv4, operations all work on signed integers. It is nevertheless
12078 possible to perform unsigned comparisons: we just have to distinguish
12079 three cases:
12081 1. when a and b have the same sign (as signed integers); then we should
12082 return: a OP(signed) b;
12084 2. when a is a negative signed integer while b is a positive one, then a
12085 is a greater unsigned integer than b; likewise when a and b's roles
12086 are flipped.
12088 So first, compare the sign of the two operands. */
12089 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0);
12090 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
12091 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_xor, 0, 0));
12092 /* If they have different signs (i.e. they have different sign bits), then
12093 the stack top value has now the sign bit set and thus it's smaller than
12094 zero. */
12095 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_lit0, 0, 0));
12096 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_lt, 0, 0));
12097 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
12099 /* We are in case 1. At this point, we know both operands have the same
12100 sign, to it's safe to use the built-in signed comparison. */
12101 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
12102 add_loc_descr (&ret, jmp_node);
12104 /* We are in case 2. Here, we know both operands do not have the same sign,
12105 so we have to flip the signed comparison. */
12106 flip_op = (kind == LT_EXPR || kind == LE_EXPR) ? DW_OP_gt : DW_OP_lt;
12107 tmp = new_loc_descr (flip_op, 0, 0);
12108 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12109 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
12110 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12112 /* This dummy operation is necessary to make the two branches join. */
12113 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
12114 jmp_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12115 jmp_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
12116 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12118 return ret;
12121 /* Likewise, but takes the location description lists (might be destructive on
12122 them). Return NULL if either is NULL or if concatenation fails. */
12124 static dw_loc_list_ref
12125 loc_list_from_uint_comparison (dw_loc_list_ref left, dw_loc_list_ref right,
12126 enum tree_code kind)
12128 if (left == NULL || right == NULL)
12129 return NULL;
12131 add_loc_list (&left, right);
12132 if (left == NULL)
12133 return NULL;
12135 add_loc_descr_to_each (left, uint_comparison_loc_list (kind));
12136 return left;
12139 /* Return size_of_locs (int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, shift))
12140 without actually allocating it. */
12142 static unsigned long
12143 size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i, int shift)
12145 return size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i >> shift)
12146 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (shift)
12147 + 1;
12150 /* Return size_of_locs (int_loc_descriptor (i)) without
12151 actually allocating it. */
12153 static unsigned long
12154 size_of_int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
12156 unsigned long s;
12158 if (i >= 0)
12160 int clz, ctz;
12161 if (i <= 31)
12162 return 1;
12163 else if (i <= 0xff)
12164 return 2;
12165 else if (i <= 0xffff)
12166 return 3;
12167 clz = clz_hwi (i);
12168 ctz = ctz_hwi (i);
12169 if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 5
12170 && clz + 5 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
12171 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
12172 - clz - 5);
12173 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
12174 && clz + 8 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
12175 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
12176 - clz - 8);
12177 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
12178 return 5;
12179 s = size_of_uleb128 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
12180 if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
12181 && clz + 8 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
12182 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
12183 - clz - 8);
12184 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 16
12185 && clz + 16 + (s > 5 ? 255 : 31) >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
12186 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
12187 - clz - 16);
12188 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 32
12189 && clz + 32 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
12190 && s > 6)
12191 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
12192 - clz - 32);
12193 else
12194 return 1 + s;
12196 else
12198 if (i >= -0x80)
12199 return 2;
12200 else if (i >= -0x8000)
12201 return 3;
12202 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i >= -0x80000000)
12204 if (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i != (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i)
12206 s = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (-i) + 1;
12207 if (s < 5)
12208 return s;
12210 return 5;
12212 else
12214 unsigned long r = 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i);
12215 if (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i != (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i)
12217 s = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (-i) + 1;
12218 if (s < r)
12219 return s;
12221 return r;
12226 /* Return loc description representing "address" of integer value.
12227 This can appear only as toplevel expression. */
12229 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12230 address_of_int_loc_descriptor (int size, HOST_WIDE_INT i)
12232 int litsize;
12233 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
12235 if (!(dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
12236 return NULL;
12238 litsize = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i);
12239 /* Determine if DW_OP_stack_value or DW_OP_implicit_value
12240 is more compact. For DW_OP_stack_value we need:
12241 litsize + 1 (DW_OP_stack_value)
12242 and for DW_OP_implicit_value:
12243 1 (DW_OP_implicit_value) + 1 (length) + size. */
12244 if ((int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE >= size && litsize + 1 <= 1 + 1 + size)
12246 loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (i);
12247 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
12248 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
12249 return loc_result;
12252 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
12253 size, 0);
12254 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
12255 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = i;
12256 return loc_result;
12259 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
12261 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12262 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
12263 enum var_init_status initialized)
12265 unsigned int regno;
12266 dw_loc_descr_ref result;
12267 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
12269 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
12270 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
12271 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
12272 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
12273 if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
12275 rtx elim = (ira_use_lra_p
12276 ? lra_eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX)
12277 : eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX));
12279 if (elim != reg)
12281 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
12283 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
12284 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
12286 gcc_assert ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
12287 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
12288 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
12289 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
12290 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
12291 : stack_pointer_rtx));
12293 /* If drap register is used to align stack, use frame
12294 pointer + offset to access stack variables. If stack
12295 is aligned without drap, use stack pointer + offset to
12296 access stack variables. */
12297 if (crtl->stack_realign_tried
12298 && reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
12300 int base_reg
12301 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM ((fde && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM)
12302 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
12303 : REGNO (elim));
12304 return new_reg_loc_descr (base_reg, offset);
12307 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid);
12308 offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
12309 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
12313 regno = REGNO (reg);
12314 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
12315 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
12317 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
12318 if (leaf_reg != -1)
12319 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
12321 #endif
12322 regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (regno);
12324 if (!optimize && fde
12325 && (fde->drap_reg == regno || fde->vdrap_reg == regno))
12327 /* Use cfa+offset to represent the location of arguments passed
12328 on the stack when drap is used to align stack.
12329 Only do this when not optimizing, for optimized code var-tracking
12330 is supposed to track where the arguments live and the register
12331 used as vdrap or drap in some spot might be used for something
12332 else in other part of the routine. */
12333 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
12336 if (regno <= 31)
12337 result = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + regno),
12338 offset, 0);
12339 else
12340 result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
12342 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
12343 add_loc_descr (&result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
12345 return result;
12348 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
12350 static inline int
12351 is_based_loc (const_rtx rtl)
12353 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
12354 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
12355 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
12356 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))));
12359 /* Try to handle TLS MEMs, for which mem_loc_descriptor on XEXP (mem, 0)
12360 failed. */
12362 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12363 tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtx mem)
12365 tree base;
12366 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
12368 if (MEM_EXPR (mem) == NULL_TREE || !MEM_OFFSET_KNOWN_P (mem))
12369 return NULL;
12371 base = get_base_address (MEM_EXPR (mem));
12372 if (base == NULL
12373 || TREE_CODE (base) != VAR_DECL
12374 || !DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (base))
12375 return NULL;
12377 loc_result = loc_descriptor_from_tree (MEM_EXPR (mem), 1, NULL);
12378 if (loc_result == NULL)
12379 return NULL;
12381 if (MEM_OFFSET (mem))
12382 loc_descr_plus_const (&loc_result, MEM_OFFSET (mem));
12384 return loc_result;
12387 /* Output debug info about reason why we failed to expand expression as dwarf
12388 expression. */
12390 static void
12391 expansion_failed (tree expr, rtx rtl, char const *reason)
12393 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
12395 fprintf (dump_file, "Failed to expand as dwarf: ");
12396 if (expr)
12397 print_generic_expr (dump_file, expr, dump_flags);
12398 if (rtl)
12400 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
12401 print_rtl (dump_file, rtl);
12403 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReason: %s\n", reason);
12407 /* Helper function for const_ok_for_output. */
12409 static bool
12410 const_ok_for_output_1 (rtx rtl)
12412 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSPEC)
12414 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, assume
12415 we can't express it in the debug info. */
12416 /* Don't complain about TLS UNSPECs, those are just too hard to
12417 delegitimize. Note this could be a non-decl SYMBOL_REF such as
12418 one in a constant pool entry, so testing SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL
12419 rather than DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P is not just an optimization. */
12420 if (flag_checking
12421 && (XVECLEN (rtl, 0) == 0
12422 || GET_CODE (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
12423 || SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) == TLS_MODEL_NONE))
12424 inform (current_function_decl
12425 ? DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (current_function_decl)
12426 : UNKNOWN_LOCATION,
12427 #if NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES > 0
12428 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %s (%d) found in variable location",
12429 ((XINT (rtl, 1) >= 0 && XINT (rtl, 1) < NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES)
12430 ? unspec_strings[XINT (rtl, 1)] : "unknown"),
12431 XINT (rtl, 1));
12432 #else
12433 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %d found in variable location",
12434 XINT (rtl, 1));
12435 #endif
12436 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
12437 "UNSPEC hasn't been delegitimized.\n");
12438 return false;
12441 if (targetm.const_not_ok_for_debug_p (rtl))
12443 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
12444 "Expression rejected for debug by the backend.\n");
12445 return false;
12448 /* FIXME: Refer to PR60655. It is possible for simplification
12449 of rtl expressions in var tracking to produce such expressions.
12450 We should really identify / validate expressions
12451 enclosed in CONST that can be handled by assemblers on various
12452 targets and only handle legitimate cases here. */
12453 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != SYMBOL_REF)
12455 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == NOT)
12456 return false;
12457 return true;
12460 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
12462 bool marked;
12463 get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
12464 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
12465 it was not output and thus we can't represent it. */
12466 if (!marked)
12468 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
12469 "Constant was removed from constant pool.\n");
12470 return false;
12474 if (SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
12475 return false;
12477 /* Avoid references to external symbols in debug info, on several targets
12478 the linker might even refuse to link when linking a shared library,
12479 and in many other cases the relocations for .debug_info/.debug_loc are
12480 dropped, so the address becomes zero anyway. Hidden symbols, guaranteed
12481 to be defined within the same shared library or executable are fine. */
12482 if (SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (rtl))
12484 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
12486 if (decl == NULL || !targetm.binds_local_p (decl))
12488 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
12489 "Symbol not defined in current TU.\n");
12490 return false;
12494 return true;
12497 /* Return true if constant RTL can be emitted in DW_OP_addr or
12498 DW_AT_const_value. TLS SYMBOL_REFs, external SYMBOL_REFs or
12499 non-marked constant pool SYMBOL_REFs can't be referenced in it. */
12501 static bool
12502 const_ok_for_output (rtx rtl)
12504 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF)
12505 return const_ok_for_output_1 (rtl);
12507 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
12509 subrtx_var_iterator::array_type array;
12510 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_VAR (iter, array, XEXP (rtl, 0), ALL)
12511 if (!const_ok_for_output_1 (*iter))
12512 return false;
12513 return true;
12516 return true;
12519 /* Return a reference to DW_TAG_base_type corresponding to MODE and UNSIGNEDP
12520 if possible, NULL otherwise. */
12522 static dw_die_ref
12523 base_type_for_mode (machine_mode mode, bool unsignedp)
12525 dw_die_ref type_die;
12526 tree type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, unsignedp);
12528 if (type == NULL)
12529 return NULL;
12530 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12532 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12533 case REAL_TYPE:
12534 break;
12535 default:
12536 return NULL;
12538 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12539 if (!type_die)
12540 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
12541 comp_unit_die ());
12542 if (type_die == NULL || type_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_base_type)
12543 return NULL;
12544 return type_die;
12547 /* For OP descriptor assumed to be in unsigned MODE, convert it to a unsigned
12548 type matching MODE, or, if MODE is narrower than or as wide as
12549 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, untyped. Return NULL if the conversion is not
12550 possible. */
12552 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12553 convert_descriptor_to_mode (machine_mode mode, dw_loc_descr_ref op)
12555 machine_mode outer_mode = mode;
12556 dw_die_ref type_die;
12557 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
12559 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12561 add_loc_descr (&op, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0));
12562 return op;
12564 type_die = base_type_for_mode (outer_mode, 1);
12565 if (type_die == NULL)
12566 return NULL;
12567 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12568 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12569 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12570 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12571 add_loc_descr (&op, cvt);
12572 return op;
12575 /* Return location descriptor for comparison OP with operands OP0 and OP1. */
12577 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12578 compare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, dw_loc_descr_ref op0,
12579 dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
12581 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = op0;
12582 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
12583 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
12584 if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE != 1)
12586 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (STORE_FLAG_VALUE));
12587 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
12589 return ret;
12592 /* Return location descriptor for signed comparison OP RTL. */
12594 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12595 scompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
12596 machine_mode mem_mode)
12598 machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
12599 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
12600 int shift;
12602 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
12603 op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
12604 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
12605 return NULL;
12607 if (dwarf_strict
12608 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT
12609 || GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
12610 return NULL;
12612 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
12613 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12614 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
12615 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12617 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
12618 return NULL;
12620 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT
12621 || GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12622 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
12624 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12626 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (op_mode, 0);
12627 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
12629 if (type_die == NULL)
12630 return NULL;
12631 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12632 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12633 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12634 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12635 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
12636 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12637 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12638 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12639 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12640 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
12641 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
12644 shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
12645 /* For eq/ne, if the operands are known to be zero-extended,
12646 there is no need to do the fancy shifting up. */
12647 if (op == DW_OP_eq || op == DW_OP_ne)
12649 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
12650 for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
12652 for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
12654 /* deref_size zero extends, and for constants we can check
12655 whether they are zero extended or not. */
12656 if (((last0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
12657 && last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
12658 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
12659 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0))
12660 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
12661 && ((last1->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
12662 && last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
12663 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
12664 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
12665 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)))))
12666 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
12668 /* EQ/NE comparison against constant in narrower type than
12669 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE can be performed either as
12670 DW_OP_const1u <shift> DW_OP_shl DW_OP_const* <cst << shift>
12671 DW_OP_{eq,ne}
12673 DW_OP_const*u <mode_mask> DW_OP_and DW_OP_const* <cst & mode_mask>
12674 DW_OP_{eq,ne}. Pick whatever is shorter. */
12675 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
12676 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
12677 && (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (shift) + 1
12678 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift)
12679 >= size_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)) + 1
12680 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
12681 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
12683 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)));
12684 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12685 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
12686 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode));
12687 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
12690 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
12691 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
12692 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
12693 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift);
12694 else
12696 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
12697 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
12699 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
12702 /* Return location descriptor for unsigned comparison OP RTL. */
12704 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12705 ucompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
12706 machine_mode mem_mode)
12708 machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
12709 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
12711 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
12712 op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
12713 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
12714 return NULL;
12715 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT)
12716 return NULL;
12718 if (dwarf_strict && GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12719 return NULL;
12721 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
12722 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12723 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
12724 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12726 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
12727 return NULL;
12729 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12731 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode);
12732 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
12733 for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
12735 for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
12737 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
12738 op0 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & mask);
12739 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
12740 else if (last0->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
12741 || last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
12743 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
12744 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12746 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
12747 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & mask);
12748 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
12749 else if (last1->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
12750 || last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
12752 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
12753 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12756 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12758 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
12759 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
12760 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
12761 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
12762 op1 = int_loc_descriptor ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bias
12763 + INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
12764 else
12765 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
12766 bias, 0));
12768 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
12771 /* Return location descriptor for {U,S}{MIN,MAX}. */
12773 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12774 minmax_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
12775 machine_mode mem_mode)
12777 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
12778 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret;
12779 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, drop_node;
12781 if (dwarf_strict
12782 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
12783 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
12784 return NULL;
12786 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
12787 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12788 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
12789 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12791 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
12792 return NULL;
12794 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
12795 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12796 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
12797 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMAX)
12799 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12801 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (mode);
12802 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
12803 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12804 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
12805 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12807 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12809 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
12810 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
12811 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
12812 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
12815 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
12816 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12818 int shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
12819 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
12820 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
12821 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
12822 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
12824 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
12825 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12827 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, 0);
12828 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
12829 if (type_die == NULL)
12830 return NULL;
12831 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12832 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12833 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12834 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12835 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
12836 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12837 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12838 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12839 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12840 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
12843 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN)
12844 op = DW_OP_lt;
12845 else
12846 op = DW_OP_gt;
12847 ret = op0;
12848 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
12849 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
12850 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
12851 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
12852 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12853 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
12854 add_loc_descr (&ret, drop_node);
12855 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12856 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
12857 if ((GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == SMAX)
12858 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
12859 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12860 ret = convert_descriptor_to_mode (mode, ret);
12861 return ret;
12864 /* Helper function for mem_loc_descriptor. Perform OP binary op,
12865 but after converting arguments to type_die, afterwards
12866 convert back to unsigned. */
12868 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12869 typed_binop (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl, dw_die_ref type_die,
12870 machine_mode mode, machine_mode mem_mode)
12872 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt, op0, op1;
12874 if (type_die == NULL)
12875 return NULL;
12876 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
12877 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12878 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
12879 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12880 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
12881 return NULL;
12882 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12883 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12884 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12885 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12886 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
12887 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12888 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12889 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12890 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12891 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
12892 add_loc_descr (&op0, op1);
12893 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
12894 return convert_descriptor_to_mode (mode, op0);
12897 /* CLZ (where constV is CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO computed value,
12898 const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
12899 const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant
12900 and constMSB is constant with just the MSB bit set
12901 for the mode):
12902 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
12903 L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
12904 L2: DW_OP_dup constMSB DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shl
12905 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
12906 L3: DW_OP_drop
12907 L4: DW_OP_nop
12909 CTZ is similar:
12910 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
12911 L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
12912 L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
12913 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
12914 L3: DW_OP_drop
12915 L4: DW_OP_nop
12917 FFS is similar:
12918 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop const0 DW_OP_skip <L4>
12919 L1: const1 DW_OP_swap
12920 L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
12921 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
12922 L3: DW_OP_drop
12923 L4: DW_OP_nop */
12925 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12926 clz_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
12927 machine_mode mem_mode)
12929 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
12930 HOST_WIDE_INT valv;
12931 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
12932 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
12933 dw_loc_descr_ref l3jump, l3label;
12934 dw_loc_descr_ref l4jump, l4label;
12935 rtx msb;
12937 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
12938 || GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode)
12939 return NULL;
12941 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
12942 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12943 if (op0 == NULL)
12944 return NULL;
12945 ret = op0;
12946 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ)
12948 if (!CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
12949 valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
12951 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS)
12952 valv = 0;
12953 else if (!CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
12954 valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
12955 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
12956 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
12957 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
12958 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
12959 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (valv), mode, mem_mode,
12960 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12961 if (tmp == NULL)
12962 return NULL;
12963 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12964 l4jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
12965 add_loc_descr (&ret, l4jump);
12966 l1label = mem_loc_descriptor (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS
12967 ? const1_rtx : const0_rtx,
12968 mode, mem_mode,
12969 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12970 if (l1label == NULL)
12971 return NULL;
12972 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
12973 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12974 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
12975 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
12976 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != CLZ)
12977 msb = const1_rtx;
12978 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
12979 msb = GEN_INT ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
12980 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1));
12981 else
12982 msb = immed_wide_int_const
12983 (wi::set_bit_in_zero (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) - 1,
12984 GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode)), mode);
12985 if (GET_CODE (msb) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (msb) < 0)
12986 tmp = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
12987 ? DW_OP_const4u : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
12988 ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu, INTVAL (msb), 0);
12989 else
12990 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (msb, mode, mem_mode,
12991 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12992 if (tmp == NULL)
12993 return NULL;
12994 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12995 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12996 l3jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
12997 add_loc_descr (&ret, l3jump);
12998 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
12999 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13000 if (tmp == NULL)
13001 return NULL;
13002 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
13003 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ
13004 ? DW_OP_shl : DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
13005 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13006 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, 1, 0));
13007 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13008 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
13009 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
13010 l3label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
13011 add_loc_descr (&ret, l3label);
13012 l4label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
13013 add_loc_descr (&ret, l4label);
13014 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13015 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
13016 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13017 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
13018 l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13019 l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l3label;
13020 l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13021 l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l4label;
13022 return ret;
13025 /* POPCOUNT (const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
13026 const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant):
13027 const0 DW_OP_swap
13028 L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
13029 DW_OP_plus DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
13030 L2: DW_OP_drop
13032 PARITY is similar:
13033 L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
13034 DW_OP_xor DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
13035 L2: DW_OP_drop */
13037 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13038 popcount_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
13039 machine_mode mem_mode)
13041 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
13042 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
13043 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
13045 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
13046 || GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode)
13047 return NULL;
13049 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
13050 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13051 if (op0 == NULL)
13052 return NULL;
13053 ret = op0;
13054 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
13055 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13056 if (tmp == NULL)
13057 return NULL;
13058 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
13059 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13060 l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
13061 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
13062 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
13063 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
13064 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
13065 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
13066 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
13067 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13068 if (tmp == NULL)
13069 return NULL;
13070 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
13071 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
13072 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == POPCOUNT
13073 ? DW_OP_plus : DW_OP_xor, 0, 0));
13074 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13075 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
13076 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13077 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
13078 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
13079 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
13080 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
13081 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
13082 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
13083 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13084 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
13085 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13086 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
13087 return ret;
13090 /* BSWAP (constS is initial shift count, either 56 or 24):
13091 constS const0
13092 L1: DW_OP_pick <2> constS DW_OP_pick <3> DW_OP_minus DW_OP_shr
13093 const255 DW_OP_and DW_OP_pick <2> DW_OP_shl DW_OP_or
13094 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_dup const0 DW_OP_eq DW_OP_bra <L2> const8
13095 DW_OP_minus DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L1>
13096 L2: DW_OP_drop DW_OP_swap DW_OP_drop */
13098 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13099 bswap_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
13100 machine_mode mem_mode)
13102 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
13103 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
13104 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
13106 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
13107 || BITS_PER_UNIT != 8
13108 || (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 32
13109 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 64))
13110 return NULL;
13112 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
13113 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13114 if (op0 == NULL)
13115 return NULL;
13117 ret = op0;
13118 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
13119 mode, mem_mode,
13120 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13121 if (tmp == NULL)
13122 return NULL;
13123 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
13124 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
13125 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13126 if (tmp == NULL)
13127 return NULL;
13128 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
13129 l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0);
13130 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
13131 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
13132 mode, mem_mode,
13133 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13134 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
13135 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 3, 0));
13136 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
13137 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
13138 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (255), mode, mem_mode,
13139 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13140 if (tmp == NULL)
13141 return NULL;
13142 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
13143 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
13144 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0));
13145 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13146 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
13147 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13148 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
13149 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
13150 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13151 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
13152 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_eq, 0, 0));
13153 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
13154 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
13155 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (8), mode, mem_mode,
13156 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13157 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
13158 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
13159 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13160 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
13161 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
13162 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
13163 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
13164 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13165 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
13166 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13167 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
13168 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13169 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
13170 return ret;
13173 /* ROTATE (constMASK is mode mask, BITSIZE is bitsize of mode):
13174 DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
13175 [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_neg
13176 DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE> DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or
13178 ROTATERT is similar:
13179 DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_neg DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE>
13180 DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
13181 [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or */
13183 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13184 rotate_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
13185 machine_mode mem_mode)
13187 rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
13188 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret, mask[2] = { NULL, NULL };
13189 int i;
13191 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
13192 return NULL;
13194 if (GET_MODE (rtlop1) != VOIDmode
13195 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtlop1)) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
13196 rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (mode, rtlop1);
13197 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
13198 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13199 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, mode, mem_mode,
13200 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13201 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
13202 return NULL;
13203 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13204 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
13206 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13207 mask[i] = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_MASK (mode)),
13208 mode, mem_mode,
13209 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13210 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13211 mask[i] = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
13212 ? DW_OP_const4u
13213 : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
13214 ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu,
13215 GET_MODE_MASK (mode), 0);
13216 else
13217 mask[i] = NULL;
13218 if (mask[i] == NULL)
13219 return NULL;
13220 add_loc_descr (&mask[i], new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
13222 ret = op0;
13223 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
13224 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13225 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13226 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATERT)
13228 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
13229 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
13230 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
13232 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13233 if (mask[0] != NULL)
13234 add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[0]);
13235 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
13236 if (mask[1] != NULL)
13238 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13239 add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[1]);
13240 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13242 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATE)
13244 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
13245 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
13246 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
13248 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
13249 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
13250 return ret;
13253 /* Helper function for mem_loc_descriptor. Return DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref
13254 for DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF RTL. */
13256 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13257 parameter_ref_descriptor (rtx rtl)
13259 dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
13260 dw_die_ref ref;
13262 if (dwarf_strict)
13263 return NULL;
13264 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL);
13265 ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl));
13266 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref, 0, 0);
13267 if (ref)
13269 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13270 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
13271 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13273 else
13275 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
13276 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl);
13278 return ret;
13281 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
13282 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
13283 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
13284 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
13286 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
13287 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
13288 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
13289 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
13291 MODE is the mode that should be assumed for the rtl if it is VOIDmode.
13293 MEM_MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
13294 autoincrement addressing modes.
13296 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
13298 dw_loc_descr_ref
13299 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
13300 machine_mode mem_mode,
13301 enum var_init_status initialized)
13303 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
13304 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
13305 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
13306 rtx inner = NULL_RTX;
13308 if (mode == VOIDmode)
13309 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
13311 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
13312 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
13313 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
13314 zeroth element of the array. */
13316 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
13318 if (mode != GET_MODE (rtl) && GET_MODE (rtl) != VOIDmode)
13319 return NULL;
13321 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
13323 case POST_INC:
13324 case POST_DEC:
13325 case POST_MODIFY:
13326 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
13328 case SUBREG:
13329 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
13330 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
13331 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
13332 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
13333 contains the given subreg. */
13334 if (!subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
13335 break;
13336 inner = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
13337 case TRUNCATE:
13338 if (inner == NULL_RTX)
13339 inner = XEXP (rtl, 0);
13340 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
13341 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (inner)) == MODE_INT
13342 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13343 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
13344 || (mode == Pmode && mem_mode != VOIDmode)
13345 #endif
13347 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13349 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (inner,
13350 GET_MODE (inner),
13351 mem_mode, initialized);
13352 break;
13354 if (dwarf_strict)
13355 break;
13356 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner)))
13357 break;
13358 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner))
13359 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
13360 || GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (inner)) != MODE_INT))
13361 break;
13362 else
13364 dw_die_ref type_die;
13365 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
13367 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (inner,
13368 GET_MODE (inner),
13369 mem_mode, initialized);
13370 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
13371 break;
13372 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode,
13373 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
13374 if (type_die == NULL)
13376 mem_loc_result = NULL;
13377 break;
13379 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
13380 != GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner)))
13381 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
13382 else
13383 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret, 0, 0);
13384 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13385 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13386 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13387 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
13388 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
13389 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13391 /* Convert it to untyped afterwards. */
13392 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
13393 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
13396 break;
13398 case REG:
13399 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
13400 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13401 && rtl != arg_pointer_rtx
13402 && rtl != frame_pointer_rtx
13403 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
13404 && (mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
13405 #endif
13408 dw_die_ref type_die;
13409 unsigned int dbx_regnum;
13411 if (dwarf_strict)
13412 break;
13413 if (REGNO (rtl) > FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
13414 break;
13415 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode,
13416 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
13417 if (type_die == NULL)
13418 break;
13420 dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (rtl);
13421 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
13422 break;
13423 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_regval_type,
13424 dbx_regnum, 0);
13425 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13426 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13427 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13428 break;
13430 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
13431 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
13432 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
13433 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
13434 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
13435 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
13436 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
13437 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
13438 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
13439 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
13440 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
13441 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
13442 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
13443 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
13444 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13445 else if (stack_realign_drap
13446 && crtl->drap_reg
13447 && crtl->args.internal_arg_pointer == rtl
13448 && REGNO (crtl->drap_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
13450 /* If RTL is internal_arg_pointer, which has been optimized
13451 out, use DRAP instead. */
13452 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (crtl->drap_reg, 0,
13453 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13455 break;
13457 case SIGN_EXTEND:
13458 case ZERO_EXTEND:
13459 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
13460 break;
13461 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
13462 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13463 if (op0 == 0)
13464 break;
13465 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND
13466 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13467 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
13468 < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13469 /* If DW_OP_const{1,2,4}u won't be used, it is shorter
13470 to expand zero extend as two shifts instead of
13471 masking. */
13472 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) <= 4)
13474 machine_mode imode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
13475 mem_loc_result = op0;
13476 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13477 int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (imode)));
13478 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
13480 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13482 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13483 - GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
13484 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
13485 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTEND)
13486 op = DW_OP_shra;
13487 else
13488 op = DW_OP_shr;
13489 mem_loc_result = op0;
13490 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13491 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13492 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13493 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13495 else if (!dwarf_strict)
13497 dw_die_ref type_die1, type_die2;
13498 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
13500 type_die1 = base_type_for_mode (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
13501 GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND);
13502 if (type_die1 == NULL)
13503 break;
13504 type_die2 = base_type_for_mode (mode, 1);
13505 if (type_die2 == NULL)
13506 break;
13507 mem_loc_result = op0;
13508 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
13509 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13510 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die1;
13511 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13512 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
13513 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
13514 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13515 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die2;
13516 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13517 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
13519 break;
13521 case MEM:
13523 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
13524 if (new_rtl != rtl)
13526 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, mem_mode,
13527 initialized);
13528 if (mem_loc_result != NULL)
13529 return mem_loc_result;
13532 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
13533 get_address_mode (rtl), mode,
13534 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13535 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
13536 mem_loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
13537 if (mem_loc_result != NULL)
13539 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13540 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
13542 dw_die_ref type_die;
13543 dw_loc_descr_ref deref;
13545 if (dwarf_strict)
13546 return NULL;
13547 type_die
13548 = base_type_for_mode (mode, GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
13549 if (type_die == NULL)
13550 return NULL;
13551 deref = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_deref_type,
13552 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
13553 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13554 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13555 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13556 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, deref);
13558 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13559 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
13560 else
13561 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13562 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size,
13563 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0));
13565 break;
13567 case LO_SUM:
13568 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
13570 case LABEL_REF:
13571 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
13572 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
13573 pool. */
13574 case CONST:
13575 case SYMBOL_REF:
13576 if ((GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
13577 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
13578 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13579 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
13580 && (mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
13581 #endif
13583 break;
13584 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
13585 && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
13587 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
13589 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
13590 if (!targetm.have_tls || !targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
13591 break;
13593 temp = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_true);
13595 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
13596 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, temp);
13598 break;
13601 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
13603 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
13604 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
13605 initialized);
13606 break;
13609 symref:
13610 mem_loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
13611 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
13612 break;
13614 case CONCAT:
13615 case CONCATN:
13616 case VAR_LOCATION:
13617 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
13618 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13619 "CONCAT/CONCATN/VAR_LOCATION is handled only by loc_descriptor");
13620 return 0;
13622 case ENTRY_VALUE:
13623 if (dwarf_strict)
13624 return NULL;
13625 if (REG_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl)))
13627 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
13628 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13629 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
13630 VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13631 else
13633 unsigned int dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl));
13634 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
13635 return NULL;
13636 op0 = one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_regnum,
13637 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13640 else if (MEM_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl))
13641 && REG_P (XEXP (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), 0)))
13643 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
13644 VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13645 if (op0 && op0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg)
13646 return NULL;
13648 else
13649 gcc_unreachable ();
13650 if (op0 == NULL)
13651 return NULL;
13652 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value, 0, 0);
13653 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13654 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = op0;
13655 break;
13657 case DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF:
13658 mem_loc_result = parameter_ref_descriptor (rtl);
13659 break;
13661 case PRE_MODIFY:
13662 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
13663 PLUS code below. */
13664 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
13665 goto plus;
13667 case PRE_INC:
13668 case PRE_DEC:
13669 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
13670 below. */
13671 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
13672 gen_int_mode (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
13673 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode)
13674 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode),
13675 mode));
13677 /* ... fall through ... */
13679 case PLUS:
13680 plus:
13681 if (is_based_loc (rtl)
13682 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13683 || XEXP (rtl, 0) == arg_pointer_rtx
13684 || XEXP (rtl, 0) == frame_pointer_rtx)
13685 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
13686 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
13687 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)),
13688 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13689 else
13691 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
13692 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13693 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
13694 break;
13696 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13697 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13698 loc_descr_plus_const (&mem_loc_result, INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
13699 else
13701 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
13702 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13703 if (op1 == 0)
13704 return NULL;
13705 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13706 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13707 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
13710 break;
13712 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
13713 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
13714 case MINUS:
13715 op = DW_OP_minus;
13716 goto do_binop;
13718 case MULT:
13719 op = DW_OP_mul;
13720 goto do_binop;
13722 case DIV:
13723 if (!dwarf_strict
13724 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
13725 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13727 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_div, rtl,
13728 base_type_for_mode (mode, 0),
13729 mode, mem_mode);
13730 break;
13732 op = DW_OP_div;
13733 goto do_binop;
13735 case UMOD:
13736 op = DW_OP_mod;
13737 goto do_binop;
13739 case ASHIFT:
13740 op = DW_OP_shl;
13741 goto do_shift;
13743 case ASHIFTRT:
13744 op = DW_OP_shra;
13745 goto do_shift;
13747 case LSHIFTRT:
13748 op = DW_OP_shr;
13749 goto do_shift;
13751 do_shift:
13752 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
13753 break;
13754 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
13755 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13757 rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
13758 if (GET_MODE (rtlop1) != VOIDmode
13759 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtlop1))
13760 < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
13761 rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (mode, rtlop1);
13762 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, mode, mem_mode,
13763 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13766 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13767 break;
13769 mem_loc_result = op0;
13770 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13771 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13772 break;
13774 case AND:
13775 op = DW_OP_and;
13776 goto do_binop;
13778 case IOR:
13779 op = DW_OP_or;
13780 goto do_binop;
13782 case XOR:
13783 op = DW_OP_xor;
13784 goto do_binop;
13786 do_binop:
13787 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
13788 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13789 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
13790 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13792 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13793 break;
13795 mem_loc_result = op0;
13796 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13797 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13798 break;
13800 case MOD:
13801 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE && !dwarf_strict)
13803 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_mod, rtl,
13804 base_type_for_mode (mode, 0),
13805 mode, mem_mode);
13806 break;
13809 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
13810 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13811 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
13812 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13814 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13815 break;
13817 mem_loc_result = op0;
13818 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13819 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13820 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13821 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
13822 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
13823 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
13824 break;
13826 case UDIV:
13827 if (!dwarf_strict && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
13829 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13831 op = DW_OP_div;
13832 goto do_binop;
13834 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_div, rtl,
13835 base_type_for_mode (mode, 1),
13836 mode, mem_mode);
13838 break;
13840 case NOT:
13841 op = DW_OP_not;
13842 goto do_unop;
13844 case ABS:
13845 op = DW_OP_abs;
13846 goto do_unop;
13848 case NEG:
13849 op = DW_OP_neg;
13850 goto do_unop;
13852 do_unop:
13853 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
13854 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13856 if (op0 == 0)
13857 break;
13859 mem_loc_result = op0;
13860 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13861 break;
13863 case CONST_INT:
13864 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13865 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
13866 || (mode == Pmode
13867 && mem_mode != VOIDmode
13868 && trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (rtl), ptr_mode) == INTVAL (rtl))
13869 #endif
13872 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
13873 break;
13875 if (!dwarf_strict
13876 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13877 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT))
13879 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, 1);
13880 machine_mode amode;
13881 if (type_die == NULL)
13882 return NULL;
13883 amode = mode_for_size (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT,
13884 MODE_INT, 0);
13885 if (INTVAL (rtl) >= 0
13886 && amode != BLKmode
13887 && trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (rtl), amode) == INTVAL (rtl)
13888 /* const DW_OP_GNU_convert <XXX> vs.
13889 DW_OP_GNU_const_type <XXX, 1, const>. */
13890 && size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl)) + 1 + 1
13891 < (unsigned long) 1 + 1 + 1 + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
13893 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
13894 op0 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
13895 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13896 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13897 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13898 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
13899 return mem_loc_result;
13901 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_const_type, 0,
13902 INTVAL (rtl));
13903 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13904 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13905 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13906 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13907 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
13908 else
13910 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
13911 = dw_val_class_const_double;
13912 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
13913 = double_int::from_shwi (INTVAL (rtl));
13916 break;
13918 case CONST_DOUBLE:
13919 if (!dwarf_strict)
13921 dw_die_ref type_die;
13923 /* Note that if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0, a
13924 CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either a large integer
13925 or a floating-point constant. If TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT != 0,
13926 the value is always a floating point constant.
13928 When it is an integer, a CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
13929 the constant requires 2 HWIs to be adequately represented.
13930 We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
13931 if (mode == VOIDmode
13932 || (GET_MODE (rtl) == VOIDmode
13933 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT))
13934 break;
13935 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode,
13936 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
13937 if (type_die == NULL)
13938 return NULL;
13939 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_const_type, 0, 0);
13940 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13941 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13942 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13943 #if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
13944 if (!SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
13946 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
13947 = dw_val_class_const_double;
13948 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
13949 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
13951 else
13952 #endif
13954 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
13955 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
13957 insert_float (rtl, array);
13958 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
13959 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
13960 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
13961 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
13964 break;
13966 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
13967 if (!dwarf_strict)
13969 dw_die_ref type_die;
13971 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode,
13972 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
13973 if (type_die == NULL)
13974 return NULL;
13975 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_const_type, 0, 0);
13976 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13977 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13978 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13979 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
13980 = dw_val_class_wide_int;
13981 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
13982 *mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = std::make_pair (rtl, mode);
13984 break;
13986 case EQ:
13987 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_eq, rtl, mem_mode);
13988 break;
13990 case GE:
13991 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
13992 break;
13994 case GT:
13995 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
13996 break;
13998 case LE:
13999 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
14000 break;
14002 case LT:
14003 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
14004 break;
14006 case NE:
14007 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ne, rtl, mem_mode);
14008 break;
14010 case GEU:
14011 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
14012 break;
14014 case GTU:
14015 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
14016 break;
14018 case LEU:
14019 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
14020 break;
14022 case LTU:
14023 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
14024 break;
14026 case UMIN:
14027 case UMAX:
14028 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
14029 break;
14030 /* FALLTHRU */
14031 case SMIN:
14032 case SMAX:
14033 mem_loc_result = minmax_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
14034 break;
14036 case ZERO_EXTRACT:
14037 case SIGN_EXTRACT:
14038 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14039 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 2))
14040 && ((unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14041 + (unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2))
14042 <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
14043 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
14044 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14045 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14047 int shift, size;
14048 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
14049 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14050 if (op0 == 0)
14051 break;
14052 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTRACT)
14053 op = DW_OP_shra;
14054 else
14055 op = DW_OP_shr;
14056 mem_loc_result = op0;
14057 size = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
14058 shift = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2));
14059 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
14060 shift = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
14061 - shift - size;
14062 if (shift + size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14064 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
14065 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14066 - shift - size));
14067 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14069 if (size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14071 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
14072 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - size));
14073 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14076 break;
14078 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
14080 dw_loc_descr_ref op2, bra_node, drop_node;
14081 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
14082 GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == VOIDmode
14083 ? word_mode : GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
14084 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14085 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
14086 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14087 op2 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 2), mode, mem_mode,
14088 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14089 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL || op2 == NULL)
14090 break;
14092 mem_loc_result = op1;
14093 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op2);
14094 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
14095 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14096 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, bra_node);
14097 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14098 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14099 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, drop_node);
14100 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14101 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
14103 break;
14105 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
14106 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
14107 case FLOAT:
14108 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
14109 case FIX:
14110 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
14111 if (!dwarf_strict)
14113 dw_die_ref type_die;
14114 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14116 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
14117 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14118 if (op0 == NULL)
14119 break;
14120 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) == MODE_INT
14121 && (GET_CODE (rtl) == FLOAT
14122 || GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
14123 <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
14125 type_die = base_type_for_mode (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
14126 GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FLOAT);
14127 if (type_die == NULL)
14128 break;
14129 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
14130 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14131 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14132 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14133 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
14135 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FIX);
14136 if (type_die == NULL)
14137 break;
14138 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
14139 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14140 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14141 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14142 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
14143 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
14144 && (GET_CODE (rtl) == FIX
14145 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
14147 op0 = convert_descriptor_to_mode (mode, op0);
14148 if (op0 == NULL)
14149 break;
14151 mem_loc_result = op0;
14153 break;
14155 case CLZ:
14156 case CTZ:
14157 case FFS:
14158 mem_loc_result = clz_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
14159 break;
14161 case POPCOUNT:
14162 case PARITY:
14163 mem_loc_result = popcount_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
14164 break;
14166 case BSWAP:
14167 mem_loc_result = bswap_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
14168 break;
14170 case ROTATE:
14171 case ROTATERT:
14172 mem_loc_result = rotate_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
14173 break;
14175 case COMPARE:
14176 /* In theory, we could implement the above. */
14177 /* DWARF cannot represent the unsigned compare operations
14178 natively. */
14179 case SS_MULT:
14180 case US_MULT:
14181 case SS_DIV:
14182 case US_DIV:
14183 case SS_PLUS:
14184 case US_PLUS:
14185 case SS_MINUS:
14186 case US_MINUS:
14187 case SS_NEG:
14188 case US_NEG:
14189 case SS_ABS:
14190 case SS_ASHIFT:
14191 case US_ASHIFT:
14192 case SS_TRUNCATE:
14193 case US_TRUNCATE:
14194 case UNORDERED:
14195 case ORDERED:
14196 case UNEQ:
14197 case UNGE:
14198 case UNGT:
14199 case UNLE:
14200 case UNLT:
14201 case LTGT:
14202 case FRACT_CONVERT:
14203 case UNSIGNED_FRACT_CONVERT:
14204 case SAT_FRACT:
14205 case UNSIGNED_SAT_FRACT:
14206 case SQRT:
14207 case ASM_OPERANDS:
14208 case VEC_MERGE:
14209 case VEC_SELECT:
14210 case VEC_CONCAT:
14211 case VEC_DUPLICATE:
14212 case UNSPEC:
14213 case HIGH:
14214 case FMA:
14215 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
14216 case CONST_VECTOR:
14217 case CONST_FIXED:
14218 case CLRSB:
14219 case CLOBBER:
14220 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, we
14221 can't express it in the debug info. This can happen e.g. with some
14222 TLS UNSPECs. */
14223 break;
14225 case CONST_STRING:
14226 resolve_one_addr (&rtl);
14227 goto symref;
14229 default:
14230 if (flag_checking)
14232 print_rtl (stderr, rtl);
14233 gcc_unreachable ();
14235 break;
14238 if (mem_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
14239 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
14241 return mem_loc_result;
14244 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
14245 This is typically a complex variable. */
14247 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14248 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1, enum var_init_status initialized)
14250 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
14251 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref
14252 = loc_descriptor (x0, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14253 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref
14254 = loc_descriptor (x1, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14256 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
14257 return 0;
14259 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
14260 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
14262 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
14263 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
14265 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
14266 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
14268 return cc_loc_result;
14271 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of N
14272 locations. */
14274 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14275 concatn_loc_descriptor (rtx concatn, enum var_init_status initialized)
14277 unsigned int i;
14278 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
14279 unsigned int n = XVECLEN (concatn, 0);
14281 for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
14283 dw_loc_descr_ref ref;
14284 rtx x = XVECEXP (concatn, 0, i);
14286 ref = loc_descriptor (x, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14287 if (ref == NULL)
14288 return NULL;
14290 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, ref);
14291 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)));
14294 if (cc_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
14295 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
14297 return cc_loc_result;
14300 /* Helper function for loc_descriptor. Return DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer
14301 for DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR RTL. */
14303 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14304 implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtx rtl, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
14306 dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
14307 dw_die_ref ref;
14309 if (dwarf_strict)
14310 return NULL;
14311 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == VAR_DECL
14312 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL
14313 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == RESULT_DECL);
14314 ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl));
14315 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer, 0, offset);
14316 ret->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
14317 if (ref)
14319 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14320 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
14321 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14323 else
14325 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
14326 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl);
14328 return ret;
14331 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
14332 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
14333 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
14334 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
14335 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
14337 MODE is mode of the decl if this loc_descriptor is going to be used in
14338 .debug_loc section where DW_OP_stack_value and DW_OP_implicit_value are
14339 allowed, VOIDmode otherwise.
14341 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
14343 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14344 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
14345 enum var_init_status initialized)
14347 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
14349 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
14351 case SUBREG:
14352 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
14353 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
14354 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
14355 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
14356 contains the given subreg. */
14357 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) && subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
14358 loc_result = loc_descriptor (SUBREG_REG (rtl),
14359 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl)), initialized);
14360 else
14361 goto do_default;
14362 break;
14364 case REG:
14365 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
14366 break;
14368 case MEM:
14369 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
14370 GET_MODE (rtl), initialized);
14371 if (loc_result == NULL)
14372 loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
14373 if (loc_result == NULL)
14375 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
14376 if (new_rtl != rtl)
14377 loc_result = loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, initialized);
14379 break;
14381 case CONCAT:
14382 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1),
14383 initialized);
14384 break;
14386 case CONCATN:
14387 loc_result = concatn_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
14388 break;
14390 case VAR_LOCATION:
14391 /* Single part. */
14392 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl)) != PARALLEL)
14394 rtx loc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl);
14395 if (GET_CODE (loc) == EXPR_LIST)
14396 loc = XEXP (loc, 0);
14397 loc_result = loc_descriptor (loc, mode, initialized);
14398 break;
14401 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
14402 /* FALLTHRU */
14404 case PARALLEL:
14406 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
14407 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
14408 machine_mode mode;
14409 int i;
14411 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
14412 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0),
14413 VOIDmode, initialized);
14414 if (loc_result == NULL)
14415 return NULL;
14416 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
14417 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
14418 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
14420 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
14422 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0),
14423 VOIDmode, initialized);
14424 if (temp == NULL)
14425 return NULL;
14426 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
14427 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
14428 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
14431 break;
14433 case CONST_INT:
14434 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
14435 loc_result = address_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode),
14436 INTVAL (rtl));
14437 break;
14439 case CONST_DOUBLE:
14440 if (mode == VOIDmode)
14441 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14443 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14445 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
14447 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer
14448 or a floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
14449 the constant requires more than one word in order to be
14450 adequately represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
14451 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
14452 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
14453 #if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
14454 if (!SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
14456 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
14457 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
14458 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
14460 else
14461 #endif
14463 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
14464 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
14466 insert_float (rtl, array);
14467 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
14468 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
14469 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
14470 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
14473 break;
14475 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
14476 if (mode == VOIDmode)
14477 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14479 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14481 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
14482 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
14483 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_wide_int;
14484 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
14485 *loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = std::make_pair (rtl, mode);
14487 break;
14489 case CONST_VECTOR:
14490 if (mode == VOIDmode)
14491 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14493 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14495 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
14496 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
14497 unsigned char *array
14498 = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length * elt_size);
14499 unsigned int i;
14500 unsigned char *p;
14501 machine_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
14503 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
14504 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
14506 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
14507 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
14509 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
14510 insert_wide_int (std::make_pair (elt, imode), p, elt_size);
14512 break;
14514 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
14515 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
14517 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
14518 insert_float (elt, p);
14520 break;
14522 default:
14523 gcc_unreachable ();
14526 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
14527 length * elt_size, 0);
14528 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
14529 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length;
14530 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
14531 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
14533 break;
14535 case CONST:
14536 if (mode == VOIDmode
14537 || CONST_SCALAR_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
14538 || CONST_DOUBLE_AS_FLOAT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
14539 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_VECTOR)
14541 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
14542 break;
14544 /* FALLTHROUGH */
14545 case SYMBOL_REF:
14546 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
14547 break;
14548 case LABEL_REF:
14549 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14550 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14552 loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
14553 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14554 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
14556 break;
14558 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
14559 loc_result = implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtl, 0);
14560 break;
14562 case PLUS:
14563 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR
14564 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14566 loc_result
14567 = implicit_ptr_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
14568 break;
14570 /* FALLTHRU */
14571 do_default:
14572 default:
14573 if ((GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE (rtl) == mode
14574 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14575 && dwarf_version >= 4)
14576 || (!dwarf_strict && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode))
14578 /* Value expression. */
14579 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
14580 if (loc_result)
14581 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
14582 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14584 break;
14587 return loc_result;
14590 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
14591 address ranges where a given location is valid.
14592 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
14593 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
14594 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
14595 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
14597 static const char *
14598 secname_for_decl (const_tree decl)
14600 const char *secname;
14602 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl)
14603 && (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) || TREE_PUBLIC (decl) || TREE_STATIC (decl))
14604 && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
14605 secname = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
14606 else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
14607 secname = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
14608 else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
14609 secname = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
14610 else
14611 secname = text_section_label;
14613 return secname;
14616 /* Return true when DECL_BY_REFERENCE is defined and set for DECL. */
14618 static bool
14619 decl_by_reference_p (tree decl)
14621 return ((TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL
14622 || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
14623 && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl));
14626 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
14627 for VARLOC. */
14629 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14630 dw_loc_list_1 (tree loc, rtx varloc, int want_address,
14631 enum var_init_status initialized)
14633 int have_address = 0;
14634 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
14635 machine_mode mode;
14637 if (want_address != 2)
14639 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION);
14640 /* Single part. */
14641 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
14643 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
14644 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
14645 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
14646 mode = GET_MODE (varloc);
14647 if (MEM_P (varloc))
14649 rtx addr = XEXP (varloc, 0);
14650 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (addr, get_address_mode (varloc),
14651 mode, initialized);
14652 if (descr)
14653 have_address = 1;
14654 else
14656 rtx x = avoid_constant_pool_reference (varloc);
14657 if (x != varloc)
14658 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (x, mode, VOIDmode,
14659 initialized);
14662 else
14663 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
14665 else
14666 return 0;
14668 else
14670 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION)
14671 mode = DECL_MODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (varloc));
14672 else
14673 mode = DECL_MODE (loc);
14674 descr = loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, initialized);
14675 have_address = 1;
14678 if (!descr)
14679 return 0;
14681 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
14682 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14684 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14686 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14687 "DWARF address size mismatch");
14688 return 0;
14690 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14691 have_address = 1;
14693 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
14694 if (want_address && !have_address)
14696 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14697 "Want address and only have value");
14698 return 0;
14701 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
14702 if (!want_address && have_address)
14704 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
14705 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
14707 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
14709 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14710 "DWARF address size mismatch");
14711 return 0;
14713 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14714 op = DW_OP_deref;
14715 else
14716 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
14718 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
14721 return descr;
14724 /* Create a DW_OP_piece or DW_OP_bit_piece for bitsize, or return NULL
14725 if it is not possible. */
14727 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14728 new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
14730 if ((bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0 && offset == 0)
14731 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT, 0);
14732 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
14733 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bit_piece, bitsize, offset);
14734 else
14735 return NULL;
14738 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
14739 for VAR_LOC_NOTE for variable DECL that has been optimized by SRA. */
14741 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14742 dw_sra_loc_expr (tree decl, rtx loc)
14744 rtx p;
14745 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT padsize = 0;
14746 dw_loc_descr_ref descr, *descr_tail;
14747 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT decl_size;
14748 rtx varloc;
14749 enum var_init_status initialized;
14751 if (DECL_SIZE (decl) == NULL
14752 || !tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
14753 return NULL;
14755 decl_size = tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (decl));
14756 descr = NULL;
14757 descr_tail = &descr;
14759 for (p = loc; p; p = XEXP (p, 1))
14761 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (p);
14762 rtx loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (p);
14763 dw_loc_descr_ref cur_descr;
14764 dw_loc_descr_ref *tail, last = NULL;
14765 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opsize = 0;
14767 if (loc_note == NULL_RTX
14768 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note) == NULL_RTX)
14770 padsize += bitsize;
14771 continue;
14773 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note);
14774 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_note);
14775 cur_descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, 2, initialized);
14776 if (cur_descr == NULL)
14778 padsize += bitsize;
14779 continue;
14782 /* Check that cur_descr either doesn't use
14783 DW_OP_*piece operations, or their sum is equal
14784 to bitsize. Otherwise we can't embed it. */
14785 for (tail = &cur_descr; *tail != NULL;
14786 tail = &(*tail)->dw_loc_next)
14787 if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece)
14789 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned
14790 * BITS_PER_UNIT;
14791 last = *tail;
14793 else if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
14795 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
14796 last = *tail;
14799 if (last != NULL && opsize != bitsize)
14801 padsize += bitsize;
14802 /* Discard the current piece of the descriptor and release any
14803 addr_table entries it uses. */
14804 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
14805 continue;
14808 /* If there is a hole, add DW_OP_*piece after empty DWARF
14809 expression, which means that those bits are optimized out. */
14810 if (padsize)
14812 if (padsize > decl_size)
14814 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
14815 goto discard_descr;
14817 decl_size -= padsize;
14818 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (padsize, 0);
14819 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
14821 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
14822 goto discard_descr;
14824 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
14825 padsize = 0;
14827 *descr_tail = cur_descr;
14828 descr_tail = tail;
14829 if (bitsize > decl_size)
14830 goto discard_descr;
14831 decl_size -= bitsize;
14832 if (last == NULL)
14834 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
14835 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION
14836 && GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
14838 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
14839 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
14840 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
14844 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == CONST
14845 || GET_CODE (varloc) == SIGN_EXTEND
14846 || GET_CODE (varloc) == ZERO_EXTEND)
14847 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
14848 else if (GET_CODE (varloc) == SUBREG)
14849 varloc = SUBREG_REG (varloc);
14850 else
14851 break;
14853 while (1);
14854 /* DW_OP_bit_size offset should be zero for register
14855 or implicit location descriptions and empty location
14856 descriptions, but for memory addresses needs big endian
14857 adjustment. */
14858 if (MEM_P (varloc))
14860 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT memsize
14861 = MEM_SIZE (varloc) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
14862 if (memsize != bitsize)
14864 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN != WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
14865 && (memsize > BITS_PER_WORD || bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD))
14866 goto discard_descr;
14867 if (memsize < bitsize)
14868 goto discard_descr;
14869 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
14870 offset = memsize - bitsize;
14874 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (bitsize, offset);
14875 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
14876 goto discard_descr;
14877 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
14881 /* If there were any non-empty expressions, add padding till the end of
14882 the decl. */
14883 if (descr != NULL && decl_size != 0)
14885 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (decl_size, 0);
14886 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
14887 goto discard_descr;
14889 return descr;
14891 discard_descr:
14892 /* Discard the descriptor and release any addr_table entries it uses. */
14893 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (descr);
14894 return NULL;
14897 /* Return the dwarf representation of the location list LOC_LIST of
14898 DECL. WANT_ADDRESS has the same meaning as in loc_list_from_tree
14899 function. */
14901 static dw_loc_list_ref
14902 dw_loc_list (var_loc_list *loc_list, tree decl, int want_address)
14904 const char *endname, *secname;
14905 rtx varloc;
14906 enum var_init_status initialized;
14907 struct var_loc_node *node;
14908 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
14909 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
14910 dw_loc_list_ref list = NULL;
14911 dw_loc_list_ref *listp = &list;
14913 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
14914 actually construct the list of locations.
14915 The first location information is what is passed to the
14916 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
14917 locations just get added on to that list.
14918 Note that we only know the start address for a location
14919 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
14920 the range [current location start, next location start].
14921 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
14922 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
14924 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
14926 for (node = loc_list->first; node; node = node->next)
14927 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST
14928 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc) != NULL_RTX)
14930 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
14932 /* This requires DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, which is not usable
14933 inside DWARF expressions. */
14934 if (want_address != 2)
14935 continue;
14936 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
14937 if (descr == NULL)
14938 continue;
14940 else
14942 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
14943 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
14944 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address, initialized);
14946 if (descr)
14948 bool range_across_switch = false;
14949 /* If section switch happens in between node->label
14950 and node->next->label (or end of function) and
14951 we can't emit it as a single entry list,
14952 emit two ranges, first one ending at the end
14953 of first partition and second one starting at the
14954 beginning of second partition. */
14955 if (node == loc_list->last_before_switch
14956 && (node != loc_list->first || loc_list->first->next)
14957 && current_function_decl)
14959 endname = cfun->fde->dw_fde_end;
14960 range_across_switch = true;
14962 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
14963 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
14964 else if (node->next)
14965 endname = node->next->label;
14966 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
14967 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
14968 else if (!current_function_decl)
14969 endname = text_end_label;
14970 else
14972 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
14973 current_function_funcdef_no);
14974 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
14977 *listp = new_loc_list (descr, node->label, endname, secname);
14978 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
14979 && node == loc_list->first
14980 && NOTE_P (node->loc)
14981 && strcmp (node->label, endname) == 0)
14982 (*listp)->force = true;
14983 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
14985 if (range_across_switch)
14987 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
14988 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
14989 else
14991 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
14992 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
14993 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address,
14994 initialized);
14996 gcc_assert (descr);
14997 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
14998 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
14999 if (node->next)
15000 endname = node->next->label;
15001 else
15002 endname = cfun->fde->dw_fde_second_end;
15003 *listp = new_loc_list (descr,
15004 cfun->fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
15005 endname, secname);
15006 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
15011 /* Try to avoid the overhead of a location list emitting a location
15012 expression instead, but only if we didn't have more than one
15013 location entry in the first place. If some entries were not
15014 representable, we don't want to pretend a single entry that was
15015 applies to the entire scope in which the variable is
15016 available. */
15017 if (list && loc_list->first->next)
15018 gen_llsym (list);
15020 return list;
15023 /* Return if the loc_list has only single element and thus can be represented
15024 as location description. */
15026 static bool
15027 single_element_loc_list_p (dw_loc_list_ref list)
15029 gcc_assert (!list->dw_loc_next || list->ll_symbol);
15030 return !list->ll_symbol;
15033 /* To each location in list LIST add loc descr REF. */
15035 static void
15036 add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
15038 dw_loc_descr_ref copy;
15039 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, ref);
15040 list = list->dw_loc_next;
15041 while (list)
15043 copy = ggc_alloc<dw_loc_descr_node> ();
15044 memcpy (copy, ref, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
15045 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, copy);
15046 while (copy->dw_loc_next)
15048 dw_loc_descr_ref new_copy = ggc_alloc<dw_loc_descr_node> ();
15049 memcpy (new_copy, copy->dw_loc_next, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
15050 copy->dw_loc_next = new_copy;
15051 copy = new_copy;
15053 list = list->dw_loc_next;
15057 /* Given two lists RET and LIST
15058 produce location list that is result of adding expression in LIST
15059 to expression in RET on each position in program.
15060 Might be destructive on both RET and LIST.
15062 TODO: We handle only simple cases of RET or LIST having at most one
15063 element. General case would inolve sorting the lists in program order
15064 and merging them that will need some additional work.
15065 Adding that will improve quality of debug info especially for SRA-ed
15066 structures. */
15068 static void
15069 add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list)
15071 if (!list)
15072 return;
15073 if (!*ret)
15075 *ret = list;
15076 return;
15078 if (!list->dw_loc_next)
15080 add_loc_descr_to_each (*ret, list->expr);
15081 return;
15083 if (!(*ret)->dw_loc_next)
15085 add_loc_descr_to_each (list, (*ret)->expr);
15086 *ret = list;
15087 return;
15089 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX,
15090 "Don't know how to merge two non-trivial"
15091 " location lists.\n");
15092 *ret = NULL;
15093 return;
15096 /* LOC is constant expression. Try a luck, look it up in constant
15097 pool and return its loc_descr of its address. */
15099 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15100 cst_pool_loc_descr (tree loc)
15102 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
15103 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
15105 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
15107 gcc_assert (!rtl);
15108 return 0;
15110 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF);
15112 /* TODO: We might get more coverage if we was actually delaying expansion
15113 of all expressions till end of compilation when constant pools are fully
15114 populated. */
15115 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0))))
15117 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15118 "CST value in contant pool but not marked.");
15119 return 0;
15121 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
15122 GET_MODE (rtl), VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15125 /* Return dw_loc_list representing address of addr_expr LOC
15126 by looking for inner INDIRECT_REF expression and turning
15127 it into simple arithmetics.
15129 See loc_list_from_tree for the meaning of CONTEXT. */
15131 static dw_loc_list_ref
15132 loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref (tree loc, bool toplev,
15133 const loc_descr_context *context)
15135 tree obj, offset;
15136 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
15137 machine_mode mode;
15138 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
15139 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
15141 obj = get_inner_reference (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0),
15142 &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
15143 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep, false);
15144 STRIP_NOPS (obj);
15145 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT)
15147 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "bitfield access");
15148 return 0;
15150 if (!INDIRECT_REF_P (obj))
15152 expansion_failed (obj,
15153 NULL_RTX, "no indirect ref in inner refrence");
15154 return 0;
15156 if (!offset && !bitpos)
15157 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), toplev ? 2 : 1,
15158 context);
15159 else if (toplev
15160 && int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15161 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
15163 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), 0, context);
15164 if (!list_ret)
15165 return 0;
15166 if (offset)
15168 /* Variable offset. */
15169 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0, context);
15170 if (list_ret1 == 0)
15171 return 0;
15172 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
15173 if (!list_ret)
15174 return 0;
15175 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
15176 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
15178 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
15179 if (bytepos > 0)
15180 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
15181 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
15182 bytepos, 0));
15183 else if (bytepos < 0)
15184 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
15185 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
15186 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
15188 return list_ret;
15191 /* Set LOC to the next operation that is not a DW_OP_nop operation. In the case
15192 all operations from LOC are nops, move to the last one. Insert in NOPS all
15193 operations that are skipped. */
15195 static void
15196 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (dw_loc_descr_ref &loc,
15197 hash_set<dw_loc_descr_ref> &nops)
15199 while (loc->dw_loc_next != NULL && loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_nop)
15201 nops.add (loc);
15202 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
15206 /* Helper for loc_descr_without_nops: free the location description operation
15207 P. */
15209 bool
15210 free_loc_descr (const dw_loc_descr_ref &loc, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
15212 ggc_free (loc);
15213 return true;
15216 /* Remove all DW_OP_nop operations from LOC except, if it exists, the one that
15217 finishes LOC. */
15219 static void
15220 loc_descr_without_nops (dw_loc_descr_ref &loc)
15222 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_nop && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
15223 return;
15225 /* Set of all DW_OP_nop operations we remove. */
15226 hash_set<dw_loc_descr_ref> nops;
15228 /* First, strip all prefix NOP operations in order to keep the head of the
15229 operations list. */
15230 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (loc, nops);
15232 for (dw_loc_descr_ref cur = loc; cur != NULL;)
15234 /* For control flow operations: strip "prefix" nops in destination
15235 labels. */
15236 if (cur->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_loc)
15237 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc, nops);
15238 if (cur->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_loc)
15239 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_loc, nops);
15241 /* Do the same for the operations that follow, then move to the next
15242 iteration. */
15243 if (cur->dw_loc_next != NULL)
15244 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_next, nops);
15245 cur = cur->dw_loc_next;
15248 nops.traverse<void *, free_loc_descr> (NULL);
15252 struct dwarf_procedure_info;
15254 /* Helper structure for location descriptions generation. */
15255 struct loc_descr_context
15257 /* The type that is implicitly referenced by DW_OP_push_object_address, or
15258 NULL_TREE if DW_OP_push_object_address in invalid for this location
15259 description. This is used when processing PLACEHOLDER_EXPR nodes. */
15260 tree context_type;
15261 /* The ..._DECL node that should be translated as a
15262 DW_OP_push_object_address operation. */
15263 tree base_decl;
15264 /* Information about the DWARF procedure we are currently generating. NULL if
15265 we are not generating a DWARF procedure. */
15266 struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi;
15269 /* DWARF procedures generation
15271 DWARF expressions (aka. location descriptions) are used to encode variable
15272 things such as sizes or offsets. Such computations can have redundant parts
15273 that can be factorized in order to reduce the size of the output debug
15274 information. This is the whole point of DWARF procedures.
15276 Thanks to stor-layout.c, size and offset expressions in GENERIC trees are
15277 already factorized into functions ("size functions") in order to handle very
15278 big and complex types. Such functions are quite simple: they have integral
15279 arguments, they return an integral result and their body contains only a
15280 return statement with arithmetic expressions. This is the only kind of
15281 function we are interested in translating into DWARF procedures, here.
15283 DWARF expressions and DWARF procedure are executed using a stack, so we have
15284 to define some calling convention for them to interact. Let's say that:
15286 - Before calling a DWARF procedure, DWARF expressions must push on the stack
15287 all arguments in reverse order (right-to-left) so that when the DWARF
15288 procedure execution starts, the first argument is the top of the stack.
15290 - Then, when returning, the DWARF procedure must have consumed all arguments
15291 on the stack, must have pushed the result and touched nothing else.
15293 - Each integral argument and the result are integral types can be hold in a
15294 single stack slot.
15296 - We call "frame offset" the number of stack slots that are "under DWARF
15297 procedure control": it includes the arguments slots, the temporaries and
15298 the result slot. Thus, it is equal to the number of arguments when the
15299 procedure execution starts and must be equal to one (the result) when it
15300 returns. */
15302 /* Helper structure used when generating operations for a DWARF procedure. */
15303 struct dwarf_procedure_info
15305 /* The FUNCTION_DECL node corresponding to the DWARF procedure that is
15306 currently translated. */
15307 tree fndecl;
15308 /* The number of arguments FNDECL takes. */
15309 unsigned args_count;
15312 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node for a DWARF procedure. Add
15313 LOCATION as its DW_AT_location attribute. If FNDECL is not NULL_TREE,
15314 equate it to this DIE. */
15316 static dw_die_ref
15317 new_dwarf_proc_die (dw_loc_descr_ref location, tree fndecl,
15318 dw_die_ref parent_die)
15320 const bool dwarf_proc_supported = dwarf_version >= 4;
15321 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die;
15323 if ((dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict)
15324 || location == NULL)
15325 return NULL;
15327 dwarf_proc_die = new_die (dwarf_proc_supported
15328 ? DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure
15329 : DW_TAG_variable,
15330 parent_die,
15331 fndecl);
15332 if (fndecl)
15333 equate_decl_number_to_die (fndecl, dwarf_proc_die);
15334 if (!dwarf_proc_supported)
15335 add_AT_flag (dwarf_proc_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
15336 add_AT_loc (dwarf_proc_die, DW_AT_location, location);
15337 return dwarf_proc_die;
15340 /* Return whether TYPE is a supported type as a DWARF procedure argument
15341 type or return type (we handle only scalar types and pointer types that
15342 aren't wider than the DWARF expression evaluation stack. */
15344 static bool
15345 is_handled_procedure_type (tree type)
15347 return ((INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
15348 || TREE_CODE (type) == OFFSET_TYPE
15349 || TREE_CODE (type) == POINTER_TYPE)
15350 && int_size_in_bytes (type) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
15353 /* Helper for resolve_args_picking: do the same but stop when coming across
15354 visited nodes. For each node we visit, register in FRAME_OFFSETS the frame
15355 offset *before* evaluating the corresponding operation. */
15357 static bool
15358 resolve_args_picking_1 (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, unsigned initial_frame_offset,
15359 struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi,
15360 hash_map<dw_loc_descr_ref, unsigned> &frame_offsets)
15362 /* The "frame_offset" identifier is already used to name a macro... */
15363 unsigned frame_offset_ = initial_frame_offset;
15364 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
15366 for (l = loc; l != NULL;)
15368 bool existed;
15369 unsigned &l_frame_offset = frame_offsets.get_or_insert (l, &existed);
15371 /* If we already met this node, there is nothing to compute anymore. */
15372 if (existed)
15374 /* Make sure that the stack size is consistent wherever the execution
15375 flow comes from. */
15376 gcc_assert ((unsigned) l_frame_offset == frame_offset_);
15377 break;
15379 l_frame_offset = frame_offset_;
15381 /* If needed, relocate the picking offset with respect to the frame
15382 offset. */
15383 if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_pick && l->frame_offset_rel)
15385 /* frame_offset_ is the size of the current stack frame, including
15386 incoming arguments. Besides, the arguments are pushed
15387 right-to-left. Thus, in order to access the Nth argument from
15388 this operation node, the picking has to skip temporaries *plus*
15389 one stack slot per argument (0 for the first one, 1 for the second
15390 one, etc.).
15392 The targetted argument number (N) is already set as the operand,
15393 and the number of temporaries can be computed with:
15394 frame_offsets_ - dpi->args_count */
15395 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned += frame_offset_ - dpi->args_count;
15397 /* DW_OP_pick handles only offsets from 0 to 255 (inclusive)... */
15398 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned > 255)
15399 return false;
15402 /* Update frame_offset according to the effect the current operation has
15403 on the stack. */
15404 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
15406 case DW_OP_deref:
15407 case DW_OP_swap:
15408 case DW_OP_rot:
15409 case DW_OP_abs:
15410 case DW_OP_neg:
15411 case DW_OP_not:
15412 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
15413 case DW_OP_skip:
15414 case DW_OP_reg0:
15415 case DW_OP_reg1:
15416 case DW_OP_reg2:
15417 case DW_OP_reg3:
15418 case DW_OP_reg4:
15419 case DW_OP_reg5:
15420 case DW_OP_reg6:
15421 case DW_OP_reg7:
15422 case DW_OP_reg8:
15423 case DW_OP_reg9:
15424 case DW_OP_reg10:
15425 case DW_OP_reg11:
15426 case DW_OP_reg12:
15427 case DW_OP_reg13:
15428 case DW_OP_reg14:
15429 case DW_OP_reg15:
15430 case DW_OP_reg16:
15431 case DW_OP_reg17:
15432 case DW_OP_reg18:
15433 case DW_OP_reg19:
15434 case DW_OP_reg20:
15435 case DW_OP_reg21:
15436 case DW_OP_reg22:
15437 case DW_OP_reg23:
15438 case DW_OP_reg24:
15439 case DW_OP_reg25:
15440 case DW_OP_reg26:
15441 case DW_OP_reg27:
15442 case DW_OP_reg28:
15443 case DW_OP_reg29:
15444 case DW_OP_reg30:
15445 case DW_OP_reg31:
15446 case DW_OP_bregx:
15447 case DW_OP_piece:
15448 case DW_OP_deref_size:
15449 case DW_OP_nop:
15450 case DW_OP_form_tls_address:
15451 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
15452 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
15453 case DW_OP_stack_value:
15454 break;
15456 case DW_OP_addr:
15457 case DW_OP_const1u:
15458 case DW_OP_const1s:
15459 case DW_OP_const2u:
15460 case DW_OP_const2s:
15461 case DW_OP_const4u:
15462 case DW_OP_const4s:
15463 case DW_OP_const8u:
15464 case DW_OP_const8s:
15465 case DW_OP_constu:
15466 case DW_OP_consts:
15467 case DW_OP_dup:
15468 case DW_OP_over:
15469 case DW_OP_pick:
15470 case DW_OP_lit0:
15471 case DW_OP_lit1:
15472 case DW_OP_lit2:
15473 case DW_OP_lit3:
15474 case DW_OP_lit4:
15475 case DW_OP_lit5:
15476 case DW_OP_lit6:
15477 case DW_OP_lit7:
15478 case DW_OP_lit8:
15479 case DW_OP_lit9:
15480 case DW_OP_lit10:
15481 case DW_OP_lit11:
15482 case DW_OP_lit12:
15483 case DW_OP_lit13:
15484 case DW_OP_lit14:
15485 case DW_OP_lit15:
15486 case DW_OP_lit16:
15487 case DW_OP_lit17:
15488 case DW_OP_lit18:
15489 case DW_OP_lit19:
15490 case DW_OP_lit20:
15491 case DW_OP_lit21:
15492 case DW_OP_lit22:
15493 case DW_OP_lit23:
15494 case DW_OP_lit24:
15495 case DW_OP_lit25:
15496 case DW_OP_lit26:
15497 case DW_OP_lit27:
15498 case DW_OP_lit28:
15499 case DW_OP_lit29:
15500 case DW_OP_lit30:
15501 case DW_OP_lit31:
15502 case DW_OP_breg0:
15503 case DW_OP_breg1:
15504 case DW_OP_breg2:
15505 case DW_OP_breg3:
15506 case DW_OP_breg4:
15507 case DW_OP_breg5:
15508 case DW_OP_breg6:
15509 case DW_OP_breg7:
15510 case DW_OP_breg8:
15511 case DW_OP_breg9:
15512 case DW_OP_breg10:
15513 case DW_OP_breg11:
15514 case DW_OP_breg12:
15515 case DW_OP_breg13:
15516 case DW_OP_breg14:
15517 case DW_OP_breg15:
15518 case DW_OP_breg16:
15519 case DW_OP_breg17:
15520 case DW_OP_breg18:
15521 case DW_OP_breg19:
15522 case DW_OP_breg20:
15523 case DW_OP_breg21:
15524 case DW_OP_breg22:
15525 case DW_OP_breg23:
15526 case DW_OP_breg24:
15527 case DW_OP_breg25:
15528 case DW_OP_breg26:
15529 case DW_OP_breg27:
15530 case DW_OP_breg28:
15531 case DW_OP_breg29:
15532 case DW_OP_breg30:
15533 case DW_OP_breg31:
15534 case DW_OP_fbreg:
15535 case DW_OP_push_object_address:
15536 case DW_OP_call_frame_cfa:
15537 ++frame_offset_;
15538 break;
15540 case DW_OP_drop:
15541 case DW_OP_xderef:
15542 case DW_OP_and:
15543 case DW_OP_div:
15544 case DW_OP_minus:
15545 case DW_OP_mod:
15546 case DW_OP_mul:
15547 case DW_OP_or:
15548 case DW_OP_plus:
15549 case DW_OP_shl:
15550 case DW_OP_shr:
15551 case DW_OP_shra:
15552 case DW_OP_xor:
15553 case DW_OP_bra:
15554 case DW_OP_eq:
15555 case DW_OP_ge:
15556 case DW_OP_gt:
15557 case DW_OP_le:
15558 case DW_OP_lt:
15559 case DW_OP_ne:
15560 case DW_OP_regx:
15561 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
15562 --frame_offset_;
15563 break;
15565 case DW_OP_call2:
15566 case DW_OP_call4:
15567 case DW_OP_call_ref:
15569 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
15570 int *stack_usage = dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map->get (dwarf_proc);
15572 if (stack_usage == NULL)
15573 return false;
15574 frame_offset_ += *stack_usage;
15575 break;
15578 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
15579 case DW_OP_GNU_uninit:
15580 case DW_OP_GNU_encoded_addr:
15581 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
15582 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
15583 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
15584 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
15585 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
15586 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
15587 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
15588 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
15589 /* loc_list_from_tree will probably not output these operations for
15590 size functions, so assume they will not appear here. */
15591 /* Fall through... */
15593 default:
15594 gcc_unreachable ();
15597 /* Now, follow the control flow (except subroutine calls). */
15598 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
15600 case DW_OP_bra:
15601 if (!resolve_args_picking_1 (l->dw_loc_next, frame_offset_, dpi,
15602 frame_offsets))
15603 return false;
15604 /* Fall through... */
15606 case DW_OP_skip:
15607 l = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc;
15608 break;
15610 case DW_OP_stack_value:
15611 return true;
15613 default:
15614 l = l->dw_loc_next;
15615 break;
15619 return true;
15622 /* Make a DFS over operations reachable through LOC (i.e. follow branch
15623 operations) in order to resolve the operand of DW_OP_pick operations that
15624 target DWARF procedure arguments (DPI). INITIAL_FRAME_OFFSET is the frame
15625 offset *before* LOC is executed. Return if all relocations were
15626 successful. */
15628 static bool
15629 resolve_args_picking (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, unsigned initial_frame_offset,
15630 struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi)
15632 /* Associate to all visited operations the frame offset *before* evaluating
15633 this operation. */
15634 hash_map<dw_loc_descr_ref, unsigned> frame_offsets;
15636 return resolve_args_picking_1 (loc, initial_frame_offset, dpi,
15637 frame_offsets);
15640 /* Try to generate a DWARF procedure that computes the same result as FNDECL.
15641 Return NULL if it is not possible. */
15643 static dw_die_ref
15644 function_to_dwarf_procedure (tree fndecl)
15646 struct loc_descr_context ctx;
15647 struct dwarf_procedure_info dpi;
15648 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die;
15649 tree tree_body = DECL_SAVED_TREE (fndecl);
15650 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_body, epilogue;
15652 tree cursor;
15653 unsigned i;
15655 /* Do not generate multiple DWARF procedures for the same function
15656 declaration. */
15657 dwarf_proc_die = lookup_decl_die (fndecl);
15658 if (dwarf_proc_die != NULL)
15659 return dwarf_proc_die;
15661 /* DWARF procedures are available starting with the DWARFv3 standard, but
15662 it's the DWARFv4 standard that introduces the DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure
15663 DIE. */
15664 if (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict)
15665 return NULL;
15667 /* We handle only functions for which we still have a body, that return a
15668 supported type and that takes arguments with supported types. Note that
15669 there is no point translating functions that return nothing. */
15670 if (tree_body == NULL_TREE
15671 || DECL_RESULT (fndecl) == NULL_TREE
15672 || !is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (fndecl))))
15673 return NULL;
15675 for (cursor = DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl);
15676 cursor != NULL_TREE;
15677 cursor = TREE_CHAIN (cursor))
15678 if (!is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (cursor)))
15679 return NULL;
15681 /* Match only "expr" in: RETURN_EXPR (MODIFY_EXPR (RESULT_DECL, expr)). */
15682 if (TREE_CODE (tree_body) != RETURN_EXPR)
15683 return NULL;
15684 tree_body = TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 0);
15685 if (TREE_CODE (tree_body) != MODIFY_EXPR
15686 || TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 0) != DECL_RESULT (fndecl))
15687 return NULL;
15688 tree_body = TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 1);
15690 /* Try to translate the body expression itself. Note that this will probably
15691 cause an infinite recursion if its call graph has a cycle. This is very
15692 unlikely for size functions, however, so don't bother with such things at
15693 the moment. */
15694 ctx.context_type = NULL_TREE;
15695 ctx.base_decl = NULL_TREE;
15696 ctx.dpi = &dpi;
15697 dpi.fndecl = fndecl;
15698 dpi.args_count = list_length (DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl));
15699 loc_body = loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree_body, 0, &ctx);
15700 if (!loc_body)
15701 return NULL;
15703 /* After evaluating all operands in "loc_body", we should still have on the
15704 stack all arguments plus the desired function result (top of the stack).
15705 Generate code in order to keep only the result in our stack frame. */
15706 epilogue = NULL;
15707 for (i = 0; i < dpi.args_count; ++i)
15709 dw_loc_descr_ref op_couple = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0);
15710 op_couple->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
15711 op_couple->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next = epilogue;
15712 epilogue = op_couple;
15714 add_loc_descr (&loc_body, epilogue);
15715 if (!resolve_args_picking (loc_body, dpi.args_count, &dpi))
15716 return NULL;
15718 /* Trailing nops from loc_descriptor_from_tree (if any) cannot be removed
15719 because they are considered useful. Now there is an epilogue, they are
15720 not anymore, so give it another try. */
15721 loc_descr_without_nops (loc_body);
15723 /* fndecl may be used both as a regular DW_TAG_subprogram DIE and as
15724 a DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, so we may have a conflict, here. It's unlikely,
15725 though, given that size functions do not come from source, so they should
15726 not have a dedicated DW_TAG_subprogram DIE. */
15727 dwarf_proc_die
15728 = new_dwarf_proc_die (loc_body, fndecl,
15729 get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (fndecl)));
15731 /* The called DWARF procedure consumes one stack slot per argument and
15732 returns one stack slot. */
15733 dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map->put (dwarf_proc_die, 1 - dpi.args_count);
15735 return dwarf_proc_die;
15739 /* Generate Dwarf location list representing LOC.
15740 If WANT_ADDRESS is false, expression computing LOC will be computed
15741 If WANT_ADDRESS is 1, expression computing address of LOC will be returned
15742 if WANT_ADDRESS is 2, expression computing address useable in location
15743 will be returned (i.e. DW_OP_reg can be used
15744 to refer to register values).
15746 CONTEXT provides information to customize the location descriptions
15747 generation. Its context_type field specifies what type is implicitly
15748 referenced by DW_OP_push_object_address. If it is NULL_TREE, this operation
15749 will not be generated.
15751 Its DPI field determines whether we are generating a DWARF expression for a
15752 DWARF procedure, so PARM_DECL references are processed specifically.
15754 If CONTEXT is NULL, the behavior is the same as if context_type, base_decl
15755 and dpi fields were null. */
15757 static dw_loc_list_ref
15758 loc_list_from_tree_1 (tree loc, int want_address,
15759 const struct loc_descr_context *context)
15761 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL, ret1 = NULL;
15762 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
15763 int have_address = 0;
15764 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
15766 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
15767 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
15768 problem... */
15770 if (context != NULL
15771 && context->base_decl == loc
15772 && want_address == 0)
15774 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
15775 return new_loc_list (new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0),
15776 NULL, NULL, NULL);
15777 else
15778 return NULL;
15781 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
15783 case ERROR_MARK:
15784 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "ERROR_MARK");
15785 return 0;
15787 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
15788 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
15789 position of other fields. It is supposed to appear only as the first
15790 operand of COMPONENT_REF nodes and to reference precisely the type
15791 that the context allows. */
15792 if (context != NULL
15793 && TREE_TYPE (loc) == context->context_type
15794 && want_address >= 1)
15796 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
15798 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0);
15799 have_address = 1;
15800 break;
15802 else
15803 return NULL;
15805 else
15806 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15807 "PLACEHOLDER_EXPR for an unexpected type");
15808 break;
15810 case CALL_EXPR:
15812 const int nargs = call_expr_nargs (loc);
15813 tree callee = get_callee_fndecl (loc);
15814 int i;
15815 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc;
15817 if (callee == NULL_TREE)
15818 goto call_expansion_failed;
15820 /* We handle only functions that return an integer. */
15821 if (!is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (callee))))
15822 goto call_expansion_failed;
15824 dwarf_proc = function_to_dwarf_procedure (callee);
15825 if (dwarf_proc == NULL)
15826 goto call_expansion_failed;
15828 /* Evaluate arguments right-to-left so that the first argument will
15829 be the top-most one on the stack. */
15830 for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; --i)
15832 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr
15833 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (CALL_EXPR_ARG (loc, i), 0,
15834 context);
15836 if (loc_descr == NULL)
15837 goto call_expansion_failed;
15839 add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descr);
15842 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call4, 0, 0);
15843 ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15844 ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = dwarf_proc;
15845 ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15846 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
15847 break;
15849 call_expansion_failed:
15850 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CALL_EXPR");
15851 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
15852 return 0;
15855 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
15856 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
15857 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
15858 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
15859 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PRE/POST INDCREMENT/DECREMENT");
15860 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
15861 return 0;
15863 case ADDR_EXPR:
15864 /* If we already want an address, see if there is INDIRECT_REF inside
15865 e.g. for &this->field. */
15866 if (want_address)
15868 list_ret = loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref
15869 (loc, want_address == 2, context);
15870 if (list_ret)
15871 have_address = 1;
15872 else if (decl_address_ip_invariant_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))
15873 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
15874 have_address = 1;
15876 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
15877 if (!list_ret && !ret)
15878 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1, context);
15879 else
15881 if (want_address)
15882 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "need address of ADDR_EXPR");
15883 return NULL;
15885 break;
15887 case VAR_DECL:
15888 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
15890 rtx rtl;
15891 enum dwarf_location_atom tls_op;
15892 enum dtprel_bool dtprel = dtprel_false;
15894 if (targetm.have_tls)
15896 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the
15897 data. */
15898 if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
15899 return 0;
15901 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we
15902 can only look up addresses of objects in the current
15903 module. We used DW_OP_addr as first op, but that's
15904 wrong, because DW_OP_addr is relocated by the debug
15905 info consumer, while DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address
15906 operand shouldn't be. */
15907 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc) && !targetm.binds_local_p (loc))
15908 return 0;
15909 dtprel = dtprel_true;
15910 tls_op = DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address;
15912 else
15914 if (!targetm.emutls.debug_form_tls_address
15915 || !(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
15916 return 0;
15917 /* We stuffed the control variable into the DECL_VALUE_EXPR
15918 to signal (via DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P) that the decl should
15919 no longer appear in gimple code. We used the control
15920 variable in specific so that we could pick it up here. */
15921 loc = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc);
15922 tls_op = DW_OP_form_tls_address;
15925 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
15926 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
15927 return 0;
15929 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
15930 return 0;
15931 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
15932 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
15933 return 0;
15935 ret = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel);
15936 ret1 = new_loc_descr (tls_op, 0, 0);
15937 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
15939 have_address = 1;
15940 break;
15942 /* FALLTHRU */
15944 case PARM_DECL:
15945 if (context != NULL && context->dpi != NULL
15946 && DECL_CONTEXT (loc) == context->dpi->fndecl)
15948 /* We are generating code for a DWARF procedure and we want to access
15949 one of its arguments: find the appropriate argument offset and let
15950 the resolve_args_picking pass compute the offset that complies
15951 with the stack frame size. */
15952 unsigned i = 0;
15953 tree cursor;
15955 for (cursor = DECL_ARGUMENTS (context->dpi->fndecl);
15956 cursor != NULL_TREE && cursor != loc;
15957 cursor = TREE_CHAIN (cursor), ++i)
15959 /* If we are translating a DWARF procedure, all referenced parameters
15960 must belong to the current function. */
15961 gcc_assert (cursor != NULL_TREE);
15963 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, i, 0);
15964 ret->frame_offset_rel = 1;
15965 break;
15967 /* FALLTHRU */
15969 case RESULT_DECL:
15970 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
15971 return loc_list_from_tree_1 (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
15972 want_address, context);
15973 /* FALLTHRU */
15975 case FUNCTION_DECL:
15977 rtx rtl;
15978 var_loc_list *loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (loc);
15980 if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
15982 list_ret = dw_loc_list (loc_list, loc, want_address);
15983 have_address = want_address != 0;
15984 break;
15986 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
15987 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
15989 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "DECL has no RTL");
15990 return 0;
15992 else if (CONST_INT_P (rtl))
15994 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
15995 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
15996 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
15997 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
15999 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
16001 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CONST_STRING");
16002 return 0;
16004 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl) && const_ok_for_output (rtl))
16005 ret = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
16006 else
16008 machine_mode mode, mem_mode;
16010 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
16011 if (want_address == 2)
16013 ret = loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode,
16014 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16015 have_address = 1;
16017 else
16019 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
16020 mem_mode = VOIDmode;
16021 if (MEM_P (rtl))
16023 mem_mode = mode;
16024 mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
16025 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
16026 have_address = 1;
16028 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode,
16029 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16031 if (!ret)
16032 expansion_failed (loc, rtl,
16033 "failed to produce loc descriptor for rtl");
16036 break;
16038 case MEM_REF:
16039 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
16041 have_address = 1;
16042 goto do_plus;
16044 /* Fallthru. */
16045 case INDIRECT_REF:
16046 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
16047 have_address = 1;
16048 break;
16050 case TARGET_MEM_REF:
16051 case SSA_NAME:
16052 case DEBUG_EXPR_DECL:
16053 return NULL;
16055 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
16056 return loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address,
16057 context);
16059 CASE_CONVERT:
16060 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
16061 case SAVE_EXPR:
16062 case MODIFY_EXPR:
16063 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
16064 return loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address,
16065 context);
16067 case COMPONENT_REF:
16068 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
16069 case ARRAY_REF:
16070 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
16071 case REALPART_EXPR:
16072 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
16074 tree obj, offset;
16075 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
16076 machine_mode mode;
16077 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
16079 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
16080 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep, false);
16082 gcc_assert (obj != loc);
16084 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (obj,
16085 want_address == 2
16086 && !bitpos && !offset ? 2 : 1,
16087 context);
16088 /* TODO: We can extract value of the small expression via shifting even
16089 for nonzero bitpos. */
16090 if (list_ret == 0)
16091 return 0;
16092 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
16094 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16095 "bitfield access");
16096 return 0;
16099 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
16101 /* Variable offset. */
16102 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (offset, 0, context);
16103 if (list_ret1 == 0)
16104 return 0;
16105 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
16106 if (!list_ret)
16107 return 0;
16108 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
16111 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
16112 if (bytepos > 0)
16113 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
16114 else if (bytepos < 0)
16115 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
16117 have_address = 1;
16118 break;
16121 case INTEGER_CST:
16122 if ((want_address || !tree_fits_shwi_p (loc))
16123 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
16124 have_address = 1;
16125 else if (want_address == 2
16126 && tree_fits_shwi_p (loc)
16127 && (ret = address_of_int_loc_descriptor
16128 (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)),
16129 tree_to_shwi (loc))))
16130 have_address = 1;
16131 else if (tree_fits_shwi_p (loc))
16132 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_to_shwi (loc));
16133 else if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (loc))
16134 ret = uint_loc_descriptor (tree_to_uhwi (loc));
16135 else
16137 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16138 "Integer operand is not host integer");
16139 return 0;
16141 break;
16143 case CONSTRUCTOR:
16144 case REAL_CST:
16145 case STRING_CST:
16146 case COMPLEX_CST:
16147 if ((ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
16148 have_address = 1;
16149 else
16150 /* We can construct small constants here using int_loc_descriptor. */
16151 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16152 "constructor or constant not in constant pool");
16153 break;
16155 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
16156 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
16157 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
16158 op = DW_OP_and;
16159 goto do_binop;
16161 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
16162 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
16163 op = DW_OP_xor;
16164 goto do_binop;
16166 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
16167 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
16168 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
16169 op = DW_OP_or;
16170 goto do_binop;
16172 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
16173 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
16174 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
16175 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
16176 case EXACT_DIV_EXPR:
16177 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
16178 return 0;
16179 op = DW_OP_div;
16180 goto do_binop;
16182 case MINUS_EXPR:
16183 op = DW_OP_minus;
16184 goto do_binop;
16186 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
16187 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
16188 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
16189 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
16190 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
16192 op = DW_OP_mod;
16193 goto do_binop;
16195 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
16196 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
16197 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
16198 return 0;
16200 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
16201 if (list_ret == 0)
16202 return 0;
16203 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
16204 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
16205 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
16206 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
16207 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
16208 break;
16210 case MULT_EXPR:
16211 op = DW_OP_mul;
16212 goto do_binop;
16214 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
16215 op = DW_OP_shl;
16216 goto do_binop;
16218 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
16219 op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
16220 goto do_binop;
16222 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
16223 case PLUS_EXPR:
16224 do_plus:
16225 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
16227 /* Big unsigned numbers can fit in HOST_WIDE_INT but it may be
16228 smarter to encode their opposite. The DW_OP_plus_uconst operation
16229 takes 1 + X bytes, X being the size of the ULEB128 addend. On the
16230 other hand, a "<push literal>; DW_OP_minus" pattern takes 1 + Y
16231 bytes, Y being the size of the operation that pushes the opposite
16232 of the addend. So let's choose the smallest representation. */
16233 const tree tree_addend = TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1);
16234 offset_int wi_addend;
16235 HOST_WIDE_INT shwi_addend;
16236 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_naddend;
16238 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
16239 if (list_ret == 0)
16240 return 0;
16242 /* Try to get the literal to push. It is the opposite of the addend,
16243 so as we rely on wrapping during DWARF evaluation, first decode
16244 the literal as a "DWARF-sized" signed number. */
16245 wi_addend = wi::to_offset (tree_addend);
16246 wi_addend = wi::sext (wi_addend, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 8);
16247 shwi_addend = wi_addend.to_shwi ();
16248 loc_naddend = (shwi_addend != INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT))
16249 ? int_loc_descriptor (-shwi_addend)
16250 : NULL;
16252 if (loc_naddend != NULL
16253 && ((unsigned) size_of_uleb128 (shwi_addend)
16254 > size_of_loc_descr (loc_naddend)))
16256 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, loc_naddend);
16257 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
16258 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
16260 else
16262 for (dw_loc_descr_ref loc_cur = loc_naddend; loc_cur != NULL; )
16264 loc_naddend = loc_cur;
16265 loc_cur = loc_cur->dw_loc_next;
16266 ggc_free (loc_naddend);
16268 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, wi_addend.to_shwi ());
16270 break;
16273 op = DW_OP_plus;
16274 goto do_binop;
16276 case LE_EXPR:
16277 op = DW_OP_le;
16278 goto do_comp_binop;
16280 case GE_EXPR:
16281 op = DW_OP_ge;
16282 goto do_comp_binop;
16284 case LT_EXPR:
16285 op = DW_OP_lt;
16286 goto do_comp_binop;
16288 case GT_EXPR:
16289 op = DW_OP_gt;
16290 goto do_comp_binop;
16292 do_comp_binop:
16293 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
16295 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
16296 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
16297 list_ret = loc_list_from_uint_comparison (list_ret, list_ret1,
16298 TREE_CODE (loc));
16299 break;
16301 else
16302 goto do_binop;
16304 case EQ_EXPR:
16305 op = DW_OP_eq;
16306 goto do_binop;
16308 case NE_EXPR:
16309 op = DW_OP_ne;
16310 goto do_binop;
16312 do_binop:
16313 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
16314 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
16315 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
16316 return 0;
16318 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
16319 if (list_ret == 0)
16320 return 0;
16321 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
16322 break;
16324 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
16325 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
16326 op = DW_OP_not;
16327 goto do_unop;
16329 case ABS_EXPR:
16330 op = DW_OP_abs;
16331 goto do_unop;
16333 case NEGATE_EXPR:
16334 op = DW_OP_neg;
16335 goto do_unop;
16337 do_unop:
16338 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
16339 if (list_ret == 0)
16340 return 0;
16342 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
16343 break;
16345 case MIN_EXPR:
16346 case MAX_EXPR:
16348 const enum tree_code code =
16349 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
16351 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
16352 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
16353 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
16354 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
16357 /* ... fall through ... */
16359 case COND_EXPR:
16361 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
16362 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
16363 dw_loc_list_ref rhs
16364 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0, context);
16365 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
16367 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
16368 if (list_ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
16369 return 0;
16371 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
16372 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, bra_node);
16374 add_loc_list (&list_ret, rhs);
16375 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
16376 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, jump_node);
16378 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, lhs);
16379 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
16380 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
16382 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
16383 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
16384 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, tmp);
16385 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
16386 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
16388 break;
16390 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
16391 return 0;
16393 default:
16394 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
16395 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
16396 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
16397 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
16399 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16400 "language specific tree node");
16401 return 0;
16404 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
16405 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
16406 if (flag_checking)
16407 gcc_unreachable ();
16409 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
16410 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
16411 return NULL;
16414 if (!ret && !list_ret)
16415 return 0;
16417 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
16418 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16420 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16422 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16423 "DWARF address size mismatch");
16424 return 0;
16426 if (ret)
16427 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16428 else
16429 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
16430 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16431 have_address = 1;
16433 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
16434 if (want_address && !have_address)
16436 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16437 "Want address and only have value");
16438 return 0;
16441 gcc_assert (!ret || !list_ret);
16443 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
16444 if (!want_address && have_address)
16446 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
16448 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
16450 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16451 "DWARF address size mismatch");
16452 return 0;
16454 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16455 op = DW_OP_deref;
16456 else
16457 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
16459 if (ret)
16460 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
16461 else
16462 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
16464 if (ret)
16465 list_ret = new_loc_list (ret, NULL, NULL, NULL);
16467 return list_ret;
16470 /* Likewise, but strip useless DW_OP_nop operations in the resulting
16471 expressions. */
16473 static dw_loc_list_ref
16474 loc_list_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address,
16475 const struct loc_descr_context *context)
16477 dw_loc_list_ref result = loc_list_from_tree_1 (loc, want_address, context);
16479 for (dw_loc_list_ref loc_cur = result;
16480 loc_cur != NULL; loc_cur =
16481 loc_cur->dw_loc_next)
16482 loc_descr_without_nops (loc_cur->expr);
16483 return result;
16486 /* Same as above but return only single location expression. */
16487 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16488 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address,
16489 const struct loc_descr_context *context)
16491 dw_loc_list_ref ret = loc_list_from_tree (loc, want_address, context);
16492 if (!ret)
16493 return NULL;
16494 if (ret->dw_loc_next)
16496 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16497 "Location list where only loc descriptor needed");
16498 return NULL;
16500 return ret->expr;
16503 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
16504 which is not less than the value itself. */
16506 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
16507 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
16509 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
16512 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
16513 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
16514 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
16515 ERROR_MARK node. */
16517 static inline tree
16518 field_type (const_tree decl)
16520 tree type;
16522 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
16523 return integer_type_node;
16525 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
16526 if (type == NULL_TREE)
16527 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
16529 return type;
16532 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
16533 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
16534 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
16536 static inline unsigned
16537 simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree type)
16539 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
16542 static inline unsigned
16543 simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree decl)
16545 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
16548 /* Return the result of rounding T up to ALIGN. */
16550 static inline offset_int
16551 round_up_to_align (const offset_int &t, unsigned int align)
16553 return wi::udiv_trunc (t + align - 1, align) * align;
16556 /* Compute the size of TYPE in bytes. If possible, return NULL and store the
16557 size as an integer constant in CST_SIZE. Otherwise, if possible, return a
16558 DWARF expression that computes the size. Return NULL and set CST_SIZE to -1
16559 if we fail to return the size in one of these two forms. */
16561 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16562 type_byte_size (const_tree type, HOST_WIDE_INT *cst_size)
16564 tree tree_size;
16565 struct loc_descr_context ctx;
16567 /* Return a constant integer in priority, if possible. */
16568 *cst_size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
16569 if (*cst_size != -1)
16570 return NULL;
16572 ctx.context_type = const_cast<tree> (type);
16573 ctx.base_decl = NULL_TREE;
16574 ctx.dpi = NULL;
16576 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
16577 tree_size = TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type);
16578 return ((tree_size != NULL_TREE)
16579 ? loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree_size, 0, &ctx)
16580 : NULL);
16583 /* Helper structure for RECORD_TYPE processing. */
16584 struct vlr_context
16586 /* Root RECORD_TYPE. It is needed to generate data member location
16587 descriptions in variable-length records (VLR), but also to cope with
16588 variants, which are composed of nested structures multiplexed with
16589 QUAL_UNION_TYPE nodes. Each time such a structure is passed to a
16590 function processing a FIELD_DECL, it is required to be non null. */
16591 tree struct_type;
16592 /* When generating a variant part in a RECORD_TYPE (i.e. a nested
16593 QUAL_UNION_TYPE), this holds an expression that computes the offset for
16594 this variant part as part of the root record (in storage units). For
16595 regular records, it must be NULL_TREE. */
16596 tree variant_part_offset;
16599 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute the byte offset of the lowest
16600 addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL. If
16601 possible, return a native constant through CST_OFFSET (in which case NULL is
16602 returned); otherwise return a DWARF expression that computes the offset.
16604 Set *CST_OFFSET to 0 and return NULL if we are unable to determine what
16605 that offset is, either because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an
16606 ERROR_MARK node, or because the offset expression is too complex for us.
16608 CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT. */
16610 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16611 field_byte_offset (const_tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx,
16612 HOST_WIDE_INT *cst_offset)
16614 offset_int object_offset_in_bits;
16615 offset_int object_offset_in_bytes;
16616 offset_int bitpos_int;
16617 bool is_byte_offset_cst, is_bit_offset_cst;
16618 tree tree_result;
16619 dw_loc_list_ref loc_result;
16621 *cst_offset = 0;
16623 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
16624 return NULL;
16625 else
16626 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
16628 is_bit_offset_cst = TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (decl)) != INTEGER_CST;
16629 is_byte_offset_cst = TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (decl)) != INTEGER_CST;
16631 /* We cannot handle variable bit offsets at the moment, so abort if it's the
16632 case. */
16633 if (is_bit_offset_cst)
16634 return NULL;
16636 #ifdef PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
16637 /* We used to handle only constant offsets in all cases. Now, we handle
16638 properly dynamic byte offsets only when PCC bitfield type doesn't
16639 matter. */
16640 if (PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS && is_byte_offset_cst && is_bit_offset_cst)
16642 tree type;
16643 tree field_size_tree;
16644 offset_int deepest_bitpos;
16645 offset_int field_size_in_bits;
16646 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
16647 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
16648 offset_int type_size_in_bits;
16650 bitpos_int = wi::to_offset (bit_position (decl));
16651 type = field_type (decl);
16652 type_size_in_bits = offset_int_type_size_in_bits (type);
16653 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
16655 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
16657 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
16658 a flexible array member. */
16659 if (!field_size_tree)
16660 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
16662 /* If the size of the field is not constant, use the type size. */
16663 if (TREE_CODE (field_size_tree) == INTEGER_CST)
16664 field_size_in_bits = wi::to_offset (field_size_tree);
16665 else
16666 field_size_in_bits = type_size_in_bits;
16668 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
16670 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the
16671 starting bit offset (relative to the start of the containing
16672 structure type) of the hypothetical "containing object" for a
16673 bit-field. Thus, when computing the byte offset value for the
16674 start of the "containing object" of a bit-field, we must deduce
16675 this information on our own. This can be rather tricky to do in
16676 some cases. For example, handling the following structure type
16677 definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only
16678 aligns long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
16680 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
16682 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used
16683 in such cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will
16684 allocate 8 bytes for the structure shown above. It decides to
16685 do this based upon one simple rule for bit-field allocation.
16686 GCC allocates each "containing object" for each bit-field at
16687 the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment boundary
16688 (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared
16689 type of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the
16690 condition that there is still enough available space remaining
16691 in the containing object (when allocated at the selected point)
16692 to fully accommodate all of the bits of the bit-field itself.
16694 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for
16695 each object of the structure type shown above. When looking
16696 for a place to allocate the "containing object" for `field2',
16697 the compiler simply tries to allocate a 64-bit "containing
16698 object" at each successive 32-bit boundary (starting at zero)
16699 until it finds a place to allocate that 64- bit field such that
16700 at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated) bits remain
16701 within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
16702 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the
16703 "containing object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the
16704 structure type.)
16706 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts
16707 we're given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC
16708 must have believed that the containing object started (within
16709 the structure type). The value we deduce is then used (by the
16710 callers of this routine) to generate DW_AT_location and
16711 DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields and, in
16712 the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
16714 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to
16715 the "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
16716 deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
16718 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce
16719 where the lowest addressed bit of the containing object must
16720 be. */
16721 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
16723 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for
16724 bitfields. */
16725 object_offset_in_bits
16726 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, type_align_in_bits);
16728 if (wi::gtu_p (object_offset_in_bits, bitpos_int))
16730 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
16732 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
16733 object_offset_in_bits
16734 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, decl_align_in_bits);
16737 #endif /* PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS */
16739 tree_result = byte_position (decl);
16740 if (ctx->variant_part_offset != NULL_TREE)
16741 tree_result = fold (build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (tree_result),
16742 ctx->variant_part_offset, tree_result));
16744 /* If the byte offset is a constant, it's simplier to handle a native
16745 constant rather than a DWARF expression. */
16746 if (TREE_CODE (tree_result) == INTEGER_CST)
16748 *cst_offset = wi::to_offset (tree_result).to_shwi ();
16749 return NULL;
16751 struct loc_descr_context loc_ctx = {
16752 ctx->struct_type, /* context_type */
16753 NULL_TREE, /* base_decl */
16754 NULL /* dpi */
16756 loc_result = loc_list_from_tree (tree_result, 0, &loc_ctx);
16758 /* We want a DWARF expression: abort if we only have a location list with
16759 multiple elements. */
16760 if (!loc_result || !single_element_loc_list_p (loc_result))
16761 return NULL;
16762 else
16763 return loc_result->expr;
16766 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
16767 associated with them. */
16769 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
16771 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
16772 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
16773 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
16775 static inline void
16776 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
16777 dw_loc_list_ref descr)
16779 if (descr == 0)
16780 return;
16781 if (single_element_loc_list_p (descr))
16782 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr->expr);
16783 else
16784 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr_kind, descr);
16787 /* Add DW_AT_accessibility attribute to DIE if needed. */
16789 static void
16790 add_accessibility_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
16792 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
16793 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
16794 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_public. */
16795 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
16796 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
16797 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
16799 if (dwarf_version == 2
16800 || die->die_parent == NULL
16801 || die->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
16802 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
16804 else if (dwarf_version > 2
16805 && die->die_parent
16806 && die->die_parent->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
16807 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
16810 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
16811 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
16812 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
16813 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
16814 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
16815 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
16816 function above).
16818 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
16819 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
16820 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
16821 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
16822 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
16823 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
16824 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
16825 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
16826 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
16827 function below.)
16829 CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT. */
16831 static void
16832 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die,
16833 tree decl,
16834 struct vlr_context *ctx)
16836 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
16837 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
16839 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
16841 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
16842 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
16844 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
16845 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
16846 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
16847 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
16849 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
16851 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
16853 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
16855 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
16856 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
16857 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
16859 /* Extract the vtable address. */
16860 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
16861 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
16863 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
16864 offset = tree_to_shwi (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl));
16865 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
16867 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
16868 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
16869 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
16870 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
16872 /* Extract the offset. */
16873 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
16874 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
16876 /* Add it to the object address. */
16877 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
16878 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
16880 else
16881 offset = tree_to_shwi (BINFO_OFFSET (decl));
16883 else
16885 loc_descr = field_byte_offset (decl, ctx, &offset);
16887 /* If loc_descr is available then we know the field offset is dynamic.
16888 However, GDB does not handle dynamic field offsets very well at the
16889 moment. */
16890 if (loc_descr != NULL && gnat_encodings != DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL)
16892 loc_descr = NULL;
16893 offset = 0;
16896 /* Data member location evalutation starts with the base address on the
16897 stack. Compute the field offset and add it to this base address. */
16898 else if (loc_descr != NULL)
16899 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
16902 if (! loc_descr)
16904 if (dwarf_version > 2)
16906 /* Don't need to output a location expression, just the constant. */
16907 if (offset < 0)
16908 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
16909 else
16910 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
16911 return;
16913 else
16915 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
16917 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
16918 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure
16919 field address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
16920 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
16921 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
16925 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
16928 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
16930 static void
16931 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
16933 while (size != 0)
16935 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
16936 val >>= 8;
16937 --size;
16941 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
16943 static HOST_WIDE_INT
16944 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
16946 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
16948 src += size;
16949 while (size != 0)
16951 val <<= 8;
16952 val |= *--src & 0xff;
16953 --size;
16955 return val;
16958 /* Writes wide_int values to dw_vec_const array. */
16960 static void
16961 insert_wide_int (const wide_int &val, unsigned char *dest, int elt_size)
16963 int i;
16965 if (elt_size <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT/BITS_PER_UNIT)
16967 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (0), elt_size, dest);
16968 return;
16971 /* We'd have to extend this code to support odd sizes. */
16972 gcc_assert (elt_size % (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
16974 int n = elt_size / (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
16976 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
16977 for (i = n - 1; i >= 0; i--)
16979 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (i), sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), dest);
16980 dest += sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
16982 else
16983 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
16985 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (i), sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), dest);
16986 dest += sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
16990 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
16992 static void
16993 insert_float (const_rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
16995 long val[4];
16996 int i;
16998 real_to_target (val, CONST_DOUBLE_REAL_VALUE (rtl), GET_MODE (rtl));
17000 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
17001 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / 4; i++)
17003 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
17004 array += 4;
17008 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
17009 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
17010 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
17011 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
17012 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
17014 static bool
17015 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
17017 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
17019 case CONST_INT:
17021 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
17023 if (val < 0)
17024 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
17025 else
17026 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
17028 return true;
17030 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
17032 wide_int w1 = std::make_pair (rtl, MAX_MODE_INT);
17033 unsigned int prec = MIN (wi::min_precision (w1, UNSIGNED),
17034 (unsigned int)CONST_WIDE_INT_NUNITS (rtl) * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
17035 wide_int w = wi::zext (w1, prec);
17036 add_AT_wide (die, DW_AT_const_value, w);
17038 return true;
17040 case CONST_DOUBLE:
17041 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
17042 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
17043 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
17044 represented. */
17046 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
17048 if (TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0 && !SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
17049 add_AT_double (die, DW_AT_const_value,
17050 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
17051 else
17053 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
17054 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
17056 insert_float (rtl, array);
17057 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
17060 return true;
17062 case CONST_VECTOR:
17064 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
17065 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
17066 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
17067 unsigned char *array
17068 = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length * elt_size);
17069 unsigned int i;
17070 unsigned char *p;
17071 machine_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
17073 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
17075 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
17076 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
17078 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
17079 insert_wide_int (std::make_pair (elt, imode), p, elt_size);
17081 break;
17083 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
17084 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
17086 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
17087 insert_float (elt, p);
17089 break;
17091 default:
17092 gcc_unreachable ();
17095 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
17097 return true;
17099 case CONST_STRING:
17100 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
17102 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
17103 resolve_one_addr (&rtl);
17104 rtl_addr:
17105 loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
17106 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
17107 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, loc_result);
17108 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
17109 return true;
17111 return false;
17113 case CONST:
17114 if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
17115 return add_const_value_attribute (die, XEXP (rtl, 0));
17116 /* FALLTHROUGH */
17117 case SYMBOL_REF:
17118 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
17119 return false;
17120 case LABEL_REF:
17121 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
17122 goto rtl_addr;
17123 return false;
17125 case PLUS:
17126 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
17127 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
17128 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
17129 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
17130 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
17131 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
17132 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
17133 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
17134 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
17135 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
17136 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
17137 return false;
17139 case HIGH:
17140 case CONST_FIXED:
17141 return false;
17143 case MEM:
17144 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_STRING
17145 && MEM_READONLY_P (rtl)
17146 && GET_MODE (rtl) == BLKmode)
17148 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0));
17149 return true;
17151 return false;
17153 default:
17154 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
17155 gcc_unreachable ();
17157 return false;
17160 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
17161 or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
17162 output). */
17163 static tree
17164 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
17165 void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
17167 if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
17168 *walk_subtrees = 0;
17170 if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
17171 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
17172 return *tp;
17173 /* ??? The C++ FE emits debug information for using decls, so
17174 putting gcc_unreachable here falls over. See PR31899. For now
17175 be conservative. */
17176 else if (!symtab->global_info_ready
17177 && (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL))
17178 return *tp;
17179 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL)
17181 varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (*tp);
17182 if (!node || !node->definition)
17183 return *tp;
17185 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL
17186 && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp)))
17188 /* The call graph machinery must have finished analyzing,
17189 optimizing and gimplifying the CU by now.
17190 So if *TP has no call graph node associated
17191 to it, it means *TP will not be emitted. */
17192 if (!cgraph_node::get (*tp))
17193 return *tp;
17195 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == STRING_CST && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
17196 return *tp;
17198 return NULL_TREE;
17201 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
17202 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
17204 static rtx
17205 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
17207 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
17209 STRIP_NOPS (init);
17211 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
17212 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
17213 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
17215 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
17216 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
17217 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
17219 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
17220 && domain
17221 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
17222 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
17223 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
17224 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
17225 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
17227 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
17228 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
17229 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, rtl);
17230 MEM_READONLY_P (rtl) = 1;
17233 /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
17234 CONCAT: FIXME! */
17235 else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)
17236 || (TREE_CODE (init) == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR
17237 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0))))
17238 || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
17240 /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
17241 FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too. */
17242 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE
17243 && !VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
17245 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
17246 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. We must be careful not to
17247 reference variables which won't be output. */
17248 else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
17249 && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
17251 /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
17252 possible. */
17253 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
17254 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
17256 case VECTOR_CST:
17257 break;
17258 case CONSTRUCTOR:
17259 if (TREE_CONSTANT (init))
17261 vec<constructor_elt, va_gc> *elts = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
17262 bool constant_p = true;
17263 tree value;
17264 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
17266 /* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
17267 elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
17268 belong into VECTOR_CST nodes. */
17269 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts, ix, value)
17270 if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value))
17272 constant_p = false;
17273 break;
17276 if (constant_p)
17278 init = build_vector_from_ctor (type, elts);
17279 break;
17282 /* FALLTHRU */
17284 default:
17285 return NULL;
17288 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
17290 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
17291 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
17294 return rtl;
17297 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
17299 static rtx
17300 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
17302 rtx rtl;
17304 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
17305 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
17306 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
17308 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
17309 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
17310 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
17311 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
17312 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
17313 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
17314 referenced within the function.
17316 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
17317 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
17318 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
17319 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
17321 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
17322 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
17323 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
17324 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
17325 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
17326 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
17328 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
17329 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
17330 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
17331 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
17332 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
17333 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
17334 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
17335 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
17336 output at debug-time.
17338 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
17339 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
17340 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
17341 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
17342 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
17343 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
17344 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
17345 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
17346 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
17347 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
17348 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
17349 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
17350 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
17352 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
17353 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
17354 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
17355 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
17356 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
17357 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
17358 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
17359 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
17360 I'd like to fix it.
17362 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
17363 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
17364 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
17365 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
17366 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
17367 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
17368 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
17369 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
17370 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
17371 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
17372 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
17374 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
17375 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
17377 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
17378 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
17379 fixed registers. */
17380 if (! reload_completed)
17382 if (rtl
17383 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
17384 || (MEM_P (rtl)
17385 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
17386 || (REG_P (rtl)
17387 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
17388 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
17390 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
17391 return rtl;
17393 rtl = NULL_RTX;
17395 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
17397 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
17398 || is_pseudo_reg (rtl)
17399 || (MEM_P (rtl)
17400 && is_pseudo_reg (XEXP (rtl, 0))
17401 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)
17402 && MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
17403 && GET_MODE (rtl) == GET_MODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))))
17405 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
17406 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
17407 machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
17408 machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
17410 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
17411 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
17412 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
17413 if (dmode == pmode)
17414 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
17415 else if ((rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
17416 && SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
17417 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
17418 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
17420 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
17421 if (REG_P (inc))
17422 rtl = inc;
17423 else if (MEM_P (inc))
17425 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
17426 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
17427 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
17428 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
17429 else
17430 rtl = inc;
17435 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
17436 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
17437 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
17438 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
17439 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
17440 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
17441 thing to do. */
17442 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
17443 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
17444 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
17445 /* Not passed in memory. */
17446 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
17447 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
17448 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
17449 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
17450 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
17451 #if !HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
17452 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
17453 #endif
17455 /* Big endian correction check. */
17456 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
17457 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
17458 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
17459 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
17461 machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
17462 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
17463 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
17465 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
17466 plus_constant (addr_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
17469 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
17470 && rtl
17471 && MEM_P (rtl)
17472 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
17473 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
17475 machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
17476 int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
17477 int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
17479 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
17480 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
17481 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
17482 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
17483 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
17484 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
17485 if (rsize > dsize)
17486 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
17487 plus_constant (addr_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
17488 rsize - dsize));
17491 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
17492 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
17493 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
17494 if (!rtl && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
17495 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
17497 if (rtl)
17498 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
17500 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
17501 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
17502 code, and thus is not emitted. */
17503 if (rtl)
17504 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
17506 /* Try harder to get a rtl. If this symbol ends up not being emitted
17507 in the current CU, resolve_addr will remove the expression referencing
17508 it. */
17509 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
17510 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
17511 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
17512 && TREE_STATIC (decl)
17513 && DECL_NAME (decl)
17514 && !DECL_HARD_REGISTER (decl)
17515 && DECL_MODE (decl) != VOIDmode)
17517 rtl = make_decl_rtl_for_debug (decl);
17518 if (!MEM_P (rtl)
17519 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
17520 || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != decl)
17521 rtl = NULL_RTX;
17524 return rtl;
17527 /* Check whether decl is a Fortran COMMON symbol. If not, NULL_TREE is
17528 returned. If so, the decl for the COMMON block is returned, and the
17529 value is the offset into the common block for the symbol. */
17531 static tree
17532 fortran_common (tree decl, HOST_WIDE_INT *value)
17534 tree val_expr, cvar;
17535 machine_mode mode;
17536 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
17537 tree offset;
17538 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
17540 /* If the decl isn't a VAR_DECL, or if it isn't static, or if
17541 it does not have a value (the offset into the common area), or if it
17542 is thread local (as opposed to global) then it isn't common, and shouldn't
17543 be handled as such. */
17544 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
17545 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
17546 || !DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl)
17547 || !is_fortran ())
17548 return NULL_TREE;
17550 val_expr = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl);
17551 if (TREE_CODE (val_expr) != COMPONENT_REF)
17552 return NULL_TREE;
17554 cvar = get_inner_reference (val_expr, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
17555 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep, true);
17557 if (cvar == NULL_TREE
17558 || TREE_CODE (cvar) != VAR_DECL
17559 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (cvar)
17560 || !TREE_PUBLIC (cvar))
17561 return NULL_TREE;
17563 *value = 0;
17564 if (offset != NULL)
17566 if (!tree_fits_shwi_p (offset))
17567 return NULL_TREE;
17568 *value = tree_to_shwi (offset);
17570 if (bitpos != 0)
17571 *value += bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
17573 return cvar;
17576 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
17577 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
17578 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
17579 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
17580 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
17581 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
17582 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
17583 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
17584 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
17585 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address.
17587 CACHE_P is true if it is worth caching the location list for DECL,
17588 so that future calls can reuse it rather than regenerate it from scratch.
17589 This is true for BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS in inlined subroutines,
17590 since we will need to refer to them each time the function is inlined. */
17592 static bool
17593 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl, bool cache_p)
17595 rtx rtl;
17596 dw_loc_list_ref list;
17597 var_loc_list *loc_list;
17598 cached_dw_loc_list *cache;
17600 if (early_dwarf)
17601 return false;
17603 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
17604 return false;
17606 if (get_AT (die, DW_AT_location)
17607 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_const_value))
17608 return true;
17610 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
17611 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
17613 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
17614 the location. */
17616 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
17617 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
17618 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
17619 return true;
17621 /* See if we have single element location list that is equivalent to
17622 a constant value. That way we are better to use add_const_value_attribute
17623 rather than expanding constant value equivalent. */
17624 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
17625 if (loc_list
17626 && loc_list->first
17627 && loc_list->first->next == NULL
17628 && NOTE_P (loc_list->first->loc)
17629 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_list->first->loc)
17630 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_list->first->loc))
17632 struct var_loc_node *node;
17634 node = loc_list->first;
17635 rtl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc);
17636 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == EXPR_LIST)
17637 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
17638 if ((CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
17639 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
17640 return true;
17642 /* If this decl is from BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS, we might need its
17643 list several times. See if we've already cached the contents. */
17644 list = NULL;
17645 if (loc_list == NULL || cached_dw_loc_list_table == NULL)
17646 cache_p = false;
17647 if (cache_p)
17649 cache = cached_dw_loc_list_table->find_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl));
17650 if (cache)
17651 list = cache->loc_list;
17653 if (list == NULL)
17655 list = loc_list_from_tree (decl, decl_by_reference_p (decl) ? 0 : 2,
17656 NULL);
17657 /* It is usually worth caching this result if the decl is from
17658 BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS and if the list has at least two elements. */
17659 if (cache_p && list && list->dw_loc_next)
17661 cached_dw_loc_list **slot
17662 = cached_dw_loc_list_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl,
17663 DECL_UID (decl),
17664 INSERT);
17665 cache = ggc_cleared_alloc<cached_dw_loc_list> ();
17666 cache->decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
17667 cache->loc_list = list;
17668 *slot = cache;
17671 if (list)
17673 add_AT_location_description (die, DW_AT_location, list);
17674 return true;
17676 /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
17677 try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL. */
17678 return tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (die, decl);
17681 /* Helper function for tree_add_const_value_attribute. Natively encode
17682 initializer INIT into an array. Return true if successful. */
17684 static bool
17685 native_encode_initializer (tree init, unsigned char *array, int size)
17687 tree type;
17689 if (init == NULL_TREE)
17690 return false;
17692 STRIP_NOPS (init);
17693 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
17695 case STRING_CST:
17696 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
17697 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
17699 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
17700 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
17702 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != 1)
17703 return false;
17704 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
17705 return false;
17706 if (size > TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init))
17708 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init),
17709 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
17710 memset (array + TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init),
17711 '\0', size - TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
17713 else
17714 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init), size);
17715 return true;
17717 return false;
17718 case CONSTRUCTOR:
17719 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
17720 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
17721 return false;
17722 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
17724 HOST_WIDE_INT min_index;
17725 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
17726 int curpos = 0, fieldsize;
17727 constructor_elt *ce;
17729 if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) == NULL_TREE
17730 || !tree_fits_shwi_p (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type))))
17731 return false;
17733 fieldsize = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type));
17734 if (fieldsize <= 0)
17735 return false;
17737 min_index = tree_to_shwi (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)));
17738 memset (array, '\0', size);
17739 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
17741 tree val = ce->value;
17742 tree index = ce->index;
17743 int pos = curpos;
17744 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
17745 pos = (tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0)) - min_index)
17746 * fieldsize;
17747 else if (index)
17748 pos = (tree_to_shwi (index) - min_index) * fieldsize;
17750 if (val)
17752 STRIP_NOPS (val);
17753 if (!native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
17754 return false;
17756 curpos = pos + fieldsize;
17757 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
17759 int count = tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 1))
17760 - tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0));
17761 while (count-- > 0)
17763 if (val)
17764 memcpy (array + curpos, array + pos, fieldsize);
17765 curpos += fieldsize;
17768 gcc_assert (curpos <= size);
17770 return true;
17772 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
17773 || TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
17775 tree field = NULL_TREE;
17776 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
17777 constructor_elt *ce;
17779 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
17780 return false;
17782 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
17783 field = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
17785 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
17787 tree val = ce->value;
17788 int pos, fieldsize;
17790 if (ce->index != 0)
17791 field = ce->index;
17793 if (val)
17794 STRIP_NOPS (val);
17796 if (field == NULL_TREE || DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
17797 return false;
17799 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) == ARRAY_TYPE
17800 && TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))
17801 && ! TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))))
17802 return false;
17803 else if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field) == NULL_TREE
17804 || !tree_fits_shwi_p (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field)))
17805 return false;
17806 fieldsize = tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field));
17807 pos = int_byte_position (field);
17808 gcc_assert (pos + fieldsize <= size);
17809 if (val && fieldsize != 0
17810 && !native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
17811 return false;
17813 return true;
17815 return false;
17816 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
17817 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
17818 return native_encode_initializer (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0), array, size);
17819 default:
17820 return native_encode_expr (init, array, size) == size;
17824 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE. The value of the
17825 attribute is the const value T. */
17827 static bool
17828 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree t)
17830 tree init;
17831 tree type = TREE_TYPE (t);
17832 rtx rtl;
17834 if (!t || !TREE_TYPE (t) || TREE_TYPE (t) == error_mark_node)
17835 return false;
17837 init = t;
17838 gcc_assert (!DECL_P (init));
17840 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
17841 if (rtl)
17842 return add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
17843 /* If the host and target are sane, try harder. */
17844 else if (CHAR_BIT == 8 && BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
17845 && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type))
17847 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (init));
17848 if (size > 0 && (int) size == size)
17850 unsigned char *array = ggc_cleared_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (size);
17852 if (native_encode_initializer (init, array, size))
17854 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, size, 1, array);
17855 return true;
17857 ggc_free (array);
17860 return false;
17863 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to VAR_DIE. The value of the
17864 attribute is the const value of T, where T is an integral constant
17865 variable with static storage duration
17866 (so it can't be a PARM_DECL or a RESULT_DECL). */
17868 static bool
17869 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
17872 if (!decl
17873 || (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
17874 && TREE_CODE (decl) != CONST_DECL)
17875 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
17876 && !TREE_STATIC (decl)))
17877 return false;
17879 if (TREE_READONLY (decl)
17880 && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
17881 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
17882 /* OK */;
17883 else
17884 return false;
17886 /* Don't add DW_AT_const_value if abstract origin already has one. */
17887 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_const_value))
17888 return false;
17890 return tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, DECL_INITIAL (decl));
17893 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
17894 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
17895 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
17896 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
17897 expressions. */
17899 static dw_loc_list_ref
17900 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
17902 int ix;
17903 dw_fde_ref fde;
17904 dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
17905 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
17906 dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
17907 const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
17908 dw_cfa_location remember;
17910 fde = cfun->fde;
17911 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
17913 section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
17914 list_tail = &list;
17915 list = NULL;
17917 memset (&next_cfa, 0, sizeof (next_cfa));
17918 next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
17919 remember = next_cfa;
17921 start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
17923 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
17924 advance opcodes. */
17925 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*cie_cfi_vec, ix, cfi)
17926 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
17928 last_cfa = next_cfa;
17929 last_label = start_label;
17931 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index == 0)
17933 /* If the first partition contained no CFI adjustments, the
17934 CIE opcodes apply to the whole first partition. */
17935 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
17936 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_end, section);
17937 list_tail =&(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
17938 start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
17941 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (fde->dw_fde_cfi, ix, cfi)
17943 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
17945 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
17946 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
17947 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
17948 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
17949 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
17951 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
17952 start_label, last_label, section);
17954 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
17955 last_cfa = next_cfa;
17956 start_label = last_label;
17958 last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
17959 break;
17961 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
17962 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
17963 gcc_unreachable ();
17965 default:
17966 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
17967 break;
17969 if (ix + 1 == fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index)
17971 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
17973 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
17974 start_label, last_label, section);
17976 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
17977 last_cfa = next_cfa;
17978 start_label = last_label;
17980 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
17981 start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section);
17982 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
17983 start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
17987 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
17989 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
17990 start_label, last_label, section);
17991 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
17992 start_label = last_label;
17995 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
17996 start_label,
17997 fde->dw_fde_second_begin
17998 ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end,
17999 section);
18001 if (list && list->dw_loc_next)
18002 gen_llsym (list);
18004 return list;
18007 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
18008 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
18009 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
18010 before the latter is negated. */
18012 static void
18013 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
18015 rtx reg, elim;
18017 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
18018 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
18019 offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
18020 #else
18021 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
18022 offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
18023 #endif
18025 elim = (ira_use_lra_p
18026 ? lra_eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX)
18027 : eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX));
18028 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
18030 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
18031 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
18034 frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
18036 /* ??? AVR doesn't set up valid eliminations when there is no stack frame
18037 in which to eliminate. This is because it's stack pointer isn't
18038 directly accessible as a register within the ISA. To work around
18039 this, assume that while we cannot provide a proper value for
18040 frame_pointer_fb_offset, we won't need one either. */
18041 frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid
18042 = ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
18043 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
18044 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
18045 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
18046 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
18047 : stack_pointer_rtx));
18050 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
18051 the value of the attribute. */
18053 static void
18054 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
18056 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
18058 if (demangle_name_func)
18059 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
18061 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
18065 /* Retrieve the descriptive type of TYPE, if any, make sure it has a
18066 DIE and attach a DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type attribute to the DIE
18067 of TYPE accordingly.
18069 ??? This is a temporary measure until after we're able to generate
18070 regular DWARF for the complex Ada type system. */
18072 static void
18073 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree type,
18074 dw_die_ref context_die)
18076 tree dtype;
18077 dw_die_ref dtype_die;
18079 if (!lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type)
18080 return;
18082 dtype = lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type (type);
18083 if (!dtype)
18084 return;
18086 dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
18087 if (!dtype_die)
18089 gen_type_die (dtype, context_die);
18090 dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
18091 gcc_assert (dtype_die);
18094 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type, dtype_die);
18097 /* Retrieve the comp_dir string suitable for use with DW_AT_comp_dir. */
18099 static const char *
18100 comp_dir_string (void)
18102 const char *wd;
18103 char *wd1;
18104 static const char *cached_wd = NULL;
18106 if (cached_wd != NULL)
18107 return cached_wd;
18109 wd = get_src_pwd ();
18110 if (wd == NULL)
18111 return NULL;
18113 if (DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR)
18115 int wdlen;
18117 wdlen = strlen (wd);
18118 wd1 = ggc_vec_alloc<char> (wdlen + 2);
18119 strcpy (wd1, wd);
18120 wd1 [wdlen] = DIR_SEPARATOR;
18121 wd1 [wdlen + 1] = 0;
18122 wd = wd1;
18125 cached_wd = remap_debug_filename (wd);
18126 return cached_wd;
18129 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
18131 static void
18132 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
18134 const char * wd = comp_dir_string ();
18135 if (wd != NULL)
18136 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
18139 /* Given a tree node VALUE describing a scalar attribute ATTR (i.e. a bound, a
18140 pointer computation, ...), output a representation for that bound according
18141 to the accepted FORMS (see enum dw_scalar_form) and add it to DIE. See
18142 loc_list_from_tree for the meaning of CONTEXT. */
18144 static void
18145 add_scalar_info (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr, tree value,
18146 int forms, const struct loc_descr_context *context)
18148 dw_die_ref context_die, decl_die;
18149 dw_loc_list_ref list;
18151 bool strip_conversions = true;
18153 while (strip_conversions)
18154 switch (TREE_CODE (value))
18156 case ERROR_MARK:
18157 case SAVE_EXPR:
18158 return;
18160 CASE_CONVERT:
18161 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
18162 value = TREE_OPERAND (value, 0);
18163 break;
18165 default:
18166 strip_conversions = false;
18167 break;
18170 /* If possible and permitted, output the attribute as a constant. */
18171 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_constant) != 0
18172 && TREE_CODE (value) == INTEGER_CST)
18174 unsigned int prec = simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (value));
18176 /* If HOST_WIDE_INT is big enough then represent the bound as
18177 a constant value. We need to choose a form based on
18178 whether the type is signed or unsigned. We cannot just
18179 call add_AT_unsigned if the value itself is positive
18180 (add_AT_unsigned might add the unsigned value encoded as
18181 DW_FORM_data[1248]). Some DWARF consumers will lookup the
18182 bounds type and then sign extend any unsigned values found
18183 for signed types. This is needed only for
18184 DW_AT_{lower,upper}_bound, since for most other attributes,
18185 consumers will treat DW_FORM_data[1248] as unsigned values,
18186 regardless of the underlying type. */
18187 if (prec <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
18188 || tree_fits_uhwi_p (value))
18190 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value)))
18191 add_AT_unsigned (die, attr, TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value));
18192 else
18193 add_AT_int (die, attr, TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value));
18195 else
18196 /* Otherwise represent the bound as an unsigned value with
18197 the precision of its type. The precision and signedness
18198 of the type will be necessary to re-interpret it
18199 unambiguously. */
18200 add_AT_wide (die, attr, value);
18201 return;
18204 /* Otherwise, if it's possible and permitted too, output a reference to
18205 another DIE. */
18206 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_reference) != 0)
18208 tree decl = NULL_TREE;
18210 /* Some type attributes reference an outer type. For instance, the upper
18211 bound of an array may reference an embedding record (this happens in
18212 Ada). */
18213 if (TREE_CODE (value) == COMPONENT_REF
18214 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (value, 0)) == PLACEHOLDER_EXPR
18215 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (value, 1)) == FIELD_DECL)
18216 decl = TREE_OPERAND (value, 1);
18218 else if (TREE_CODE (value) == VAR_DECL
18219 || TREE_CODE (value) == PARM_DECL
18220 || TREE_CODE (value) == RESULT_DECL)
18221 decl = value;
18223 if (decl != NULL_TREE)
18225 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
18227 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
18228 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
18229 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
18230 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
18231 later parameter. */
18232 if (decl_die != NULL)
18234 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr, decl_die);
18235 return;
18240 /* Last chance: try to create a stack operation procedure to evaluate the
18241 value. Do nothing if even that is not possible or permitted. */
18242 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_exprloc) == 0)
18243 return;
18245 list = loc_list_from_tree (value, 2, context);
18246 if (list == NULL || single_element_loc_list_p (list))
18248 /* If this attribute is not a reference nor constant, it is
18249 a DWARF expression rather than location description. For that
18250 loc_list_from_tree (value, 0, &context) is needed. */
18251 dw_loc_list_ref list2 = loc_list_from_tree (value, 0, context);
18252 if (list2 && single_element_loc_list_p (list2))
18254 add_AT_loc (die, attr, list2->expr);
18255 return;
18259 /* If that failed to give a single element location list, fall back to
18260 outputting this as a reference... still if permitted. */
18261 if (list == NULL || (forms & dw_scalar_form_reference) == 0)
18262 return;
18264 if (current_function_decl == 0)
18265 context_die = comp_unit_die ();
18266 else
18267 context_die = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
18269 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, value);
18270 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18271 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (value), TYPE_QUAL_CONST, false,
18272 context_die);
18273 add_AT_location_description (decl_die, DW_AT_location, list);
18274 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr, decl_die);
18277 /* Return the default for DW_AT_lower_bound, or -1 if there is not any
18278 default. */
18280 static int
18281 lower_bound_default (void)
18283 switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language))
18285 case DW_LANG_C:
18286 case DW_LANG_C89:
18287 case DW_LANG_C99:
18288 case DW_LANG_C11:
18289 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus:
18290 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11:
18291 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14:
18292 case DW_LANG_ObjC:
18293 case DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus:
18294 case DW_LANG_Java:
18295 return 0;
18296 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
18297 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
18298 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
18299 case DW_LANG_Fortran03:
18300 case DW_LANG_Fortran08:
18301 return 1;
18302 case DW_LANG_UPC:
18303 case DW_LANG_D:
18304 case DW_LANG_Python:
18305 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 0 : -1;
18306 case DW_LANG_Ada95:
18307 case DW_LANG_Ada83:
18308 case DW_LANG_Cobol74:
18309 case DW_LANG_Cobol85:
18310 case DW_LANG_Pascal83:
18311 case DW_LANG_Modula2:
18312 case DW_LANG_PLI:
18313 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 1 : -1;
18314 default:
18315 return -1;
18319 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
18320 a representation for that bound. */
18322 static void
18323 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr,
18324 tree bound, const struct loc_descr_context *context)
18326 int dflt;
18328 while (1)
18329 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
18331 /* Strip all conversions. */
18332 CASE_CONVERT:
18333 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
18334 bound = TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0);
18335 break;
18337 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. Lower bounds
18338 are even omitted when they are the default. */
18339 case INTEGER_CST:
18340 /* If the value for this bound is the default one, we can even omit the
18341 attribute. */
18342 if (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
18343 && tree_fits_shwi_p (bound)
18344 && (dflt = lower_bound_default ()) != -1
18345 && tree_to_shwi (bound) == dflt)
18346 return;
18348 /* FALLTHRU */
18350 default:
18351 /* Because of the complex interaction there can be with other GNAT
18352 encodings, GDB isn't ready yet to handle proper DWARF description
18353 for self-referencial subrange bounds: let GNAT encodings do the
18354 magic in such a case. */
18355 if (gnat_encodings != DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL
18356 && contains_placeholder_p (bound))
18357 return;
18359 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, bound,
18360 dw_scalar_form_constant
18361 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
18362 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
18363 context);
18364 return;
18368 /* Add subscript info to TYPE_DIE, describing an array TYPE, collapsing
18369 possibly nested array subscripts in a flat sequence if COLLAPSE_P is true.
18370 Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
18371 includes information about the element type of the given array type.
18373 This function reuses previously set type and bound information if
18374 available. */
18376 static void
18377 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type, bool collapse_p)
18379 unsigned dimension_number;
18380 tree lower, upper;
18381 dw_die_ref child = type_die->die_child;
18383 for (dimension_number = 0;
18384 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE && (dimension_number == 0 || collapse_p);
18385 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
18387 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
18389 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type) && is_fortran () && dimension_number > 0)
18390 break;
18392 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
18393 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
18394 here. */
18396 /* Find and reuse a previously generated DW_TAG_subrange_type if
18397 available.
18399 For multi-dimensional arrays, as we iterate through the
18400 various dimensions in the enclosing for loop above, we also
18401 iterate through the DIE children and pick at each
18402 DW_TAG_subrange_type previously generated (if available).
18403 Each child DW_TAG_subrange_type DIE describes the range of
18404 the current dimension. At this point we should have as many
18405 DW_TAG_subrange_type's as we have dimensions in the
18406 array. */
18407 dw_die_ref subrange_die = NULL;
18408 if (child)
18409 while (1)
18411 child = child->die_sib;
18412 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_subrange_type)
18413 subrange_die = child;
18414 if (child == type_die->die_child)
18416 /* If we wrapped around, stop looking next time. */
18417 child = NULL;
18418 break;
18420 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_subrange_type)
18421 break;
18423 if (!subrange_die)
18424 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
18426 if (domain)
18428 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
18429 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
18430 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
18432 /* Define the index type. */
18433 if (TREE_TYPE (domain)
18434 && !get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_type))
18436 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
18437 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
18438 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
18439 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
18440 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
18441 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
18442 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
18444 else
18445 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain),
18446 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, type_die);
18449 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
18450 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
18451 dimension arr(N:*)
18452 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
18453 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
18454 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
18456 if (!get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound))
18457 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower, NULL);
18458 if (upper && !get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound))
18459 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper, NULL);
18462 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
18463 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
18464 bounds. */
18468 /* Add a DW_AT_byte_size attribute to DIE with TREE_NODE's size. */
18470 static void
18471 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
18473 dw_die_ref decl_die;
18474 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
18475 dw_loc_descr_ref size_expr = NULL;
18477 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
18479 case ERROR_MARK:
18480 size = 0;
18481 break;
18482 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
18483 case RECORD_TYPE:
18484 case UNION_TYPE:
18485 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
18486 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (tree_node)) == VAR_DECL
18487 && (decl_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (tree_node))))
18489 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_byte_size, decl_die);
18490 return;
18492 size_expr = type_byte_size (tree_node, &size);
18493 break;
18494 case FIELD_DECL:
18495 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
18496 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
18497 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
18498 even for bit-fields. */
18499 size = int_size_in_bytes (field_type (tree_node));
18500 break;
18501 default:
18502 gcc_unreachable ();
18505 /* Support for dynamically-sized objects was introduced by DWARFv3.
18506 At the moment, GDB does not handle variable byte sizes very well,
18507 though. */
18508 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
18509 && gnat_encodings == DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL
18510 && size_expr != NULL)
18511 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_expr);
18513 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
18514 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable and
18515 that we could not generate a DWARF expression that computes it. */
18516 if (size >= 0)
18517 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
18520 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
18521 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
18522 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
18523 bit-field itself.
18525 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
18526 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
18527 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
18528 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
18529 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
18530 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
18532 CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT.
18534 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
18535 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
18536 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
18538 static inline void
18539 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx)
18541 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes;
18542 tree original_type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
18543 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
18544 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
18545 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
18546 HOST_WIDE_INT bit_offset;
18548 field_byte_offset (decl, ctx, &object_offset_in_bytes);
18550 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
18551 gcc_assert (original_type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
18553 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
18554 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
18555 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
18556 if (! tree_fits_shwi_p (bit_position (decl))
18557 || ! tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
18558 return;
18560 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
18562 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
18563 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
18564 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
18565 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
18566 below must take account of these differences. */
18567 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
18568 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
18570 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
18572 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE (decl));
18573 highest_order_object_bit_offset +=
18574 simple_type_size_in_bits (original_type);
18577 bit_offset
18578 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
18579 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
18580 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
18582 if (bit_offset < 0)
18583 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
18584 else
18585 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bit_offset);
18588 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
18589 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
18591 static inline void
18592 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18594 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
18595 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
18596 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
18598 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
18599 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (decl)));
18602 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
18603 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
18605 static inline void
18606 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
18608 switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language))
18610 case DW_LANG_C:
18611 case DW_LANG_C89:
18612 case DW_LANG_C99:
18613 case DW_LANG_C11:
18614 case DW_LANG_ObjC:
18615 if (prototype_p (func_type))
18616 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
18617 break;
18618 default:
18619 break;
18623 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
18624 by looking in the type declaration, the object declaration equate table or
18625 the block mapping. */
18627 static inline dw_die_ref
18628 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
18630 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
18632 if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL
18633 && TREE_CODE (origin) != BLOCK)
18635 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
18636 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
18637 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
18639 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
18640 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
18641 tree fn = origin;
18643 if (TYPE_P (fn))
18644 fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
18646 fn = decl_function_context (fn);
18647 if (fn)
18648 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
18651 if (DECL_P (origin))
18652 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
18653 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
18654 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
18655 else if (TREE_CODE (origin) == BLOCK)
18656 origin_die = BLOCK_DIE (origin);
18658 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
18659 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
18660 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
18661 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
18662 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
18663 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
18664 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
18665 here. */
18667 if (origin_die)
18668 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
18669 return origin_die;
18672 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
18674 static inline void
18675 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
18677 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
18679 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
18681 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl)))
18682 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
18683 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
18684 tree_to_shwi (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl)),
18685 0));
18687 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
18688 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
18689 && DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl))
18690 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
18691 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
18695 /* Add a DW_AT_linkage_name or DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name attribute for the
18696 given decl. This used to be a vendor extension until after DWARF 4
18697 standardized it. */
18699 static void
18700 add_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18702 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl));
18704 /* Mimic what assemble_name_raw does with a leading '*'. */
18705 if (name[0] == '*')
18706 name = &name[1];
18708 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
18709 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_linkage_name, name);
18710 else
18711 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name, name);
18714 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
18716 static void
18717 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18719 expanded_location s;
18721 if (LOCATION_LOCUS (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl)) == UNKNOWN_LOCATION)
18722 return;
18723 s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
18724 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
18725 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
18728 /* Add DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute for the given decl. */
18730 static void
18731 add_linkage_name_raw (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18733 /* Defer until we have an assembler name set. */
18734 if (!DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME_SET_P (decl))
18736 limbo_die_node *asm_name;
18738 asm_name = ggc_cleared_alloc<limbo_die_node> ();
18739 asm_name->die = die;
18740 asm_name->created_for = decl;
18741 asm_name->next = deferred_asm_name;
18742 deferred_asm_name = asm_name;
18744 else if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
18745 add_linkage_attr (die, decl);
18748 /* Add DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute for the given decl if desired. */
18750 static void
18751 add_linkage_name (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18753 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_NONE
18754 && (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
18755 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
18756 && !(TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_REGISTER (decl))
18757 && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_member)
18758 add_linkage_name_raw (die, decl);
18761 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
18762 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
18764 static void
18765 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18767 tree decl_name;
18769 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
18770 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
18772 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
18773 if (name)
18774 add_name_attribute (die, name);
18775 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
18776 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
18778 add_linkage_name (die, decl);
18781 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
18782 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
18783 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
18784 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
18786 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
18787 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), false);
18788 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
18790 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
18793 /* Add VALUE as a DW_AT_discr_value attribute to DIE. */
18795 static void
18796 add_discr_value (dw_die_ref die, dw_discr_value *value)
18798 dw_attr_node attr;
18800 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_discr_value;
18801 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_discr_value;
18802 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
18803 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.pos = value->pos;
18804 if (value->pos)
18805 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.v.uval = value->v.uval;
18806 else
18807 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.v.sval = value->v.sval;
18808 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
18811 /* Add DISCR_LIST as a DW_AT_discr_list to DIE. */
18813 static void
18814 add_discr_list (dw_die_ref die, dw_discr_list_ref discr_list)
18816 dw_attr_node attr;
18818 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_discr_list;
18819 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_discr_list;
18820 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
18821 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_list = discr_list;
18822 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
18825 static inline dw_discr_list_ref
18826 AT_discr_list (dw_attr_node *attr)
18828 return attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_list;
18831 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
18832 /* Output the debug main pointer die for VMS */
18834 void
18835 dwarf2out_vms_debug_main_pointer (void)
18837 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
18838 dw_die_ref die;
18840 /* Allocate the VMS debug main subprogram die. */
18841 die = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
18842 die->die_tag = DW_TAG_subprogram;
18843 add_name_attribute (die, VMS_DEBUG_MAIN_POINTER);
18844 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
18845 current_function_funcdef_no);
18846 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
18848 /* Make it the first child of comp_unit_die (). */
18849 die->die_parent = comp_unit_die ();
18850 if (comp_unit_die ()->die_child)
18852 die->die_sib = comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib;
18853 comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib = die;
18855 else
18857 die->die_sib = die;
18858 comp_unit_die ()->die_child = die;
18861 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
18863 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
18865 static void
18866 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
18868 vec_safe_push (decl_scope_table, scope);
18871 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
18873 static inline void
18874 pop_decl_scope (void)
18876 decl_scope_table->pop ();
18879 /* walk_tree helper function for uses_local_type, below. */
18881 static tree
18882 uses_local_type_r (tree *tp, int *walk_subtrees, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
18884 if (!TYPE_P (*tp))
18885 *walk_subtrees = 0;
18886 else
18888 tree name = TYPE_NAME (*tp);
18889 if (name && DECL_P (name) && decl_function_context (name))
18890 return *tp;
18892 return NULL_TREE;
18895 /* If TYPE involves a function-local type (including a local typedef to a
18896 non-local type), returns that type; otherwise returns NULL_TREE. */
18898 static tree
18899 uses_local_type (tree type)
18901 tree used = walk_tree_without_duplicates (&type, uses_local_type_r, NULL);
18902 return used;
18905 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
18906 Non-named types that do not involve a function-local type get global
18907 scope. Named types nested in namespaces or other types get their
18908 containing scope. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
18909 the current active scope. */
18911 static dw_die_ref
18912 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
18914 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
18915 tree containing_scope;
18917 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
18918 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
18920 /* Use the scope of the typedef, rather than the scope of the type
18921 it refers to. */
18922 if (TYPE_NAME (t) && DECL_P (TYPE_NAME (t)))
18923 containing_scope = DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (t));
18924 else
18925 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
18927 /* Use the containing namespace if there is one. */
18928 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
18930 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
18931 /* OK */;
18932 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18933 context_die = get_context_die (containing_scope);
18934 else
18935 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
18938 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
18939 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
18940 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
18941 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
18942 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
18944 if (SCOPE_FILE_SCOPE_P (containing_scope))
18946 /* If T uses a local type keep it local as well, to avoid references
18947 to function-local DIEs from outside the function. */
18948 if (current_function_decl && uses_local_type (t))
18949 scope_die = context_die;
18950 else
18951 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
18953 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
18955 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. */
18956 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18957 scope_die = get_context_die (containing_scope);
18958 else
18960 scope_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (containing_scope);
18961 if (scope_die == NULL)
18962 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
18965 else
18966 scope_die = context_die;
18968 return scope_die;
18971 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
18973 static inline int
18974 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
18976 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
18977 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
18978 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
18979 return 1;
18981 return 0;
18984 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class. */
18986 static inline int
18987 class_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
18989 return (context_die
18990 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
18991 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
18992 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_interface_type
18993 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type));
18996 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
18997 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
18999 static inline int
19000 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
19002 return (class_scope_p (context_die)
19003 || (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
19006 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
19007 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
19008 by 'type' plus any additional qualifiers given by 'cv_quals', and
19009 adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
19011 static void
19012 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int cv_quals,
19013 bool reverse, dw_die_ref context_die)
19015 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
19016 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
19018 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral, floating-point
19019 or fixed-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
19020 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
19021 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
19022 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE || code == FIXED_POINT_TYPE)
19023 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
19024 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
19026 if (code == ERROR_MARK
19027 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
19028 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
19029 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
19030 || code == VOID_TYPE)
19031 return;
19033 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
19034 cv_quals | TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (type),
19035 reverse,
19036 context_die);
19038 if (type_die != NULL)
19039 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
19042 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
19043 function call type. */
19044 static void
19045 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree decl)
19047 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
19049 value = ((enum dwarf_calling_convention)
19050 targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
19052 if (is_fortran ()
19053 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)), "MAIN__"))
19055 /* DWARF 2 doesn't provide a way to identify a program's source-level
19056 entry point. DW_AT_calling_convention attributes are only meant
19057 to describe functions' calling conventions. However, lacking a
19058 better way to signal the Fortran main program, we used this for
19059 a long time, following existing custom. Now, DWARF 4 has
19060 DW_AT_main_subprogram, which we add below, but some tools still
19061 rely on the old way, which we thus keep. */
19062 value = DW_CC_program;
19064 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
19065 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_main_subprogram, 1);
19068 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
19069 is not DW_CC_normal. */
19070 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
19071 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
19074 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
19075 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
19076 was declared without a tag. */
19078 static const char *
19079 type_tag (const_tree type)
19081 const char *name = 0;
19083 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
19085 tree t = 0;
19087 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
19088 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE
19089 && !TYPE_NAMELESS (type))
19090 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
19092 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
19093 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
19094 involved. */
19095 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
19096 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
19098 /* We want to be extra verbose. Don't call dwarf_name if
19099 DECL_NAME isn't set. The default hook for decl_printable_name
19100 doesn't like that, and in this context it's correct to return
19101 0, instead of "<anonymous>" or the like. */
19102 if (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type))
19103 && !DECL_NAMELESS (TYPE_NAME (type)))
19104 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (TYPE_NAME (type), 2);
19107 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
19108 if (!name && t != 0)
19109 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
19112 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
19115 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
19116 for bit field types. */
19118 static inline tree
19119 member_declared_type (const_tree member)
19121 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
19122 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
19125 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
19126 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
19128 #if 0
19129 static const char *
19130 decl_start_label (tree decl)
19132 rtx x;
19133 const char *fnname;
19135 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
19136 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
19138 x = XEXP (x, 0);
19139 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
19141 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
19142 return fnname;
19144 #endif
19146 /* For variable-length arrays that have been previously generated, but
19147 may be incomplete due to missing subscript info, fill the subscript
19148 info. Return TRUE if this is one of those cases. */
19149 static bool
19150 fill_variable_array_bounds (tree type)
19152 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
19153 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
19154 && variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
19156 dw_die_ref array_die = lookup_type_die (type);
19157 if (!array_die)
19158 return false;
19159 add_subscript_info (array_die, type, !is_ada ());
19160 return true;
19162 return false;
19165 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
19166 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
19167 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
19169 static void
19170 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19172 dw_die_ref array_die;
19174 /* GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of one
19175 dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array types.
19176 We sometimes squish that down to a single array_type DIE with multiple
19177 subscripts in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft Dwarf specification
19178 say that we are allowed to do this kind of compression in C, because
19179 there is no difference between an array of arrays and a multidimensional
19180 array. We don't do this for Ada to remain as close as possible to the
19181 actual representation, which is especially important against the language
19182 flexibilty wrt arrays of variable size. */
19184 bool collapse_nested_arrays = !is_ada ();
19186 if (fill_variable_array_bounds (type))
19187 return;
19189 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
19190 tree element_type;
19192 /* Emit DW_TAG_string_type for Fortran character types (with kind 1 only, as
19193 DW_TAG_string_type doesn't have DW_AT_type attribute). */
19194 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type)
19195 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
19196 && is_fortran ()
19197 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == TYPE_MODE (char_type_node))
19199 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
19201 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_string_type, scope_die, type);
19202 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
19203 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
19204 size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
19205 if (size >= 0)
19206 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
19207 else if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) != NULL_TREE
19208 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)) != NULL_TREE
19209 && DECL_P (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type))))
19211 tree szdecl = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type));
19212 dw_loc_list_ref loc = loc_list_from_tree (szdecl, 2, NULL);
19214 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (szdecl));
19215 if (loc && size > 0)
19217 add_AT_location_description (array_die, DW_AT_string_length, loc);
19218 if (size != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
19219 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
19222 return;
19225 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
19226 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
19227 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
19229 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
19230 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
19232 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
19233 if (is_fortran ()
19234 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
19235 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == ARRAY_TYPE
19236 && !TYPE_STRING_FLAG (TREE_TYPE (type)))
19237 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
19239 #if 0
19240 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
19241 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
19242 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
19243 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
19244 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
19245 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
19246 for multidimensional arrays. */
19247 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
19248 #endif
19250 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
19252 /* For VECTOR_TYPEs we use an array die with appropriate bounds. */
19253 dw_die_ref subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
19254 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, size_zero_node, NULL);
19255 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
19256 size_int (TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type) - 1), NULL);
19258 else
19259 add_subscript_info (array_die, type, collapse_nested_arrays);
19261 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type and
19262 emit the corresponding DIE if we haven't done it already. */
19263 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
19264 if (collapse_nested_arrays)
19265 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
19267 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (element_type) && is_fortran ())
19268 break;
19269 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
19272 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
19273 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
19274 && TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type),
19275 context_die);
19277 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (array_die, type, context_die);
19278 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
19279 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19281 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
19282 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
19285 /* This routine generates DIE for array with hidden descriptor, details
19286 are filled into *info by a langhook. */
19288 static void
19289 gen_descr_array_type_die (tree type, struct array_descr_info *info,
19290 dw_die_ref context_die)
19292 const dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
19293 const dw_die_ref array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
19294 const struct loc_descr_context context = { type, info->base_decl, NULL };
19295 int dim;
19297 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
19298 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
19300 if (info->ndimensions > 1)
19301 switch (info->ordering)
19303 case array_descr_ordering_row_major:
19304 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
19305 break;
19306 case array_descr_ordering_column_major:
19307 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
19308 break;
19309 default:
19310 break;
19313 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19315 if (info->data_location)
19316 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_data_location, info->data_location,
19317 dw_scalar_form_exprloc, &context);
19318 if (info->associated)
19319 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_associated, info->associated,
19320 dw_scalar_form_constant
19321 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
19322 | dw_scalar_form_reference, &context);
19323 if (info->allocated)
19324 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_allocated, info->allocated,
19325 dw_scalar_form_constant
19326 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
19327 | dw_scalar_form_reference, &context);
19328 if (info->stride)
19330 const enum dwarf_attribute attr
19331 = (info->stride_in_bits) ? DW_AT_bit_stride : DW_AT_byte_stride;
19332 const int forms
19333 = (info->stride_in_bits)
19334 ? dw_scalar_form_constant
19335 : (dw_scalar_form_constant
19336 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
19337 | dw_scalar_form_reference);
19339 add_scalar_info (array_die, attr, info->stride, forms, &context);
19343 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (array_die, type, context_die);
19345 for (dim = 0; dim < info->ndimensions; dim++)
19347 dw_die_ref subrange_die
19348 = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
19350 if (info->dimen[dim].bounds_type)
19351 add_type_attribute (subrange_die,
19352 info->dimen[dim].bounds_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
19353 false, context_die);
19354 if (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound)
19355 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
19356 info->dimen[dim].lower_bound, &context);
19357 if (info->dimen[dim].upper_bound)
19358 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
19359 info->dimen[dim].upper_bound, &context);
19360 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict) && info->dimen[dim].stride)
19361 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_stride,
19362 info->dimen[dim].stride,
19363 dw_scalar_form_constant
19364 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
19365 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
19366 &context);
19369 gen_type_die (info->element_type, context_die);
19370 add_type_attribute (array_die, info->element_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
19371 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
19372 && TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type),
19373 context_die);
19375 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
19376 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
19379 #if 0
19380 static void
19381 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
19383 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
19384 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
19386 if (origin != NULL)
19387 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
19388 else
19390 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
19391 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
19392 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
19395 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
19396 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
19397 else
19398 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
19400 #endif
19402 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
19403 emit full debugging info for them. */
19405 static void
19406 retry_incomplete_types (void)
19408 set_early_dwarf s;
19409 int i;
19411 for (i = vec_safe_length (incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
19412 if (should_emit_struct_debug ((*incomplete_types)[i], DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
19413 gen_type_die ((*incomplete_types)[i], comp_unit_die ());
19414 vec_safe_truncate (incomplete_types, 0);
19417 /* Determine what tag to use for a record type. */
19419 static enum dwarf_tag
19420 record_type_tag (tree type)
19422 if (! lang_hooks.types.classify_record)
19423 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
19425 switch (lang_hooks.types.classify_record (type))
19427 case RECORD_IS_STRUCT:
19428 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
19430 case RECORD_IS_CLASS:
19431 return DW_TAG_class_type;
19433 case RECORD_IS_INTERFACE:
19434 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19435 return DW_TAG_interface_type;
19436 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
19438 default:
19439 gcc_unreachable ();
19443 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
19444 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
19445 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
19446 DIE. */
19448 static dw_die_ref
19449 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19451 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
19453 if (type_die == NULL)
19455 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
19456 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
19457 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
19458 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
19459 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
19461 if (ENUM_IS_SCOPED (type))
19462 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_enum_class, 1);
19463 if (ENUM_IS_OPAQUE (type))
19464 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19467 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
19468 return type_die;
19469 else
19470 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
19472 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
19473 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
19474 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
19475 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
19477 tree link;
19479 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
19480 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
19481 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19483 tree underlying = lang_hooks.types.enum_underlying_base_type (type);
19484 add_type_attribute (type_die, underlying, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
19485 context_die);
19487 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
19489 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
19490 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
19493 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
19494 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
19495 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
19496 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
19498 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
19499 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
19501 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
19502 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
19504 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
19505 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
19507 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONST_DECL)
19508 value = DECL_INITIAL (value);
19510 if (simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (value))
19511 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT || tree_fits_shwi_p (value))
19513 /* For constant forms created by add_AT_unsigned DWARF
19514 consumers (GDB, elfutils, etc.) always zero extend
19515 the value. Only when the actual value is negative
19516 do we need to use add_AT_int to generate a constant
19517 form that can represent negative values. */
19518 HOST_WIDE_INT val = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value);
19519 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value)) || val >= 0)
19520 add_AT_unsigned (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
19521 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
19522 else
19523 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
19525 else
19526 /* Enumeration constants may be wider than HOST_WIDE_INT. Handle
19527 that here. TODO: This should be re-worked to use correct
19528 signed/unsigned double tags for all cases. */
19529 add_AT_wide (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value, value);
19532 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
19533 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
19534 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19536 else
19537 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19539 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
19541 return type_die;
19544 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
19545 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
19546 type.
19548 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
19549 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
19550 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
19551 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
19552 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
19553 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
19554 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
19555 argument type of some subprogram type.
19556 If EMIT_NAME_P is true, name and source coordinate attributes
19557 are emitted. */
19559 static dw_die_ref
19560 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, tree origin, bool emit_name_p,
19561 dw_die_ref context_die)
19563 tree node_or_origin = node ? node : origin;
19564 tree ultimate_origin;
19565 dw_die_ref parm_die = NULL;
19567 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node_or_origin)) == tcc_declaration)
19569 parm_die = lookup_decl_die (node);
19571 /* If the contexts differ, we may not be talking about the same
19572 thing. */
19573 if (parm_die && parm_die->die_parent != context_die)
19575 if (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node))
19577 /* This can happen when creating an inlined instance, in
19578 which case we need to create a new DIE that will get
19579 annotated with DW_AT_abstract_origin. */
19580 parm_die = NULL;
19582 else
19584 /* FIXME: Reuse DIE even with a differing context.
19586 This can happen when calling
19587 dwarf2out_abstract_function to build debug info for
19588 the abstract instance of a function for which we have
19589 already generated a DIE in
19590 dwarf2out_early_global_decl.
19592 Once we remove dwarf2out_abstract_function, we should
19593 have a call to gcc_unreachable here. */
19597 if (parm_die && parm_die->die_parent == NULL)
19599 /* Check that parm_die already has the right attributes that
19600 we would have added below. If any attributes are
19601 missing, fall through to add them. */
19602 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin)
19603 && !get_AT (parm_die, DW_AT_location)
19604 && !get_AT (parm_die, DW_AT_const_value))
19605 /* We are missing location info, and are about to add it. */
19607 else
19609 add_child_die (context_die, parm_die);
19610 return parm_die;
19615 /* If we have a previously generated DIE, use it, unless this is an
19616 concrete instance (origin != NULL), in which case we need a new
19617 DIE with a corresponding DW_AT_abstract_origin. */
19618 bool reusing_die;
19619 if (parm_die && origin == NULL)
19620 reusing_die = true;
19621 else
19623 parm_die = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
19624 reusing_die = false;
19627 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node_or_origin)))
19629 case tcc_declaration:
19630 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node_or_origin);
19631 if (node || ultimate_origin)
19632 origin = ultimate_origin;
19634 if (reusing_die)
19635 goto add_location;
19637 if (origin != NULL)
19638 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
19639 else if (emit_name_p)
19640 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
19641 if (origin == NULL
19642 || (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin)
19643 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin),
19644 decl_function_context
19645 (node_or_origin))))
19647 tree type = TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin);
19648 if (decl_by_reference_p (node_or_origin))
19649 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (type),
19650 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
19651 false, context_die);
19652 else
19653 add_type_attribute (parm_die, type,
19654 decl_quals (node_or_origin),
19655 false, context_die);
19657 if (origin == NULL && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
19658 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19659 add_location:
19660 if (node && node != origin)
19661 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
19662 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin))
19663 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin,
19664 node == NULL);
19666 break;
19668 case tcc_type:
19669 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
19670 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
19671 context_die);
19672 break;
19674 default:
19675 gcc_unreachable ();
19678 return parm_die;
19681 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack. Also generate
19682 children DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs representing the arguments of the
19683 parameter pack.
19685 PARM_PACK must be a function parameter pack.
19686 PACK_ARG is the first argument of the parameter pack. Its TREE_CHAIN
19687 must point to the subsequent arguments of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
19688 SUBR_DIE is the DIE of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
19689 If NEXT_ARG is non NULL, *NEXT_ARG is set to the function argument
19690 following the last one for which a DIE was generated. */
19692 static dw_die_ref
19693 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
19694 tree pack_arg,
19695 dw_die_ref subr_die,
19696 tree *next_arg)
19698 tree arg;
19699 dw_die_ref parm_pack_die;
19701 gcc_assert (parm_pack
19702 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (parm_pack)
19703 && subr_die);
19705 parm_pack_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack, subr_die, parm_pack);
19706 add_src_coords_attributes (parm_pack_die, parm_pack);
19708 for (arg = pack_arg; arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
19710 if (! lang_hooks.decls.function_parm_expanded_from_pack_p (arg,
19711 parm_pack))
19712 break;
19713 gen_formal_parameter_die (arg, NULL,
19714 false /* Don't emit name attribute. */,
19715 parm_pack_die);
19717 if (next_arg)
19718 *next_arg = arg;
19719 return parm_pack_die;
19722 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
19723 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
19725 static void
19726 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19728 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
19731 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
19732 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
19733 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
19734 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
19736 static void
19737 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19739 tree link;
19740 tree formal_type = NULL;
19741 tree first_parm_type;
19742 tree arg;
19744 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
19746 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
19747 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
19749 else
19750 arg = NULL_TREE;
19752 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
19754 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
19755 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
19756 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
19758 dw_die_ref parm_die;
19760 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
19761 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
19762 break;
19764 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
19765 if (!POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE_P (formal_type))
19767 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, NULL,
19768 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
19769 context_die);
19770 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
19771 && link == first_parm_type)
19773 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19774 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19775 add_AT_die_ref (context_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
19777 else if (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg))
19778 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19781 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
19782 if (arg)
19783 arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg);
19786 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
19787 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
19788 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
19789 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
19791 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
19792 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
19793 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
19794 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
19795 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
19796 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
19799 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
19800 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
19801 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
19802 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
19803 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
19805 static void
19806 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
19808 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
19810 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
19811 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
19812 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
19813 && TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
19814 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
19816 dw_die_ref type_die;
19817 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
19819 push_decl_scope (type);
19820 type_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (type);
19821 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
19822 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
19823 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
19825 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
19826 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
19827 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
19828 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
19829 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
19831 struct vlr_context vlr_ctx = {
19832 DECL_CONTEXT (member), /* struct_type */
19833 NULL_TREE /* variant_part_offset */
19835 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
19836 gen_field_die (member, &vlr_ctx, type_die);
19839 else
19840 gen_variable_die (member, NULL_TREE, type_die);
19842 pop_decl_scope ();
19846 /* Forward declare these functions, because they are mutually recursive
19847 with their set_block_* pairing functions. */
19848 static void set_decl_origin_self (tree);
19849 static void set_decl_abstract_flags (tree, vec<tree> &);
19851 /* Given a pointer to some BLOCK node, if the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the
19852 given BLOCK node is NULL, set the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the node so
19853 that it points to the node itself, thus indicating that the node is its
19854 own (abstract) origin. Additionally, if the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for
19855 the given node is NULL, recursively descend the decl/block tree which
19856 it is the root of, and for each other ..._DECL or BLOCK node contained
19857 therein whose DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs are also
19858 still NULL, set *their* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
19859 values to point to themselves. */
19861 static void
19862 set_block_origin_self (tree stmt)
19864 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt) == NULL_TREE)
19866 BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt) = stmt;
19869 tree local_decl;
19871 for (local_decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
19872 local_decl != NULL_TREE;
19873 local_decl = DECL_CHAIN (local_decl))
19874 /* Do not recurse on nested functions since the inlining status
19875 of parent and child can be different as per the DWARF spec. */
19876 if (TREE_CODE (local_decl) != FUNCTION_DECL
19877 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (local_decl))
19878 set_decl_origin_self (local_decl);
19882 tree subblock;
19884 for (subblock = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
19885 subblock != NULL_TREE;
19886 subblock = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblock))
19887 set_block_origin_self (subblock); /* Recurse. */
19892 /* Given a pointer to some ..._DECL node, if the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for
19893 the given ..._DECL node is NULL, set the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the
19894 node to so that it points to the node itself, thus indicating that the
19895 node represents its own (abstract) origin. Additionally, if the
19896 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the given node is NULL, recursively descend
19897 the decl/block tree of which the given node is the root of, and for
19898 each other ..._DECL or BLOCK node contained therein whose
19899 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs are also still NULL,
19900 set *their* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN values to
19901 point to themselves. */
19903 static void
19904 set_decl_origin_self (tree decl)
19906 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL_TREE)
19908 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) = decl;
19909 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
19911 tree arg;
19913 for (arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl); arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
19914 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (arg) = arg;
19915 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE
19916 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != error_mark_node)
19917 set_block_origin_self (DECL_INITIAL (decl));
19922 /* Given a pointer to some BLOCK node, set the BLOCK_ABSTRACT flag to 1
19923 and if it wasn't 1 before, push it to abstract_vec vector.
19924 For all local decls and all local sub-blocks (recursively) do it
19925 too. */
19927 static void
19928 set_block_abstract_flags (tree stmt, vec<tree> &abstract_vec)
19930 tree local_decl;
19931 tree subblock;
19932 unsigned int i;
19934 if (!BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
19936 abstract_vec.safe_push (stmt);
19937 BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt) = 1;
19940 for (local_decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
19941 local_decl != NULL_TREE;
19942 local_decl = DECL_CHAIN (local_decl))
19943 if (! DECL_EXTERNAL (local_decl))
19944 set_decl_abstract_flags (local_decl, abstract_vec);
19946 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt); i++)
19948 local_decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (stmt, i);
19949 if ((TREE_CODE (local_decl) == VAR_DECL && !TREE_STATIC (local_decl))
19950 || TREE_CODE (local_decl) == PARM_DECL)
19951 set_decl_abstract_flags (local_decl, abstract_vec);
19954 for (subblock = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
19955 subblock != NULL_TREE;
19956 subblock = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblock))
19957 set_block_abstract_flags (subblock, abstract_vec);
19960 /* Given a pointer to some ..._DECL node, set DECL_ABSTRACT_P flag on it
19961 to 1 and if it wasn't 1 before, push to abstract_vec vector.
19962 In the case where the decl is a FUNCTION_DECL also set the abstract
19963 flags for all of the parameters, local vars, local
19964 blocks and sub-blocks (recursively). */
19966 static void
19967 set_decl_abstract_flags (tree decl, vec<tree> &abstract_vec)
19969 if (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
19971 abstract_vec.safe_push (decl);
19972 DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl) = 1;
19975 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
19977 tree arg;
19979 for (arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl); arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
19980 if (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (arg))
19982 abstract_vec.safe_push (arg);
19983 DECL_ABSTRACT_P (arg) = 1;
19985 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE
19986 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != error_mark_node)
19987 set_block_abstract_flags (DECL_INITIAL (decl), abstract_vec);
19991 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
19992 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of.
19994 FIXME: In the early-dwarf world, this function, and most of the
19995 DECL_ABSTRACT code should be obsoleted. The early DIE _is_
19996 the abstract instance. All we would need to do is annotate
19997 the early DIE with the appropriate DW_AT_inline in late
19998 dwarf (perhaps in gen_inlined_subroutine_die).
20000 However, we can't do this yet, because LTO streaming of DIEs
20001 has not been implemented yet. */
20003 static void
20004 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
20006 dw_die_ref old_die;
20007 tree save_fn;
20008 tree context;
20009 hash_table<decl_loc_hasher> *old_decl_loc_table;
20010 hash_table<dw_loc_list_hasher> *old_cached_dw_loc_list_table;
20011 int old_call_site_count, old_tail_call_site_count;
20012 struct call_arg_loc_node *old_call_arg_locations;
20014 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
20015 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
20017 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
20018 if (old_die && get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
20019 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
20020 return;
20022 /* We can be called while recursively when seeing block defining inlined subroutine
20023 DIE. Be sure to not clobber the outer location table nor use it or we would
20024 get locations in abstract instantces. */
20025 old_decl_loc_table = decl_loc_table;
20026 decl_loc_table = NULL;
20027 old_cached_dw_loc_list_table = cached_dw_loc_list_table;
20028 cached_dw_loc_list_table = NULL;
20029 old_call_arg_locations = call_arg_locations;
20030 call_arg_locations = NULL;
20031 old_call_site_count = call_site_count;
20032 call_site_count = -1;
20033 old_tail_call_site_count = tail_call_site_count;
20034 tail_call_site_count = -1;
20036 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
20037 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT_P. */
20038 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20040 context = decl_class_context (decl);
20041 if (context)
20042 gen_type_die_for_member
20043 (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die ());
20046 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
20047 save_fn = current_function_decl;
20048 current_function_decl = decl;
20050 auto_vec<tree, 64> abstract_vec;
20051 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, abstract_vec);
20052 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
20053 unsigned int i;
20054 tree t;
20055 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (abstract_vec, i, t)
20056 if (TREE_CODE (t) == BLOCK)
20057 BLOCK_ABSTRACT (t) = 0;
20058 else
20059 DECL_ABSTRACT_P (t) = 0;
20061 current_function_decl = save_fn;
20062 decl_loc_table = old_decl_loc_table;
20063 cached_dw_loc_list_table = old_cached_dw_loc_list_table;
20064 call_arg_locations = old_call_arg_locations;
20065 call_site_count = old_call_site_count;
20066 tail_call_site_count = old_tail_call_site_count;
20069 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
20070 htab_traverse.
20072 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
20073 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. */
20075 bool
20076 premark_used_types_helper (tree const &type, void *)
20078 dw_die_ref die;
20080 die = lookup_type_die (type);
20081 if (die != NULL)
20082 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
20083 return true;
20086 /* Helper function of premark_types_used_by_global_vars which gets called
20087 through htab_traverse.
20089 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
20090 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. The DIE of the type is marked
20091 only if the global variable using the type will actually be emitted. */
20094 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper (types_used_by_vars_entry **slot,
20095 void *)
20097 struct types_used_by_vars_entry *entry;
20098 dw_die_ref die;
20100 entry = (struct types_used_by_vars_entry *) *slot;
20101 gcc_assert (entry->type != NULL
20102 && entry->var_decl != NULL);
20103 die = lookup_type_die (entry->type);
20104 if (die)
20106 /* Ask cgraph if the global variable really is to be emitted.
20107 If yes, then we'll keep the DIE of ENTRY->TYPE. */
20108 varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (entry->var_decl);
20109 if (node && node->definition)
20111 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
20112 /* Keep the parent DIEs as well. */
20113 while ((die = die->die_parent) && die->die_perennial_p == 0)
20114 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
20117 return 1;
20120 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial. */
20122 static void
20123 premark_used_types (struct function *fun)
20125 if (fun && fun->used_types_hash)
20126 fun->used_types_hash->traverse<void *, premark_used_types_helper> (NULL);
20129 /* Mark all members of types_used_by_vars_entry as perennial. */
20131 static void
20132 premark_types_used_by_global_vars (void)
20134 if (types_used_by_vars_hash)
20135 types_used_by_vars_hash
20136 ->traverse<void *, premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper> (NULL);
20139 /* Generate a DW_TAG_GNU_call_site DIE in function DECL under SUBR_DIE
20140 for CA_LOC call arg loc node. */
20142 static dw_die_ref
20143 gen_call_site_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref subr_die,
20144 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc)
20146 dw_die_ref stmt_die = NULL, die;
20147 tree block = ca_loc->block;
20149 while (block
20150 && block != DECL_INITIAL (decl)
20151 && TREE_CODE (block) == BLOCK)
20153 stmt_die = BLOCK_DIE (block);
20154 if (stmt_die)
20155 break;
20156 block = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (block);
20158 if (stmt_die == NULL)
20159 stmt_die = subr_die;
20160 die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_call_site, stmt_die, NULL_TREE);
20161 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, ca_loc->label);
20162 if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
20163 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_GNU_tail_call, 1);
20164 if (ca_loc->symbol_ref)
20166 dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (ca_loc->symbol_ref));
20167 if (tdie)
20168 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, tdie);
20169 else
20170 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, ca_loc->symbol_ref, false);
20172 return die;
20175 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
20176 block-local). */
20178 static void
20179 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
20181 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
20182 dw_die_ref subr_die;
20183 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
20185 /* This function gets called multiple times for different stages of
20186 the debug process. For example, for func() in this code:
20188 namespace S
20190 void func() { ... }
20193 ...we get called 4 times. Twice in early debug and twice in
20194 late debug:
20196 Early debug
20197 -----------
20199 1. Once while generating func() within the namespace. This is
20200 the declaration. The declaration bit below is set, as the
20201 context is the namespace.
20203 A new DIE will be generated with DW_AT_declaration set.
20205 2. Once for func() itself. This is the specification. The
20206 declaration bit below is clear as the context is the CU.
20208 We will use the cached DIE from (1) to create a new DIE with
20209 DW_AT_specification pointing to the declaration in (1).
20211 Late debug via rest_of_handle_final()
20212 -------------------------------------
20214 3. Once generating func() within the namespace. This is also the
20215 declaration, as in (1), but this time we will early exit below
20216 as we have a cached DIE and a declaration needs no additional
20217 annotations (no locations), as the source declaration line
20218 info is enough.
20220 4. Once for func() itself. As in (2), this is the specification,
20221 but this time we will re-use the cached DIE, and just annotate
20222 it with the location information that should now be available.
20224 For something without namespaces, but with abstract instances, we
20225 are also called a multiple times:
20227 class Base
20229 public:
20230 Base (); // constructor declaration (1)
20233 Base::Base () { } // constructor specification (2)
20235 Early debug
20236 -----------
20238 1. Once for the Base() constructor by virtue of it being a
20239 member of the Base class. This is done via
20240 rest_of_type_compilation.
20242 This is a declaration, so a new DIE will be created with
20243 DW_AT_declaration.
20245 2. Once for the Base() constructor definition, but this time
20246 while generating the abstract instance of the base
20247 constructor (__base_ctor) which is being generated via early
20248 debug of reachable functions.
20250 Even though we have a cached version of the declaration (1),
20251 we will create a DW_AT_specification of the declaration DIE
20252 in (1).
20254 3. Once for the __base_ctor itself, but this time, we generate
20255 an DW_AT_abstract_origin version of the DW_AT_specification in
20256 (2).
20258 Late debug via rest_of_handle_final
20259 -----------------------------------
20261 4. One final time for the __base_ctor (which will have a cached
20262 DIE with DW_AT_abstract_origin created in (3). This time,
20263 we will just annotate the location information now
20264 available.
20266 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
20267 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
20269 premark_used_types (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
20271 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
20272 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
20273 if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
20274 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
20275 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
20276 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20277 old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
20279 /* An inlined instance, tag a new DIE with DW_AT_abstract_origin. */
20280 if (origin != NULL)
20282 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
20284 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
20285 inline function. */
20286 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
20287 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
20289 if (old_die && get_AT_ref (old_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
20291 /* If we have a DW_AT_abstract_origin we have a working
20292 cached version. */
20293 subr_die = old_die;
20295 else
20297 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
20298 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
20299 /* This is where the actual code for a cloned function is.
20300 Let's emit linkage name attribute for it. This helps
20301 debuggers to e.g, set breakpoints into
20302 constructors/destructors when the user asks "break
20303 K::K". */
20304 add_linkage_name (subr_die, decl);
20307 /* A cached copy, possibly from early dwarf generation. Reuse as
20308 much as possible. */
20309 else if (old_die)
20311 /* A declaration that has been previously dumped needs no
20312 additional information. */
20313 if (declaration)
20314 return;
20316 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
20317 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
20318 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
20319 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
20320 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
20322 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
20323 something we have already output. */
20324 if (get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_low_pc)
20325 || get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_ranges))
20326 return;
20328 /* If we have no location information, this must be a
20329 partially generated DIE from early dwarf generation.
20330 Fall through and generate it. */
20333 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
20334 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
20335 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
20336 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
20337 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
20338 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
20339 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
20340 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
20341 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
20342 if ((is_cu_die (old_die->die_parent)
20343 /* This condition fixes the inconsistency/ICE with the
20344 following Fortran test (or some derivative thereof) while
20345 building libgfortran:
20347 module some_m
20348 contains
20349 logical function funky (FLAG)
20350 funky = .true.
20351 end function
20352 end module
20354 || (old_die->die_parent
20355 && old_die->die_parent->die_tag == DW_TAG_module)
20356 || context_die == NULL)
20357 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
20358 || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
20359 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
20360 == (unsigned) s.line))))
20362 subr_die = old_die;
20364 /* Clear out the declaration attribute, but leave the
20365 parameters so they can be augmented with location
20366 information later. Unless this was a declaration, in
20367 which case, wipe out the nameless parameters and recreate
20368 them further down. */
20369 if (remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration))
20372 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer);
20373 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
20376 /* Make a specification pointing to the previously built
20377 declaration. */
20378 else
20380 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
20381 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
20382 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
20383 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
20384 add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
20385 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
20386 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
20388 /* If the prototype had an 'auto' or 'decltype(auto)' return type,
20389 emit the real type on the definition die. */
20390 if (is_cxx() && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20392 dw_die_ref die = get_AT_ref (old_die, DW_AT_type);
20393 if (die == auto_die || die == decltype_auto_die)
20394 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
20395 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
20399 /* Create a fresh DIE for anything else. */
20400 else
20402 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
20404 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
20405 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
20407 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
20408 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
20409 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20411 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
20412 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
20413 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
20416 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
20417 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
20418 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
20420 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict))
20421 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_noreturn, 1);
20423 add_accessibility_attribute (subr_die, decl);
20426 /* Unless we have an existing non-declaration DIE, equate the new
20427 DIE. */
20428 if (!old_die || is_declaration_die (old_die))
20429 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
20431 if (declaration)
20433 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
20435 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
20437 /* If this is an explicit function declaration then generate
20438 a DW_AT_explicit attribute. */
20439 if (lang_hooks.decls.function_decl_explicit_p (decl)
20440 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
20441 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_explicit, 1);
20443 /* If this is a C++11 deleted special function member then generate
20444 a DW_AT_GNU_deleted attribute. */
20445 if (lang_hooks.decls.function_decl_deleted_p (decl)
20446 && (! dwarf_strict))
20447 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_GNU_deleted, 1);
20450 /* Tag abstract instances with DW_AT_inline. */
20451 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
20453 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
20455 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
20456 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
20457 else
20458 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
20460 else
20462 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
20463 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
20464 else
20465 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
20468 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl)
20469 && lookup_attribute ("artificial", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)))
20470 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
20472 /* For non DECL_EXTERNALs, if range information is available, fill
20473 the DIE with it. */
20474 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !early_dwarf)
20476 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
20478 struct function *fun = DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl);
20480 if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
20482 dw_fde_ref fde = fun->fde;
20483 if (fde->dw_fde_begin)
20485 /* We have already generated the labels. */
20486 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
20487 fde->dw_fde_end, false);
20489 else
20491 /* Create start/end labels and add the range. */
20492 char label_id_low[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
20493 char label_id_high[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
20494 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id_low, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
20495 current_function_funcdef_no);
20496 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id_high, FUNC_END_LABEL,
20497 current_function_funcdef_no);
20498 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, label_id_low, label_id_high,
20499 false);
20502 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
20503 /* HP OpenVMS Industry Standard 64: DWARF Extensions
20504 Section 2.3 Prologue and Epilogue Attributes:
20505 When a breakpoint is set on entry to a function, it is generally
20506 desirable for execution to be suspended, not on the very first
20507 instruction of the function, but rather at a point after the
20508 function's frame has been set up, after any language defined local
20509 declaration processing has been completed, and before execution of
20510 the first statement of the function begins. Debuggers generally
20511 cannot properly determine where this point is. Similarly for a
20512 breakpoint set on exit from a function. The prologue and epilogue
20513 attributes allow a compiler to communicate the location(s) to use. */
20516 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue)
20517 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_prologue,
20518 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue);
20520 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
20521 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_epilogue,
20522 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue);
20524 #endif
20527 else
20529 /* Generate pubnames entries for the split function code ranges. */
20530 dw_fde_ref fde = fun->fde;
20532 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin)
20534 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
20536 /* We should use ranges for non-contiguous code section
20537 addresses. Use the actual code range for the initial
20538 section, since the HOT/COLD labels might precede an
20539 alignment offset. */
20540 bool range_list_added = false;
20541 add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
20542 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added,
20543 false);
20544 add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
20545 fde->dw_fde_second_end,
20546 &range_list_added, false);
20547 if (range_list_added)
20548 add_ranges (NULL);
20550 else
20552 /* There is no real support in DW2 for this .. so we make
20553 a work-around. First, emit the pub name for the segment
20554 containing the function label. Then make and emit a
20555 simplified subprogram DIE for the second segment with the
20556 name pre-fixed by __hot/cold_sect_of_. We use the same
20557 linkage name for the second die so that gdb will find both
20558 sections when given "b foo". */
20559 const char *name = NULL;
20560 tree decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
20561 dw_die_ref seg_die;
20563 /* Do the 'primary' section. */
20564 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
20565 fde->dw_fde_end, false);
20567 /* Build a minimal DIE for the secondary section. */
20568 seg_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram,
20569 subr_die->die_parent, decl);
20571 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
20572 add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
20574 if (decl_name != NULL
20575 && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
20577 name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
20578 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
20579 add_src_coords_attributes (seg_die, decl);
20581 add_linkage_name (seg_die, decl);
20583 gcc_assert (name != NULL);
20584 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (seg_die, decl);
20585 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
20586 add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
20588 name = concat ("__second_sect_of_", name, NULL);
20589 add_AT_low_high_pc (seg_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
20590 fde->dw_fde_second_end, false);
20591 add_name_attribute (seg_die, name);
20592 if (want_pubnames ())
20593 add_pubname_string (name, seg_die);
20596 else
20597 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_end,
20598 false);
20601 cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
20603 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
20604 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
20605 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
20606 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
20607 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
20608 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
20609 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
20610 function. */
20611 if (dwarf_version >= 3 && targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
20613 dw_loc_descr_ref op = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call_frame_cfa, 0, 0);
20614 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, op);
20616 else
20618 dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
20619 if (list->dw_loc_next)
20620 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
20621 else
20622 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
20625 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
20626 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
20627 will reference in the rtl; the latter is what we've told the
20628 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
20629 by this displacement. */
20630 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
20632 if (fun->static_chain_decl)
20634 /* DWARF requires here a location expression that computes the
20635 address of the enclosing subprogram's frame base. The machinery
20636 in tree-nested.c is supposed to store this specific address in the
20637 last field of the FRAME record. */
20638 const tree frame_type
20639 = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (fun->static_chain_decl));
20640 const tree fb_decl = tree_last (TYPE_FIELDS (frame_type));
20642 tree fb_expr
20643 = build1 (INDIRECT_REF, frame_type, fun->static_chain_decl);
20644 fb_expr = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (fb_decl),
20645 fb_expr, fb_decl, NULL_TREE);
20647 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
20648 loc_list_from_tree (fb_expr, 0, NULL));
20652 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
20653 if (early_dwarf && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20654 gen_generic_params_dies (decl);
20656 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
20657 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
20658 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
20659 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
20660 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
20661 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
20662 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
20663 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
20664 an ellipsis at the end. */
20666 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
20667 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
20668 its formal parameters. */
20669 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20671 else if (declaration)
20672 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
20673 else
20675 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
20676 tree parm = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
20677 tree generic_decl = early_dwarf
20678 ? lang_hooks.decls.get_generic_function_decl (decl) : NULL;
20679 tree generic_decl_parm = generic_decl
20680 ? DECL_ARGUMENTS (generic_decl)
20681 : NULL;
20683 /* Now we want to walk the list of parameters of the function and
20684 emit their relevant DIEs.
20686 We consider the case of DECL being an instance of a generic function
20687 as well as it being a normal function.
20689 If DECL is an instance of a generic function we walk the
20690 parameters of the generic function declaration _and_ the parameters of
20691 DECL itself. This is useful because we want to emit specific DIEs for
20692 function parameter packs and those are declared as part of the
20693 generic function declaration. In that particular case,
20694 the parameter pack yields a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE.
20695 That DIE has children DIEs representing the set of arguments
20696 of the pack. Note that the set of pack arguments can be empty.
20697 In that case, the DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE will not have any
20698 children DIE.
20700 Otherwise, we just consider the parameters of DECL. */
20701 while (generic_decl_parm || parm)
20703 if (generic_decl_parm
20704 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (generic_decl_parm))
20705 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (generic_decl_parm,
20706 parm, subr_die,
20707 &parm);
20708 else if (parm && !POINTER_BOUNDS_P (parm))
20710 dw_die_ref parm_die = gen_decl_die (parm, NULL, NULL, subr_die);
20712 if (parm == DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl)
20713 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == METHOD_TYPE
20714 && parm_die
20715 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
20716 add_AT_die_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
20718 parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
20720 else if (parm)
20721 parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
20723 if (generic_decl_parm)
20724 generic_decl_parm = DECL_CHAIN (generic_decl_parm);
20727 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
20728 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
20729 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
20730 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
20731 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
20732 parameters at all. */
20733 if (prototype_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
20735 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
20736 if (stdarg_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
20737 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
20739 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
20740 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
20743 if (subr_die != old_die)
20744 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
20745 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, decl);
20747 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
20748 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration).
20750 OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
20751 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
20752 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
20753 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
20754 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
20755 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
20756 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
20758 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
20759 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
20760 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
20761 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
20762 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
20763 constructor function. */
20764 tree outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
20765 if (! declaration && outer_scope && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
20767 int call_site_note_count = 0;
20768 int tail_call_site_note_count = 0;
20770 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
20771 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
20772 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), NULL, NULL, subr_die);
20774 /* The first time through decls_for_scope we will generate the
20775 DIEs for the locals. The second time, we fill in the
20776 location info. */
20777 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die);
20779 if (call_arg_locations && !dwarf_strict)
20781 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc;
20782 for (ca_loc = call_arg_locations; ca_loc; ca_loc = ca_loc->next)
20784 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
20785 rtx tloc = NULL_RTX, tlocc = NULL_RTX;
20786 rtx arg, next_arg;
20788 for (arg = (ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note != NULL_RTX
20789 ? NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note)
20790 : NULL_RTX);
20791 arg; arg = next_arg)
20793 dw_loc_descr_ref reg, val;
20794 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1));
20795 dw_die_ref cdie, tdie = NULL;
20797 next_arg = XEXP (arg, 1);
20798 if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
20799 && next_arg
20800 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0))
20801 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0))
20802 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
20803 == REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0)))
20804 next_arg = XEXP (next_arg, 1);
20805 if (mode == VOIDmode)
20807 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0));
20808 if (mode == VOIDmode)
20809 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (arg, 0));
20811 if (mode == VOIDmode || mode == BLKmode)
20812 continue;
20813 /* Get dynamic information about call target only if we
20814 have no static information: we cannot generate both
20815 DW_AT_abstract_origin and DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target
20816 attributes. */
20817 if (ca_loc->symbol_ref == NULL_RTX)
20819 if (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
20821 tloc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
20822 continue;
20824 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)) == CLOBBER
20825 && XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
20827 tlocc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
20828 continue;
20831 reg = NULL;
20832 if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
20833 reg = reg_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0),
20834 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
20835 else if (MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
20837 rtx mem = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0);
20838 reg = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (mem, 0),
20839 get_address_mode (mem),
20840 GET_MODE (mem),
20841 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
20843 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
20844 == DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF)
20846 tree tdecl
20847 = DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0));
20848 tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
20849 if (tdie == NULL)
20850 continue;
20852 else
20853 continue;
20854 if (reg == NULL
20855 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
20856 != DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF)
20857 continue;
20858 val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1), mode,
20859 VOIDmode,
20860 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
20861 if (val == NULL)
20862 continue;
20863 if (die == NULL)
20864 die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
20865 cdie = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_call_site_parameter, die,
20866 NULL_TREE);
20867 if (reg != NULL)
20868 add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_location, reg);
20869 else if (tdie != NULL)
20870 add_AT_die_ref (cdie, DW_AT_abstract_origin, tdie);
20871 add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_value, val);
20872 if (next_arg != XEXP (arg, 1))
20874 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 1));
20875 if (mode == VOIDmode)
20876 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 0));
20877 val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1),
20878 0), 1),
20879 mode, VOIDmode,
20880 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
20881 if (val != NULL)
20882 add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_data_value, val);
20885 if (die == NULL
20886 && (ca_loc->symbol_ref || tloc))
20887 die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
20888 if (die != NULL && (tloc != NULL_RTX || tlocc != NULL_RTX))
20890 dw_loc_descr_ref tval = NULL;
20892 if (tloc != NULL_RTX)
20893 tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tloc,
20894 GET_MODE (tloc) == VOIDmode
20895 ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tloc),
20896 VOIDmode,
20897 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
20898 if (tval)
20899 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target, tval);
20900 else if (tlocc != NULL_RTX)
20902 tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tlocc,
20903 GET_MODE (tlocc) == VOIDmode
20904 ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tlocc),
20905 VOIDmode,
20906 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
20907 if (tval)
20908 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target_clobbered,
20909 tval);
20912 if (die != NULL)
20914 call_site_note_count++;
20915 if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
20916 tail_call_site_note_count++;
20920 call_arg_locations = NULL;
20921 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
20922 if (tail_call_site_count >= 0
20923 && tail_call_site_count == tail_call_site_note_count
20924 && !dwarf_strict)
20926 if (call_site_count >= 0
20927 && call_site_count == call_site_note_count)
20928 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_GNU_all_call_sites, 1);
20929 else
20930 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_GNU_all_tail_call_sites, 1);
20932 call_site_count = -1;
20933 tail_call_site_count = -1;
20937 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
20939 hashval_t
20940 block_die_hasher::hash (die_struct *d)
20942 return (hashval_t) d->decl_id ^ htab_hash_pointer (d->die_parent);
20945 /* Return nonzero if decl_id and die_parent of die_struct X is the same
20946 as decl_id and die_parent of die_struct Y. */
20948 bool
20949 block_die_hasher::equal (die_struct *x, die_struct *y)
20951 return x->decl_id == y->decl_id && x->die_parent == y->die_parent;
20954 /* Return TRUE if DECL, which may have been previously generated as
20955 OLD_DIE, is a candidate for a DW_AT_specification. DECLARATION is
20956 true if decl (or its origin) is either an extern declaration or a
20957 class/namespace scoped declaration.
20959 The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
20960 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid
20961 considering one to be a specification, so we must test for
20962 DECLARATION and DW_AT_declaration. */
20963 static inline bool
20964 decl_will_get_specification_p (dw_die_ref old_die, tree decl, bool declaration)
20966 return (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && !declaration
20967 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1);
20970 /* Return true if DECL is a local static. */
20972 static inline bool
20973 local_function_static (tree decl)
20975 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL);
20976 return TREE_STATIC (decl)
20977 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
20978 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == FUNCTION_DECL;
20981 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object.
20982 Either DECL or ORIGIN must be non-null. */
20984 static void
20985 gen_variable_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
20987 HOST_WIDE_INT off = 0;
20988 tree com_decl;
20989 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
20990 tree ultimate_origin;
20991 dw_die_ref var_die;
20992 dw_die_ref old_die = decl ? lookup_decl_die (decl) : NULL;
20993 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
20994 bool declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin)
20995 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
20996 bool specialization_p = false;
20998 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
20999 if (decl || ultimate_origin)
21000 origin = ultimate_origin;
21001 com_decl = fortran_common (decl_or_origin, &off);
21003 /* Symbol in common gets emitted as a child of the common block, in the form
21004 of a data member. */
21005 if (com_decl)
21007 dw_die_ref com_die;
21008 dw_loc_list_ref loc;
21009 die_node com_die_arg;
21011 var_die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
21012 if (var_die)
21014 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL)
21016 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, off ? 1 : 2, NULL);
21017 if (loc)
21019 if (off)
21021 /* Optimize the common case. */
21022 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
21023 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
21024 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
21025 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
21026 == SYMBOL_REF)
21028 rtx x = loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
21029 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
21030 = plus_constant (GET_MODE (x), x , off);
21032 else
21033 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
21035 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
21036 remove_AT (var_die, DW_AT_declaration);
21039 return;
21042 if (common_block_die_table == NULL)
21043 common_block_die_table = hash_table<block_die_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
21045 com_die_arg.decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
21046 com_die_arg.die_parent = context_die;
21047 com_die = common_block_die_table->find (&com_die_arg);
21048 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
21049 if (com_die == NULL)
21051 const char *cnam
21052 = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (com_decl));
21053 die_node **slot;
21055 com_die = new_die (DW_TAG_common_block, context_die, decl);
21056 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (com_die, com_decl);
21057 if (loc)
21059 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
21060 /* Avoid sharing the same loc descriptor between
21061 DW_TAG_common_block and DW_TAG_variable. */
21062 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
21064 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin))
21065 add_AT_flag (com_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
21066 if (want_pubnames ())
21067 add_pubname_string (cnam, com_die); /* ??? needed? */
21068 com_die->decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
21069 slot = common_block_die_table->find_slot (com_die, INSERT);
21070 *slot = com_die;
21072 else if (get_AT (com_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL && loc)
21074 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
21075 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
21076 remove_AT (com_die, DW_AT_declaration);
21078 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, com_die, decl);
21079 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl_or_origin);
21080 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin),
21081 decl_quals (decl_or_origin), false,
21082 context_die);
21083 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
21084 if (loc)
21086 if (off)
21088 /* Optimize the common case. */
21089 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
21090 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
21091 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
21092 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF)
21094 rtx x = loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
21095 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
21096 = plus_constant (GET_MODE (x), x, off);
21098 else
21099 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
21101 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
21103 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin))
21104 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
21105 if (decl)
21106 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
21107 return;
21110 if (old_die)
21112 if (declaration)
21114 /* A declaration that has been previously dumped, needs no
21115 further annotations, since it doesn't need location on
21116 the second pass. */
21117 return;
21119 else if (decl_will_get_specification_p (old_die, decl, declaration)
21120 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_specification))
21122 /* Fall-thru so we can make a new variable die along with a
21123 DW_AT_specification. */
21125 else if (origin && old_die->die_parent != context_die)
21127 /* If we will be creating an inlined instance, we need a
21128 new DIE that will get annotated with
21129 DW_AT_abstract_origin. Clear things so we can get a
21130 new DIE. */
21131 gcc_assert (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl));
21132 old_die = NULL;
21134 else
21136 /* If a DIE was dumped early, it still needs location info.
21137 Skip to where we fill the location bits. */
21138 var_die = old_die;
21139 goto gen_variable_die_location;
21143 /* For static data members, the declaration in the class is supposed
21144 to have DW_TAG_member tag; the specification should still be
21145 DW_TAG_variable referencing the DW_TAG_member DIE. */
21146 if (declaration && class_scope_p (context_die))
21147 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
21148 else
21149 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
21151 if (origin != NULL)
21152 origin_die = add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
21154 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
21155 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
21157 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
21158 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT_P flag on them instead of
21159 sharing them.
21161 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges. */
21162 else if (decl_will_get_specification_p (old_die, decl, declaration))
21164 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
21165 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
21166 specialization_p = true;
21167 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
21169 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
21170 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
21172 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
21173 add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
21175 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
21176 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
21178 if (old_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_member)
21179 add_linkage_name (var_die, decl);
21182 else
21183 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
21185 if ((origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
21186 || (origin != NULL
21187 && !DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl_or_origin)
21188 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin),
21189 decl_function_context
21190 (decl_or_origin))))
21192 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin);
21194 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
21195 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
21196 context_die);
21197 else
21198 add_type_attribute (var_die, type, decl_quals (decl_or_origin), false,
21199 context_die);
21202 if (origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
21204 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
21205 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
21207 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
21208 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21210 add_accessibility_attribute (var_die, decl);
21213 if (declaration)
21214 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
21216 if (decl && (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
21217 || !old_die || is_declaration_die (old_die)))
21218 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
21220 gen_variable_die_location:
21221 if (! declaration
21222 && (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl_or_origin)
21223 /* Local static vars are shared between all clones/inlines,
21224 so emit DW_AT_location on the abstract DIE if DECL_RTL is
21225 already set. */
21226 || (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == VAR_DECL
21227 && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
21228 && DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl_or_origin)))
21229 /* When abstract origin already has DW_AT_location attribute, no need
21230 to add it again. */
21231 && (origin_die == NULL || get_AT (origin_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL))
21233 if (early_dwarf)
21234 add_pubname (decl_or_origin, var_die);
21235 else
21236 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl_or_origin,
21237 decl == NULL);
21239 else
21240 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (var_die, decl_or_origin);
21243 /* Generate a DIE to represent a named constant. */
21245 static void
21246 gen_const_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
21248 dw_die_ref const_die;
21249 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
21251 const_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
21252 if (const_die)
21253 return;
21255 const_die = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, context_die, decl);
21256 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, const_die);
21257 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (const_die, decl);
21258 add_type_attribute (const_die, type, TYPE_QUAL_CONST, false, context_die);
21259 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
21260 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
21261 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
21262 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21263 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (const_die, decl);
21266 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
21268 static void
21269 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
21271 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
21272 dw_die_ref lbl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
21273 rtx insn;
21274 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
21276 if (!lbl_die)
21278 lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
21279 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
21281 if (origin != NULL)
21282 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
21283 else
21284 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
21287 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
21288 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
21289 else
21291 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
21293 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
21294 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
21295 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
21296 if (insn
21297 && (LABEL_P (insn)
21298 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
21299 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
21301 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
21302 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
21303 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
21304 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
21305 it if it ever does happen. */
21306 gcc_assert (!as_a<rtx_insn *> (insn)->deleted ());
21308 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
21309 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
21311 else if (insn
21312 && NOTE_P (insn)
21313 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_DEBUG_LABEL
21314 && CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn) != -1)
21316 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LDL", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
21317 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
21322 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
21323 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
21324 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
21326 static inline void
21327 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
21329 expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
21331 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21333 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
21334 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
21339 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
21340 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
21342 static inline void
21343 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
21345 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
21347 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt)
21348 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
21350 tree chain, superblock = NULL_TREE;
21351 dw_die_ref pdie;
21352 dw_attr_node *attr = NULL;
21354 if (inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt))
21356 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
21357 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
21358 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
21361 /* Optimize duplicate .debug_ranges lists or even tails of
21362 lists. If this BLOCK has same ranges as its supercontext,
21363 lookup DW_AT_ranges attribute in the supercontext (and
21364 recursively so), verify that the ranges_table contains the
21365 right values and use it instead of adding a new .debug_range. */
21366 for (chain = stmt, pdie = die;
21367 BLOCK_SAME_RANGE (chain);
21368 chain = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain))
21370 dw_attr_node *new_attr;
21372 pdie = pdie->die_parent;
21373 if (pdie == NULL)
21374 break;
21375 if (BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain) == NULL_TREE)
21376 break;
21377 new_attr = get_AT (pdie, DW_AT_ranges);
21378 if (new_attr == NULL
21379 || new_attr->dw_attr_val.val_class != dw_val_class_range_list)
21380 break;
21381 attr = new_attr;
21382 superblock = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain);
21384 if (attr != NULL
21385 && (ranges_table[attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset
21386 / 2 / DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE].num
21387 == BLOCK_NUMBER (superblock))
21388 && BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (superblock))
21390 unsigned long off = attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset
21391 / 2 / DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
21392 unsigned long supercnt = 0, thiscnt = 0;
21393 for (chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (superblock);
21394 chain; chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain))
21396 ++supercnt;
21397 gcc_checking_assert (ranges_table[off + supercnt].num
21398 == BLOCK_NUMBER (chain));
21400 gcc_checking_assert (ranges_table[off + supercnt + 1].num == 0);
21401 for (chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
21402 chain; chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain))
21403 ++thiscnt;
21404 gcc_assert (supercnt >= thiscnt);
21405 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges,
21406 ((off + supercnt - thiscnt)
21407 * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE),
21408 false);
21409 return;
21412 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt), false);
21414 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
21417 add_ranges (chain);
21418 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
21420 while (chain);
21421 add_ranges (NULL);
21423 else
21425 char label_high[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
21426 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
21427 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
21428 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_high, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
21429 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
21430 add_AT_low_high_pc (die, label, label_high, false);
21434 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
21436 static void
21437 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
21439 dw_die_ref old_die = BLOCK_DIE (stmt);
21440 dw_die_ref stmt_die = NULL;
21441 if (!old_die)
21443 stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
21444 BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = stmt_die;
21447 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
21449 if (old_die)
21451 /* This must have been generated early and it won't even
21452 need location information since it's a DW_AT_inline
21453 function. */
21454 if (flag_checking)
21455 for (dw_die_ref c = context_die; c; c = c->die_parent)
21456 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
21457 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
21459 gcc_assert (get_AT (c, DW_AT_inline));
21460 break;
21462 return;
21465 else if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt))
21467 /* If this is an inlined instance, create a new lexical die for
21468 anything below to attach DW_AT_abstract_origin to. */
21469 if (old_die)
21471 stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
21472 BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = stmt_die;
21473 old_die = NULL;
21476 tree origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
21477 if (origin != NULL_TREE && origin != stmt)
21478 add_abstract_origin_attribute (stmt_die, origin);
21481 if (old_die)
21482 stmt_die = old_die;
21484 /* A non abstract block whose blocks have already been reordered
21485 should have the instruction range for this block. If so, set the
21486 high/low attributes. */
21487 if (!early_dwarf && !BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt) && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
21489 gcc_assert (stmt_die);
21490 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
21493 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die);
21496 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
21498 static void
21499 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
21501 tree decl;
21503 /* The instance of function that is effectively being inlined shall not
21504 be abstract. */
21505 gcc_assert (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt));
21507 decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
21509 /* Make sure any inlined functions are known to be inlineable. */
21510 gcc_checking_assert (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
21511 || cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl));
21513 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. We
21514 must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
21515 emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
21516 a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing. */
21517 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
21519 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
21521 dw_die_ref subr_die
21522 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
21524 if (call_arg_locations)
21525 BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = subr_die;
21526 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
21527 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
21528 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
21529 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
21531 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die);
21535 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. CTX is required: see
21536 the comment for VLR_CONTEXT. */
21538 static void
21539 gen_field_die (tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx, dw_die_ref context_die)
21541 dw_die_ref decl_die;
21543 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
21544 return;
21546 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
21547 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
21548 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl), decl_quals (decl),
21549 TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)),
21550 context_die);
21552 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
21554 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
21555 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
21556 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl, ctx);
21559 /* If we have a variant part offset, then we are supposed to process a member
21560 of a QUAL_UNION_TYPE, which is how we represent variant parts in
21561 trees. */
21562 gcc_assert (ctx->variant_part_offset == NULL_TREE
21563 || TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != QUAL_UNION_TYPE);
21564 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
21565 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl, ctx);
21567 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
21568 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21570 add_accessibility_attribute (decl_die, decl);
21572 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
21573 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
21576 #if 0
21577 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
21578 Use modified_type_die instead.
21579 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
21580 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
21582 static void
21583 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21585 dw_die_ref ptr_die
21586 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
21588 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
21589 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
21590 context_die);
21591 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
21594 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
21595 Use modified_type_die instead.
21596 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
21597 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
21599 static void
21600 gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21602 dw_die_ref ref_die, scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
21604 if (TYPE_REF_IS_RVALUE (type) && dwarf_version >= 4)
21605 ref_die = new_die (DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type, scope_die, type);
21606 else
21607 ref_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die, type);
21609 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
21610 add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
21611 context_die);
21612 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
21614 #endif
21616 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
21618 static void
21619 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21621 dw_die_ref ptr_die
21622 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
21623 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
21625 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
21626 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
21627 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
21628 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
21629 context_die);
21632 static char *producer_string;
21634 /* Return a heap allocated producer string including command line options
21635 if -grecord-gcc-switches. */
21637 static char *
21638 gen_producer_string (void)
21640 size_t j;
21641 auto_vec<const char *> switches;
21642 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
21643 char *producer, *tail;
21644 const char *p;
21645 size_t len = dwarf_record_gcc_switches ? 0 : 3;
21646 size_t plen = strlen (language_string) + 1 + strlen (version_string);
21648 for (j = 1; dwarf_record_gcc_switches && j < save_decoded_options_count; j++)
21649 switch (save_decoded_options[j].opt_index)
21651 case OPT_o:
21652 case OPT_d:
21653 case OPT_dumpbase:
21654 case OPT_dumpdir:
21655 case OPT_auxbase:
21656 case OPT_auxbase_strip:
21657 case OPT_quiet:
21658 case OPT_version:
21659 case OPT_v:
21660 case OPT_w:
21661 case OPT_L:
21662 case OPT_D:
21663 case OPT_I:
21664 case OPT_U:
21665 case OPT_SPECIAL_unknown:
21666 case OPT_SPECIAL_ignore:
21667 case OPT_SPECIAL_program_name:
21668 case OPT_SPECIAL_input_file:
21669 case OPT_grecord_gcc_switches:
21670 case OPT_gno_record_gcc_switches:
21671 case OPT__output_pch_:
21672 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_location_:
21673 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_option:
21674 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_caret:
21675 case OPT_fdiagnostics_color_:
21676 case OPT_fverbose_asm:
21677 case OPT____:
21678 case OPT__sysroot_:
21679 case OPT_nostdinc:
21680 case OPT_nostdinc__:
21681 case OPT_fpreprocessed:
21682 case OPT_fltrans_output_list_:
21683 case OPT_fresolution_:
21684 case OPT_fdebug_prefix_map_:
21685 /* Ignore these. */
21686 continue;
21687 default:
21688 if (cl_options[save_decoded_options[j].opt_index].flags
21689 & CL_NO_DWARF_RECORD)
21690 continue;
21691 gcc_checking_assert (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0][0]
21692 == '-');
21693 switch (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0][1])
21695 case 'M':
21696 case 'i':
21697 case 'W':
21698 continue;
21699 case 'f':
21700 if (strncmp (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0] + 2,
21701 "dump", 4) == 0)
21702 continue;
21703 break;
21704 default:
21705 break;
21707 switches.safe_push (save_decoded_options[j].orig_option_with_args_text);
21708 len += strlen (save_decoded_options[j].orig_option_with_args_text) + 1;
21709 break;
21712 producer = XNEWVEC (char, plen + 1 + len + 1);
21713 tail = producer;
21714 sprintf (tail, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
21715 tail += plen;
21717 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (switches, j, p)
21719 len = strlen (p);
21720 *tail = ' ';
21721 memcpy (tail + 1, p, len);
21722 tail += len + 1;
21725 *tail = '\0';
21726 return producer;
21729 /* Given a C and/or C++ language/version string return the "highest".
21730 C++ is assumed to be "higher" than C in this case. Used for merging
21731 LTO translation unit languages. */
21732 static const char *
21733 highest_c_language (const char *lang1, const char *lang2)
21735 if (strcmp ("GNU C++14", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++14", lang2) == 0)
21736 return "GNU C++14";
21737 if (strcmp ("GNU C++11", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++11", lang2) == 0)
21738 return "GNU C++11";
21739 if (strcmp ("GNU C++98", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++98", lang2) == 0)
21740 return "GNU C++98";
21742 if (strcmp ("GNU C11", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C11", lang2) == 0)
21743 return "GNU C11";
21744 if (strcmp ("GNU C99", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C99", lang2) == 0)
21745 return "GNU C99";
21746 if (strcmp ("GNU C89", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C89", lang2) == 0)
21747 return "GNU C89";
21749 gcc_unreachable ();
21753 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
21755 static dw_die_ref
21756 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
21758 dw_die_ref die;
21759 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
21760 int language;
21762 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
21764 if (filename)
21766 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
21767 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
21768 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename) && filename[0] != '<')
21769 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
21772 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer_string ? producer_string : "");
21774 /* If our producer is LTO try to figure out a common language to use
21775 from the global list of translation units. */
21776 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU GIMPLE") == 0)
21778 unsigned i;
21779 tree t;
21780 const char *common_lang = NULL;
21782 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (all_translation_units, i, t)
21784 if (!TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t))
21785 continue;
21786 if (!common_lang)
21787 common_lang = TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t);
21788 else if (strcmp (common_lang, TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t)) == 0)
21790 else if (strncmp (common_lang, "GNU C", 5) == 0
21791 && strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t), "GNU C", 5) == 0)
21792 /* Mixing C and C++ is ok, use C++ in that case. */
21793 common_lang = highest_c_language (common_lang,
21794 TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t));
21795 else
21797 /* Fall back to C. */
21798 common_lang = NULL;
21799 break;
21803 if (common_lang)
21804 language_string = common_lang;
21807 language = DW_LANG_C;
21808 if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU C", 5) == 0
21809 && ISDIGIT (language_string[5]))
21811 language = DW_LANG_C89;
21812 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21814 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C89") != 0)
21815 language = DW_LANG_C99;
21817 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
21818 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C11") == 0)
21819 language = DW_LANG_C11;
21822 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU C++", 7) == 0)
21824 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
21825 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
21827 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++11") == 0)
21828 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11;
21829 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++14") == 0)
21830 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14;
21833 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
21834 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
21835 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
21836 language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
21837 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21839 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
21840 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
21841 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0)
21843 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
21844 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
21846 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran2003") == 0)
21847 language = DW_LANG_Fortran03;
21848 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran2008") == 0)
21849 language = DW_LANG_Fortran08;
21852 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
21853 language = DW_LANG_Java;
21854 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
21855 language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
21856 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
21857 language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
21858 else if (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
21860 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Go") == 0)
21861 language = DW_LANG_Go;
21864 /* Use a degraded Fortran setting in strict DWARF2 so is_fortran works. */
21865 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0)
21866 language = DW_LANG_Fortran90;
21868 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
21870 switch (language)
21872 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
21873 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
21874 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
21875 case DW_LANG_Fortran03:
21876 case DW_LANG_Fortran08:
21877 /* Fortran has case insensitive identifiers and the front-end
21878 lowercases everything. */
21879 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_identifier_case, DW_ID_down_case);
21880 break;
21881 default:
21882 /* The default DW_ID_case_sensitive doesn't need to be specified. */
21883 break;
21885 return die;
21888 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
21890 static void
21891 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, tree type,
21892 dw_die_ref context_die)
21894 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
21895 struct vlr_context ctx = { type, NULL };
21897 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
21898 context_die);
21899 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo, &ctx);
21901 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
21902 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
21904 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
21905 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
21906 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_private. */
21907 if (access == access_public_node)
21909 if (dwarf_version == 2
21910 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
21911 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
21913 else if (access == access_protected_node)
21914 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
21915 else if (dwarf_version > 2
21916 && context_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
21917 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
21920 /* Return whether DECL is a FIELD_DECL that represents the variant part of a
21921 structure. */
21922 static bool
21923 is_variant_part (tree decl)
21925 return (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
21926 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE);
21929 /* Check that OPERAND is a reference to a field in STRUCT_TYPE. If it is,
21930 return the FIELD_DECL. Return NULL_TREE otherwise. */
21932 static tree
21933 analyze_discr_in_predicate (tree operand, tree struct_type)
21935 bool continue_stripping = true;
21936 while (continue_stripping)
21937 switch (TREE_CODE (operand))
21939 CASE_CONVERT:
21940 operand = TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0);
21941 break;
21942 default:
21943 continue_stripping = false;
21944 break;
21947 /* Match field access to members of struct_type only. */
21948 if (TREE_CODE (operand) == COMPONENT_REF
21949 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0)) == PLACEHOLDER_EXPR
21950 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0)) == struct_type
21951 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 1)) == FIELD_DECL)
21952 return TREE_OPERAND (operand, 1);
21953 else
21954 return NULL_TREE;
21957 /* Check that SRC is a constant integer that can be represented as a native
21958 integer constant (either signed or unsigned). If so, store it into DEST and
21959 return true. Return false otherwise. */
21961 static bool
21962 get_discr_value (tree src, dw_discr_value *dest)
21964 bool is_unsigned = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (src));
21966 if (TREE_CODE (src) != INTEGER_CST
21967 || !(is_unsigned ? tree_fits_uhwi_p (src) : tree_fits_shwi_p (src)))
21968 return false;
21970 dest->pos = is_unsigned;
21971 if (is_unsigned)
21972 dest->v.uval = tree_to_uhwi (src);
21973 else
21974 dest->v.sval = tree_to_shwi (src);
21976 return true;
21979 /* Try to extract synthetic properties out of VARIANT_PART_DECL, which is a
21980 FIELD_DECL in STRUCT_TYPE that represents a variant part. If unsuccessful,
21981 store NULL_TREE in DISCR_DECL. Otherwise:
21983 - store the discriminant field in STRUCT_TYPE that controls the variant
21984 part to *DISCR_DECL
21986 - put in *DISCR_LISTS_P an array where for each variant, the item
21987 represents the corresponding matching list of discriminant values.
21989 - put in *DISCR_LISTS_LENGTH the number of variants, which is the size of
21990 the above array.
21992 Note that when the array is allocated (i.e. when the analysis is
21993 successful), it is up to the caller to free the array. */
21995 static void
21996 analyze_variants_discr (tree variant_part_decl,
21997 tree struct_type,
21998 tree *discr_decl,
21999 dw_discr_list_ref **discr_lists_p,
22000 unsigned *discr_lists_length)
22002 tree variant_part_type = TREE_TYPE (variant_part_decl);
22003 tree variant;
22004 dw_discr_list_ref *discr_lists;
22005 unsigned i;
22007 /* Compute how many variants there are in this variant part. */
22008 *discr_lists_length = 0;
22009 for (variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type);
22010 variant != NULL_TREE;
22011 variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant))
22012 ++*discr_lists_length;
22014 *discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
22015 *discr_lists_p
22016 = (dw_discr_list_ref *) xcalloc (*discr_lists_length,
22017 sizeof (**discr_lists_p));
22018 discr_lists = *discr_lists_p;
22020 /* And then analyze all variants to extract discriminant information for all
22021 of them. This analysis is conservative: as soon as we detect something we
22022 do not support, abort everything and pretend we found nothing. */
22023 for (variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type), i = 0;
22024 variant != NULL_TREE;
22025 variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant), ++i)
22027 tree match_expr = DECL_QUALIFIER (variant);
22029 /* Now, try to analyze the predicate and deduce a discriminant for
22030 it. */
22031 if (match_expr == boolean_true_node)
22032 /* Typically happens for the default variant: it matches all cases that
22033 previous variants rejected. Don't output any matching value for
22034 this one. */
22035 continue;
22037 /* The following loop tries to iterate over each discriminant
22038 possibility: single values or ranges. */
22039 while (match_expr != NULL_TREE)
22041 tree next_round_match_expr;
22042 tree candidate_discr = NULL_TREE;
22043 dw_discr_list_ref new_node = NULL;
22045 /* Possibilities are matched one after the other by nested
22046 TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR expressions. Process the current possibility and
22047 continue with the rest at next iteration. */
22048 if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR)
22050 next_round_match_expr = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0);
22051 match_expr = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
22053 else
22054 next_round_match_expr = NULL_TREE;
22056 if (match_expr == boolean_false_node)
22057 /* This sub-expression matches nothing: just wait for the next
22058 one. */
22061 else if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == EQ_EXPR)
22063 /* We are matching: <discr_field> == <integer_cst>
22064 This sub-expression matches a single value. */
22065 tree integer_cst = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
22067 candidate_discr
22068 = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0),
22069 struct_type);
22071 new_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_discr_list_node> ();
22072 if (!get_discr_value (integer_cst,
22073 &new_node->dw_discr_lower_bound))
22074 goto abort;
22075 new_node->dw_discr_range = false;
22078 else if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR)
22080 /* We are matching:
22081 <discr_field> > <integer_cst>
22082 && <discr_field> < <integer_cst>.
22083 This sub-expression matches the range of values between the
22084 two matched integer constants. Note that comparisons can be
22085 inclusive or exclusive. */
22086 tree candidate_discr_1, candidate_discr_2;
22087 tree lower_cst, upper_cst;
22088 bool lower_cst_included, upper_cst_included;
22089 tree lower_op = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0);
22090 tree upper_op = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
22092 /* When the comparison is exclusive, the integer constant is not
22093 the discriminant range bound we are looking for: we will have
22094 to increment or decrement it. */
22095 if (TREE_CODE (lower_op) == GE_EXPR)
22096 lower_cst_included = true;
22097 else if (TREE_CODE (lower_op) == GT_EXPR)
22098 lower_cst_included = false;
22099 else
22100 goto abort;
22102 if (TREE_CODE (upper_op) == LE_EXPR)
22103 upper_cst_included = true;
22104 else if (TREE_CODE (upper_op) == LT_EXPR)
22105 upper_cst_included = false;
22106 else
22107 goto abort;
22109 /* Extract the discriminant from the first operand and check it
22110 is consistant with the same analysis in the second
22111 operand. */
22112 candidate_discr_1
22113 = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (lower_op, 0),
22114 struct_type);
22115 candidate_discr_2
22116 = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (upper_op, 0),
22117 struct_type);
22118 if (candidate_discr_1 == candidate_discr_2)
22119 candidate_discr = candidate_discr_1;
22120 else
22121 goto abort;
22123 /* Extract bounds from both. */
22124 new_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_discr_list_node> ();
22125 lower_cst = TREE_OPERAND (lower_op, 1);
22126 upper_cst = TREE_OPERAND (upper_op, 1);
22128 if (!lower_cst_included)
22129 lower_cst
22130 = fold (build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (lower_cst),
22131 lower_cst,
22132 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (lower_cst), 1)));
22133 if (!upper_cst_included)
22134 upper_cst
22135 = fold (build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (upper_cst),
22136 upper_cst,
22137 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (upper_cst), 1)));
22139 if (!get_discr_value (lower_cst,
22140 &new_node->dw_discr_lower_bound)
22141 || !get_discr_value (upper_cst,
22142 &new_node->dw_discr_upper_bound))
22143 goto abort;
22145 new_node->dw_discr_range = true;
22148 else
22149 /* Unsupported sub-expression: we cannot determine the set of
22150 matching discriminant values. Abort everything. */
22151 goto abort;
22153 /* If the discriminant info is not consistant with what we saw so
22154 far, consider the analysis failed and abort everything. */
22155 if (candidate_discr == NULL_TREE
22156 || (*discr_decl != NULL_TREE && candidate_discr != *discr_decl))
22157 goto abort;
22158 else
22159 *discr_decl = candidate_discr;
22161 if (new_node != NULL)
22163 new_node->dw_discr_next = discr_lists[i];
22164 discr_lists[i] = new_node;
22166 match_expr = next_round_match_expr;
22170 /* If we reach this point, we could match everything we were interested
22171 in. */
22172 return;
22174 abort:
22175 /* Clean all data structure and return no result. */
22176 free (*discr_lists_p);
22177 *discr_lists_p = NULL;
22178 *discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
22181 /* Generate a DIE to represent VARIANT_PART_DECL, a variant part that is part
22182 of STRUCT_TYPE, a record type. This new DIE is emitted as the next child
22183 under CONTEXT_DIE.
22185 Variant parts are supposed to be implemented as a FIELD_DECL whose type is a
22186 QUAL_UNION_TYPE: this is the VARIANT_PART_DECL parameter. The members for
22187 this type, which are record types, represent the available variants and each
22188 has a DECL_QUALIFIER attribute. The discriminant and the discriminant
22189 values are inferred from these attributes.
22191 In trees, the offsets for the fields inside these sub-records are relative
22192 to the variant part itself, whereas the corresponding DIEs should have
22193 offset attributes that are relative to the embedding record base address.
22194 This is why the caller must provide a VARIANT_PART_OFFSET expression: it
22195 must be an expression that computes the offset of the variant part to
22196 describe in DWARF. */
22198 static void
22199 gen_variant_part (tree variant_part_decl, struct vlr_context *vlr_ctx,
22200 dw_die_ref context_die)
22202 const tree variant_part_type = TREE_TYPE (variant_part_decl);
22203 tree variant_part_offset = vlr_ctx->variant_part_offset;
22204 struct loc_descr_context ctx = {
22205 vlr_ctx->struct_type, /* context_type */
22206 NULL_TREE, /* base_decl */
22207 NULL /* dpi */
22210 /* The FIELD_DECL node in STRUCT_TYPE that acts as the discriminant, or
22211 NULL_TREE if there is no such field. */
22212 tree discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
22213 dw_discr_list_ref *discr_lists;
22214 unsigned discr_lists_length = 0;
22215 unsigned i;
22217 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die = NULL;
22218 dw_die_ref variant_part_die
22219 = new_die (DW_TAG_variant_part, context_die, variant_part_type);
22221 equate_decl_number_to_die (variant_part_decl, variant_part_die);
22223 analyze_variants_discr (variant_part_decl, vlr_ctx->struct_type,
22224 &discr_decl, &discr_lists, &discr_lists_length);
22226 if (discr_decl != NULL_TREE)
22228 dw_die_ref discr_die = lookup_decl_die (discr_decl);
22230 if (discr_die)
22231 add_AT_die_ref (variant_part_die, DW_AT_discr, discr_die);
22232 else
22233 /* We have no DIE for the discriminant, so just discard all
22234 discrimimant information in the output. */
22235 discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
22238 /* If the offset for this variant part is more complex than a constant,
22239 create a DWARF procedure for it so that we will not have to generate DWARF
22240 expressions for it for each member. */
22241 if (TREE_CODE (variant_part_offset) != INTEGER_CST
22242 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
22244 const tree dwarf_proc_fndecl
22245 = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL, NULL_TREE,
22246 build_function_type (TREE_TYPE (variant_part_offset),
22247 NULL_TREE));
22248 const tree dwarf_proc_call = build_call_expr (dwarf_proc_fndecl, 0);
22249 const dw_loc_descr_ref dwarf_proc_body
22250 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (variant_part_offset, 0, &ctx);
22252 dwarf_proc_die = new_dwarf_proc_die (dwarf_proc_body,
22253 dwarf_proc_fndecl, context_die);
22254 if (dwarf_proc_die != NULL)
22255 variant_part_offset = dwarf_proc_call;
22258 /* Output DIEs for all variants. */
22259 i = 0;
22260 for (tree variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type);
22261 variant != NULL_TREE;
22262 variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant), ++i)
22264 tree variant_type = TREE_TYPE (variant);
22265 dw_die_ref variant_die;
22267 /* All variants (i.e. members of a variant part) are supposed to be
22268 encoded as structures. Sub-variant parts are QUAL_UNION_TYPE fields
22269 under these records. */
22270 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (variant_type) == RECORD_TYPE);
22272 variant_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variant, variant_part_die, variant_type);
22273 equate_decl_number_to_die (variant, variant_die);
22275 /* Output discriminant values this variant matches, if any. */
22276 if (discr_decl == NULL || discr_lists[i] == NULL)
22277 /* In the case we have discriminant information at all, this is
22278 probably the default variant: as the standard says, don't
22279 output any discriminant value/list attribute. */
22281 else if (discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_next == NULL
22282 && !discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_range)
22283 /* If there is only one accepted value, don't bother outputting a
22284 list. */
22285 add_discr_value (variant_die, &discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_lower_bound);
22286 else
22287 add_discr_list (variant_die, discr_lists[i]);
22289 for (tree member = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_type);
22290 member != NULL_TREE;
22291 member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
22293 struct vlr_context vlr_sub_ctx = {
22294 vlr_ctx->struct_type, /* struct_type */
22295 NULL /* variant_part_offset */
22297 if (is_variant_part (member))
22299 /* All offsets for fields inside variant parts are relative to
22300 the top-level embedding RECORD_TYPE's base address. On the
22301 other hand, offsets in GCC's types are relative to the
22302 nested-most variant part. So we have to sum offsets each time
22303 we recurse. */
22305 vlr_sub_ctx.variant_part_offset
22306 = fold (build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (variant_part_offset),
22307 variant_part_offset, byte_position (member)));
22308 gen_variant_part (member, &vlr_sub_ctx, variant_die);
22310 else
22312 vlr_sub_ctx.variant_part_offset = variant_part_offset;
22313 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, &vlr_sub_ctx, variant_die);
22318 free (discr_lists);
22321 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
22323 static void
22324 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
22326 tree member;
22327 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
22328 dw_die_ref child;
22330 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
22331 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
22332 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
22333 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
22334 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
22335 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
22336 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
22337 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
22338 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
22339 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
22340 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
22342 /* First output info about the base classes. */
22343 if (binfo)
22345 vec<tree, va_gc> *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
22346 int i;
22347 tree base;
22349 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
22350 gen_inheritance_die (base,
22351 (accesses ? (*accesses)[i] : access_public_node),
22352 type,
22353 context_die);
22356 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
22357 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
22359 struct vlr_context vlr_ctx = { type, NULL_TREE };
22361 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
22362 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
22363 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
22364 do put them in the right order. */
22366 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
22367 if (child)
22368 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
22370 /* Do not generate standard DWARF for variant parts if we are generating
22371 the corresponding GNAT encodings: DIEs generated for both would
22372 conflict in our mappings. */
22373 else if (is_variant_part (member)
22374 && gnat_encodings == DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL)
22376 vlr_ctx.variant_part_offset = byte_position (member);
22377 gen_variant_part (member, &vlr_ctx, context_die);
22379 else
22381 vlr_ctx.variant_part_offset = NULL_TREE;
22382 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, &vlr_ctx, context_die);
22386 /* We do not keep type methods in type variants. */
22387 gcc_assert (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type) == type);
22388 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
22389 if (TYPE_METHODS (type) != error_mark_node)
22390 for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
22392 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
22393 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
22394 continue;
22395 /* Nor constructors for anonymous classes. */
22396 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (member)
22397 && dwarf2_name (member, 0) == NULL)
22398 continue;
22400 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
22401 if (child)
22402 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
22403 else
22404 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, NULL, context_die);
22408 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
22409 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
22410 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
22412 static void
22413 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
22414 enum debug_info_usage usage)
22416 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
22418 /* Fill in the bound of variable-length fields in late dwarf if
22419 still incomplete. */
22420 if (!early_dwarf && variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
22421 for (tree member = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
22422 member;
22423 member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
22424 fill_variable_array_bounds (TREE_TYPE (member));
22425 return;
22428 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
22429 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
22430 int nested = 0;
22431 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
22432 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
22433 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
22434 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
22435 complete = complete && should_emit_struct_debug (type, usage);
22437 if (type_die && ! complete)
22438 return;
22440 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
22441 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
22442 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
22443 nested = 1;
22445 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
22447 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
22448 if (!type_die && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22449 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (type);
22451 if (! type_die || (nested && is_cu_die (scope_die)))
22452 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
22454 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
22456 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
22457 ? record_type_tag (type) : DW_TAG_union_type,
22458 scope_die, type);
22459 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
22460 if (old_die)
22461 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
22462 else
22463 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
22465 else
22466 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
22468 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
22469 then give a list of members. */
22470 if (complete && !ns_decl)
22472 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
22473 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
22474 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
22475 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
22476 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
22478 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
22479 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
22482 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
22483 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
22484 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
22485 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
22487 push_decl_scope (type);
22488 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
22489 pop_decl_scope ();
22491 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
22492 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
22493 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22495 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
22496 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
22498 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
22500 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
22501 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
22502 lookup_type_die (vtype));
22505 else
22507 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
22509 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
22510 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
22511 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
22512 vec_safe_push (incomplete_types, type);
22515 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
22516 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
22519 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
22521 static void
22522 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
22524 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
22525 dw_die_ref subr_die
22526 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
22527 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
22529 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
22530 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
22531 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
22532 context_die);
22533 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
22535 if (get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_name))
22536 add_pubtype (type, subr_die);
22539 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
22541 static void
22542 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
22544 dw_die_ref type_die;
22545 tree origin;
22547 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
22549 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
22550 fill_variable_array_bounds (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl));
22551 return;
22554 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
22555 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
22556 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
22557 if (origin != NULL)
22558 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
22559 else
22561 tree type;
22563 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
22564 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
22566 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
22568 if (type == error_mark_node)
22569 return;
22571 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
22572 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
22574 else
22576 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
22578 if (type == error_mark_node)
22579 return;
22581 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
22583 /* Here, we are in the case of decl being a typedef naming
22584 an anonymous type, e.g:
22585 typedef struct {...} foo;
22586 In that case TREE_TYPE (decl) is not a typedef variant
22587 type and TYPE_NAME of the anonymous type is set to the
22588 TYPE_DECL of the typedef. This construct is emitted by
22589 the C++ FE.
22591 TYPE is the anonymous struct named by the typedef
22592 DECL. As we need the DW_AT_type attribute of the
22593 DW_TAG_typedef to point to the DIE of TYPE, let's
22594 generate that DIE right away. add_type_attribute
22595 called below will then pick (via lookup_type_die) that
22596 anonymous struct DIE. */
22597 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
22598 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
22600 /* This is a GNU Extension. We are adding a
22601 DW_AT_linkage_name attribute to the DIE of the
22602 anonymous struct TYPE. The value of that attribute
22603 is the name of the typedef decl naming the anonymous
22604 struct. This greatly eases the work of consumers of
22605 this debug info. */
22606 add_linkage_name_raw (lookup_type_die (type), decl);
22610 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, decl_quals (decl), false,
22611 context_die);
22613 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (decl))
22614 /* We want that all subsequent calls to lookup_type_die with
22615 TYPE in argument yield the DW_TAG_typedef we have just
22616 created. */
22617 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
22619 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, decl);
22622 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
22623 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
22625 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
22626 add_pubtype (decl, type_die);
22629 /* Generate a DIE for a struct, class, enum or union type. */
22631 static void
22632 gen_tagged_type_die (tree type,
22633 dw_die_ref context_die,
22634 enum debug_info_usage usage)
22636 int need_pop;
22638 if (type == NULL_TREE
22639 || !is_tagged_type (type))
22640 return;
22642 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
22643 need_pop = 0;
22644 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
22645 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
22646 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
22647 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
22648 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
22649 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
22650 else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
22651 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
22652 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
22654 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die, usage);
22656 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
22657 return;
22659 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
22660 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
22661 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
22662 need_pop = 1;
22664 else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
22665 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == FUNCTION_DECL))
22667 /* If this type is local to a function that hasn't been written
22668 out yet, use a NULL context for now; it will be fixed up in
22669 decls_for_scope. */
22670 context_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
22671 /* A declaration DIE doesn't count; nested types need to go in the
22672 specification. */
22673 if (context_die && is_declaration_die (context_die))
22674 context_die = NULL;
22675 need_pop = 0;
22677 else
22679 context_die = declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
22680 need_pop = 0;
22683 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
22685 /* This might have been written out by the call to
22686 declare_in_namespace. */
22687 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
22688 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
22690 else
22691 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
22693 if (need_pop)
22694 pop_decl_scope ();
22696 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
22697 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
22698 when appropriate. */
22701 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
22703 static void
22704 gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
22705 enum debug_info_usage usage)
22707 struct array_descr_info info;
22709 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
22710 return;
22712 if (flag_checking && type)
22713 verify_type (type);
22715 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != NULL_TREE
22716 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
22717 && is_redundant_typedef (TYPE_NAME (type))
22718 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
22719 /* The DECL of this type is a typedef we don't want to emit debug
22720 info for but we want debug info for its underlying typedef.
22721 This can happen for e.g, the injected-class-name of a C++
22722 type. */
22723 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type));
22725 /* If TYPE is a typedef type variant, let's generate debug info
22726 for the parent typedef which TYPE is a type of. */
22727 if (typedef_variant_p (type))
22729 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
22730 return;
22732 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
22733 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) != type);
22735 /* Give typedefs the right scope. */
22736 context_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
22738 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
22740 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, NULL, context_die);
22741 return;
22744 /* If type is an anonymous tagged type named by a typedef, let's
22745 generate debug info for the typedef. */
22746 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
22748 /* Use the DIE of the containing namespace as the parent DIE of
22749 the type description DIE we want to generate. */
22750 if (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))
22751 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
22752 context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type)));
22754 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, NULL, context_die);
22755 return;
22758 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
22759 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
22760 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
22761 now. (Vectors and arrays are special because the debugging info is in the
22762 cloned type itself). */
22763 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE
22764 && TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE)
22765 type = type_main_variant (type);
22767 /* If this is an array type with hidden descriptor, handle it first. */
22768 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
22769 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info)
22771 memset (&info, 0, sizeof (info));
22772 if (lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info (type, &info))
22774 /* Fortran sometimes emits array types with no dimension. */
22775 gcc_assert (info.ndimensions >= 0
22776 && (info.ndimensions
22777 <= DWARF2OUT_ARRAY_DESCR_INFO_MAX_DIMEN));
22778 gen_descr_array_type_die (type, &info, context_die);
22779 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
22780 return;
22784 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
22786 /* Variable-length types may be incomplete even if
22787 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN. For such types, fall through to
22788 gen_array_type_die() and possibly fill in
22789 DW_AT_{upper,lower}_bound attributes. */
22790 if ((TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE
22791 && TREE_CODE (type) != RECORD_TYPE
22792 && TREE_CODE (type) != UNION_TYPE
22793 && TREE_CODE (type) != QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
22794 || !variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
22795 return;
22798 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
22800 case ERROR_MARK:
22801 break;
22803 case POINTER_TYPE:
22804 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
22805 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
22806 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
22807 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
22808 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
22809 statement. */
22810 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
22812 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
22813 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
22814 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
22815 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
22816 break;
22818 case OFFSET_TYPE:
22819 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
22820 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
22821 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die,
22822 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
22824 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
22825 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
22826 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
22828 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
22829 itself. */
22830 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
22831 break;
22833 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
22834 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
22835 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
22836 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
22837 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
22838 break;
22840 case METHOD_TYPE:
22841 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
22842 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
22843 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
22844 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
22845 break;
22847 case ARRAY_TYPE:
22848 case VECTOR_TYPE:
22849 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
22850 break;
22852 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
22853 case RECORD_TYPE:
22854 case UNION_TYPE:
22855 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
22856 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
22857 return;
22859 case VOID_TYPE:
22860 case INTEGER_TYPE:
22861 case REAL_TYPE:
22862 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
22863 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
22864 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
22865 case POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE:
22866 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
22867 break;
22869 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
22870 case LANG_TYPE:
22871 /* Just use DW_TAG_unspecified_type. */
22873 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
22874 if (type_die == NULL)
22876 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
22877 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type, comp_unit_die (),
22878 type);
22879 add_name_attribute (type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
22880 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
22883 break;
22885 default:
22886 if (is_cxx_auto (type))
22888 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
22889 dw_die_ref *die = (name == get_identifier ("auto")
22890 ? &auto_die : &decltype_auto_die);
22891 if (!*die)
22893 *die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type,
22894 comp_unit_die (), NULL_TREE);
22895 add_name_attribute (*die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
22897 equate_type_number_to_die (type, *die);
22898 break;
22900 gcc_unreachable ();
22903 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
22906 static void
22907 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
22909 if (type != error_mark_node)
22911 gen_type_die_with_usage (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
22912 if (flag_checking)
22914 dw_die_ref die = lookup_type_die (type);
22915 if (die)
22916 check_die (die);
22921 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
22922 things which are local to the given block. */
22924 static void
22925 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
22927 int must_output_die = 0;
22928 bool inlined_func;
22930 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
22931 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
22932 return;
22934 inlined_func = inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt);
22936 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
22937 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
22938 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
22939 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
22941 tree sub;
22943 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
22944 gen_block_die (sub, context_die);
22946 return;
22949 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
22950 block. */
22951 if (inlined_func)
22952 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
22953 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
22954 must_output_die = 1;
22955 else
22957 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
22958 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
22959 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22960 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
22961 as being a "significant" one. */
22962 must_output_die = ((BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
22963 || BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt))
22964 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
22965 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
22966 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
22967 else if ((TREE_USED (stmt)
22968 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
22969 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
22970 && !dwarf2out_ignore_block (stmt))
22971 must_output_die = 1;
22974 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
22975 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
22976 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
22977 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
22978 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
22979 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
22980 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
22981 if (must_output_die)
22983 if (inlined_func)
22985 /* If STMT block is abstract, that means we have been called
22986 indirectly from dwarf2out_abstract_function.
22987 That function rightfully marks the descendent blocks (of
22988 the abstract function it is dealing with) as being abstract,
22989 precisely to prevent us from emitting any
22990 DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE as a descendent
22991 of an abstract function instance. So in that case, we should
22992 not call gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
22994 Later though, when cgraph asks dwarf2out to emit info
22995 for the concrete instance of the function decl into which
22996 the concrete instance of STMT got inlined, the later will lead
22997 to the generation of a DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE. */
22998 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
22999 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die);
23001 else
23002 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die);
23004 else
23005 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die);
23008 /* Process variable DECL (or variable with origin ORIGIN) within
23009 block STMT and add it to CONTEXT_DIE. */
23010 static void
23011 process_scope_var (tree stmt, tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
23013 dw_die_ref die;
23014 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
23016 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == FUNCTION_DECL)
23017 die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
23018 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == TYPE_DECL
23019 && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl_or_origin))
23020 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin));
23021 else
23022 die = NULL;
23024 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
23025 add_child_die (context_die, die);
23026 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == IMPORTED_DECL)
23028 if (early_dwarf)
23029 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl_or_origin, DECL_NAME (decl_or_origin),
23030 stmt, context_die);
23032 else
23033 gen_decl_die (decl, origin, NULL, context_die);
23036 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
23037 all of its sub-blocks. */
23039 static void
23040 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
23042 tree decl;
23043 unsigned int i;
23044 tree subblocks;
23046 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
23047 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
23048 return;
23050 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
23051 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
23052 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
23053 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. We don't
23054 have to do this if we're at -g1. */
23055 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23057 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
23058 process_scope_var (stmt, decl, NULL_TREE, context_die);
23059 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt); i++)
23060 process_scope_var (stmt, NULL, BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (stmt, i),
23061 context_die);
23064 /* Even if we're at -g1, we need to process the subblocks in order to get
23065 inlined call information. */
23067 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
23068 therein) of this block. */
23069 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
23070 subblocks != NULL;
23071 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
23072 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die);
23075 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
23077 bool
23078 is_redundant_typedef (const_tree decl)
23080 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
23081 return true;
23083 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
23084 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
23085 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
23086 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
23087 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
23088 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
23089 return true;
23091 return false;
23094 /* Return TRUE if TYPE is a typedef that names a type for linkage
23095 purposes. This kind of typedefs is produced by the C++ FE for
23096 constructs like:
23098 typedef struct {...} foo;
23100 In that case, there is no typedef variant type produced for foo.
23101 Rather, the TREE_TYPE of the TYPE_DECL of foo is the anonymous
23102 struct type. */
23104 static bool
23105 is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree decl)
23107 if (decl == NULL_TREE
23108 || TREE_CODE (decl) != TYPE_DECL
23109 || DECL_NAMELESS (decl)
23110 || !is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl))
23111 || DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl)
23112 || is_redundant_typedef (decl)
23113 /* It looks like Ada produces TYPE_DECLs that are very similar
23114 to C++ naming typedefs but that have different
23115 semantics. Let's be specific to c++ for now. */
23116 || !is_cxx ())
23117 return FALSE;
23119 return (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl) == NULL_TREE
23120 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == decl
23121 && (TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))
23122 != TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
23125 /* Looks up the DIE for a context. */
23127 static inline dw_die_ref
23128 lookup_context_die (tree context)
23130 if (context)
23132 /* Find die that represents this context. */
23133 if (TYPE_P (context))
23135 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (context);
23136 dw_die_ref ctx = lookup_type_die (context);
23137 if (!ctx)
23138 return NULL;
23139 return strip_naming_typedef (context, ctx);
23141 else
23142 return lookup_decl_die (context);
23144 return comp_unit_die ();
23147 /* Returns the DIE for a context. */
23149 static inline dw_die_ref
23150 get_context_die (tree context)
23152 if (context)
23154 /* Find die that represents this context. */
23155 if (TYPE_P (context))
23157 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (context);
23158 return strip_naming_typedef (context, force_type_die (context));
23160 else
23161 return force_decl_die (context);
23163 return comp_unit_die ();
23166 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
23168 static dw_die_ref
23169 force_decl_die (tree decl)
23171 dw_die_ref decl_die;
23172 unsigned saved_external_flag;
23173 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
23174 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
23175 if (!decl_die)
23177 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
23179 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
23180 if (decl_die)
23181 return decl_die;
23183 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
23185 case FUNCTION_DECL:
23186 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
23187 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
23188 declaration die. */
23189 save_fn = current_function_decl;
23190 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
23191 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
23192 current_function_decl = save_fn;
23193 break;
23195 case VAR_DECL:
23196 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
23197 gen_decl_die() call. */
23198 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
23199 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
23200 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, NULL, context_die);
23201 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
23202 break;
23204 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
23205 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
23206 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
23207 else
23208 /* DWARF2 has neither DW_TAG_module, nor DW_TAG_namespace. */
23209 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
23210 break;
23212 case TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL:
23213 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
23214 break;
23216 default:
23217 gcc_unreachable ();
23220 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
23221 if (!decl_die)
23222 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
23223 gcc_assert (decl_die);
23226 return decl_die;
23229 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type. A DIE is
23230 always returned. */
23232 static dw_die_ref
23233 force_type_die (tree type)
23235 dw_die_ref type_die;
23237 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
23238 if (!type_die)
23240 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
23242 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (type),
23243 false, context_die);
23244 gcc_assert (type_die);
23246 return type_die;
23249 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
23250 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
23252 static dw_die_ref
23253 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
23255 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
23256 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
23257 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
23258 /* Force out the namespace. */
23259 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
23261 return context_die;
23264 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
23265 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
23267 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
23268 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope, with
23269 DW_AT_specification pointing to the declaration (like with class
23270 members). */
23272 static dw_die_ref
23273 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
23275 dw_die_ref ns_context;
23277 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23278 return context_die;
23280 /* External declarations in the local scope only need to be emitted
23281 once, not once in the namespace and once in the scope.
23283 This avoids declaring the `extern' below in the
23284 namespace DIE as well as in the innermost scope:
23286 namespace S
23288 int i=5;
23289 int foo()
23291 int i=8;
23292 extern int i;
23293 return i;
23297 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_EXTERNAL (thing) && local_scope_p (context_die))
23298 return context_die;
23300 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
23301 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
23302 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
23303 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
23304 return context_die;
23306 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
23308 if (ns_context != context_die)
23310 if (is_fortran ())
23311 return ns_context;
23312 if (DECL_P (thing))
23313 gen_decl_die (thing, NULL, NULL, ns_context);
23314 else
23315 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
23317 return context_die;
23320 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
23322 static void
23323 gen_namespace_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
23325 dw_die_ref namespace_die;
23327 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
23328 they are an alias of. */
23329 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
23331 /* Output a real namespace or module. */
23332 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
23333 namespace_die = new_die (is_fortran ()
23334 ? DW_TAG_module : DW_TAG_namespace,
23335 context_die, decl);
23336 /* For Fortran modules defined in different CU don't add src coords. */
23337 if (namespace_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_module && DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
23339 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
23340 if (name)
23341 add_name_attribute (namespace_die, name);
23343 else
23344 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
23345 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
23346 add_AT_flag (namespace_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
23347 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
23349 else
23351 /* Output a namespace alias. */
23353 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
23354 dw_die_ref origin_die
23355 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
23357 if (DECL_FILE_SCOPE_P (decl)
23358 || TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
23359 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
23360 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
23361 namespace_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
23362 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
23363 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
23364 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
23366 /* Bypass dwarf2_name's check for DECL_NAMELESS. */
23367 if (want_pubnames ())
23368 add_pubname_string (lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, 1), namespace_die);
23371 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL.
23372 The return value is currently only meaningful for PARM_DECLs,
23373 for all other decls it returns NULL.
23375 If DECL is a FIELD_DECL, CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT.
23376 It can be NULL otherwise. */
23378 static dw_die_ref
23379 gen_decl_die (tree decl, tree origin, struct vlr_context *ctx,
23380 dw_die_ref context_die)
23382 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
23383 tree class_origin = NULL, ultimate_origin;
23385 if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl_or_origin))
23386 return NULL;
23388 /* Ignore pointer bounds decls. */
23389 if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin)
23390 && TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)
23391 && POINTER_BOUNDS_P (decl_or_origin))
23392 return NULL;
23394 switch (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin))
23396 case ERROR_MARK:
23397 break;
23399 case CONST_DECL:
23400 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
23402 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
23403 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
23404 break;
23407 /* Emit its type. */
23408 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
23410 /* And its containing namespace. */
23411 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
23413 gen_const_die (decl, context_die);
23414 break;
23416 case FUNCTION_DECL:
23417 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
23418 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
23419 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl_or_origin) == NULL_TREE
23420 && DECL_FILE_SCOPE_P (decl_or_origin)
23421 && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE
23422 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl_or_origin)))
23423 break;
23425 #if 0
23426 /* FIXME */
23427 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
23428 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
23429 if (current_function_decl != decl)
23430 /* This is only a declaration. */;
23431 #endif
23433 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
23434 if (origin || DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
23435 dwarf2out_abstract_function (origin
23436 ? DECL_ORIGIN (origin)
23437 : DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
23439 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
23440 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
23441 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
23442 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
23443 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
23444 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
23445 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
23446 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
23447 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
23449 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
23450 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
23453 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
23454 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23456 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
23457 have its containing type. */
23458 if (!origin)
23459 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
23460 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
23461 gen_type_die (origin, context_die);
23463 /* And its return type. */
23464 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
23466 /* And its virtual context. */
23467 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
23468 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
23470 /* Make sure we have a member DIE for decl. */
23471 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
23472 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
23474 /* And its containing namespace. */
23475 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
23478 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
23479 if (decl)
23480 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
23481 break;
23483 case TYPE_DECL:
23484 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
23485 actual typedefs. */
23486 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23487 break;
23489 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
23490 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
23491 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
23492 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
23493 used to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
23494 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. But nothing
23495 should be actually referencing those DIEs, as variable DIEs with that
23496 type would be emitted already in the abstract origin, so it was always
23497 removed during unused type prunning. Don't add anything in this
23498 case. */
23499 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
23500 break;
23502 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
23503 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
23504 else
23505 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
23506 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
23507 break;
23509 case LABEL_DECL:
23510 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
23511 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
23512 break;
23514 case VAR_DECL:
23515 case RESULT_DECL:
23516 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
23517 variable declarations or definitions. */
23518 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23519 break;
23521 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
23522 object. */
23523 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
23524 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
23525 else
23526 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
23528 /* And its containing type. */
23529 class_origin = decl_class_context (decl_or_origin);
23530 if (class_origin != NULL_TREE)
23531 gen_type_die_for_member (class_origin, decl_or_origin, context_die);
23533 /* And its containing namespace. */
23534 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl_or_origin, context_die);
23536 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
23537 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
23538 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
23539 function. */
23540 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
23541 if (ultimate_origin != NULL_TREE
23542 && TREE_CODE (ultimate_origin) == PARM_DECL)
23543 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
23544 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
23545 context_die);
23546 else
23547 gen_variable_die (decl, origin, context_die);
23548 break;
23550 case FIELD_DECL:
23551 gcc_assert (ctx != NULL && ctx->struct_type != NULL);
23552 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
23553 anonymous unions and structs. */
23554 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
23555 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
23556 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
23558 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
23559 gen_field_die (decl, ctx, context_die);
23561 break;
23563 case PARM_DECL:
23564 if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl_or_origin))
23565 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
23566 else
23567 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
23568 return gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
23569 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
23570 context_die);
23572 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
23573 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
23574 gen_namespace_die (decl, context_die);
23575 break;
23577 case IMPORTED_DECL:
23578 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, DECL_NAME (decl),
23579 DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
23580 break;
23582 case NAMELIST_DECL:
23583 gen_namelist_decl (DECL_NAME (decl), context_die,
23584 NAMELIST_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl));
23585 break;
23587 default:
23588 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
23589 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
23590 break;
23593 return NULL;
23596 /* Output initial debug information for global DECL. Called at the
23597 end of the parsing process.
23599 This is the initial debug generation process. As such, the DIEs
23600 generated may be incomplete. A later debug generation pass
23601 (dwarf2out_late_global_decl) will augment the information generated
23602 in this pass (e.g., with complete location info). */
23604 static void
23605 dwarf2out_early_global_decl (tree decl)
23607 set_early_dwarf s;
23609 /* gen_decl_die() will set DECL_ABSTRACT because
23610 cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p() returns true. This is in
23611 turn will cause DW_AT_inline attributes to be set.
23613 This happens because at early dwarf generation, there is no
23614 cgraph information, causing cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p()
23615 to return true. Trick cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p()
23616 while we generate dwarf early. */
23617 bool save = symtab->global_info_ready;
23618 symtab->global_info_ready = true;
23620 /* We don't handle TYPE_DECLs. If required, they'll be reached via
23621 other DECLs and they can point to template types or other things
23622 that dwarf2out can't handle when done via dwarf2out_decl. */
23623 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != TYPE_DECL
23624 && TREE_CODE (decl) != PARM_DECL)
23626 tree save_fndecl = current_function_decl;
23627 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
23629 /* No cfun means the symbol has no body, so there's nothing
23630 to emit. */
23631 if (!DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl))
23632 goto early_decl_exit;
23634 current_function_decl = decl;
23636 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
23637 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
23638 current_function_decl = save_fndecl;
23640 early_decl_exit:
23641 symtab->global_info_ready = save;
23644 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from
23645 toplev.c after compilation proper has finished. */
23647 static void
23648 dwarf2out_late_global_decl (tree decl)
23650 /* We have to generate early debug late for LTO. */
23651 if (in_lto_p)
23652 dwarf2out_early_global_decl (decl);
23654 /* Fill-in any location information we were unable to determine
23655 on the first pass. */
23656 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
23657 && !POINTER_BOUNDS_P (decl))
23659 dw_die_ref die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
23660 if (die)
23661 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (die, decl, false);
23665 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
23666 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
23667 static void
23668 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
23670 if (!local)
23672 set_early_dwarf s;
23673 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
23677 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
23678 NAME is non-NULL name in the lexical block if the decl has been renamed.
23679 LEXICAL_BLOCK is the lexical block (which TREE_CODE is a BLOCK)
23680 that DECL belongs to.
23681 LEXICAL_BLOCK_DIE is the DIE of LEXICAL_BLOCK. */
23682 static void
23683 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree decl,
23684 tree name,
23685 tree lexical_block,
23686 dw_die_ref lexical_block_die)
23688 expanded_location xloc;
23689 dw_die_ref imported_die = NULL;
23690 dw_die_ref at_import_die;
23692 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == IMPORTED_DECL)
23694 xloc = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
23695 decl = IMPORTED_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl);
23696 gcc_assert (decl);
23698 else
23699 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
23701 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
23703 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
23704 /* For namespace N { typedef void T; } using N::T; base_type_die
23705 returns NULL, but DW_TAG_imported_declaration requires
23706 the DW_AT_import tag. Force creation of DW_TAG_typedef. */
23707 if (!at_import_die)
23709 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL);
23710 gen_typedef_die (decl, get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)));
23711 at_import_die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
23712 gcc_assert (at_import_die);
23715 else
23717 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
23718 if (!at_import_die)
23720 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
23721 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
23722 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
23724 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
23726 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
23727 && TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
23728 && !should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type),
23729 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
23730 return;
23731 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl,
23732 get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)));
23734 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMELIST_DECL)
23735 at_import_die = gen_namelist_decl (DECL_NAME (decl),
23736 get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)),
23737 NULL_TREE);
23738 else
23739 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
23743 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
23745 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
23746 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module,
23747 lexical_block_die,
23748 lexical_block);
23749 else
23750 return;
23752 else
23753 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration,
23754 lexical_block_die,
23755 lexical_block);
23757 add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
23758 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
23759 if (name)
23760 add_AT_string (imported_die, DW_AT_name,
23761 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
23762 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
23765 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
23766 NAME is non-NULL name in context if the decl has been renamed.
23767 CHILD is true if decl is one of the renamed decls as part of
23768 importing whole module. */
23770 static void
23771 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree name, tree context,
23772 bool child)
23774 /* dw_die_ref at_import_die; */
23775 dw_die_ref scope_die;
23777 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23778 return;
23780 gcc_assert (decl);
23782 set_early_dwarf s;
23784 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
23785 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
23786 itself. */
23788 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
23789 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
23790 if (context
23791 && TYPE_P (context)
23792 && !should_emit_struct_debug (context, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
23793 return;
23795 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
23796 return;
23798 scope_die = get_context_die (context);
23800 if (child)
23802 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child);
23803 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child->die_tag == DW_TAG_imported_module);
23804 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) != NAMESPACE_DECL);
23805 scope_die = scope_die->die_child;
23808 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
23809 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, name, context, scope_die);
23812 /* Output debug information for namelists. */
23814 static dw_die_ref
23815 gen_namelist_decl (tree name, dw_die_ref scope_die, tree item_decls)
23817 dw_die_ref nml_die, nml_item_die, nml_item_ref_die;
23818 tree value;
23819 unsigned i;
23821 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23822 return NULL;
23824 gcc_assert (scope_die != NULL);
23825 nml_die = new_die (DW_TAG_namelist, scope_die, NULL);
23826 add_AT_string (nml_die, DW_AT_name, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
23828 /* If there are no item_decls, we have a nondefining namelist, e.g.
23829 with USE association; hence, set DW_AT_declaration. */
23830 if (item_decls == NULL_TREE)
23832 add_AT_flag (nml_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
23833 return nml_die;
23836 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (item_decls), i, value)
23838 nml_item_ref_die = lookup_decl_die (value);
23839 if (!nml_item_ref_die)
23840 nml_item_ref_die = force_decl_die (value);
23842 nml_item_die = new_die (DW_TAG_namelist_item, nml_die, NULL);
23843 add_AT_die_ref (nml_item_die, DW_AT_namelist_items, nml_item_ref_die);
23845 return nml_die;
23849 /* Write the debugging output for DECL and return the DIE. */
23851 static void
23852 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
23854 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die ();
23856 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
23858 case ERROR_MARK:
23859 return;
23861 case FUNCTION_DECL:
23862 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
23863 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
23864 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
23865 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
23866 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
23867 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
23868 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
23869 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
23870 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
23871 with the definition of the function.
23873 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
23874 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
23875 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
23876 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
23877 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
23878 translation unit (and thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
23879 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
23880 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
23881 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
23882 that they *are* definitions).
23884 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
23885 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
23886 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
23887 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
23888 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas.
23890 If we are called from dwarf2out_abstract_function output a DIE
23891 anyway. We can end up here this way with early inlining and LTO
23892 where the inlined function is output in a different LTRANS unit
23893 or not at all. */
23894 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE
23895 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
23896 return;
23898 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
23899 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
23900 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
23901 if (decl_function_context (decl)
23902 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
23903 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23904 context_die = NULL;
23905 break;
23907 case VAR_DECL:
23908 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
23909 if (local_function_static (decl))
23910 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
23912 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
23913 variable declarations or definitions. */
23914 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23915 return;
23916 break;
23918 case CONST_DECL:
23919 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23920 return;
23921 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
23922 return;
23923 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
23924 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
23925 break;
23927 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
23928 case IMPORTED_DECL:
23929 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23930 return;
23931 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
23932 return;
23933 break;
23935 case TYPE_DECL:
23936 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
23937 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
23938 return;
23940 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
23941 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
23942 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
23943 return;
23945 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
23946 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23947 return;
23949 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
23950 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
23951 if (decl_function_context (decl))
23952 context_die = NULL;
23954 break;
23956 case NAMELIST_DECL:
23957 break;
23959 default:
23960 return;
23963 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, NULL, context_die);
23965 if (flag_checking)
23967 dw_die_ref die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
23968 if (die)
23969 check_die (die);
23973 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
23975 static void
23976 dwarf2out_function_decl (tree decl)
23978 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
23979 call_arg_locations = NULL;
23980 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
23981 call_site_count = -1;
23982 tail_call_site_count = -1;
23983 decl_loc_table->empty ();
23984 cached_dw_loc_list_table->empty ();
23987 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
23988 a lexical block. */
23990 static void
23991 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
23992 unsigned int blocknum)
23994 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
23995 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
23998 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
23999 lexical block. */
24001 static void
24002 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
24004 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
24005 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
24008 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
24009 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
24011 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
24012 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
24013 we may end up calling them anyway. */
24015 static bool
24016 dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree block)
24018 tree decl;
24019 unsigned int i;
24021 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
24022 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
24023 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
24024 return 0;
24025 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (block); i++)
24027 decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (block, i);
24028 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
24029 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
24030 return 0;
24033 return 1;
24036 /* Hash table routines for file_hash. */
24038 bool
24039 dwarf_file_hasher::equal (dwarf_file_data *p1, const char *p2)
24041 return filename_cmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
24044 hashval_t
24045 dwarf_file_hasher::hash (dwarf_file_data *p)
24047 return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
24050 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
24051 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
24052 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
24053 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
24054 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
24055 and .debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
24056 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
24057 available unique index number. */
24059 static struct dwarf_file_data *
24060 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
24062 struct dwarf_file_data * created;
24064 if (!file_name)
24065 return NULL;
24067 dwarf_file_data **slot
24068 = file_table->find_slot_with_hash (file_name, htab_hash_string (file_name),
24069 INSERT);
24070 if (*slot)
24071 return *slot;
24073 created = ggc_alloc<dwarf_file_data> ();
24074 created->filename = file_name;
24075 created->emitted_number = 0;
24076 *slot = created;
24077 return created;
24080 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
24081 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
24082 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
24083 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
24084 types, which may include filenames. */
24086 static int
24087 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
24089 if (! fd->emitted_number)
24091 if (last_emitted_file)
24092 fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
24093 else
24094 fd->emitted_number = 1;
24095 last_emitted_file = fd;
24097 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
24099 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
24100 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
24101 remap_debug_filename (fd->filename));
24102 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
24106 return fd->emitted_number;
24109 /* Schedule generation of a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE.
24110 That generation should happen after function debug info has been
24111 generated. The value of the attribute is the constant value of ARG. */
24113 static void
24114 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref die, tree arg)
24116 die_arg_entry entry;
24118 if (!die || !arg)
24119 return;
24121 gcc_assert (early_dwarf);
24123 if (!tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
24124 vec_alloc (tmpl_value_parm_die_table, 32);
24126 entry.die = die;
24127 entry.arg = arg;
24128 vec_safe_push (tmpl_value_parm_die_table, entry);
24131 /* Return TRUE if T is an instance of generic type, FALSE
24132 otherwise. */
24134 static bool
24135 generic_type_p (tree t)
24137 if (t == NULL_TREE || !TYPE_P (t))
24138 return false;
24139 return lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t) != NULL_TREE;
24142 /* Schedule the generation of the generic parameter dies for the
24143 instance of generic type T. The proper generation itself is later
24144 done by gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies. */
24146 static void
24147 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t)
24149 if (!generic_type_p (t))
24150 return;
24152 gcc_assert (early_dwarf);
24154 if (!generic_type_instances)
24155 vec_alloc (generic_type_instances, 256);
24157 vec_safe_push (generic_type_instances, t);
24160 /* Add a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIEs that were scheduled
24161 by append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table. This function must
24162 be called after function DIEs have been generated. */
24164 static void
24165 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void)
24167 if (tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
24169 unsigned i, j;
24170 die_arg_entry *e;
24172 /* We do this in two phases - first get the cases we can
24173 handle during early-finish, preserving those we cannot
24174 (containing symbolic constants where we don't yet know
24175 whether we are going to output the referenced symbols).
24176 For those we try again at late-finish. */
24177 j = 0;
24178 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*tmpl_value_parm_die_table, i, e)
24180 if (!tree_add_const_value_attribute (e->die, e->arg))
24181 (*tmpl_value_parm_die_table)[j++] = *e;
24183 tmpl_value_parm_die_table->truncate (j);
24187 /* Generate generic parameters DIEs for instances of generic types
24188 that have been previously scheduled by
24189 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen. This function must be called
24190 after all the types of the CU have been laid out. */
24192 static void
24193 gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void)
24195 unsigned i;
24196 tree t;
24198 if (!generic_type_instances)
24199 return;
24201 /* We end up "recursing" into schedule_generic_params_dies_gen, so
24202 pretend this generation is part of "early dwarf" as well. */
24203 set_early_dwarf s;
24205 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*generic_type_instances, i, t)
24206 if (COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t))
24207 gen_generic_params_dies (t);
24209 generic_type_instances = NULL;
24213 /* Replace DW_AT_name for the decl with name. */
24215 static void
24216 dwarf2out_set_name (tree decl, tree name)
24218 dw_die_ref die;
24219 dw_attr_node *attr;
24220 const char *dname;
24222 die = TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (decl);
24223 if (!die)
24224 return;
24226 dname = dwarf2_name (name, 0);
24227 if (!dname)
24228 return;
24230 attr = get_AT (die, DW_AT_name);
24231 if (attr)
24233 struct indirect_string_node *node;
24235 node = find_AT_string (dname);
24236 /* replace the string. */
24237 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
24240 else
24241 add_name_attribute (die, dname);
24244 /* True if before or during processing of the first function being emitted. */
24245 static bool in_first_function_p = true;
24246 /* True if loc_note during dwarf2out_var_location call might still be
24247 before first real instruction at address equal to .Ltext0. */
24248 static bool maybe_at_text_label_p = true;
24249 /* One above highest N where .LVLN label might be equal to .Ltext0 label. */
24250 static unsigned int first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label;
24252 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
24253 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
24254 our lookup table. */
24256 static void
24257 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx_insn *loc_note)
24259 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES + 2];
24260 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
24261 rtx_insn *next_real, *next_note;
24262 rtx_insn *call_insn = NULL;
24263 static const char *last_label;
24264 static const char *last_postcall_label;
24265 static bool last_in_cold_section_p;
24266 static rtx_insn *expected_next_loc_note;
24267 tree decl;
24268 bool var_loc_p;
24270 if (!NOTE_P (loc_note))
24272 if (CALL_P (loc_note))
24274 call_site_count++;
24275 if (SIBLING_CALL_P (loc_note))
24276 tail_call_site_count++;
24277 if (optimize == 0 && !flag_var_tracking)
24279 /* When the var-tracking pass is not running, there is no note
24280 for indirect calls whose target is compile-time known. In this
24281 case, process such calls specifically so that we generate call
24282 sites for them anyway. */
24283 rtx x = PATTERN (loc_note);
24284 if (GET_CODE (x) == PARALLEL)
24285 x = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0);
24286 if (GET_CODE (x) == SET)
24287 x = SET_SRC (x);
24288 if (GET_CODE (x) == CALL)
24289 x = XEXP (x, 0);
24290 if (!MEM_P (x)
24291 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
24292 || !SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))
24293 || (TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0)))
24294 != FUNCTION_DECL))
24296 call_insn = loc_note;
24297 loc_note = NULL;
24298 var_loc_p = false;
24300 next_real = next_real_insn (call_insn);
24301 next_note = NULL;
24302 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
24303 goto create_label;
24307 return;
24310 var_loc_p = NOTE_KIND (loc_note) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION;
24311 if (var_loc_p && !DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
24312 return;
24314 /* Optimize processing a large consecutive sequence of location
24315 notes so we don't spend too much time in next_real_insn. If the
24316 next insn is another location note, remember the next_real_insn
24317 calculation for next time. */
24318 next_real = cached_next_real_insn;
24319 if (next_real)
24321 if (expected_next_loc_note != loc_note)
24322 next_real = NULL;
24325 next_note = NEXT_INSN (loc_note);
24326 if (! next_note
24327 || next_note->deleted ()
24328 || ! NOTE_P (next_note)
24329 || (NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
24330 && NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_CALL_ARG_LOCATION))
24331 next_note = NULL;
24333 if (! next_real)
24334 next_real = next_real_insn (loc_note);
24336 if (next_note)
24338 expected_next_loc_note = next_note;
24339 cached_next_real_insn = next_real;
24341 else
24342 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
24344 /* If there are no instructions which would be affected by this note,
24345 don't do anything. */
24346 if (var_loc_p
24347 && next_real == NULL_RTX
24348 && !NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
24349 return;
24351 create_label:
24353 if (next_real == NULL_RTX)
24354 next_real = get_last_insn ();
24356 /* If there were any real insns between note we processed last time
24357 and this note (or if it is the first note), clear
24358 last_{,postcall_}label so that they are not reused this time. */
24359 if (last_var_location_insn == NULL_RTX
24360 || last_var_location_insn != next_real
24361 || last_in_cold_section_p != in_cold_section_p)
24363 last_label = NULL;
24364 last_postcall_label = NULL;
24367 if (var_loc_p)
24369 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
24370 newloc = add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, loc_note,
24371 NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note)
24372 ? last_postcall_label : last_label);
24373 if (newloc == NULL)
24374 return;
24376 else
24378 decl = NULL_TREE;
24379 newloc = NULL;
24382 /* If there were no real insns between note we processed last time
24383 and this note, use the label we emitted last time. Otherwise
24384 create a new label and emit it. */
24385 if (last_label == NULL)
24387 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
24388 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
24389 loclabel_num++;
24390 last_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
24391 /* See if loclabel might be equal to .Ltext0. If yes,
24392 bump first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label. */
24393 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
24394 && in_first_function_p
24395 && maybe_at_text_label_p)
24397 static rtx_insn *last_start;
24398 rtx_insn *insn;
24399 for (insn = loc_note; insn; insn = previous_insn (insn))
24400 if (insn == last_start)
24401 break;
24402 else if (!NONDEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
24403 continue;
24404 else
24406 rtx body = PATTERN (insn);
24407 if (GET_CODE (body) == USE || GET_CODE (body) == CLOBBER)
24408 continue;
24409 /* Inline asm could occupy zero bytes. */
24410 else if (GET_CODE (body) == ASM_INPUT
24411 || asm_noperands (body) >= 0)
24412 continue;
24413 #ifdef HAVE_attr_length
24414 else if (get_attr_min_length (insn) == 0)
24415 continue;
24416 #endif
24417 else
24419 /* Assume insn has non-zero length. */
24420 maybe_at_text_label_p = false;
24421 break;
24424 if (maybe_at_text_label_p)
24426 last_start = loc_note;
24427 first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label = loclabel_num;
24432 gcc_assert ((loc_note == NULL_RTX && call_insn != NULL_RTX)
24433 || (loc_note != NULL_RTX && call_insn == NULL_RTX));
24435 if (!var_loc_p)
24437 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc
24438 = ggc_cleared_alloc<call_arg_loc_node> ();
24439 rtx_insn *prev
24440 = loc_note != NULL_RTX ? prev_real_insn (loc_note) : call_insn;
24442 ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note = loc_note;
24443 ca_loc->next = NULL;
24444 ca_loc->label = last_label;
24445 gcc_assert (prev
24446 && (CALL_P (prev)
24447 || (NONJUMP_INSN_P (prev)
24448 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == SEQUENCE
24449 && CALL_P (XVECEXP (PATTERN (prev), 0, 0)))));
24450 if (!CALL_P (prev))
24451 prev = as_a <rtx_sequence *> (PATTERN (prev))->insn (0);
24452 ca_loc->tail_call_p = SIBLING_CALL_P (prev);
24454 /* Look for a SYMBOL_REF in the "prev" instruction. */
24455 rtx x = get_call_rtx_from (PATTERN (prev));
24456 if (x)
24458 /* Try to get the call symbol, if any. */
24459 if (MEM_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
24460 x = XEXP (x, 0);
24461 /* First, look for a memory access to a symbol_ref. */
24462 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF
24463 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))
24464 && TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))) == FUNCTION_DECL)
24465 ca_loc->symbol_ref = XEXP (x, 0);
24466 /* Otherwise, look at a compile-time known user-level function
24467 declaration. */
24468 else if (MEM_P (x)
24469 && MEM_EXPR (x)
24470 && TREE_CODE (MEM_EXPR (x)) == FUNCTION_DECL)
24471 ca_loc->symbol_ref = XEXP (DECL_RTL (MEM_EXPR (x)), 0);
24474 ca_loc->block = insn_scope (prev);
24475 if (call_arg_locations)
24476 call_arg_loc_last->next = ca_loc;
24477 else
24478 call_arg_locations = ca_loc;
24479 call_arg_loc_last = ca_loc;
24481 else if (loc_note != NULL_RTX && !NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
24482 newloc->label = last_label;
24483 else
24485 if (!last_postcall_label)
24487 sprintf (loclabel, "%s-1", last_label);
24488 last_postcall_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
24490 newloc->label = last_postcall_label;
24493 last_var_location_insn = next_real;
24494 last_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
24497 /* Called from finalize_size_functions for size functions so that their body
24498 can be encoded in the debug info to describe the layout of variable-length
24499 structures. */
24501 static void
24502 dwarf2out_size_function (tree decl)
24504 function_to_dwarf_procedure (decl);
24507 /* Note in one location list that text section has changed. */
24510 var_location_switch_text_section_1 (var_loc_list **slot, void *)
24512 var_loc_list *list = *slot;
24513 if (list->first)
24514 list->last_before_switch
24515 = list->last->next ? list->last->next : list->last;
24516 return 1;
24519 /* Note in all location lists that text section has changed. */
24521 static void
24522 var_location_switch_text_section (void)
24524 if (decl_loc_table == NULL)
24525 return;
24527 decl_loc_table->traverse<void *, var_location_switch_text_section_1> (NULL);
24530 /* Create a new line number table. */
24532 static dw_line_info_table *
24533 new_line_info_table (void)
24535 dw_line_info_table *table;
24537 table = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_line_info_table> ();
24538 table->file_num = 1;
24539 table->line_num = 1;
24540 table->is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
24542 return table;
24545 /* Lookup the "current" table into which we emit line info, so
24546 that we don't have to do it for every source line. */
24548 static void
24549 set_cur_line_info_table (section *sec)
24551 dw_line_info_table *table;
24553 if (sec == text_section)
24554 table = text_section_line_info;
24555 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
24557 table = cold_text_section_line_info;
24558 if (!table)
24560 cold_text_section_line_info = table = new_line_info_table ();
24561 table->end_label = cold_end_label;
24564 else
24566 const char *end_label;
24568 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
24570 if (in_cold_section_p)
24571 end_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
24572 else
24573 end_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
24575 else
24577 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
24578 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
24579 current_function_funcdef_no);
24580 end_label = ggc_strdup (label);
24583 table = new_line_info_table ();
24584 table->end_label = end_label;
24586 vec_safe_push (separate_line_info, table);
24589 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
24590 table->is_stmt = (cur_line_info_table
24591 ? cur_line_info_table->is_stmt
24592 : DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START);
24593 cur_line_info_table = table;
24597 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
24598 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
24599 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
24600 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
24602 static void
24603 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
24605 section *sec = function_section (fun);
24607 if (sec != text_section)
24608 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
24610 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition && !cold_text_section)
24612 gcc_assert (current_function_decl == fun);
24613 cold_text_section = unlikely_text_section ();
24614 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
24615 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
24616 switch_to_section (sec);
24619 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
24620 call_site_count = 0;
24621 tail_call_site_count = 0;
24623 set_cur_line_info_table (sec);
24626 /* Helper function of dwarf2out_end_function, called only after emitting
24627 the very first function into assembly. Check if some .debug_loc range
24628 might end with a .LVL* label that could be equal to .Ltext0.
24629 In that case we must force using absolute addresses in .debug_loc ranges,
24630 because this range could be .LVLN-.Ltext0 .. .LVLM-.Ltext0 for
24631 .LVLN == .LVLM == .Ltext0, thus 0 .. 0, which is a .debug_loc
24632 list terminator.
24633 Set have_multiple_function_sections to true in that case and
24634 terminate htab traversal. */
24637 find_empty_loc_ranges_at_text_label (var_loc_list **slot, int)
24639 var_loc_list *entry = *slot;
24640 struct var_loc_node *node;
24642 node = entry->first;
24643 if (node && node->next && node->next->label)
24645 unsigned int i;
24646 const char *label = node->next->label;
24647 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
24649 for (i = 0; i < first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label; i++)
24651 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", i);
24652 if (strcmp (label, loclabel) == 0)
24654 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
24655 return 0;
24659 return 1;
24662 /* Hook called after emitting a function into assembly.
24663 This does something only for the very first function emitted. */
24665 static void
24666 dwarf2out_end_function (unsigned int)
24668 if (in_first_function_p
24669 && !have_multiple_function_sections
24670 && first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label
24671 && decl_loc_table)
24672 decl_loc_table->traverse<int, find_empty_loc_ranges_at_text_label> (0);
24673 in_first_function_p = false;
24674 maybe_at_text_label_p = false;
24677 /* Temporary holder for dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit. Used to let
24678 front-ends register a translation unit even before dwarf2out_init is
24679 called. */
24680 static tree main_translation_unit = NULL_TREE;
24682 /* Hook called by front-ends after they built their main translation unit.
24683 Associate comp_unit_die to UNIT. */
24685 static void
24686 dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit (tree unit)
24688 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (unit) == TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL
24689 && main_translation_unit == NULL_TREE);
24690 main_translation_unit = unit;
24691 /* If dwarf2out_init has not been called yet, it will perform the association
24692 itself looking at main_translation_unit. */
24693 if (decl_die_table != NULL)
24694 equate_decl_number_to_die (unit, comp_unit_die ());
24697 /* Add OPCODE+VAL as an entry at the end of the opcode array in TABLE. */
24699 static void
24700 push_dw_line_info_entry (dw_line_info_table *table,
24701 enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode, unsigned int val)
24703 dw_line_info_entry e;
24704 e.opcode = opcode;
24705 e.val = val;
24706 vec_safe_push (table->entries, e);
24709 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
24710 and record information relating to this source line, in
24711 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
24712 /* ??? The discriminator parameter ought to be unsigned. */
24714 static void
24715 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename,
24716 int discriminator, bool is_stmt)
24718 unsigned int file_num;
24719 dw_line_info_table *table;
24721 if (debug_info_level < DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE || line == 0)
24722 return;
24724 /* The discriminator column was added in dwarf4. Simplify the below
24725 by simply removing it if we're not supposed to output it. */
24726 if (dwarf_version < 4 && dwarf_strict)
24727 discriminator = 0;
24729 table = cur_line_info_table;
24730 file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
24732 /* ??? TODO: Elide duplicate line number entries. Traditionally,
24733 the debugger has used the second (possibly duplicate) line number
24734 at the beginning of the function to mark the end of the prologue.
24735 We could eliminate any other duplicates within the function. For
24736 Dwarf3, we ought to include the DW_LNS_set_prologue_end mark in
24737 that second line number entry. */
24738 /* Recall that this end-of-prologue indication is *not* the same thing
24739 as the end_prologue debug hook. The NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END note,
24740 to which the hook corresponds, follows the last insn that was
24741 emitted by gen_prologue. What we need is to precede the first insn
24742 that had been emitted after NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG, i.e. the first
24743 insn that corresponds to something the user wrote. These may be
24744 very different locations once scheduling is enabled. */
24746 if (0 && file_num == table->file_num
24747 && line == table->line_num
24748 && discriminator == table->discrim_num
24749 && is_stmt == table->is_stmt)
24750 return;
24752 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
24754 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
24755 if (flag_debug_asm)
24756 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START, filename, line);
24758 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
24760 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
24761 /* "\t.loc %u %u 0 is_stmt %u discriminator %u",
24762 file_num, line, is_stmt, discriminator */
24763 fputs ("\t.loc ", asm_out_file);
24764 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, file_num);
24765 putc (' ', asm_out_file);
24766 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, line);
24767 putc (' ', asm_out_file);
24768 putc ('0', asm_out_file);
24770 if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
24772 fputs (" is_stmt ", asm_out_file);
24773 putc (is_stmt ? '1' : '0', asm_out_file);
24775 if (SUPPORTS_DISCRIMINATOR && discriminator != 0)
24777 gcc_assert (discriminator > 0);
24778 fputs (" discriminator ", asm_out_file);
24779 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, (unsigned long) discriminator);
24781 putc ('\n', asm_out_file);
24783 else
24785 unsigned int label_num = ++line_info_label_num;
24787 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL, label_num);
24789 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_address, label_num);
24790 if (file_num != table->file_num)
24791 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_file, file_num);
24792 if (discriminator != table->discrim_num)
24793 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_discriminator, discriminator);
24794 if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
24795 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_negate_stmt, 0);
24796 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_line, line);
24799 table->file_num = file_num;
24800 table->line_num = line;
24801 table->discrim_num = discriminator;
24802 table->is_stmt = is_stmt;
24803 table->in_use = true;
24806 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
24808 static void
24809 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
24811 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
24813 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
24814 dw_die_ref bincl_die;
24816 bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die (), NULL);
24817 add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, remap_debug_filename (filename));
24820 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
24822 macinfo_entry e;
24823 e.code = DW_MACINFO_start_file;
24824 e.lineno = lineno;
24825 e.info = ggc_strdup (filename);
24826 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
24830 /* Record the end of a source file. */
24832 static void
24833 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
24835 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
24836 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
24837 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die (), NULL);
24839 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
24841 macinfo_entry e;
24842 e.code = DW_MACINFO_end_file;
24843 e.lineno = lineno;
24844 e.info = NULL;
24845 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
24849 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
24850 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
24851 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
24853 static void
24854 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
24855 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
24857 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
24859 macinfo_entry e;
24860 /* Insert a dummy first entry to be able to optimize the whole
24861 predefined macro block using DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include. */
24862 if (macinfo_table->is_empty () && lineno <= 1)
24864 e.code = 0;
24865 e.lineno = 0;
24866 e.info = NULL;
24867 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
24869 e.code = DW_MACINFO_define;
24870 e.lineno = lineno;
24871 e.info = ggc_strdup (buffer);
24872 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
24876 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
24877 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
24878 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
24880 static void
24881 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
24882 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
24884 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
24886 macinfo_entry e;
24887 /* Insert a dummy first entry to be able to optimize the whole
24888 predefined macro block using DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include. */
24889 if (macinfo_table->is_empty () && lineno <= 1)
24891 e.code = 0;
24892 e.lineno = 0;
24893 e.info = NULL;
24894 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
24896 e.code = DW_MACINFO_undef;
24897 e.lineno = lineno;
24898 e.info = ggc_strdup (buffer);
24899 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
24903 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
24905 struct macinfo_entry_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <macinfo_entry>
24907 static inline hashval_t hash (const macinfo_entry *);
24908 static inline bool equal (const macinfo_entry *, const macinfo_entry *);
24911 inline hashval_t
24912 macinfo_entry_hasher::hash (const macinfo_entry *entry)
24914 return htab_hash_string (entry->info);
24917 inline bool
24918 macinfo_entry_hasher::equal (const macinfo_entry *entry1,
24919 const macinfo_entry *entry2)
24921 return !strcmp (entry1->info, entry2->info);
24924 typedef hash_table<macinfo_entry_hasher> macinfo_hash_type;
24926 /* Output a single .debug_macinfo entry. */
24928 static void
24929 output_macinfo_op (macinfo_entry *ref)
24931 int file_num;
24932 size_t len;
24933 struct indirect_string_node *node;
24934 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
24935 struct dwarf_file_data *fd;
24937 switch (ref->code)
24939 case DW_MACINFO_start_file:
24940 fd = lookup_filename (ref->info);
24941 file_num = maybe_emit_file (fd);
24942 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
24943 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno,
24944 "Included from line number %lu",
24945 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
24946 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", ref->info);
24947 break;
24948 case DW_MACINFO_end_file:
24949 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
24950 break;
24951 case DW_MACINFO_define:
24952 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
24953 len = strlen (ref->info) + 1;
24954 if (!dwarf_strict
24955 && len > DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
24956 && !DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
24957 && (debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) != 0)
24959 ref->code = ref->code == DW_MACINFO_define
24960 ? DW_MACRO_GNU_define_indirect
24961 : DW_MACRO_GNU_undef_indirect;
24962 output_macinfo_op (ref);
24963 return;
24965 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code,
24966 ref->code == DW_MACINFO_define
24967 ? "Define macro" : "Undefine macro");
24968 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
24969 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
24970 dw2_asm_output_nstring (ref->info, -1, "The macro");
24971 break;
24972 case DW_MACRO_GNU_define_indirect:
24973 case DW_MACRO_GNU_undef_indirect:
24974 node = find_AT_string (ref->info);
24975 gcc_assert (node
24976 && ((node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
24977 || (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)));
24978 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code,
24979 ref->code == DW_MACRO_GNU_define_indirect
24980 ? "Define macro indirect"
24981 : "Undefine macro indirect");
24982 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
24983 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
24984 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
24985 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->label,
24986 debug_str_section, "The macro: \"%s\"",
24987 ref->info);
24988 else
24989 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (node->index, "The macro: \"%s\"",
24990 ref->info);
24991 break;
24992 case DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include:
24993 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code, "Transparent include");
24994 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label,
24995 DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL, ref->lineno);
24996 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, label, NULL, NULL);
24997 break;
24998 default:
24999 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s unrecognized macinfo code %lu\n",
25000 ASM_COMMENT_START, (unsigned long) ref->code);
25001 break;
25005 /* Attempt to make a sequence of define/undef macinfo ops shareable with
25006 other compilation unit .debug_macinfo sections. IDX is the first
25007 index of a define/undef, return the number of ops that should be
25008 emitted in a comdat .debug_macinfo section and emit
25009 a DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include entry referencing it.
25010 If the define/undef entry should be emitted normally, return 0. */
25012 static unsigned
25013 optimize_macinfo_range (unsigned int idx, vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *files,
25014 macinfo_hash_type **macinfo_htab)
25016 macinfo_entry *first, *second, *cur, *inc;
25017 char linebuf[sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT) * 3 + 1];
25018 unsigned char checksum[16];
25019 struct md5_ctx ctx;
25020 char *grp_name, *tail;
25021 const char *base;
25022 unsigned int i, count, encoded_filename_len, linebuf_len;
25023 macinfo_entry **slot;
25025 first = &(*macinfo_table)[idx];
25026 second = &(*macinfo_table)[idx + 1];
25028 /* Optimize only if there are at least two consecutive define/undef ops,
25029 and either all of them are before first DW_MACINFO_start_file
25030 with lineno {0,1} (i.e. predefined macro block), or all of them are
25031 in some included header file. */
25032 if (second->code != DW_MACINFO_define && second->code != DW_MACINFO_undef)
25033 return 0;
25034 if (vec_safe_is_empty (files))
25036 if (first->lineno > 1 || second->lineno > 1)
25037 return 0;
25039 else if (first->lineno == 0)
25040 return 0;
25042 /* Find the last define/undef entry that can be grouped together
25043 with first and at the same time compute md5 checksum of their
25044 codes, linenumbers and strings. */
25045 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
25046 for (i = idx; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &cur); i++)
25047 if (cur->code != DW_MACINFO_define && cur->code != DW_MACINFO_undef)
25048 break;
25049 else if (vec_safe_is_empty (files) && cur->lineno > 1)
25050 break;
25051 else
25053 unsigned char code = cur->code;
25054 md5_process_bytes (&code, 1, &ctx);
25055 checksum_uleb128 (cur->lineno, &ctx);
25056 md5_process_bytes (cur->info, strlen (cur->info) + 1, &ctx);
25058 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
25059 count = i - idx;
25061 /* From the containing include filename (if any) pick up just
25062 usable characters from its basename. */
25063 if (vec_safe_is_empty (files))
25064 base = "";
25065 else
25066 base = lbasename (files->last ().info);
25067 for (encoded_filename_len = 0, i = 0; base[i]; i++)
25068 if (ISIDNUM (base[i]) || base[i] == '.')
25069 encoded_filename_len++;
25070 /* Count . at the end. */
25071 if (encoded_filename_len)
25072 encoded_filename_len++;
25074 sprintf (linebuf, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, first->lineno);
25075 linebuf_len = strlen (linebuf);
25077 /* The group name format is: wmN.[<encoded filename>.]<lineno>.<md5sum> */
25078 grp_name = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + encoded_filename_len + linebuf_len + 1
25079 + 16 * 2 + 1);
25080 memcpy (grp_name, DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? "wm4." : "wm8.", 4);
25081 tail = grp_name + 4;
25082 if (encoded_filename_len)
25084 for (i = 0; base[i]; i++)
25085 if (ISIDNUM (base[i]) || base[i] == '.')
25086 *tail++ = base[i];
25087 *tail++ = '.';
25089 memcpy (tail, linebuf, linebuf_len);
25090 tail += linebuf_len;
25091 *tail++ = '.';
25092 for (i = 0; i < 16; i++)
25093 sprintf (tail + i * 2, "%02x", checksum[i] & 0xff);
25095 /* Construct a macinfo_entry for DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include
25096 in the empty vector entry before the first define/undef. */
25097 inc = &(*macinfo_table)[idx - 1];
25098 inc->code = DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include;
25099 inc->lineno = 0;
25100 inc->info = ggc_strdup (grp_name);
25101 if (!*macinfo_htab)
25102 *macinfo_htab = new macinfo_hash_type (10);
25103 /* Avoid emitting duplicates. */
25104 slot = (*macinfo_htab)->find_slot (inc, INSERT);
25105 if (*slot != NULL)
25107 inc->code = 0;
25108 inc->info = NULL;
25109 /* If such an entry has been used before, just emit
25110 a DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include op. */
25111 inc = *slot;
25112 output_macinfo_op (inc);
25113 /* And clear all macinfo_entry in the range to avoid emitting them
25114 in the second pass. */
25115 for (i = idx; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &cur) && i < idx + count; i++)
25117 cur->code = 0;
25118 cur->info = NULL;
25121 else
25123 *slot = inc;
25124 inc->lineno = (*macinfo_htab)->elements ();
25125 output_macinfo_op (inc);
25127 return count;
25130 /* Save any strings needed by the macinfo table in the debug str
25131 table. All strings must be collected into the table by the time
25132 index_string is called. */
25134 static void
25135 save_macinfo_strings (void)
25137 unsigned len;
25138 unsigned i;
25139 macinfo_entry *ref;
25141 for (i = 0; macinfo_table && macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
25143 switch (ref->code)
25145 /* Match the logic in output_macinfo_op to decide on
25146 indirect strings. */
25147 case DW_MACINFO_define:
25148 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
25149 len = strlen (ref->info) + 1;
25150 if (!dwarf_strict
25151 && len > DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
25152 && !DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
25153 && (debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) != 0)
25154 set_indirect_string (find_AT_string (ref->info));
25155 break;
25156 case DW_MACRO_GNU_define_indirect:
25157 case DW_MACRO_GNU_undef_indirect:
25158 set_indirect_string (find_AT_string (ref->info));
25159 break;
25160 default:
25161 break;
25166 /* Output macinfo section(s). */
25168 static void
25169 output_macinfo (void)
25171 unsigned i;
25172 unsigned long length = vec_safe_length (macinfo_table);
25173 macinfo_entry *ref;
25174 vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *files = NULL;
25175 macinfo_hash_type *macinfo_htab = NULL;
25177 if (! length)
25178 return;
25180 /* output_macinfo* uses these interchangeably. */
25181 gcc_assert ((int) DW_MACINFO_define == (int) DW_MACRO_GNU_define
25182 && (int) DW_MACINFO_undef == (int) DW_MACRO_GNU_undef
25183 && (int) DW_MACINFO_start_file == (int) DW_MACRO_GNU_start_file
25184 && (int) DW_MACINFO_end_file == (int) DW_MACRO_GNU_end_file);
25186 /* For .debug_macro emit the section header. */
25187 if (!dwarf_strict)
25189 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 4, "DWARF macro version number");
25190 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
25191 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 3, "Flags: 64-bit, lineptr present");
25192 else
25193 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2, "Flags: 32-bit, lineptr present");
25194 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
25195 (!dwarf_split_debug_info ? debug_line_section_label
25196 : debug_skeleton_line_section_label),
25197 debug_line_section, NULL);
25200 /* In the first loop, it emits the primary .debug_macinfo section
25201 and after each emitted op the macinfo_entry is cleared.
25202 If a longer range of define/undef ops can be optimized using
25203 DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include, the
25204 DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include op is emitted and kept in
25205 the vector before the first define/undef in the range and the
25206 whole range of define/undef ops is not emitted and kept. */
25207 for (i = 0; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
25209 switch (ref->code)
25211 case DW_MACINFO_start_file:
25212 vec_safe_push (files, *ref);
25213 break;
25214 case DW_MACINFO_end_file:
25215 if (!vec_safe_is_empty (files))
25216 files->pop ();
25217 break;
25218 case DW_MACINFO_define:
25219 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
25220 if (!dwarf_strict
25221 && HAVE_COMDAT_GROUP
25222 && vec_safe_length (files) != 1
25223 && i > 0
25224 && i + 1 < length
25225 && (*macinfo_table)[i - 1].code == 0)
25227 unsigned count = optimize_macinfo_range (i, files, &macinfo_htab);
25228 if (count)
25230 i += count - 1;
25231 continue;
25234 break;
25235 case 0:
25236 /* A dummy entry may be inserted at the beginning to be able
25237 to optimize the whole block of predefined macros. */
25238 if (i == 0)
25239 continue;
25240 default:
25241 break;
25243 output_macinfo_op (ref);
25244 ref->info = NULL;
25245 ref->code = 0;
25248 if (!macinfo_htab)
25249 return;
25251 delete macinfo_htab;
25252 macinfo_htab = NULL;
25254 /* If any DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include were used, on those
25255 DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include entries terminate the
25256 current chain and switch to a new comdat .debug_macinfo
25257 section and emit the define/undef entries within it. */
25258 for (i = 0; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
25259 switch (ref->code)
25261 case 0:
25262 continue;
25263 case DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include:
25265 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
25266 tree comdat_key = get_identifier (ref->info);
25267 /* Terminate the previous .debug_macinfo section. */
25268 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
25269 targetm.asm_out.named_section (DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION,
25270 SECTION_DEBUG
25271 | SECTION_LINKONCE,
25272 comdat_key);
25273 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label,
25274 DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL,
25275 ref->lineno);
25276 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
25277 ref->code = 0;
25278 ref->info = NULL;
25279 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 4, "DWARF macro version number");
25280 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
25281 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Flags: 64-bit");
25282 else
25283 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Flags: 32-bit");
25285 break;
25286 case DW_MACINFO_define:
25287 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
25288 output_macinfo_op (ref);
25289 ref->code = 0;
25290 ref->info = NULL;
25291 break;
25292 default:
25293 gcc_unreachable ();
25297 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
25299 static void
25300 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
25302 /* This option is currently broken, see (PR53118 and PR46102). */
25303 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups
25304 && strstr (lang_hooks.name, "C++"))
25306 warning (0, "-feliminate-dwarf2-dups is broken for C++, ignoring");
25307 flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups = 0;
25310 /* Allocate the file_table. */
25311 file_table = hash_table<dwarf_file_hasher>::create_ggc (50);
25313 #ifndef DWARF2_LINENO_DEBUGGING_INFO
25314 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
25315 decl_die_table = hash_table<decl_die_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
25317 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
25318 decl_loc_table = hash_table<decl_loc_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
25320 /* Allocate the cached_dw_loc_list_table. */
25321 cached_dw_loc_list_table = hash_table<dw_loc_list_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
25323 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
25324 vec_alloc (decl_scope_table, 256);
25326 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
25327 abbrev_die_table = ggc_cleared_vec_alloc<dw_die_ref>
25328 (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT);
25329 abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
25330 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
25331 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
25333 /* Allocate the dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map. */
25334 dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map = new hash_map<dw_die_ref, int>;
25336 /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors. */
25337 vec_alloc (pubname_table, 32);
25338 vec_alloc (pubtype_table, 32);
25340 vec_alloc (incomplete_types, 64);
25342 vec_alloc (used_rtx_array, 32);
25344 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
25346 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
25347 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25348 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
25349 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25350 debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
25351 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25353 else
25355 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION,
25356 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
25357 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION,
25358 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
25359 NULL);
25360 debug_addr_section = get_section (DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION,
25361 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25362 debug_skeleton_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
25363 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25364 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
25365 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25366 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
25367 DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25369 /* Somewhat confusing detail: The skeleton_[abbrev|info] sections stay in
25370 the main .o, but the skeleton_line goes into the split off dwo. */
25371 debug_skeleton_line_section
25372 = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION,
25373 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
25374 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_line_section_label,
25375 DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25376 debug_str_offsets_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION,
25377 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
25378 NULL);
25379 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
25380 DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25381 debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION,
25382 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
25383 debug_str_dwo_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION,
25384 DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
25386 debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
25387 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25388 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (dwarf_strict
25389 ? DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
25390 : DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION,
25391 DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
25392 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
25393 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25394 debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
25395 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25396 debug_pubtypes_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION,
25397 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25398 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
25399 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
25400 debug_ranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
25401 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25402 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
25403 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25405 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
25406 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
25407 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25408 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25409 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
25410 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25411 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
25413 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
25414 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25415 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
25416 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25417 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
25418 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25419 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_addr_section_label,
25420 DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25421 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
25422 dwarf_strict
25423 ? DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
25424 : DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25425 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label, DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25427 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
25428 vec_alloc (macinfo_table, 64);
25430 switch_to_section (text_section);
25431 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
25432 #endif
25434 /* Make sure the line number table for .text always exists. */
25435 text_section_line_info = new_line_info_table ();
25436 text_section_line_info->end_label = text_end_label;
25438 #ifdef DWARF2_LINENO_DEBUGGING_INFO
25439 cur_line_info_table = text_section_line_info;
25440 #endif
25442 /* If front-ends already registered a main translation unit but we were not
25443 ready to perform the association, do this now. */
25444 if (main_translation_unit != NULL_TREE)
25445 equate_decl_number_to_die (main_translation_unit, comp_unit_die ());
25448 /* Called before compile () starts outputtting functions, variables
25449 and toplevel asms into assembly. */
25451 static void
25452 dwarf2out_assembly_start (void)
25454 if (HAVE_GAS_CFI_SECTIONS_DIRECTIVE
25455 && dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ()
25456 && (!(flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions)
25457 || targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) != UI_DWARF2))
25458 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_sections\t.debug_frame\n");
25461 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
25462 htab_traverse. Assign a string its index. All strings must be
25463 collected into the table by the time index_string is called,
25464 because the indexing code relies on htab_traverse to traverse nodes
25465 in the same order for each run. */
25468 index_string (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *index)
25470 indirect_string_node *node = *h;
25472 find_string_form (node);
25473 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
25475 gcc_assert (node->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
25476 node->index = *index;
25477 *index += 1;
25479 return 1;
25482 /* A helper function for output_indirect_strings called through
25483 htab_traverse. Output the offset to a string and update the
25484 current offset. */
25487 output_index_string_offset (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *offset)
25489 indirect_string_node *node = *h;
25491 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
25493 /* Assert that this node has been assigned an index. */
25494 gcc_assert (node->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED
25495 && node->index != NOT_INDEXED);
25496 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, *offset,
25497 "indexed string 0x%x: %s", node->index, node->str);
25498 *offset += strlen (node->str) + 1;
25500 return 1;
25503 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
25504 htab_traverse. Output the indexed string. */
25507 output_index_string (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *cur_idx)
25509 struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
25511 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
25513 /* Assert that the strings are output in the same order as their
25514 indexes were assigned. */
25515 gcc_assert (*cur_idx == node->index);
25516 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
25517 *cur_idx += 1;
25519 return 1;
25522 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
25523 htab_traverse. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
25526 output_indirect_string (indirect_string_node **h, void *)
25528 struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
25530 node->form = find_string_form (node);
25531 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp && node->refcount > 0)
25533 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
25534 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
25537 return 1;
25540 /* Output the indexed string table. */
25542 static void
25543 output_indirect_strings (void)
25545 switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
25546 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
25547 debug_str_hash->traverse<void *, output_indirect_string> (NULL);
25548 else
25550 unsigned int offset = 0;
25551 unsigned int cur_idx = 0;
25553 skeleton_debug_str_hash->traverse<void *, output_indirect_string> (NULL);
25555 switch_to_section (debug_str_offsets_section);
25556 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize
25557 <unsigned int *, output_index_string_offset> (&offset);
25558 switch_to_section (debug_str_dwo_section);
25559 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, output_index_string>
25560 (&cur_idx);
25564 /* Callback for htab_traverse to assign an index to an entry in the
25565 table, and to write that entry to the .debug_addr section. */
25568 output_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry **slot, unsigned int *cur_index)
25570 addr_table_entry *entry = *slot;
25572 if (entry->refcount == 0)
25574 gcc_assert (entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED
25575 || entry->index == NOT_INDEXED);
25576 return 1;
25579 gcc_assert (entry->index == *cur_index);
25580 (*cur_index)++;
25582 switch (entry->kind)
25584 case ate_kind_rtx:
25585 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, entry->addr.rtl,
25586 "0x%x", entry->index);
25587 break;
25588 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
25589 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
25590 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
25591 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
25592 entry->addr.rtl);
25593 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
25594 break;
25595 case ate_kind_label:
25596 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, entry->addr.label,
25597 "0x%x", entry->index);
25598 break;
25599 default:
25600 gcc_unreachable ();
25602 return 1;
25605 /* Produce the .debug_addr section. */
25607 static void
25608 output_addr_table (void)
25610 unsigned int index = 0;
25611 if (addr_index_table == NULL || addr_index_table->size () == 0)
25612 return;
25614 switch_to_section (debug_addr_section);
25615 addr_index_table
25616 ->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, output_addr_table_entry> (&index);
25619 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
25620 /* Verify that all marks are clear. */
25622 static void
25623 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
25625 dw_die_ref c;
25627 gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
25628 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
25630 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
25632 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
25633 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
25635 static void
25636 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
25638 dw_die_ref c;
25640 if (die->die_mark)
25641 die->die_mark = 0;
25642 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
25645 /* Given LOC that is referenced by a DIE we're marking as used, find all
25646 referenced DWARF procedures it references and mark them as used. */
25648 static void
25649 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
25651 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
25652 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
25654 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
25655 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
25656 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
25657 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
25658 prune_unused_types_mark (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
25659 break;
25660 case DW_OP_call2:
25661 case DW_OP_call4:
25662 case DW_OP_call_ref:
25663 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
25664 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
25665 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
25666 prune_unused_types_mark (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
25667 break;
25668 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
25669 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
25670 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
25671 prune_unused_types_mark (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
25672 break;
25673 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
25674 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
25675 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
25676 break;
25677 default:
25678 break;
25682 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
25683 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
25685 static void
25686 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
25688 dw_attr_node *a;
25689 unsigned ix;
25691 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
25693 switch (AT_class (a))
25695 /* Make sure DWARF procedures referenced by location descriptions will
25696 get emitted. */
25697 case dw_val_class_loc:
25698 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (AT_loc (a));
25699 break;
25700 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
25701 for (dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
25702 list != NULL;
25703 list = list->dw_loc_next)
25704 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (list->expr);
25705 break;
25707 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
25708 /* A reference to another DIE.
25709 Make sure that it will get emitted.
25710 If it was broken out into a comdat group, don't follow it. */
25711 if (! AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p
25712 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification)
25713 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
25714 break;
25716 case dw_val_class_str:
25717 /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
25718 accounts properly for it. */
25719 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
25720 break;
25722 default:
25723 break;
25728 /* Mark the generic parameters and arguments children DIEs of DIE. */
25730 static void
25731 prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref die)
25733 dw_die_ref c;
25735 if (die == NULL || die->die_child == NULL)
25736 return;
25737 c = die->die_child;
25740 if (is_template_parameter (c))
25741 prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1);
25742 c = c->die_sib;
25743 } while (c && c != die->die_child);
25746 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
25747 to DIE's children. */
25749 static void
25750 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
25752 dw_die_ref c;
25754 if (die->die_mark == 0)
25756 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
25757 die->die_mark = 1;
25758 /* If this is the DIE of a generic type instantiation,
25759 mark the children DIEs that describe its generic parms and
25760 args. */
25761 prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (die);
25763 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
25764 (But we don't want to mark our parent's kids due to this,
25765 unless it is a class.) */
25766 if (die->die_parent)
25767 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent,
25768 class_scope_p (die->die_parent));
25770 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
25771 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
25773 /* If this node is a specification,
25774 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
25775 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
25776 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
25779 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
25781 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
25782 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
25783 die->die_mark = 2;
25785 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
25786 kids get marked, even if they're types. If we're
25787 breaking out types into comdat sections, do this
25788 for all type definitions. */
25789 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type
25790 || (use_debug_types
25791 && is_type_die (die) && ! is_declaration_die (die)))
25792 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
25793 else
25794 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
25798 /* For local classes, look if any static member functions were emitted
25799 and if so, mark them. */
25801 static void
25802 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (dw_die_ref die)
25804 dw_die_ref c;
25806 if (die->die_mark == 2)
25807 return;
25809 switch (die->die_tag)
25811 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
25812 case DW_TAG_union_type:
25813 case DW_TAG_class_type:
25814 break;
25816 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
25817 if (!get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration)
25818 || die->die_definition != NULL)
25819 prune_unused_types_mark (die, 1);
25820 return;
25822 default:
25823 return;
25826 /* Mark children. */
25827 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (c));
25830 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
25832 static void
25833 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
25835 dw_die_ref c;
25837 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked and
25838 children have been marked as well. */
25839 if (die->die_mark == 2)
25840 return;
25842 switch (die->die_tag)
25844 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
25845 case DW_TAG_union_type:
25846 case DW_TAG_class_type:
25847 if (die->die_perennial_p)
25848 break;
25850 for (c = die->die_parent; c; c = c->die_parent)
25851 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
25852 break;
25854 /* Finding used static member functions inside of classes
25855 is needed just for local classes, because for other classes
25856 static member function DIEs with DW_AT_specification
25857 are emitted outside of the DW_TAG_*_type. If we ever change
25858 it, we'd need to call this even for non-local classes. */
25859 if (c)
25860 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (die);
25862 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
25863 return;
25865 case DW_TAG_const_type:
25866 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
25867 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
25868 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
25869 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
25870 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
25871 case DW_TAG_typedef:
25872 case DW_TAG_array_type:
25873 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
25874 case DW_TAG_friend:
25875 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
25876 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
25877 case DW_TAG_string_type:
25878 case DW_TAG_set_type:
25879 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
25880 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
25881 case DW_TAG_file_type:
25882 /* Type nodes are useful only when other DIEs reference them --- don't
25883 mark them. */
25884 /* FALLTHROUGH */
25886 case DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure:
25887 /* Likewise for DWARF procedures. */
25889 if (die->die_perennial_p)
25890 break;
25892 return;
25894 default:
25895 /* Mark everything else. */
25896 break;
25899 if (die->die_mark == 0)
25901 die->die_mark = 1;
25903 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
25904 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
25907 die->die_mark = 2;
25909 /* Mark children. */
25910 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
25913 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
25914 attributes. */
25916 static void
25917 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
25919 dw_attr_node *a;
25920 unsigned ix;
25922 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
25923 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
25925 struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
25926 s->refcount++;
25927 /* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
25928 twice in the hash table. */
25929 if (s->refcount
25930 == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
25932 indirect_string_node **slot
25933 = debug_str_hash->find_slot_with_hash (s->str,
25934 htab_hash_string (s->str),
25935 INSERT);
25936 gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
25937 *slot = s;
25942 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
25944 static void
25945 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
25947 dw_die_ref c;
25949 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
25950 prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
25952 if (! die->die_child)
25953 return;
25955 c = die->die_child;
25956 do {
25957 dw_die_ref prev = c;
25958 for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = c->die_sib)
25959 if (c == die->die_child)
25961 /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list. */
25962 if (prev == c)
25963 /* No marked children at all. */
25964 die->die_child = NULL;
25965 else
25967 prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
25968 die->die_child = prev;
25970 return;
25973 if (c != prev->die_sib)
25974 prev->die_sib = c;
25975 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
25976 } while (c != die->die_child);
25979 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
25981 static void
25982 prune_unused_types (void)
25984 unsigned int i;
25985 limbo_die_node *node;
25986 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
25987 pubname_entry *pub;
25988 dw_die_ref base_type;
25990 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
25991 /* All the marks should already be clear. */
25992 verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die ());
25993 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
25994 verify_marks_clear (node->die);
25995 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
25996 verify_marks_clear (ctnode->root_die);
25997 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
25999 /* Mark types that are used in global variables. */
26000 premark_types_used_by_global_vars ();
26002 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
26003 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die ());
26004 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
26005 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
26006 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
26008 prune_unused_types_walk (ctnode->root_die);
26009 prune_unused_types_mark (ctnode->type_die, 1);
26012 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the pubname_table. Enumerators
26013 are unusual in that they are pubnames that are the children of pubtypes.
26014 They should only be marked via their parent DW_TAG_enumeration_type die,
26015 not as roots in themselves. */
26016 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*pubname_table, i, pub)
26017 if (pub->die->die_tag != DW_TAG_enumerator)
26018 prune_unused_types_mark (pub->die, 1);
26019 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
26020 prune_unused_types_mark (base_type, 1);
26022 if (debug_str_hash)
26023 debug_str_hash->empty ();
26024 if (skeleton_debug_str_hash)
26025 skeleton_debug_str_hash->empty ();
26026 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die ());
26027 for (limbo_die_node **pnode = &limbo_die_list; *pnode; )
26029 node = *pnode;
26030 if (!node->die->die_mark)
26031 *pnode = node->next;
26032 else
26034 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
26035 pnode = &node->next;
26038 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
26039 prune_unused_types_prune (ctnode->root_die);
26041 /* Leave the marks clear. */
26042 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die ());
26043 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
26044 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
26045 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
26046 prune_unmark_dies (ctnode->root_die);
26049 /* Set the parameter to true if there are any relative pathnames in
26050 the file table. */
26052 file_table_relative_p (dwarf_file_data **slot, bool *p)
26054 struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
26055 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (d->filename))
26057 *p = true;
26058 return 0;
26060 return 1;
26063 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of comdat type units. */
26065 struct comdat_type_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <comdat_type_node>
26067 static inline hashval_t hash (const comdat_type_node *);
26068 static inline bool equal (const comdat_type_node *, const comdat_type_node *);
26071 inline hashval_t
26072 comdat_type_hasher::hash (const comdat_type_node *type_node)
26074 hashval_t h;
26075 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
26076 return h;
26079 inline bool
26080 comdat_type_hasher::equal (const comdat_type_node *type_node_1,
26081 const comdat_type_node *type_node_2)
26083 return (! memcmp (type_node_1->signature, type_node_2->signature,
26084 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE));
26087 /* Move a DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute just added to dw_die_ref
26088 to the location it would have been added, should we know its
26089 DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME when we added other attributes. This will
26090 probably improve compactness of debug info, removing equivalent
26091 abbrevs, and hide any differences caused by deferring the
26092 computation of the assembler name, triggered by e.g. PCH. */
26094 static inline void
26095 move_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die)
26097 unsigned ix = vec_safe_length (die->die_attr);
26098 dw_attr_node linkage = (*die->die_attr)[ix - 1];
26100 gcc_assert (linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_linkage_name
26101 || linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name);
26103 while (--ix > 0)
26105 dw_attr_node *prev = &(*die->die_attr)[ix - 1];
26107 if (prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_line || prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_name)
26108 break;
26111 if (ix != vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) - 1)
26113 die->die_attr->pop ();
26114 die->die_attr->quick_insert (ix, linkage);
26118 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, mark DW_TAG_base_type nodes
26119 referenced from typed stack ops and count how often they are used. */
26121 static void
26122 mark_base_types (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
26124 dw_die_ref base_type = NULL;
26126 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
26128 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
26130 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
26131 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
26132 base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
26133 break;
26134 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
26135 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
26136 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
26137 continue;
26138 /* FALLTHRU */
26139 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
26140 base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
26141 break;
26142 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
26143 mark_base_types (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
26144 continue;
26145 default:
26146 continue;
26148 gcc_assert (base_type->die_parent == comp_unit_die ());
26149 if (base_type->die_mark)
26150 base_type->die_mark++;
26151 else
26153 base_types.safe_push (base_type);
26154 base_type->die_mark = 1;
26159 /* Comparison function for sorting marked base types. */
26161 static int
26162 base_type_cmp (const void *x, const void *y)
26164 dw_die_ref dx = *(const dw_die_ref *) x;
26165 dw_die_ref dy = *(const dw_die_ref *) y;
26166 unsigned int byte_size1, byte_size2;
26167 unsigned int encoding1, encoding2;
26168 if (dx->die_mark > dy->die_mark)
26169 return -1;
26170 if (dx->die_mark < dy->die_mark)
26171 return 1;
26172 byte_size1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_byte_size);
26173 byte_size2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_byte_size);
26174 if (byte_size1 < byte_size2)
26175 return 1;
26176 if (byte_size1 > byte_size2)
26177 return -1;
26178 encoding1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_encoding);
26179 encoding2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_encoding);
26180 if (encoding1 < encoding2)
26181 return 1;
26182 if (encoding1 > encoding2)
26183 return -1;
26184 return 0;
26187 /* Move base types marked by mark_base_types as early as possible
26188 in the CU, sorted by decreasing usage count both to make the
26189 uleb128 references as small as possible and to make sure they
26190 will have die_offset already computed by calc_die_sizes when
26191 sizes of typed stack loc ops is computed. */
26193 static void
26194 move_marked_base_types (void)
26196 unsigned int i;
26197 dw_die_ref base_type, die, c;
26199 if (base_types.is_empty ())
26200 return;
26202 /* Sort by decreasing usage count, they will be added again in that
26203 order later on. */
26204 base_types.qsort (base_type_cmp);
26205 die = comp_unit_die ();
26206 c = die->die_child;
26209 dw_die_ref prev = c;
26210 c = c->die_sib;
26211 while (c->die_mark)
26213 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
26214 /* As base types got marked, there must be at least
26215 one node other than DW_TAG_base_type. */
26216 gcc_assert (c != c->die_sib);
26217 c = c->die_sib;
26220 while (c != die->die_child);
26221 gcc_assert (die->die_child);
26222 c = die->die_child;
26223 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
26225 base_type->die_mark = 0;
26226 base_type->die_sib = c->die_sib;
26227 c->die_sib = base_type;
26228 c = base_type;
26232 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, attempt to resolve
26233 one CONST_STRING, return true if successful. Similarly verify that
26234 SYMBOL_REFs refer to variables emitted in the current CU. */
26236 static bool
26237 resolve_one_addr (rtx *addr)
26239 rtx rtl = *addr;
26241 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
26243 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
26244 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
26245 tree tlen = size_int (len - 1);
26246 TREE_TYPE (t)
26247 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
26248 rtl = lookup_constant_def (t);
26249 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
26250 return false;
26251 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
26252 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
26253 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)
26254 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
26255 return false;
26256 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
26257 *addr = rtl;
26258 return true;
26261 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
26262 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))
26264 if (TREE_CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
26266 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (DECL_INITIAL (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))))
26267 return false;
26269 else if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
26270 return false;
26273 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
26275 subrtx_ptr_iterator::array_type array;
26276 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_PTR (iter, array, &XEXP (rtl, 0), ALL)
26277 if (!resolve_one_addr (*iter))
26278 return false;
26281 return true;
26284 /* For STRING_CST, return SYMBOL_REF of its constant pool entry,
26285 if possible, and create DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure that can be referenced
26286 from DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer if the string hasn't been seen yet. */
26288 static rtx
26289 string_cst_pool_decl (tree t)
26291 rtx rtl = output_constant_def (t, 1);
26292 unsigned char *array;
26293 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
26294 tree decl;
26295 size_t len;
26296 dw_die_ref ref;
26298 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
26299 return NULL_RTX;
26300 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
26301 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != SYMBOL_REF
26302 || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl) == NULL_TREE)
26303 return NULL_RTX;
26305 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
26306 if (!lookup_decl_die (decl))
26308 len = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (t);
26309 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
26310 ref = new_die (DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, comp_unit_die (), decl);
26311 array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (len);
26312 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (t), len);
26313 l = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value, len, 0);
26314 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
26315 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = len;
26316 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 1;
26317 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
26318 add_AT_loc (ref, DW_AT_location, l);
26319 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, ref);
26321 return rtl;
26324 /* Helper function of resolve_addr_in_expr. LOC is
26325 a DW_OP_addr followed by DW_OP_stack_value, either at the start
26326 of exprloc or after DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, and val_addr can't be
26327 resolved. Replace it (both DW_OP_addr and DW_OP_stack_value)
26328 with DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer if possible
26329 and return true, if unsuccessful, return false. */
26331 static bool
26332 optimize_one_addr_into_implicit_ptr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
26334 rtx rtl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
26335 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
26336 dw_die_ref ref = NULL;
26337 tree decl;
26339 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST
26340 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == PLUS
26341 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 1)))
26343 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 1));
26344 rtl = XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0);
26346 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
26348 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
26349 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
26350 tree tlen = size_int (len - 1);
26352 TREE_TYPE (t)
26353 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
26354 rtl = string_cst_pool_decl (t);
26355 if (!rtl)
26356 return false;
26358 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))
26360 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
26361 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
26363 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
26364 if (ref && (get_AT (ref, DW_AT_location)
26365 || get_AT (ref, DW_AT_const_value)))
26367 loc->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer;
26368 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
26369 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
26370 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
26371 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
26372 loc->dw_loc_next = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next;
26373 loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = offset;
26374 return true;
26378 return false;
26381 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, handle one location
26382 expression, return false if at least one CONST_STRING or SYMBOL_REF in
26383 the location list couldn't be resolved. */
26385 static bool
26386 resolve_addr_in_expr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
26388 dw_loc_descr_ref keep = NULL;
26389 for (dw_loc_descr_ref prev = NULL; loc; prev = loc, loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
26390 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
26392 case DW_OP_addr:
26393 if (!resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr))
26395 if ((prev == NULL
26396 || prev->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece
26397 || prev->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
26398 && loc->dw_loc_next
26399 && loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_stack_value
26400 && !dwarf_strict
26401 && optimize_one_addr_into_implicit_ptr (loc))
26402 break;
26403 return false;
26405 break;
26406 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
26407 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
26408 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_addr_index
26409 || (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_const_index && loc->dtprel))
26411 rtx rtl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->addr.rtl;
26412 if (!resolve_one_addr (&rtl))
26413 return false;
26414 remove_addr_table_entry (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry);
26415 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry =
26416 add_addr_table_entry (rtl, ate_kind_rtx);
26418 break;
26419 case DW_OP_const4u:
26420 case DW_OP_const8u:
26421 if (loc->dtprel
26422 && !resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr))
26423 return false;
26424 break;
26425 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
26426 if (size_of_loc_descr (loc)
26427 > size_of_int_loc_descriptor (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
26429 && loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned > 0)
26431 dw_loc_descr_ref repl
26432 = int_loc_descriptor (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
26433 add_loc_descr (&repl, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
26434 add_loc_descr (&repl, loc->dw_loc_next);
26435 *loc = *repl;
26437 break;
26438 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
26439 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_addr
26440 && !resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_addr))
26441 return false;
26442 break;
26443 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
26444 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
26445 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
26447 dw_die_ref ref
26448 = lookup_decl_die (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref);
26449 if (ref == NULL)
26450 return false;
26451 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
26452 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
26453 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
26455 break;
26456 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
26457 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
26458 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
26459 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
26460 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
26461 while (loc->dw_loc_next
26462 && loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_convert)
26464 dw_die_ref base1, base2;
26465 unsigned enc1, enc2, size1, size2;
26466 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
26467 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
26468 base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
26469 else if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
26470 == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
26471 break;
26472 else
26473 base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
26474 if (loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
26475 == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
26476 break;
26477 base2 = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
26478 gcc_assert (base1->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type
26479 && base2->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type);
26480 enc1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_encoding);
26481 enc2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_encoding);
26482 size1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_byte_size);
26483 size2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_byte_size);
26484 if (size1 == size2
26485 && (((enc1 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc1 == DW_ATE_signed)
26486 && (enc2 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc2 == DW_ATE_signed)
26487 && loc != keep)
26488 || enc1 == enc2))
26490 /* Optimize away next DW_OP_GNU_convert after
26491 adjusting LOC's base type die reference. */
26492 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
26493 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
26494 loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
26495 else
26496 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
26497 loc->dw_loc_next = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next;
26498 continue;
26500 /* Don't change integer DW_OP_GNU_convert after e.g. floating
26501 point typed stack entry. */
26502 else if (enc1 != DW_ATE_unsigned && enc1 != DW_ATE_signed)
26503 keep = loc->dw_loc_next;
26504 break;
26506 break;
26507 default:
26508 break;
26510 return true;
26513 /* Helper function of resolve_addr. DIE had DW_AT_location of
26514 DW_OP_addr alone, which referred to DECL in DW_OP_addr's operand
26515 and DW_OP_addr couldn't be resolved. resolve_addr has already
26516 removed the DW_AT_location attribute. This function attempts to
26517 add a new DW_AT_location attribute with DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer
26518 to it or DW_AT_const_value attribute, if possible. */
26520 static void
26521 optimize_location_into_implicit_ptr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
26523 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
26524 || lookup_decl_die (decl) != die
26525 || DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
26526 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
26527 || DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE
26528 || DECL_P (DECL_INITIAL (decl))
26529 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_const_value))
26530 return;
26532 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
26533 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
26534 /* For variables that have been optimized away and thus
26535 don't have a memory location, see if we can emit
26536 DW_AT_const_value instead. */
26537 if (tree_add_const_value_attribute (die, init))
26538 return;
26539 if (dwarf_strict)
26540 return;
26541 /* If init is ADDR_EXPR or POINTER_PLUS_EXPR of ADDR_EXPR,
26542 and ADDR_EXPR refers to a decl that has DW_AT_location or
26543 DW_AT_const_value (but isn't addressable, otherwise
26544 resolving the original DW_OP_addr wouldn't fail), see if
26545 we can add DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer. */
26546 STRIP_NOPS (init);
26547 if (TREE_CODE (init) == POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
26548 && tree_fits_shwi_p (TREE_OPERAND (init, 1)))
26550 offset = tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (init, 1));
26551 init = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
26552 STRIP_NOPS (init);
26554 if (TREE_CODE (init) != ADDR_EXPR)
26555 return;
26556 if ((TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == STRING_CST
26557 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)))
26558 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == VAR_DECL
26559 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0))
26560 && TREE_OPERAND (init, 0) != decl))
26562 dw_die_ref ref;
26563 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
26565 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == STRING_CST)
26567 rtx rtl = string_cst_pool_decl (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0));
26568 if (!rtl)
26569 return;
26570 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
26572 else
26573 decl = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
26574 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
26575 if (ref == NULL
26576 || (!get_AT (ref, DW_AT_location)
26577 && !get_AT (ref, DW_AT_const_value)))
26578 return;
26579 l = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer, 0, offset);
26580 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
26581 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
26582 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
26583 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, l);
26587 /* Resolve DW_OP_addr and DW_AT_const_value CONST_STRING arguments to
26588 an address in .rodata section if the string literal is emitted there,
26589 or remove the containing location list or replace DW_AT_const_value
26590 with DW_AT_location and empty location expression, if it isn't found
26591 in .rodata. Similarly for SYMBOL_REFs, keep only those that refer
26592 to something that has been emitted in the current CU. */
26594 static void
26595 resolve_addr (dw_die_ref die)
26597 dw_die_ref c;
26598 dw_attr_node *a;
26599 dw_loc_list_ref *curr, *start, loc;
26600 unsigned ix;
26602 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
26603 switch (AT_class (a))
26605 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
26606 start = curr = AT_loc_list_ptr (a);
26607 loc = *curr;
26608 gcc_assert (loc);
26609 /* The same list can be referenced more than once. See if we have
26610 already recorded the result from a previous pass. */
26611 if (loc->replaced)
26612 *curr = loc->dw_loc_next;
26613 else if (!loc->resolved_addr)
26615 /* As things stand, we do not expect or allow one die to
26616 reference a suffix of another die's location list chain.
26617 References must be identical or completely separate.
26618 There is therefore no need to cache the result of this
26619 pass on any list other than the first; doing so
26620 would lead to unnecessary writes. */
26621 while (*curr)
26623 gcc_assert (!(*curr)->replaced && !(*curr)->resolved_addr);
26624 if (!resolve_addr_in_expr ((*curr)->expr))
26626 dw_loc_list_ref next = (*curr)->dw_loc_next;
26627 dw_loc_descr_ref l = (*curr)->expr;
26629 if (next && (*curr)->ll_symbol)
26631 gcc_assert (!next->ll_symbol);
26632 next->ll_symbol = (*curr)->ll_symbol;
26634 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
26635 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (l);
26636 *curr = next;
26638 else
26640 mark_base_types ((*curr)->expr);
26641 curr = &(*curr)->dw_loc_next;
26644 if (loc == *start)
26645 loc->resolved_addr = 1;
26646 else
26648 loc->replaced = 1;
26649 loc->dw_loc_next = *start;
26652 if (!*start)
26654 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
26655 ix--;
26657 break;
26658 case dw_val_class_loc:
26660 dw_loc_descr_ref l = AT_loc (a);
26661 /* For -gdwarf-2 don't attempt to optimize
26662 DW_AT_data_member_location containing
26663 DW_OP_plus_uconst - older consumers might
26664 rely on it being that op instead of a more complex,
26665 but shorter, location description. */
26666 if ((dwarf_version > 2
26667 || a->dw_attr != DW_AT_data_member_location
26668 || l == NULL
26669 || l->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_plus_uconst
26670 || l->dw_loc_next != NULL)
26671 && !resolve_addr_in_expr (l))
26673 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
26674 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (l);
26675 if (l != NULL
26676 && l->dw_loc_next == NULL
26677 && l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
26678 && GET_CODE (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF
26679 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
26680 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_location)
26682 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr);
26683 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
26684 ix--;
26685 optimize_location_into_implicit_ptr (die, decl);
26686 break;
26688 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
26689 ix--;
26691 else
26692 mark_base_types (l);
26694 break;
26695 case dw_val_class_addr:
26696 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_const_value
26697 && !resolve_one_addr (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr))
26699 if (AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
26700 remove_addr_table_entry (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry);
26701 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
26702 ix--;
26704 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_call_site
26705 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
26707 tree tdecl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr);
26708 dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
26709 dw_die_ref cdie;
26710 if (tdie == NULL
26711 && DECL_EXTERNAL (tdecl)
26712 && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (tdecl) == NULL_TREE
26713 && (cdie = lookup_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (tdecl))))
26715 /* Creating a full DIE for tdecl is overly expensive and
26716 at this point even wrong when in the LTO phase
26717 as it can end up generating new type DIEs we didn't
26718 output and thus optimize_external_refs will crash. */
26719 tdie = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, cdie, NULL_TREE);
26720 add_AT_flag (tdie, DW_AT_external, 1);
26721 add_AT_flag (tdie, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
26722 add_linkage_attr (tdie, tdecl);
26723 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (tdie, tdecl);
26724 equate_decl_number_to_die (tdecl, tdie);
26726 if (tdie)
26728 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
26729 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = tdie;
26730 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
26732 else
26734 if (AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
26735 remove_addr_table_entry (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry);
26736 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
26737 ix--;
26740 break;
26741 default:
26742 break;
26745 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, resolve_addr (c));
26748 /* Helper routines for optimize_location_lists.
26749 This pass tries to share identical local lists in .debug_loc
26750 section. */
26752 /* Iteratively hash operands of LOC opcode into HSTATE. */
26754 static void
26755 hash_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, inchash::hash &hstate)
26757 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
26758 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
26760 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
26762 case DW_OP_const4u:
26763 case DW_OP_const8u:
26764 if (loc->dtprel)
26765 goto hash_addr;
26766 /* FALLTHRU */
26767 case DW_OP_const1u:
26768 case DW_OP_const1s:
26769 case DW_OP_const2u:
26770 case DW_OP_const2s:
26771 case DW_OP_const4s:
26772 case DW_OP_const8s:
26773 case DW_OP_constu:
26774 case DW_OP_consts:
26775 case DW_OP_pick:
26776 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
26777 case DW_OP_breg0:
26778 case DW_OP_breg1:
26779 case DW_OP_breg2:
26780 case DW_OP_breg3:
26781 case DW_OP_breg4:
26782 case DW_OP_breg5:
26783 case DW_OP_breg6:
26784 case DW_OP_breg7:
26785 case DW_OP_breg8:
26786 case DW_OP_breg9:
26787 case DW_OP_breg10:
26788 case DW_OP_breg11:
26789 case DW_OP_breg12:
26790 case DW_OP_breg13:
26791 case DW_OP_breg14:
26792 case DW_OP_breg15:
26793 case DW_OP_breg16:
26794 case DW_OP_breg17:
26795 case DW_OP_breg18:
26796 case DW_OP_breg19:
26797 case DW_OP_breg20:
26798 case DW_OP_breg21:
26799 case DW_OP_breg22:
26800 case DW_OP_breg23:
26801 case DW_OP_breg24:
26802 case DW_OP_breg25:
26803 case DW_OP_breg26:
26804 case DW_OP_breg27:
26805 case DW_OP_breg28:
26806 case DW_OP_breg29:
26807 case DW_OP_breg30:
26808 case DW_OP_breg31:
26809 case DW_OP_regx:
26810 case DW_OP_fbreg:
26811 case DW_OP_piece:
26812 case DW_OP_deref_size:
26813 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
26814 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
26815 break;
26816 case DW_OP_skip:
26817 case DW_OP_bra:
26819 int offset;
26821 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
26822 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
26823 hstate.add_object (offset);
26825 break;
26826 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
26827 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_unsigned);
26828 switch (val2->val_class)
26830 case dw_val_class_const:
26831 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
26832 break;
26833 case dw_val_class_vec:
26835 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
26836 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
26838 hstate.add_int (elt_size);
26839 hstate.add_int (len);
26840 hstate.add (val2->v.val_vec.array, len * elt_size);
26842 break;
26843 case dw_val_class_const_double:
26844 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.low);
26845 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.high);
26846 break;
26847 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
26848 hstate.add (val2->v.val_wide->get_val (),
26849 get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide)
26850 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
26851 break;
26852 case dw_val_class_addr:
26853 inchash::add_rtx (val2->v.val_addr, hstate);
26854 break;
26855 default:
26856 gcc_unreachable ();
26858 break;
26859 case DW_OP_bregx:
26860 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
26861 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
26862 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
26863 break;
26864 case DW_OP_addr:
26865 hash_addr:
26866 if (loc->dtprel)
26868 unsigned char dtprel = 0xd1;
26869 hstate.add_object (dtprel);
26871 inchash::add_rtx (val1->v.val_addr, hstate);
26872 break;
26873 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
26874 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
26876 if (loc->dtprel)
26878 unsigned char dtprel = 0xd1;
26879 hstate.add_object (dtprel);
26881 inchash::add_rtx (val1->val_entry->addr.rtl, hstate);
26883 break;
26884 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
26885 hstate.add_int (val2->v.val_int);
26886 break;
26887 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
26888 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_loc);
26889 break;
26890 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
26891 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
26893 unsigned int byte_size
26894 = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
26895 unsigned int encoding
26896 = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
26897 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
26898 hstate.add_object (byte_size);
26899 hstate.add_object (encoding);
26901 break;
26902 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
26903 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
26904 if (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
26906 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_unsigned);
26907 break;
26909 /* FALLTHRU */
26910 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
26912 unsigned int byte_size
26913 = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
26914 unsigned int encoding
26915 = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
26916 hstate.add_object (byte_size);
26917 hstate.add_object (encoding);
26918 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_GNU_const_type)
26919 break;
26920 hstate.add_object (val2->val_class);
26921 switch (val2->val_class)
26923 case dw_val_class_const:
26924 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
26925 break;
26926 case dw_val_class_vec:
26928 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
26929 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
26931 hstate.add_object (elt_size);
26932 hstate.add_object (len);
26933 hstate.add (val2->v.val_vec.array, len * elt_size);
26935 break;
26936 case dw_val_class_const_double:
26937 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.low);
26938 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.high);
26939 break;
26940 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
26941 hstate.add (val2->v.val_wide->get_val (),
26942 get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide)
26943 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
26944 break;
26945 default:
26946 gcc_unreachable ();
26949 break;
26951 default:
26952 /* Other codes have no operands. */
26953 break;
26957 /* Iteratively hash the whole DWARF location expression LOC into HSTATE. */
26959 static inline void
26960 hash_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, inchash::hash &hstate)
26962 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
26963 bool sizes_computed = false;
26964 /* Compute sizes, so that DW_OP_skip/DW_OP_bra can be checksummed. */
26965 size_of_locs (loc);
26967 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
26969 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = l->dw_loc_opc;
26970 hstate.add_object (opc);
26971 if ((opc == DW_OP_skip || opc == DW_OP_bra) && !sizes_computed)
26973 size_of_locs (loc);
26974 sizes_computed = true;
26976 hash_loc_operands (l, hstate);
26980 /* Compute hash of the whole location list LIST_HEAD. */
26982 static inline void
26983 hash_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
26985 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
26986 inchash::hash hstate;
26988 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
26990 hstate.add (curr->begin, strlen (curr->begin) + 1);
26991 hstate.add (curr->end, strlen (curr->end) + 1);
26992 if (curr->section)
26993 hstate.add (curr->section, strlen (curr->section) + 1);
26994 hash_locs (curr->expr, hstate);
26996 list_head->hash = hstate.end ();
26999 /* Return true if X and Y opcodes have the same operands. */
27001 static inline bool
27002 compare_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
27004 dw_val_ref valx1 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd1;
27005 dw_val_ref valx2 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd2;
27006 dw_val_ref valy1 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd1;
27007 dw_val_ref valy2 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd2;
27009 switch (x->dw_loc_opc)
27011 case DW_OP_const4u:
27012 case DW_OP_const8u:
27013 if (x->dtprel)
27014 goto hash_addr;
27015 /* FALLTHRU */
27016 case DW_OP_const1u:
27017 case DW_OP_const1s:
27018 case DW_OP_const2u:
27019 case DW_OP_const2s:
27020 case DW_OP_const4s:
27021 case DW_OP_const8s:
27022 case DW_OP_constu:
27023 case DW_OP_consts:
27024 case DW_OP_pick:
27025 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
27026 case DW_OP_breg0:
27027 case DW_OP_breg1:
27028 case DW_OP_breg2:
27029 case DW_OP_breg3:
27030 case DW_OP_breg4:
27031 case DW_OP_breg5:
27032 case DW_OP_breg6:
27033 case DW_OP_breg7:
27034 case DW_OP_breg8:
27035 case DW_OP_breg9:
27036 case DW_OP_breg10:
27037 case DW_OP_breg11:
27038 case DW_OP_breg12:
27039 case DW_OP_breg13:
27040 case DW_OP_breg14:
27041 case DW_OP_breg15:
27042 case DW_OP_breg16:
27043 case DW_OP_breg17:
27044 case DW_OP_breg18:
27045 case DW_OP_breg19:
27046 case DW_OP_breg20:
27047 case DW_OP_breg21:
27048 case DW_OP_breg22:
27049 case DW_OP_breg23:
27050 case DW_OP_breg24:
27051 case DW_OP_breg25:
27052 case DW_OP_breg26:
27053 case DW_OP_breg27:
27054 case DW_OP_breg28:
27055 case DW_OP_breg29:
27056 case DW_OP_breg30:
27057 case DW_OP_breg31:
27058 case DW_OP_regx:
27059 case DW_OP_fbreg:
27060 case DW_OP_piece:
27061 case DW_OP_deref_size:
27062 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
27063 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int;
27064 case DW_OP_skip:
27065 case DW_OP_bra:
27066 /* If splitting debug info, the use of DW_OP_GNU_addr_index
27067 can cause irrelevant differences in dw_loc_addr. */
27068 gcc_assert (valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
27069 && valy1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
27070 && (dwarf_split_debug_info
27071 || x->dw_loc_addr == y->dw_loc_addr));
27072 return valx1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr == valy1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr;
27073 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
27074 if (valx1->v.val_unsigned != valy1->v.val_unsigned
27075 || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
27076 return false;
27077 switch (valx2->val_class)
27079 case dw_val_class_const:
27080 return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
27081 case dw_val_class_vec:
27082 return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
27083 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
27084 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
27085 valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
27086 * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
27087 case dw_val_class_const_double:
27088 return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
27089 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
27090 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
27091 return *valx2->v.val_wide == *valy2->v.val_wide;
27092 case dw_val_class_addr:
27093 return rtx_equal_p (valx2->v.val_addr, valy2->v.val_addr);
27094 default:
27095 gcc_unreachable ();
27097 case DW_OP_bregx:
27098 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
27099 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
27100 && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
27101 case DW_OP_addr:
27102 hash_addr:
27103 return rtx_equal_p (valx1->v.val_addr, valy1->v.val_addr);
27104 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
27105 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
27107 rtx ax1 = valx1->val_entry->addr.rtl;
27108 rtx ay1 = valy1->val_entry->addr.rtl;
27109 return rtx_equal_p (ax1, ay1);
27111 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
27112 return valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref
27113 && valx1->val_class == valy1->val_class
27114 && valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
27115 && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
27116 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
27117 return compare_loc_operands (valx1->v.val_loc, valy1->v.val_loc);
27118 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
27119 if (valx1->v.val_die_ref.die != valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
27120 || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
27121 return false;
27122 switch (valx2->val_class)
27124 case dw_val_class_const:
27125 return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
27126 case dw_val_class_vec:
27127 return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
27128 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
27129 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
27130 valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
27131 * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
27132 case dw_val_class_const_double:
27133 return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
27134 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
27135 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
27136 return *valx2->v.val_wide == *valy2->v.val_wide;
27137 default:
27138 gcc_unreachable ();
27140 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
27141 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
27142 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
27143 && valx2->v.val_die_ref.die == valy2->v.val_die_ref.die;
27144 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
27145 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
27146 if (valx1->val_class != valy1->val_class)
27147 return false;
27148 if (valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
27149 return valx1->v.val_unsigned == valy1->v.val_unsigned;
27150 return valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die;
27151 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
27152 return valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref
27153 && valx1->val_class == valy1->val_class
27154 && valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die;
27155 default:
27156 /* Other codes have no operands. */
27157 return true;
27161 /* Return true if DWARF location expressions X and Y are the same. */
27163 static inline bool
27164 compare_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
27166 for (; x != NULL && y != NULL; x = x->dw_loc_next, y = y->dw_loc_next)
27167 if (x->dw_loc_opc != y->dw_loc_opc
27168 || x->dtprel != y->dtprel
27169 || !compare_loc_operands (x, y))
27170 break;
27171 return x == NULL && y == NULL;
27174 /* Hashtable helpers. */
27176 struct loc_list_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <dw_loc_list_struct>
27178 static inline hashval_t hash (const dw_loc_list_struct *);
27179 static inline bool equal (const dw_loc_list_struct *,
27180 const dw_loc_list_struct *);
27183 /* Return precomputed hash of location list X. */
27185 inline hashval_t
27186 loc_list_hasher::hash (const dw_loc_list_struct *x)
27188 return x->hash;
27191 /* Return true if location lists A and B are the same. */
27193 inline bool
27194 loc_list_hasher::equal (const dw_loc_list_struct *a,
27195 const dw_loc_list_struct *b)
27197 if (a == b)
27198 return 1;
27199 if (a->hash != b->hash)
27200 return 0;
27201 for (; a != NULL && b != NULL; a = a->dw_loc_next, b = b->dw_loc_next)
27202 if (strcmp (a->begin, b->begin) != 0
27203 || strcmp (a->end, b->end) != 0
27204 || (a->section == NULL) != (b->section == NULL)
27205 || (a->section && strcmp (a->section, b->section) != 0)
27206 || !compare_locs (a->expr, b->expr))
27207 break;
27208 return a == NULL && b == NULL;
27211 typedef hash_table<loc_list_hasher> loc_list_hash_type;
27214 /* Recursively optimize location lists referenced from DIE
27215 children and share them whenever possible. */
27217 static void
27218 optimize_location_lists_1 (dw_die_ref die, loc_list_hash_type *htab)
27220 dw_die_ref c;
27221 dw_attr_node *a;
27222 unsigned ix;
27223 dw_loc_list_struct **slot;
27225 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
27226 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
27228 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
27229 /* TODO: perform some optimizations here, before hashing
27230 it and storing into the hash table. */
27231 hash_loc_list (list);
27232 slot = htab->find_slot_with_hash (list, list->hash, INSERT);
27233 if (*slot == NULL)
27234 *slot = list;
27235 else
27236 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = *slot;
27239 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, optimize_location_lists_1 (c, htab));
27243 /* Recursively assign each location list a unique index into the debug_addr
27244 section. */
27246 static void
27247 index_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
27249 dw_die_ref c;
27250 dw_attr_node *a;
27251 unsigned ix;
27253 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
27254 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
27256 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
27257 dw_loc_list_ref curr;
27258 for (curr = list; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
27260 /* Don't index an entry that has already been indexed
27261 or won't be output. */
27262 if (curr->begin_entry != NULL
27263 || (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0 && !curr->force))
27264 continue;
27266 curr->begin_entry
27267 = add_addr_table_entry (xstrdup (curr->begin),
27268 ate_kind_label);
27272 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, index_location_lists (c));
27275 /* Optimize location lists referenced from DIE
27276 children and share them whenever possible. */
27278 static void
27279 optimize_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
27281 loc_list_hash_type htab (500);
27282 optimize_location_lists_1 (die, &htab);
27285 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
27286 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
27287 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
27288 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
27289 instance. */
27291 static void
27292 flush_limbo_die_list (void)
27294 limbo_die_node *node;
27296 /* get_context_die calls force_decl_die, which can put new DIEs on the
27297 limbo list in LTO mode when nested functions are put in a different
27298 partition than that of their parent function. */
27299 while ((node = limbo_die_list))
27301 dw_die_ref die = node->die;
27302 limbo_die_list = node->next;
27304 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
27306 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
27308 if (origin && origin->die_parent)
27309 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
27310 else if (is_cu_die (die))
27312 else if (seen_error ())
27313 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
27314 add_child_die (comp_unit_die (), die);
27315 else
27317 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
27318 nested function can be optimized away, which results
27319 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
27320 with the return type of that nested function. Force
27321 this to be a child of the containing function.
27323 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
27324 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
27325 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
27326 the function is likely unreachable too. */
27327 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
27329 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
27330 origin = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for));
27331 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
27332 origin = scope_die_for (node->created_for, comp_unit_die ());
27333 else
27334 origin = comp_unit_die ();
27336 add_child_die (origin, die);
27342 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
27343 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
27345 static void
27346 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
27348 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
27349 dw_die_ref main_comp_unit_die;
27351 /* Flush out any latecomers to the limbo party. */
27352 flush_limbo_die_list ();
27354 /* We shouldn't have any symbols with delayed asm names for
27355 DIEs generated after early finish. */
27356 gcc_assert (deferred_asm_name == NULL);
27358 /* PCH might result in DW_AT_producer string being restored from the
27359 header compilation, so always fill it with empty string initially
27360 and overwrite only here. */
27361 dw_attr_node *producer = get_AT (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_producer);
27362 producer_string = gen_producer_string ();
27363 producer->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
27364 producer->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = find_AT_string (producer_string);
27366 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
27368 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
27369 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH.
27370 For LTO produced units use a fixed artificial name to avoid
27371 leaking tempfile names into the dwarf. */
27372 if (!in_lto_p)
27373 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die (), remap_debug_filename (filename));
27374 else
27375 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die (), "<artificial>");
27376 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename) || targetm.force_at_comp_dir)
27377 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die ());
27378 else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
27380 bool p = false;
27381 file_table->traverse<bool *, file_table_relative_p> (&p);
27382 if (p)
27383 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die ());
27386 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
27388 dw_die_ref die = comp_unit_die (), c;
27389 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, gcc_assert (! c->die_mark));
27391 #endif
27392 resolve_addr (comp_unit_die ());
27393 move_marked_base_types ();
27395 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
27396 prune_unused_types ();
27398 /* Generate separate COMDAT sections for type DIEs. */
27399 if (use_debug_types)
27401 break_out_comdat_types (comp_unit_die ());
27403 /* Each new type_unit DIE was added to the limbo die list when created.
27404 Since these have all been added to comdat_type_list, clear the
27405 limbo die list. */
27406 limbo_die_list = NULL;
27408 /* For each new comdat type unit, copy declarations for incomplete
27409 types to make the new unit self-contained (i.e., no direct
27410 references to the main compile unit). */
27411 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
27412 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (ctnode->root_die);
27413 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (comp_unit_die ());
27415 /* In the process of copying declarations from one unit to another,
27416 we may have left some declarations behind that are no longer
27417 referenced. Prune them. */
27418 prune_unused_types ();
27421 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
27422 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
27423 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
27424 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die ());
27426 /* Traverse the DIE's and add sibling attributes to those DIE's that
27427 have children. */
27428 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die ());
27429 limbo_die_node *node;
27430 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
27431 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
27432 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
27433 add_sibling_attributes (ctnode->root_die);
27435 /* When splitting DWARF info, we put some attributes in the
27436 skeleton compile_unit DIE that remains in the .o, while
27437 most attributes go in the DWO compile_unit_die. */
27438 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
27439 main_comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
27440 else
27441 main_comp_unit_die = comp_unit_die ();
27443 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
27444 switch_to_section (text_section);
27445 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
27446 if (cold_text_section)
27448 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
27449 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
27452 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
27453 in .text. */
27454 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
27455 || (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict))
27457 /* Don't add if the CU has no associated code. */
27458 if (text_section_used)
27459 add_AT_low_high_pc (main_comp_unit_die, text_section_label,
27460 text_end_label, true);
27462 else
27464 unsigned fde_idx;
27465 dw_fde_ref fde;
27466 bool range_list_added = false;
27468 if (text_section_used)
27469 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, text_section_label,
27470 text_end_label, &range_list_added, true);
27471 if (cold_text_section_used)
27472 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, cold_text_section_label,
27473 cold_end_label, &range_list_added, true);
27475 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
27477 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
27478 continue;
27479 if (!fde->in_std_section)
27480 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
27481 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added,
27482 true);
27483 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
27484 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
27485 fde->dw_fde_second_end, &range_list_added,
27486 true);
27489 if (range_list_added)
27491 /* We need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
27492 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become
27493 absolute. Historically, we've emitted the unexpected
27494 DW_AT_entry_pc instead of DW_AT_low_pc for this purpose.
27495 Emit both to give time for other tools to adapt. */
27496 add_AT_addr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, const0_rtx, true);
27497 if (! dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 4)
27498 add_AT_addr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx, true);
27500 add_ranges (NULL);
27504 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
27505 add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
27506 debug_line_section_label);
27508 if (have_macinfo)
27509 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die (),
27510 dwarf_strict ? DW_AT_macro_info : DW_AT_GNU_macros,
27511 macinfo_section_label);
27513 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
27515 /* optimize_location_lists calculates the size of the lists,
27516 so index them first, and assign indices to the entries.
27517 Although optimize_location_lists will remove entries from
27518 the table, it only does so for duplicates, and therefore
27519 only reduces ref_counts to 1. */
27520 index_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
27522 if (addr_index_table != NULL)
27524 unsigned int index = 0;
27525 addr_index_table
27526 ->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, index_addr_table_entry>
27527 (&index);
27531 if (have_location_lists)
27532 optimize_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
27534 save_macinfo_strings ();
27536 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
27538 unsigned int index = 0;
27540 /* Add attributes common to skeleton compile_units and
27541 type_units. Because these attributes include strings, it
27542 must be done before freezing the string table. Top-level
27543 skeleton die attrs are added when the skeleton type unit is
27544 created, so ensure it is created by this point. */
27545 add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs (main_comp_unit_die);
27546 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, index_string> (&index);
27549 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
27550 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
27551 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
27552 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
27554 hash_table<comdat_type_hasher> comdat_type_table (100);
27555 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
27557 comdat_type_node **slot = comdat_type_table.find_slot (ctnode, INSERT);
27559 /* Don't output duplicate types. */
27560 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
27561 continue;
27563 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
27564 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
27565 attributes. */
27566 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
27567 add_AT_lineptr (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
27568 (!dwarf_split_debug_info
27569 ? debug_line_section_label
27570 : debug_skeleton_line_section_label));
27572 output_comdat_type_unit (ctnode);
27573 *slot = ctnode;
27576 /* The AT_pubnames attribute needs to go in all skeleton dies, including
27577 both the main_cu and all skeleton TUs. Making this call unconditional
27578 would end up either adding a second copy of the AT_pubnames attribute, or
27579 requiring a special case in add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs. */
27580 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
27581 add_AT_pubnames (comp_unit_die ());
27583 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
27585 int mark;
27586 unsigned char checksum[16];
27587 struct md5_ctx ctx;
27589 /* Compute a checksum of the comp_unit to use as the dwo_id. */
27590 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
27591 mark = 0;
27592 die_checksum (comp_unit_die (), &ctx, &mark);
27593 unmark_all_dies (comp_unit_die ());
27594 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
27596 /* Use the first 8 bytes of the checksum as the dwo_id,
27597 and add it to both comp-unit DIEs. */
27598 add_AT_data8 (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_GNU_dwo_id, checksum);
27599 add_AT_data8 (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_GNU_dwo_id, checksum);
27601 /* Add the base offset of the ranges table to the skeleton
27602 comp-unit DIE. */
27603 if (ranges_table_in_use)
27604 add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_GNU_ranges_base,
27605 ranges_section_label);
27607 switch_to_section (debug_addr_section);
27608 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_addr_section_label);
27609 output_addr_table ();
27612 /* Output the main compilation unit if non-empty or if .debug_macinfo
27613 or .debug_macro will be emitted. */
27614 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die (), have_macinfo);
27616 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && info_section_emitted)
27617 output_skeleton_debug_sections (main_comp_unit_die);
27619 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
27620 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use != 1)
27622 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
27623 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
27624 output_abbrev_section ();
27627 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
27628 if (have_location_lists)
27630 /* Output the location lists info. */
27631 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
27632 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
27633 output_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
27636 output_pubtables ();
27638 /* Output the address range information if a CU (.debug_info section)
27639 was emitted. We output an empty table even if we had no functions
27640 to put in it. This because the consumer has no way to tell the
27641 difference between an empty table that we omitted and failure to
27642 generate a table that would have contained data. */
27643 if (info_section_emitted)
27645 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
27646 output_aranges ();
27649 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
27650 if (ranges_table_in_use)
27652 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
27653 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
27654 output_ranges ();
27657 /* Have to end the macro section. */
27658 if (have_macinfo)
27660 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
27661 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
27662 output_macinfo ();
27663 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
27666 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
27667 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
27668 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
27669 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
27670 examining the file. This is done late so that any filenames
27671 used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'. */
27672 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
27673 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
27674 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
27675 output_line_info (false);
27677 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && info_section_emitted)
27679 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_line_section);
27680 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_line_section_label);
27681 output_line_info (true);
27684 /* If we emitted any indirect strings, output the string table too. */
27685 if (debug_str_hash || skeleton_debug_str_hash)
27686 output_indirect_strings ();
27689 /* Perform any cleanups needed after the early debug generation pass
27690 has run. */
27692 static void
27693 dwarf2out_early_finish (void)
27695 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
27696 emit full debugging info for them. */
27697 retry_incomplete_types ();
27699 /* The point here is to flush out the limbo list so that it is empty
27700 and we don't need to stream it for LTO. */
27701 flush_limbo_die_list ();
27703 gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies ();
27704 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
27706 /* Add DW_AT_linkage_name for all deferred DIEs. */
27707 for (limbo_die_node *node = deferred_asm_name; node; node = node->next)
27709 tree decl = node->created_for;
27710 if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
27711 /* A missing DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME can be a constant DIE that
27712 ended up in deferred_asm_name before we knew it was
27713 constant and never written to disk. */
27714 && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl))
27716 add_linkage_attr (node->die, decl);
27717 move_linkage_attr (node->die);
27720 deferred_asm_name = NULL;
27723 /* Reset all state within dwarf2out.c so that we can rerun the compiler
27724 within the same process. For use by toplev::finalize. */
27726 void
27727 dwarf2out_c_finalize (void)
27729 last_var_location_insn = NULL;
27730 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
27731 used_rtx_array = NULL;
27732 incomplete_types = NULL;
27733 decl_scope_table = NULL;
27734 debug_info_section = NULL;
27735 debug_skeleton_info_section = NULL;
27736 debug_abbrev_section = NULL;
27737 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section = NULL;
27738 debug_aranges_section = NULL;
27739 debug_addr_section = NULL;
27740 debug_macinfo_section = NULL;
27741 debug_line_section = NULL;
27742 debug_skeleton_line_section = NULL;
27743 debug_loc_section = NULL;
27744 debug_pubnames_section = NULL;
27745 debug_pubtypes_section = NULL;
27746 debug_str_section = NULL;
27747 debug_str_dwo_section = NULL;
27748 debug_str_offsets_section = NULL;
27749 debug_ranges_section = NULL;
27750 debug_frame_section = NULL;
27751 fde_vec = NULL;
27752 debug_str_hash = NULL;
27753 skeleton_debug_str_hash = NULL;
27754 dw2_string_counter = 0;
27755 have_multiple_function_sections = false;
27756 text_section_used = false;
27757 cold_text_section_used = false;
27758 cold_text_section = NULL;
27759 current_unit_personality = NULL;
27761 next_die_offset = 0;
27762 single_comp_unit_die = NULL;
27763 comdat_type_list = NULL;
27764 limbo_die_list = NULL;
27765 file_table = NULL;
27766 decl_die_table = NULL;
27767 common_block_die_table = NULL;
27768 decl_loc_table = NULL;
27769 call_arg_locations = NULL;
27770 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
27771 call_site_count = -1;
27772 tail_call_site_count = -1;
27773 cached_dw_loc_list_table = NULL;
27774 abbrev_die_table = NULL;
27775 abbrev_die_table_allocated = 0;
27776 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 0;
27777 delete dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map;
27778 dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map = NULL;
27779 line_info_label_num = 0;
27780 cur_line_info_table = NULL;
27781 text_section_line_info = NULL;
27782 cold_text_section_line_info = NULL;
27783 separate_line_info = NULL;
27784 info_section_emitted = false;
27785 pubname_table = NULL;
27786 pubtype_table = NULL;
27787 macinfo_table = NULL;
27788 ranges_table = NULL;
27789 ranges_table_allocated = 0;
27790 ranges_table_in_use = 0;
27791 ranges_by_label = 0;
27792 ranges_by_label_allocated = 0;
27793 ranges_by_label_in_use = 0;
27794 have_location_lists = false;
27795 loclabel_num = 0;
27796 poc_label_num = 0;
27797 last_emitted_file = NULL;
27798 label_num = 0;
27799 tmpl_value_parm_die_table = NULL;
27800 generic_type_instances = NULL;
27801 frame_pointer_fb_offset = 0;
27802 frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid = false;
27803 base_types.release ();
27804 XDELETEVEC (producer_string);
27805 producer_string = NULL;
27808 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"